Xlib − C Language X Interface

X Window System Standard

X Version 11, Release 7

libX11 1.3.1

James Gettys
Cambridge Research Laboratory Digital Equipment Corporation

Robert W. Scheifler
Laboratory for Computer Science Massachusetts Institute of Technology

with contributions from

Chuck Adams, Tektronix, Inc.

Vania Joloboff, Open Software Foundation

Hideki Hiura, Sun Microsystems, Inc.

Bill McMahon, Hewlett-Packard Company

Ron Newman, Massachusetts Institute of Technology

Al Tabayoyon, Tektronix, Inc.

Glenn Widener, Tektronix, Inc.

Shigeru Yamada, Fujitsu OSSI

The X Window System is a trademark of The Open Group.

TekHVC is a trademark of Tektronix, Inc.

Copyright © 1985, 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1994, 1996, 2002 The Open Group

Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:

The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE X CONSORTIUM BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.

Except as contained in this notice, the name of The Open Group shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from The Open Group.

Copyright © 1985, 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991 by Digital Equipment Corporation

Portions Copyright © 1990, 1991 by Tektronix, Inc.

Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice appears in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies, and that the names of Digital and Tektronix not be used in in advertising or publicity pertaining to this documentation without specific, written prior permission. Digital and Tektronix makes no representations about the suitability of this documentation for any purpose. It is provided ‘‘as is’’ without express or implied warranty.

Acknowledgments

The design and implementation of the first 10 versions of X were primarily the work of three individuals: Robert Scheifler of the MIT Laboratory for Computer Science and Jim Gettys of Digital Equipment Corporation and Ron Newman of MIT, both at MIT Project Athena. X version 11, however, is the result of the efforts of dozens of individuals at almost as many locations and organizations. At the risk of offending some of the players by exclusion, we would like to acknowledge some of the people who deserve special credit and recognition for their work on Xlib. Our apologies to anyone inadvertently overlooked.

Release 1

Our thanks does to Ron Newman (MIT Project Athena), who contributed substantially to the design and implementation of the Version 11 Xlib interface.

Our thanks also goes to Ralph Swick (Project Athena and Digital) who kept it all together for us during the early releases. He handled literally thousands of requests from people everywhere and saved the sanity of at least one of us. His calm good cheer was a foundation on which we could build.

Our thanks also goes to Todd Brunhoff (Tektronix) who was ‘‘loaned’’ to Project Athena at exactly the right moment to provide very capable and much-needed assistance during the alpha and beta releases. He was responsible for the successful integration of sources from multiple sites; we would not have had a release without him.

Our thanks also goes to Al Mento and Al Wojtas of Digital’s ULTRIX Documentation Group. With good humor and cheer, they took a rough draft and made it an infinitely better and more useful document. The work they have done will help many everywhere. We also would like to thank Hal Murray (Digital SRC) and Peter George (Digital VMS) who contributed much by proofreading the early drafts of this document.

Our thanks also goes to Jeff Dike (Digital UEG), Tom Benson, Jackie Granfield, and Vince Orgovan (Digital VMS) who helped with the library utilities implementation; to Hania Gajewska (Digital UEG-WSL) who, along with Ellis Cohen (CMU and Siemens), was instrumental in the semantic design of the window manager properties; and to Dave Rosenthal (Sun Microsystems) who also contributed to the protocol and provided the sample generic color frame buffer device-dependent code.

The alpha and beta test participants deserve special recognition and thanks as well. It is significant that the bug reports (and many fixes) during alpha and beta test came almost exclusively from just a few of the alpha testers, mostly hardware vendors working on product implementations of X. The continued public contribution of vendors and universities is certainly to the benefit of the entire X community.

Our special thanks must go to Sam Fuller, Vice-President of Corporate Research at Digital, who has remained committed to the widest public availability of X and who made it possible to greatly supplement MIT’s resources with the Digital staff in order to make version 11 a reality. Many of the people mentioned here are part of the Western Software Laboratory (Digital UEG-WSL) of the ULTRIX Engineering group and work for Smokey Wallace, who has been vital to the project’s success. Others not mentioned here worked on the toolkit and are acknowledged in the X Toolkit documentation.

Of course, we must particularly thank Paul Asente, formerly of Stanford University and now of Digital UEG-WSL, who wrote W, the predecessor to X, and Brian Reid, formerly of Stanford University and now of Digital WRL, who had much to do with W’s design.

Finally, our thanks goes to MIT, Digital Equipment Corporation, and IBM for providing the environment where it could happen.

Release 4

Our thanks go to Jim Fulton (MIT X Consortium) for designing and specifying the new Xlib functions for Inter-Client Communication Conventions (ICCCM) support.

We also thank Al Mento of Digital for his continued effort in maintaining this document and Jim Fulton and Donna Converse (MIT X Consortium) for their much-appreciated efforts in reviewing the changes.

Release 5

The principal authors of the Input Method facilities are Vania Joloboff (Open Software Foundation) and Bill McMahon (Hewlett-Packard). The principal author of the rest of the internationalization facilities is Glenn Widener (Tektronix). Our thanks to them for keeping their sense of humor through a long and sometimes difficult design process. Although the words and much of the design are due to them, many others have contributed substantially to the design and implementation. Tom McFarland (HP) and Frank Rojas (IBM) deserve particular recognition for their contributions. Other contributors were: Tim Anderson (Motorola), Alka Badshah (OSF), Gabe Beged-Dov (HP), Chih-Chung Ko (III), Vera Cheng (III), Michael Collins (Digital), Walt Daniels (IBM), Noritoshi Demizu (OMRON), Keisuke Fukui (Fujitsu), Hitoshoi Fukumoto (Nihon Sun), Tim Greenwood (Digital), John Harvey (IBM), Hideki Hiura (Sun), Fred Horman (AT&T), Norikazu Kaiya (Fujitsu), Yuji Kamata (IBM), Yutaka Kataoka (Waseda University), Ranee Khubchandani (Sun), Akira Kon (NEC), Hiroshi Kuribayashi (OMRON), Teruhiko Kurosaka (Sun), Seiji Kuwari (OMRON), Sandra Martin (OSF), Narita Masahiko (Fujitsu), Masato Morisaki (NTT), Nelson Ng (Sun), Takashi Nishimura (NTT America), Makato Nishino (IBM), Akira Ohsone (Nihon Sun), Chris Peterson (MIT), Sam Shteingart (AT&T), Manish Sheth (AT&T), Muneiyoshi Suzuki (NTT), Cori Mehring (Digital), Shoji Sugiyama (IBM), and Eiji Tosa (IBM).

We are deeply indebted to Tatsuya Kato (NTT), Hiroshi Kuribayashi (OMRON), Seiji Kuwari (OMRON), Muneiyoshi Suzuki (NTT), and Li Yuhong (OMRON) for producing one of the first complete sample implementation of the internationalization facilities, and Hiromu Inukai (Nihon Sun), Takashi Fujiwara (Fujitsu), Hideki Hiura (Sun), Yasuhiro Kawai (Oki Technosystems Laboratory), Kazunori Nishihara (Fuji Xerox), Masaki Takeuchi (Sony), Katsuhisa Yano (Toshiba), Makoto Wakamatsu (Sony Corporation) for producing the another complete sample implementation of the internationalization facilities.

The principal authors (design and implementation) of the Xcms color management facilities are Al Tabayoyon (Tektronix) and Chuck Adams (Tektronix). Joann Taylor (Tektronix), Bob Toole (Tektronix), and Keith Packard (MIT X Consortium) also contributed significantly to the design. Others who contributed are: Harold Boll (Kodak), Ken Bronstein (HP), Nancy Cam (SGI), Donna Converse (MIT X Consortium), Elias Israel (ISC), Deron Johnson (Sun), Jim King (Adobe), Ricardo Motta (HP), Chuck Peek (IBM), Wil Plouffe (IBM), Dave Sternlicht (MIT X Consortium), Kumar Talluri (AT&T), and Richard Verberg (IBM).

We also once again thank Al Mento of Digital for his work in formatting and reformatting text for this manual, and for producing man pages. Thanks also to Clive Feather (IXI) for proof-reading and finding a number of small errors.

Release 6

Stephen Gildea (X Consortium) authored the threads support. Ovais Ashraf (Sun) and Greg Olsen (Sun) contributed substantially by testing the facilities and reporting bugs in a timely fashion.

The principal authors of the internationalization facilities, including Input and Output Methods, are Hideki Hiura (SunSoft) and Shigeru Yamada (Fujitsu OSSI). Although the words and much of the design are due to them, many others have contributed substantially to the design and implementation. They are: Takashi Fujiwara (Fujitsu), Yoshio Horiuchi (IBM), Makoto Inada (Digital), Hiromu Inukai (Nihon SunSoft), Song JaeKyung (KAIST), Franky Ling (Digital), Tom McFarland (HP), Hiroyuki Miyamoto (Digital), Masahiko Narita (Fujitsu), Frank Rojas (IBM), Hidetoshi Tajima (HP), Masaki Takeuchi (Sony), Makoto Wakamatsu (Sony), Masaki Wakao (IBM), Katsuhisa Yano(Toshiba) and Jinsoo Yoon (KAIST).

The principal producers of the sample implementation of the internationalization facilities are: Jeffrey Bloomfield (Fujitsu OSSI), Takashi Fujiwara (Fujitsu), Hideki Hiura (SunSoft), Yoshio Horiuchi (IBM), Makoto Inada (Digital), Hiromu Inukai (Nihon SunSoft), Song JaeKyung (KAIST), Riki Kawaguchi (Fujitsu), Franky Ling (Digital), Hiroyuki Miyamoto (Digital), Hidetoshi Tajima (HP), Toshimitsu Terazono (Fujitsu), Makoto Wakamatsu (Sony), Masaki Wakao (IBM), Shigeru Yamada (Fujitsu OSSI) and Katsuhisa Yano (Toshiba).

The coordinators of the integration, testing, and release of this implementation of the internationalization facilities are Nobuyuki Tanaka (Sony) and Makoto Wakamatsu (Sony).

Others who have contributed to the architectural design or testing of the sample implementation of the internationalization facilities are: Hector Chan (Digital), Michael Kung (IBM), Joseph Kwok (Digital), Hiroyuki Machida (Sony), Nelson Ng (SunSoft), Frank Rojas (IBM), Yoshiyuki Segawa (Fujitsu OSSI), Makiko Shimamura (Fujitsu), Shoji Sugiyama (IBM), Lining Sun (SGI), Masaki Takeuchi (Sony), Jinsoo Yoon (KAIST) and Akiyasu Zen (HP).

Jim Gettys
Cambridge Research Laboratory
Digital Equipment Corporation

Robert W. Scheifler
Laboratory for Computer Science
Massachusetts Institute of Technology

Chapter 1

Introduction to Xlib

The X Window System is a network-transparent window system that was designed at MIT. X display servers run on computers with either monochrome or color bitmap display hardware. The server distributes user input to and accepts output requests from various client programs located either on the same machine or elsewhere in the network. Xlib is a C subroutine library that application programs (clients) use to interface with the window system by means of a stream connection. Although a client usually runs on the same machine as the X server it is talking to, this need not be the case.

Xlib − C Language X Interface is a reference guide to the low-level C language interface to the X Window System protocol. It is neither a tutorial nor a user’s guide to programming the X Window System. Rather, it provides a detailed description of each function in the library as well as a discussion of the related background information. Xlib − C Language X Interface assumes a basic understanding of a graphics window system and of the C programming language. Other higher-level abstractions (for example, those provided by the toolkits for X) are built on top of the Xlib library. For further information about these higher-level libraries, see the appropriate toolkit documentation. The X Window System Protocol provides the definitive word on the behavior of X. Although additional information appears here, the protocol document is the ruling document.

To provide an introduction to X programming, this chapter discusses:

Overview of the X Window System

Errors

Standard header files

Generic values and types

Naming and argument conventions within Xlib

Programming considerations

Character sets and encodings

Formatting conventions

1.1. Overview of the X Window System

Some of the terms used in this book are unique to X, and other terms that are common to other window systems have different meanings in X. You may find it helpful to refer to the glossary, which is located at the end of the book.

The X Window System supports one or more screens containing overlapping windows or subwindows. A screen is a physical monitor and hardware that can be color, grayscale, or monochrome. There can be multiple screens for each display or workstation. A single X server can provide display services for any number of screens. A set of screens for a single user with one keyboard and one pointer (usually a mouse) is called a display.

All the windows in an X server are arranged in strict hierarchies. At the top of each hierarchy is a root window, which covers each of the display screens. Each root window is partially or completely covered by child windows. All windows, except for root windows, have parents. There is usually at least one window for each application program. Child windows may in turn have their own children. In this way, an application program can create an arbitrarily deep tree on each screen. X provides graphics, text, and raster operations for windows.

A child window can be larger than its parent. That is, part or all of the child window can extend beyond the boundaries of the parent, but all output to a window is clipped by its parent. If several children of a window have overlapping locations, one of the children is considered to be on top of or raised over the others, thus obscuring them. Output to areas covered by other windows is suppressed by the window system unless the window has backing store. If a window is obscured by a second window, the second window obscures only those ancestors of the second window that are also ancestors of the first window.

A window has a border zero or more pixels in width, which can be any pattern (pixmap) or solid color you like. A window usually but not always has a background pattern, which will be repainted by the window system when uncovered. Child windows obscure their parents, and graphic operations in the parent window usually are clipped by the children.

Each window and pixmap has its own coordinate system. The coordinate system has the X axis horizontal and the Y axis vertical with the origin [0, 0] at the upper-left corner. Coordinates are integral, in terms of pixels, and coincide with pixel centers. For a window, the origin is inside the border at the inside, upper-left corner.

X does not guarantee to preserve the contents of windows. When part or all of a window is hidden and then brought back onto the screen, its contents may be lost. The server then sends the client program an Expose event to notify it that part or all of the window needs to be repainted. Programs must be prepared to regenerate the contents of windows on demand.

X also provides off-screen storage of graphics objects, called pixmaps. Single plane (depth 1) pixmaps are sometimes referred to as bitmaps. Pixmaps can be used in most graphics functions interchangeably with windows and are used in various graphics operations to define patterns or tiles. Windows and pixmaps together are referred to as drawables.

Most of the functions in Xlib just add requests to an output buffer. These requests later execute asynchronously on the X server. Functions that return values of information stored in the server do not return (that is, they block) until an explicit reply is received or an error occurs. You can provide an error handler, which will be called when the error is reported.

If a client does not want a request to execute asynchronously, it can follow the request with a call to XSync, which blocks until all previously buffered asynchronous events have been sent and acted on. As an important side effect, the output buffer in Xlib is always flushed by a call to any function that returns a value from the server or waits for input.

Many Xlib functions will return an integer resource ID, which allows you to refer to objects stored on the X server. These can be of type Window, Font, Pixmap, Colormap, Cursor, and GContext, as defined in the file <X11/X.h>. These resources are created by requests and are destroyed (or freed) by requests or when connections are closed. Most of these resources are potentially sharable between applications, and in fact, windows are manipulated explicitly by window manager programs. Fonts and cursors are shared automatically across multiple screens. Fonts are loaded and unloaded as needed and are shared by multiple clients. Fonts are often cached in the server. Xlib provides no support for sharing graphics contexts between applications.

Client programs are informed of events. Events may either be side effects of a request (for example, restacking windows generates Expose events) or completely asynchronous (for example, from the keyboard). A client program asks to be informed of events. Because other applications can send events to your application, programs must be prepared to handle (or ignore) events of all types.

Input events (for example, a key pressed or the pointer moved) arrive asynchronously from the server and are queued until they are requested by an explicit call (for example, XNextEvent or XWindowEvent). In addition, some library functions (for example, XRaiseWindow) generate Expose and ConfigureRequest events. These events also arrive asynchronously, but the client may wish to explicitly wait for them by calling XSync after calling a function that can cause the server to generate events.

1.2. Errors

Some functions return Status, an integer error indication. If the function fails, it returns a zero. If the function returns a status of zero, it has not updated the return arguments. Because C does not provide multiple return values, many functions must return their results by writing into client-passed storage. By default, errors are handled either by a standard library function or by one that you provide. Functions that return pointers to strings return NULL pointers if the string does not exist.

The X server reports protocol errors at the time that it detects them. If more than one error could be generated for a given request, the server can report any of them.

Because Xlib usually does not transmit requests to the server immediately (that is, it buffers them), errors can be reported much later than they actually occur. For debugging purposes, however, Xlib provides a mechanism for forcing synchronous behavior (see section 11.8.1). When synchronization is enabled, errors are reported as they are generated.

When Xlib detects an error, it calls an error handler, which your program can provide. If you do not provide an error handler, the error is printed, and your program terminates.

1.3. Standard Header Files

The following include files are part of the Xlib standard:

<X11/Xlib.h>

This is the main header file for Xlib. The majority of all Xlib symbols are declared by including this file. This file also contains the preprocessor symbol XlibSpecificationRelease. This symbol is defined to have the 6 in this release of the standard. (Release 5 of Xlib was the first release to have this symbol.)

<X11/X.h>

This file declares types and constants for the X protocol that are to be used by applications. It is included automatically from <X11/Xlib.h>, so application code should never need to reference this file directly.

<X11/Xcms.h>

This file contains symbols for much of the color management facilities described in chapter 6. All functions, types, and symbols with the prefix ‘‘Xcms’’, plus the Color Conversion Contexts macros, are declared in this file. <X11/Xlib.h> must be included before including this file.

<X11/Xutil.h>

This file declares various functions, types, and symbols used for inter-client communication and application utility functions, which are described in chapters 14 and 16. <X11/Xlib.h> must be included before including this file.

<X11/Xresource.h>

This file declares all functions, types, and symbols for the resource manager facilities, which are described in chapter 15. <X11/Xlib.h> must be included before including this file.

<X11/Xatom.h>

This file declares all predefined atoms, which are symbols with the prefix ‘‘XA_’’.

<X11/cursorfont.h>

This file declares the cursor symbols for the standard cursor font, which are listed in appendix B. All cursor symbols have the prefix ‘‘XC_’’.

<X11/keysymdef.h>

This file declares all standard KeySym values, which are symbols with the prefix ‘‘XK_’’. The KeySyms are arranged in groups, and a preprocessor symbol controls inclusion of each group. The preprocessor symbol must be defined prior to inclusion of the file to obtain the associated values. The preprocessor symbols are XK_MISCELLANY, XK_XKB_KEYS, XK_3270, XK_LATIN1, XK_LATIN2, XK_LATIN3, XK_LATIN4, XK_KATAKANA, XK_ARABIC, XK_CYRILLIC, XK_GREEK, XK_TECHNICAL, XK_SPECIAL, XK_PUBLISHING, XK_APL, XK_HEBREW, XK_THAI, and XK_KOREAN.

<X11/keysym.h>

This file defines the preprocessor symbols XK_MISCELLANY, XK_XKB_KEYS, XK_LATIN1, XK_LATIN2, XK_LATIN3, XK_LATIN4, and XK_GREEK and then includes <X11/keysymdef.h>.

<X11/Xlibint.h>

This file declares all the functions, types, and symbols used for extensions, which are described in appendix C. This file automatically includes <X11/Xlib.h>.

<X11/Xproto.h>

This file declares types and symbols for the basic X protocol, for use in implementing extensions. It is included automatically from <X11/Xlibint.h>, so application and extension code should never need to reference this file directly.

<X11/Xprotostr.h>

This file declares types and symbols for the basic X protocol, for use in implementing extensions. It is included automatically from <X11/Xproto.h>, so application and extension code should never need to reference this file directly.

<X11/X10.h>

This file declares all the functions, types, and symbols used for the X10 compatibility functions, which are described in appendix D.

1.4. Generic Values and Types

The following symbols are defined by Xlib and used throughout the manual:

Xlib defines the type Bool and the Boolean values True and False.

None is the universal null resource ID or atom.

The type XID is used for generic resource IDs.

The type XPointer is defined to be char* and is used as a generic opaque pointer to data.

1.5. Naming and Argument Conventions within Xlib

Xlib follows a number of conventions for the naming and syntax of the functions. Given that you remember what information the function requires, these conventions are intended to make the syntax of the functions more predictable.

The major naming conventions are:

To differentiate the X symbols from the other symbols, the library uses mixed case for external symbols. It leaves lowercase for variables and all uppercase for user macros, as per existing convention.

All Xlib functions begin with a capital X.

The beginnings of all function names and symbols are capitalized.

All user-visible data structures begin with a capital X. More generally, anything that a user might dereference begins with a capital X.

Macros and other symbols do not begin with a capital X. To distinguish them from all user symbols, each word in the macro is capitalized.

All elements of or variables in a data structure are in lowercase. Compound words, where needed, are constructed with underscores (_).

The display argument, where used, is always first in the argument list.

All resource objects, where used, occur at the beginning of the argument list immediately after the display argument.

When a graphics context is present together with another type of resource (most commonly, a drawable), the graphics context occurs in the argument list after the other resource. Drawables outrank all other resources.

Source arguments always precede the destination arguments in the argument list.

The x argument always precedes the y argument in the argument list.

The width argument always precedes the height argument in the argument list.

Where the x, y, width, and height arguments are used together, the x and y arguments always precede the width and height arguments.

Where a mask is accompanied with a structure, the mask always precedes the pointer to the structure in the argument list.

1.6. Programming Considerations

The major programming considerations are:

Coordinates and sizes in X are actually 16-bit quantities. This decision was made to minimize the bandwidth required for a given level of performance. Coordinates usually are declared as an int in the interface. Values larger than 16 bits are truncated silently. Sizes (width and height) are declared as unsigned quantities.

Keyboards are the greatest variable between different manufacturers’ workstations. If you want your program to be portable, you should be particularly conservative here.

Many display systems have limited amounts of off-screen memory. If you can, you should minimize use of pixmaps and backing store.

The user should have control of his screen real estate. Therefore, you should write your applications to react to window management rather than presume control of the entire screen. What you do inside of your top-level window, however, is up to your application. For further information, see chapter 14 and the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual.

1.7. Character Sets and Encodings

Some of the Xlib functions make reference to specific character sets and character encodings. The following are the most common:

X Portable Character Set

A basic set of 97 characters, which are assumed to exist in all locales supported by Xlib. This set contains the following characters:

a..z A..Z 0..9
!"#$%&’()*+,-./:;<=>?@[\]^_‘{|}~
<space>, <tab>, and <newline>

This set is the left/lower half of the graphic character set of ISO8859-1 plus space, tab, and newline. It is also the set of graphic characters in 7-bit ASCII plus the same three control characters. The actual encoding of these characters on the host is system dependent.

Host Portable Character Encoding

The encoding of the X Portable Character Set on the host. The encoding itself is not defined by this standard, but the encoding must be the same in all locales supported by Xlib on the host. If a string is said to be in the Host Portable Character Encoding, then it only contains characters from the X Portable Character Set, in the host encoding.

Latin-1

The coded character set defined by the ISO8859-1 standard.

Latin Portable Character Encoding

The encoding of the X Portable Character Set using the Latin-1 codepoints plus ASCII control characters. If a string is said to be in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then it only contains characters from the X Portable Character Set, not all of Latin-1.

STRING Encoding

Latin-1, plus tab and newline.

POSIX Portable Filename Character Set

The set of 65 characters, which can be used in naming files on a POSIX-compliant host, that are correctly processed in all locales. The set is:

a..z A..Z 0..9 ._-

1.8. Formatting Conventions

Xlib − C Language X Interface uses the following conventions:

Global symbols are printed in this special font. These can be either function names, symbols defined in include files, or structure names. When declared and defined, function arguments are printed in italics. In the explanatory text that follows, they usually are printed in regular type.

Each function is introduced by a general discussion that distinguishes it from other functions. The function declaration itself follows, and each argument is specifically explained. Although ANSI C function prototype syntax is not used, Xlib header files normally declare functions using function prototypes in ANSI C environments. General discussion of the function, if any is required, follows the arguments. Where applicable, the last paragraph of the explanation lists the possible Xlib error codes that the function can generate. For a complete discussion of the Xlib error codes, see section 11.8.2.

To eliminate any ambiguity between those arguments that you pass and those that a function returns to you, the explanations for all arguments that you pass start with the word specifies or, in the case of multiple arguments, the word specify. The explanations for all arguments that are returned to you start with the word returns or, in the case of multiple arguments, the word return. The explanations for all arguments that you can pass and are returned start with the words specifies and returns.

Any pointer to a structure that is used to return a value is designated as such by the _return suffix as part of its name. All other pointers passed to these functions are used for reading only. A few arguments use pointers to structures that are used for both input and output and are indicated by using the _in_out suffix.

1

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 2

Display Functions

Before your program can use a display, you must establish a connection to the X server. Once you have established a connection, you then can use the Xlib macros and functions discussed in this chapter to return information about the display. This chapter discusses how to:

Open (connect to) the display

Obtain information about the display, image formats, or screens

Generate a NoOperation protocol request

Free client-created data

Close (disconnect from) a display

Use X Server connection close operations

Use Xlib with threads

Use internal connections

2.1. Opening the Display

To open a connection to the X server that controls a display, use XOpenDisplay. __ │

Display *XOpenDisplay(display_name)
char *display_name;

display_name
Specifies the hardware display name, which deter-
mines the display and communications domain to be
used. On a POSIX-conformant system, if the dis-
play_name is NULL, it defaults to the value of the
DISPLAY environment variable. │__

The encoding and interpretation of the display name are implementation-dependent. Strings in the Host Portable Character Encoding are supported; support for other characters is implementation-dependent. On POSIX-conformant systems, the display name or DISPLAY environment variable can be a string in the format: __ │

protocol/hostname:number.screen_number

protocol

Specifies a protocol family or an alias for a protocol family. Supported protocol families are implementation dependent. The protocol entry is optional. If protocol is not specified, the / separating protocol and hostname must also not be specified.

hostname

Specifies the name of the host machine on which the display is physically attached. You follow the hostname with either a single colon (:) or a double colon (::).

number

Specifies the number of the display server on that host machine. You may optionally follow this display number with a period (.). A single CPU can have more than one display. Multiple displays are usually numbered starting with zero.

screen_number
Specifies the screen to be used on that server. Multiple screens can be controlled by a single X server. The screen_number sets an internal variable that can be accessed by using the DefaultScreen macro or the XDefaultScreen function if you are using languages other than C (see section 2.2.1). │__

For example, the following would specify screen 1 of display 0 on the machine named ‘‘dual-headed’’:

dual-headed:0.1

The XOpenDisplay function returns a Display structure that serves as the connection to the X server and that contains all the information about that X server. XOpenDisplay connects your application to the X server through TCP or DECnet communications protocols, or through some local inter-process communication protocol. If the protocol is specified as "tcp", "inet", or "inet6", or if no protocol is specified and the hostname is a host machine name and a single colon (:) separates the hostname and display number, XOpenDisplay connects using TCP streams. (If the protocol is specified as "inet", TCP over IPv4 is used. If the protocol is specified as "inet6", TCP over IPv6 is used. Otherwise, the implementation determines which IP version is used.) If the hostname and protocol are both not specified, Xlib uses whatever it believes is the fastest transport. If the hostname is a host machine name and a double colon (::) separates the hostname and display number, XOpenDisplay connects using DECnet. A single X server can support any or all of these transport mechanisms simultaneously. A particular Xlib implementation can support many more of these transport mechanisms.

If successful, XOpenDisplay returns a pointer to a Display structure, which is defined in <X11/Xlib.h>. If XOpenDisplay does not succeed, it returns NULL. After a successful call to XOpenDisplay, all of the screens in the display can be used by the client. The screen number specified in the display_name argument is returned by the DefaultScreen macro (or the XDefaultScreen function). You can access elements of the Display and Screen structures only by using the information macros or functions. For information about using macros and functions to obtain information from the Display structure, see section 2.2.1.

X servers may implement various types of access control mechanisms (see section 9.8).

2.2. Obtaining Information about the Display, Image Formats, or Screens

The Xlib library provides a number of useful macros and corresponding functions that return data from the Display structure. The macros are used for C programming, and their corresponding function equivalents are for other language bindings. This section discusses the:

• Display macros

• Image format functions and macros

• Screen information macros

All other members of the Display structure (that is, those for which no macros are defined) are private to Xlib and must not be used. Applications must never directly modify or inspect these private members of the Display structure.

Note

The XDisplayWidth, XDisplayHeight, XDisplayCells, XDisplayPlanes, XDisplayWidthMM, and XDisplayHeightMM functions in the next sections are misnamed. These functions really should be named Screenwhatever and XScreenwhatever, not Displaywhatever or XDisplaywhatever. Our apologies for the resulting confusion.

2.2.1. Display Macros

Applications should not directly modify any part of the Display and Screen structures. The members should be considered read-only, although they may change as the result of other operations on the display.

The following lists the C language macros, their corresponding function equivalents that are for other language bindings, and what data both can return. __ │

AllPlanes

unsigned long XAllPlanes() │__

Both return a value with all bits set to 1 suitable for use in a plane argument to a procedure.

Both BlackPixel and WhitePixel can be used in implementing a monochrome application. These pixel values are for permanently allocated entries in the default colormap. The actual RGB (red, green, and blue) values are settable on some screens and, in any case, may not actually be black or white. The names are intended to convey the expected relative intensity of the colors. __ │

BlackPixel(display, screen_number)

unsigned long XBlackPixel(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the black pixel value for the specified screen. __ │

WhitePixel(display, screen_number)

unsigned long XWhitePixel(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the white pixel value for the specified screen. __ │

ConnectionNumber(display)

int XConnectionNumber(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return a connection number for the specified display. On a POSIX-conformant system, this is the file descriptor of the connection. __ │

DefaultColormap(display, screen_number)

Colormap XDefaultColormap(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the default colormap ID for allocation on the specified screen. Most routine allocations of color should be made out of this colormap. __ │

DefaultDepth(display, screen_number)

int XDefaultDepth(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the depth (number of planes) of the default root window for the specified screen. Other depths may also be supported on this screen (see XMatchVisualInfo).

To determine the number of depths that are available on a given screen, use XListDepths. __ │

int *XListDepths(display, screen_number, count_return)
Display *display;
int screen_number;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server.

count_return
Returns the number of depths. │__

The XListDepths function returns the array of depths that are available on the specified screen. If the specified screen_number is valid and sufficient memory for the array can be allocated, XListDepths sets count_return to the number of available depths. Otherwise, it does not set count_return and returns NULL. To release the memory allocated for the array of depths, use XFree. __ │

DefaultGC(display, screen_number)

GC XDefaultGC(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the default graphics context for the root window of the specified screen. This GC is created for the convenience of simple applications and contains the default GC components with the foreground and background pixel values initialized to the black and white pixels for the screen, respectively. You can modify its contents freely because it is not used in any Xlib function. This GC should never be freed. __ │

DefaultRootWindow(display)

Window XDefaultRootWindow(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the root window for the default screen. __ │

DefaultScreenOfDisplay(display)

Screen *XDefaultScreenOfDisplay(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return a pointer to the default screen. __ │

ScreenOfDisplay(display, screen_number)

Screen *XScreenOfDisplay(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return a pointer to the indicated screen. __ │

DefaultScreen(display)

int XDefaultScreen(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the default screen number referenced by the XOpenDisplay function. This macro or function should be used to retrieve the screen number in applications that will use only a single screen. __ │

DefaultVisual(display, screen_number)

Visual *XDefaultVisual(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the default visual type for the specified screen. For further information about visual types, see section 3.1. __ │

DisplayCells(display, screen_number)

int XDisplayCells(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the number of entries in the default colormap. __ │

DisplayPlanes(display, screen_number)

int XDisplayPlanes(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the depth of the root window of the specified screen. For an explanation of depth, see the glossary. __ │

DisplayString(display)

char *XDisplayString(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the string that was passed to XOpenDisplay when the current display was opened. On POSIX-conformant systems, if the passed string was NULL, these return the value of the DISPLAY environment variable when the current display was opened. These are useful to applications that invoke the fork system call and want to open a new connection to the same display from the child process as well as for printing error messages. __ │

long XExtendedMaxRequestSize(display)

Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XExtendedMaxRequestSize function returns zero if the specified display does not support an extended-length protocol encoding; otherwise, it returns the maximum request size (in 4-byte units) supported by the server using the extended-length encoding. The Xlib functions XDrawLines, XDrawArcs, XFillPolygon, XChangeProperty, XSetClipRectangles, and XSetRegion will use the extended-length encoding as necessary, if supported by the server. Use of the extended-length encoding in other Xlib functions (for example, XDrawPoints, XDrawRectangles, XDrawSegments, XFillArcs, XFillRectangles, XPutImage) is permitted but not required; an Xlib implementation may choose to split the data across multiple smaller requests instead. __ │

long XMaxRequestSize(display)

Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XMaxRequestSize function returns the maximum request size (in 4-byte units) supported by the server without using an extended-length protocol encoding. Single protocol requests to the server can be no larger than this size unless an extended-length protocol encoding is supported by the server. The protocol guarantees the size to be no smaller than 4096 units (16384 bytes). Xlib automatically breaks data up into multiple protocol requests as necessary for the following functions: XDrawPoints, XDrawRectangles, XDrawSegments, XFillArcs, XFillRectangles, and XPutImage. __ │

LastKnownRequestProcessed(display)

unsigned long XLastKnownRequestProcessed(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both extract the full serial number of the last request known by Xlib to have been processed by the X server. Xlib automatically sets this number when replies, events, and errors are received. __ │

NextRequest(display)

unsigned long XNextRequest(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both extract the full serial number that is to be used for the next request. Serial numbers are maintained separately for each display connection. __ │

ProtocolVersion(display)

int XProtocolVersion(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the major version number (11) of the X protocol associated with the connected display. __ │

ProtocolRevision(display)

int XProtocolRevision(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the minor protocol revision number of the X server. __ │

QLength(display)

int XQLength(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the length of the event queue for the connected display. Note that there may be more events that have not been read into the queue yet (see XEventsQueued). __ │

RootWindow(display, screen_number)

Window XRootWindow(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the root window. These are useful with functions that need a drawable of a particular screen and for creating top-level windows. __ │

ScreenCount(display)

int XScreenCount(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the number of available screens. __ │

ServerVendor(display)

char *XServerVendor(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return a pointer to a null-terminated string that provides some identification of the owner of the X server implementation. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the string is in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the contents of the string are implementation-dependent. __ │

VendorRelease(display)

int XVendorRelease(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return a number related to a vendor’s release of the X server.

2.2.2. Image Format Functions and Macros

Applications are required to present data to the X server in a format that the server demands. To help simplify applications, most of the work required to convert the data is provided by Xlib (see sections 8.7 and 16.8).

The XPixmapFormatValues structure provides an interface to the pixmap format information that is returned at the time of a connection setup. It contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int depth;

int bits_per_pixel;

int scanline_pad;

} XPixmapFormatValues; │__

To obtain the pixmap format information for a given display, use XListPixmapFormats. __ │

XPixmapFormatValues *XListPixmapFormats(display, count_return)
Display *display;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

count_return
Returns the number of pixmap formats that are sup-
ported by the display. │__

The XListPixmapFormats function returns an array of XPixmapFormatValues structures that describe the types of Z format images supported by the specified display. If insufficient memory is available, XListPixmapFormats returns NULL. To free the allocated storage for the XPixmapFormatValues structures, use XFree.

The following lists the C language macros, their corresponding function equivalents that are for other language bindings, and what data they both return for the specified server and screen. These are often used by toolkits as well as by simple applications. __ │

ImageByteOrder(display)

int XImageByteOrder(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both specify the required byte order for images for each scanline unit in XY format (bitmap) or for each pixel value in Z format. The macro or function can return either LSBFirst or MSBFirst. __ │

BitmapUnit(display)

int XBitmapUnit(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Both return the size of a bitmap’s scanline unit in bits. The scanline is calculated in multiples of this value. __ │

BitmapBitOrder(display)

int XBitmapBitOrder(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Within each bitmap unit, the left-most bit in the bitmap as displayed on the screen is either the least significant or most significant bit in the unit. This macro or function can return LSBFirst or MSBFirst. __ │

BitmapPad(display)

int XBitmapPad(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Each scanline must be padded to a multiple of bits returned by this macro or function. __ │

DisplayHeight(display, screen_number)

int XDisplayHeight(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return an integer that describes the height of the screen in pixels. __ │

DisplayHeightMM(display, screen_number)

int XDisplayHeightMM(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the height of the specified screen in millimeters. __ │

DisplayWidth(display, screen_number)

int XDisplayWidth(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the width of the screen in pixels. __ │

DisplayWidthMM(display, screen_number)

int XDisplayWidthMM(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

Both return the width of the specified screen in millimeters.

2.2.3. Screen Information Macros

The following lists the C language macros, their corresponding function equivalents that are for other language bindings, and what data they both can return. These macros or functions all take a pointer to the appropriate screen structure. __ │

BlackPixelOfScreen(screen)

unsigned long XBlackPixelOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the black pixel value of the specified screen. __ │

WhitePixelOfScreen(screen)

unsigned long XWhitePixelOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the white pixel value of the specified screen. __ │

CellsOfScreen(screen)

int XCellsOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the number of colormap cells in the default colormap of the specified screen. __ │

DefaultColormapOfScreen(screen)

Colormap XDefaultColormapOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the default colormap of the specified screen. __ │

DefaultDepthOfScreen(screen)

int XDefaultDepthOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the depth of the root window. __ │

DefaultGCOfScreen(screen)

GC XDefaultGCOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return a default graphics context (GC) of the specified screen, which has the same depth as the root window of the screen. The GC must never be freed. __ │

DefaultVisualOfScreen(screen)

Visual *XDefaultVisualOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the default visual of the specified screen. For information on visual types, see section 3.1. __ │

DoesBackingStore(screen)

int XDoesBackingStore(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return a value indicating whether the screen supports backing stores. The value returned can be one of WhenMapped, NotUseful, or Always (see section 3.2.4). __ │

DoesSaveUnders(screen)

Bool XDoesSaveUnders(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return a Boolean value indicating whether the screen supports save unders. If True, the screen supports save unders. If False, the screen does not support save unders (see section 3.2.5). __ │

DisplayOfScreen(screen)

Display *XDisplayOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the display of the specified screen. __ │

int XScreenNumberOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

The XScreenNumberOfScreen function returns the screen index number of the specified screen. __ │

EventMaskOfScreen(screen)

long XEventMaskOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the event mask of the root window for the specified screen at connection setup time. __ │

WidthOfScreen(screen)

int XWidthOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the width of the specified screen in pixels. __ │

HeightOfScreen(screen)

int XHeightOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the height of the specified screen in pixels. __ │

WidthMMOfScreen(screen)

int XWidthMMOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the width of the specified screen in millimeters. __ │

HeightMMOfScreen(screen)

int XHeightMMOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the height of the specified screen in millimeters. __ │

MaxCmapsOfScreen(screen)

int XMaxCmapsOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the maximum number of installed colormaps supported by the specified screen (see section 9.3). __ │

MinCmapsOfScreen(screen)

int XMinCmapsOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the minimum number of installed colormaps supported by the specified screen (see section 9.3). __ │

PlanesOfScreen(screen)

int XPlanesOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the depth of the root window. __ │

RootWindowOfScreen(screen)

Window XRootWindowOfScreen(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the appropriate Screen structure. │__

Both return the root window of the specified screen.

2.3. Generating a NoOperation Protocol Request

To execute a NoOperation protocol request, use XNoOp. __ │

XNoOp(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XNoOp function sends a NoOperation protocol request to the X server, thereby exercising the connection.

2.4. Freeing Client-Created Data

To free in-memory data that was created by an Xlib function, use XFree. __ │

XFree(data)
void *data;

data

Specifies the data that is to be freed. │__

The XFree function is a general-purpose Xlib routine that frees the specified data. You must use it to free any objects that were allocated by Xlib, unless an alternate function is explicitly specified for the object. A NULL pointer cannot be passed to this function.

2.5. Closing the Display

To close a display or disconnect from the X server, use XCloseDisplay. __ │

XCloseDisplay(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XCloseDisplay function closes the connection to the X server for the display specified in the Display structure and destroys all windows, resource IDs (Window, Font, Pixmap, Colormap, Cursor, and GContext), or other resources that the client has created on this display, unless the close-down mode of the resource has been changed (see XSetCloseDownMode). Therefore, these windows, resource IDs, and other resources should never be referenced again or an error will be generated. Before exiting, you should call XCloseDisplay explicitly so that any pending errors are reported as XCloseDisplay performs a final XSync operation.

XCloseDisplay can generate a BadGC error.

Xlib provides a function to permit the resources owned by a client to survive after the client’s connection is closed. To change a client’s close-down mode, use XSetCloseDownMode. __ │

XSetCloseDownMode(display, close_mode)
Display *display;

int close_mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

close_modeSpecifies the client close-down mode. You can
pass DestroyAll, RetainPermanent, or RetainTempo-
rary
. │__

The XSetCloseDownMode defines what will happen to the client’s resources at connection close. A connection starts in DestroyAll mode. For information on what happens to the client’s resources when the close_mode argument is RetainPermanent or RetainTemporary, see section 2.6.

XSetCloseDownMode can generate a BadValue error.

2.6. Using X Server Connection Close Operations

When the X server’s connection to a client is closed either by an explicit call to XCloseDisplay or by a process that exits, the X server performs the following automatic operations:

It disowns all selections owned by the client (see XSetSelectionOwner).

It performs an XUngrabPointer and XUngrabKeyboard if the client has actively grabbed the pointer or the keyboard.

It performs an XUngrabServer if the client has grabbed the server.

It releases all passive grabs made by the client.

It marks all resources (including colormap entries) allocated by the client either as permanent or temporary, depending on whether the close-down mode is RetainPermanent or RetainTemporary. However, this does not prevent other client applications from explicitly destroying the resources (see XSetCloseDownMode).

When the close-down mode is DestroyAll, the X server destroys all of a client’s resources as follows:

It examines each window in the client’s save-set to determine if it is an inferior (subwindow) of a window created by the client. (The save-set is a list of other clients’ windows that are referred to as save-set windows.) If so, the X server reparents the save-set window to the closest ancestor so that the save-set window is not an inferior of a window created by the client. The reparenting leaves unchanged the absolute coordinates (with respect to the root window) of the upper-left outer corner of the save-set window.

It performs a MapWindow request on the save-set window if the save-set window is unmapped. The X server does this even if the save-set window was not an inferior of a window created by the client.

It destroys all windows created by the client.

It performs the appropriate free request on each nonwindow resource created by the client in the server (for example, Font, Pixmap, Cursor, Colormap, and GContext).

It frees all colors and colormap entries allocated by a client application.

Additional processing occurs when the last connection to the X server closes. An X server goes through a cycle of having no connections and having some connections. When the last connection to the X server closes as a result of a connection closing with the close_mode of DestroyAll, the X server does the following:

It resets its state as if it had just been started. The X server begins by destroying all lingering resources from clients that have terminated in RetainPermanent or RetainTemporary mode.

It deletes all but the predefined atom identifiers.

It deletes all properties on all root windows (see section 4.3).

It resets all device maps and attributes (for example, key click, bell volume, and acceleration) as well as the access control list.

It restores the standard root tiles and cursors.

It restores the default font path.

It restores the input focus to state PointerRoot.

However, the X server does not reset if you close a connection with a close-down mode set to RetainPermanent or RetainTemporary.

2.7. Using Xlib with Threads

On systems that have threads, support may be provided to permit multiple threads to use Xlib concurrently.

To initialize support for concurrent threads, use XInitThreads. __ │

Status XInitThreads(); │__

The XInitThreads function initializes Xlib support for concurrent threads. This function must be the first Xlib function a multi-threaded program calls, and it must complete before any other Xlib call is made. This function returns a nonzero status if initialization was successful; otherwise, it returns zero. On systems that do not support threads, this function always returns zero.

It is only necessary to call this function if multiple threads might use Xlib concurrently. If all calls to Xlib functions are protected by some other access mechanism (for example, a mutual exclusion lock in a toolkit or through explicit client programming), Xlib thread initialization is not required. It is recommended that single-threaded programs not call this function.

To lock a display across several Xlib calls, use XLockDisplay. __ │

void XLockDisplay(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XLockDisplay function locks out all other threads from using the specified display. Other threads attempting to use the display will block until the display is unlocked by this thread. Nested calls to XLockDisplay work correctly; the display will not actually be unlocked until XUnlockDisplay has been called the same number of times as XLockDisplay. This function has no effect unless Xlib was successfully initialized for threads using XInitThreads.

To unlock a display, use XUnlockDisplay. __ │

void XUnlockDisplay(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XUnlockDisplay function allows other threads to use the specified display again. Any threads that have blocked on the display are allowed to continue. Nested locking works correctly; if XLockDisplay has been called multiple times by a thread, then XUnlockDisplay must be called an equal number of times before the display is actually unlocked. This function has no effect unless Xlib was successfully initialized for threads using XInitThreads.

2.8. Using Internal Connections

In addition to the connection to the X server, an Xlib implementation may require connections to other kinds of servers (for example, to input method servers as described in chapter 13). Toolkits and clients that use multiple displays, or that use displays in combination with other inputs, need to obtain these additional connections to correctly block until input is available and need to process that input when it is available. Simple clients that use a single display and block for input in an Xlib event function do not need to use these facilities.

To track internal connections for a display, use XAddConnectionWatch. __ │

typedef void (*XConnectionWatchProc)(display, client_data, fd, opening, watch_data)
Display *display;
XPointer client_data;
int fd;
Bool opening;
XPointer *watch_data;

Status XAddConnectionWatch(display, procedure, client_data)
Display *display;
XWatchProc procedure;
XPointer client_data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

procedure

Specifies the procedure to be called.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data. │__

The XAddConnectionWatch function registers a procedure to be called each time Xlib opens or closes an internal connection for the specified display. The procedure is passed the display, the specified client_data, the file descriptor for the connection, a Boolean indicating whether the connection is being opened or closed, and a pointer to a location for private watch data. If opening is True, the procedure can store a pointer to private data in the location pointed to by watch_data; when the procedure is later called for this same connection and opening is False, the location pointed to by watch_data will hold this same private data pointer.

This function can be called at any time after a display is opened. If internal connections already exist, the registered procedure will immediately be called for each of them, before XAddConnectionWatch returns. XAddConnectionWatch returns a nonzero status if the procedure is successfully registered; otherwise, it returns zero.

The registered procedure should not call any Xlib functions. If the procedure directly or indirectly causes the state of internal connections or watch procedures to change, the result is not defined. If Xlib has been initialized for threads, the procedure is called with the display locked and the result of a call by the procedure to any Xlib function that locks the display is not defined unless the executing thread has externally locked the display using XLockDisplay.

To stop tracking internal connections for a display, use XRemoveConnectionWatch. __ │

Status XRemoveConnectionWatch(display, procedure, client_data)
Display *display;
XWatchProc procedure;
XPointer client_data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

procedure

Specifies the procedure to be called.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data. │__

The XRemoveConnectionWatch function removes a previously registered connection watch procedure. The client_data must match the client_data used when the procedure was initially registered.

To process input on an internal connection, use XProcessInternalConnection. __ │

void XProcessInternalConnection(display, fd)
Display *display;
int fd;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

fd

Specifies the file descriptor. │__

The XProcessInternalConnection function processes input available on an internal connection. This function should be called for an internal connection only after an operating system facility (for example, select or poll) has indicated that input is available; otherwise, the effect is not defined.

To obtain all of the current internal connections for a display, use XInternalConnectionNumbers. __ │

Status XInternalConnectionNumbers(display, fd_return, count_return)
Display *display;
int **fd_return;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

fd_return

Returns the file descriptors.

count_return
Returns the number of file descriptors. │__

The XInternalConnectionNumbers function returns a list of the file descriptors for all internal connections currently open for the specified display. When the allocated list is no longer needed, free it by using XFree. This functions returns a nonzero status if the list is successfully allocated; otherwise, it returns zero.

2

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 3

Window Functions

In the X Window System, a window is a rectangular area on the screen that lets you view graphic output. Client applications can display overlapping and nested windows on one or more screens that are driven by X servers on one or more machines. Clients who want to create windows must first connect their program to the X server by calling XOpenDisplay. This chapter begins with a discussion of visual types and window attributes. The chapter continues with a discussion of the Xlib functions you can use to:

Create windows

Destroy windows

Map windows

Unmap windows

Configure windows

Change window stacking order

Change window attributes

This chapter also identifies the window actions that may generate events.

Note that it is vital that your application conform to the established conventions for communicating with window managers for it to work well with the various window managers in use (see section 14.1). Toolkits generally adhere to these conventions for you, relieving you of the burden. Toolkits also often supersede many functions in this chapter with versions of their own. For more information, refer to the documentation for the toolkit that you are using.

3.1. Visual Types

On some display hardware, it may be possible to deal with color resources in more than one way. For example, you may be able to deal with a screen of either 12-bit depth with arbitrary mapping of pixel to color (pseudo-color) or 24-bit depth with 8 bits of the pixel dedicated to each of red, green, and blue. These different ways of dealing with the visual aspects of the screen are called visuals. For each screen of the display, there may be a list of valid visual types supported at different depths of the screen. Because default windows and visual types are defined for each screen, most simple applications need not deal with this complexity. Xlib provides macros and functions that return the default root window, the default depth of the default root window, and the default visual type (see sections 2.2.1 and 16.7).

Xlib uses an opaque Visual structure that contains information about the possible color mapping. The visual utility functions (see section 16.7) use an XVisualInfo structure to return this information to an application. The members of this structure pertinent to this discussion are class, red_mask, green_mask, blue_mask, bits_per_rgb, and colormap_size. The class member specifies one of the possible visual classes of the screen and can be StaticGray, StaticColor, TrueColor, GrayScale, PseudoColor, or DirectColor.

The following concepts may serve to make the explanation of visual types clearer. The screen can be color or grayscale, can have a colormap that is writable or read-only, and can also have a colormap whose indices are decomposed into separate RGB pieces, provided one is not on a grayscale screen. This leads to the following diagram:

Color Gray-scale
R/O R/W R/O R/W
Undecomposed Static Pseudo Static Gray
Colormap Color Color Gray Scale
Decomposed True Direct
Colormap Color Color

Conceptually, as each pixel is read out of video memory for display on the screen, it goes through a look-up stage by indexing into a colormap. Colormaps can be manipulated arbitrarily on some hardware, in limited ways on other hardware, and not at all on other hardware. The visual types affect the colormap and the RGB values in the following ways:

For PseudoColor, a pixel value indexes a colormap to produce independent RGB values, and the RGB values can be changed dynamically.

GrayScale is treated the same way as PseudoColor except that the primary that drives the screen is undefined. Thus, the client should always store the same value for red, green, and blue in the colormaps.

For DirectColor, a pixel value is decomposed into separate RGB subfields, and each subfield separately indexes the colormap for the corresponding value. The RGB values can be changed dynamically.

TrueColor is treated the same way as DirectColor except that the colormap has predefined, read-only RGB values. These RGB values are server dependent but provide linear or near-linear ramps in each primary.

StaticColor is treated the same way as PseudoColor except that the colormap has predefined, read-only, server-dependent RGB values.

StaticGray is treated the same way as StaticColor except that the RGB values are equal for any single pixel value, thus resulting in shades of gray. StaticGray with a two-entry colormap can be thought of as monochrome.

The red_mask, green_mask, and blue_mask members are only defined for DirectColor and TrueColor. Each has one contiguous set of bits with no intersections. The bits_per_rgb member specifies the log base 2 of the number of distinct color values (individually) of red, green, and blue. Actual RGB values are unsigned 16-bit numbers. The colormap_size member defines the number of available colormap entries in a newly created colormap. For DirectColor and TrueColor, this is the size of an individual pixel subfield.

To obtain the visual ID from a Visual, use XVisualIDFromVisual. __ │

VisualID XVisualIDFromVisual(visual)
Visual *visual;

visual

Specifies the visual type. │__

The XVisualIDFromVisual function returns the visual ID for the specified visual type.

3.2. Window Attributes

All InputOutput windows have a border width of zero or more pixels, an optional background, an event suppression mask (which suppresses propagation of events from children), and a property list (see section 4.3). The window border and background can be a solid color or a pattern, called a tile. All windows except the root have a parent and are clipped by their parent. If a window is stacked on top of another window, it obscures that other window for the purpose of input. If a window has a background (almost all do), it obscures the other window for purposes of output. Attempts to output to the obscured area do nothing, and no input events (for example, pointer motion) are generated for the obscured area.

Windows also have associated property lists (see section 4.3).

Both InputOutput and InputOnly windows have the following common attributes, which are the only attributes of an InputOnly window:

win-gravity

event-mask

do-not-propagate-mask

override-redirect

cursor

If you specify any other attributes for an InputOnly window, a BadMatch error results.

InputOnly windows are used for controlling input events in situations where InputOutput windows are unnecessary. InputOnly windows are invisible; can only be used to control such things as cursors, input event generation, and grabbing; and cannot be used in any graphics requests. Note that InputOnly windows cannot have InputOutput windows as inferiors.

Windows have borders of a programmable width and pattern as well as a background pattern or tile. Pixel values can be used for solid colors. The background and border pixmaps can be destroyed immediately after creating the window if no further explicit references to them are to be made. The pattern can either be relative to the parent or absolute. If ParentRelative, the parent’s background is used.

When windows are first created, they are not visible (not mapped) on the screen. Any output to a window that is not visible on the screen and that does not have backing store will be discarded. An application may wish to create a window long before it is mapped to the screen. When a window is eventually mapped to the screen (using XMapWindow), the X server generates an Expose event for the window if backing store has not been maintained.

A window manager can override your choice of size, border width, and position for a top-level window. Your program must be prepared to use the actual size and position of the top window. It is not acceptable for a client application to resize itself unless in direct response to a human command to do so. Instead, either your program should use the space given to it, or if the space is too small for any useful work, your program might ask the user to resize the window. The border of your top-level window is considered fair game for window managers.

To set an attribute of a window, set the appropriate member of the XSetWindowAttributes structure and OR in the corresponding value bitmask in your subsequent calls to XCreateWindow and XChangeWindowAttributes, or use one of the other convenience functions that set the appropriate attribute. The symbols for the value mask bits and the XSetWindowAttributes structure are: __ │

/* Window attribute value mask bits */

#de-
fine
CWBackPixmap

(1L<<0)

#de-
fine
CWBackPixel

(1L<<1)

#de-
fine
CWBorderPixmap

(1L<<2)

#de-
fine
CWBorderPixel

(1L<<3)

#de-
fine
CWBitGravity

(1L<<4)

#de-
fine
CWWinGravity

(1L<<5)

#de-
fine
CWBackingStore

(1L<<6)

#de-
fine
CWBackingPlanes

(1L<<7)

#de-
fine
CWBackingPixel

(1L<<8)

#de-
fine
CWOverrideRedirect

(1L<<9)

#de-
fine
CWSaveUnder

(1L<<10)

#de-
fine
CWEventMask

(1L<<11)

#de-
fine
CWDontPropagate

(1L<<12)

#de-
fine
CWColormap

(1L<<13)

#de-
fine
CWCursor

(1L<<14)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

Pixmap background_pixmap;/* background, None, or ParentRelative */

unsigned long background_pixel;/* background pixel */

Pixmap border_pixmap;

/* border of the window or CopyFromParent */

unsigned long border_pixel;/* border pixel value */

int bit_gravity;

/* one of bit gravity values */

int win_gravity;

/* one of the window gravity values */

int backing_store;

/* NotUseful, WhenMapped, Always */

unsigned long backing_planes;/* planes to be preserved if possible */

unsigned long backing_pixel;/* value to use in restoring planes */

Bool save_under;

/* should bits under be saved? (popups) */

long event_mask;

/* set of events that should be saved */

long do_not_propagate_mask;/* set of events that should not propagate */

Bool override_redirect;

/* boolean value for override_redirect */

Colormap colormap;

/* color map to be associated with window */

Cursor cursor;

/* cursor to be displayed (or None) */

} XSetWindowAttributes; │__

The following lists the defaults for each window attribute and indicates whether the attribute is applicable to InputOutput and InputOnly windows:
Attribute
Default
InputOutput
InputOnly

background-pixmap
None

Yes
No
background-pixel Undefined Yes No
border-pixmap
CopyFromParent

Yes
No
border-pixel Undefined Yes No
bit-gravity
ForgetGravity

Yes
No
win-gravity
NorthWestGravity

Yes
Yes
backing-store
NotUseful

Yes
No
backing-planes All ones Yes No
backing-pixel zero Yes No
save-under
False

Yes
No
event-mask empty set Yes Yes
do-not-propagate-mask empty set Yes Yes
override-redirect
False

Yes
Yes
colormap
CopyFromParent

Yes
No
cursor
None

Yes
Yes

3.2.1. Background Attribute

Only InputOutput windows can have a background. You can set the background of an InputOutput window by using a pixel or a pixmap.

The background-pixmap attribute of a window specifies the pixmap to be used for a window’s background. This pixmap can be of any size, although some sizes may be faster than others. The background-pixel attribute of a window specifies a pixel value used to paint a window’s background in a single color.

You can set the background-pixmap to a pixmap, None (default), or ParentRelative. You can set the background-pixel of a window to any pixel value (no default). If you specify a background-pixel, it overrides either the default background-pixmap or any value you may have set in the background-pixmap. A pixmap of an undefined size that is filled with the background-pixel is used for the background. Range checking is not performed on the background pixel; it simply is truncated to the appropriate number of bits.

If you set the background-pixmap, it overrides the default. The background-pixmap and the window must have the same depth, or a BadMatch error results. If you set background-pixmap to None, the window has no defined background. If you set the background-pixmap to ParentRelative:

The parent window’s background-pixmap is used. The child window, however, must have the same depth as its parent, or a BadMatch error results.

If the parent window has a background-pixmap of None, the window also has a background-pixmap of None.

A copy of the parent window’s background-pixmap is not made. The parent’s background-pixmap is examined each time the child window’s background-pixmap is required.

The background tile origin always aligns with the parent window’s background tile origin. If the background-pixmap is not ParentRelative, the background tile origin is the child window’s origin.

Setting a new background, whether by setting background-pixmap or background-pixel, overrides any previous background. The background-pixmap can be freed immediately if no further explicit reference is made to it (the X server will keep a copy to use when needed). If you later draw into the pixmap used for the background, what happens is undefined because the X implementation is free to make a copy of the pixmap or to use the same pixmap.

When no valid contents are available for regions of a window and either the regions are visible or the server is maintaining backing store, the server automatically tiles the regions with the window’s background unless the window has a background of None. If the background is None, the previous screen contents from other windows of the same depth as the window are simply left in place as long as the contents come from the parent of the window or an inferior of the parent. Otherwise, the initial contents of the exposed regions are undefined. Expose events are then generated for the regions, even if the background-pixmap is None (see section 10.9).

3.2.2. Border Attribute

Only InputOutput windows can have a border. You can set the border of an InputOutput window by using a pixel or a pixmap.

The border-pixmap attribute of a window specifies the pixmap to be used for a window’s border. The border-pixel attribute of a window specifies a pixmap of undefined size filled with that pixel be used for a window’s border. Range checking is not performed on the background pixel; it simply is truncated to the appropriate number of bits. The border tile origin is always the same as the background tile origin.

You can also set the border-pixmap to a pixmap of any size (some may be faster than others) or to CopyFromParent (default). You can set the border-pixel to any pixel value (no default).

If you set a border-pixmap, it overrides the default. The border-pixmap and the window must have the same depth, or a BadMatch error results. If you set the border-pixmap to CopyFromParent, the parent window’s border-pixmap is copied. Subsequent changes to the parent window’s border attribute do not affect the child window. However, the child window must have the same depth as the parent window, or a BadMatch error results.

The border-pixmap can be freed immediately if no further explicit reference is made to it. If you later draw into the pixmap used for the border, what happens is undefined because the X implementation is free either to make a copy of the pixmap or to use the same pixmap. If you specify a border-pixel, it overrides either the default border-pixmap or any value you may have set in the border-pixmap. All pixels in the window’s border will be set to the border-pixel. Setting a new border, whether by setting border-pixel or by setting border-pixmap, overrides any previous border.

Output to a window is always clipped to the inside of the window. Therefore, graphics operations never affect the window border.

3.2.3. Gravity Attributes

The bit gravity of a window defines which region of the window should be retained when an InputOutput window is resized. The default value for the bit-gravity attribute is ForgetGravity. The window gravity of a window allows you to define how the InputOutput or InputOnly window should be repositioned if its parent is resized. The default value for the win-gravity attribute is NorthWestGravity.

If the inside width or height of a window is not changed and if the window is moved or its border is changed, then the contents of the window are not lost but move with the window. Changing the inside width or height of the window causes its contents to be moved or lost (depending on the bit-gravity of the window) and causes children to be reconfigured (depending on their win-gravity). For a change of width and height, the (x, y) pairs are defined:
Gravity Direction Coordinates
NorthWestGravity

(0, 0)
NorthGravity

(Width/2, 0)
NorthEastGravity

(Width, 0)
WestGravity

(0, Height/2)
CenterGravity

(Width/2, Height/2)
EastGravity

(Width, Height/2)
SouthWestGravity

(0, Height)
SouthGravity

(Width/2, Height)
SouthEastGravity

(Width, Height)

When a window with one of these bit-gravity values is resized, the corresponding pair defines the change in position of each pixel in the window. When a window with one of these win-gravities has its parent window resized, the corresponding pair defines the change in position of the window within the parent. When a window is so repositioned, a GravityNotify event is generated (see section 10.10.5).

A bit-gravity of StaticGravity indicates that the contents or origin should not move relative to the origin of the root window. If the change in size of the window is coupled with a change in position (x, y), then for bit-gravity the change in position of each pixel is (−x, −y), and for win-gravity the change in position of a child when its parent is so resized is (−x, −y). Note that StaticGravity still only takes effect when the width or height of the window is changed, not when the window is moved.

A bit-gravity of ForgetGravity indicates that the window’s contents are always discarded after a size change, even if a backing store or save under has been requested. The window is tiled with its background and zero or more Expose events are generated. If no background is defined, the existing screen contents are not altered. Some X servers may also ignore the specified bit-gravity and always generate Expose events.

The contents and borders of inferiors are not affected by their parent’s bit-gravity. A server is permitted to ignore the specified bit-gravity and use Forget instead.

A win-gravity of UnmapGravity is like NorthWestGravity (the window is not moved), except the child is also unmapped when the parent is resized, and an UnmapNotify event is generated.

3.2.4. Backing Store Attribute

Some implementations of the X server may choose to maintain the contents of InputOutput windows. If the X server maintains the contents of a window, the off-screen saved pixels are known as backing store. The backing store advises the X server on what to do with the contents of a window. The backing-store attribute can be set to NotUseful (default), WhenMapped, or Always.

A backing-store attribute of NotUseful advises the X server that maintaining contents is unnecessary, although some X implementations may still choose to maintain contents and, therefore, not generate Expose events. A backing-store attribute of WhenMapped advises the X server that maintaining contents of obscured regions when the window is mapped would be beneficial. In this case, the server may generate an Expose event when the window is created. A backing-store attribute of Always advises the X server that maintaining contents even when the window is unmapped would be beneficial. Even if the window is larger than its parent, this is a request to the X server to maintain complete contents, not just the region within the parent window boundaries. While the X server maintains the window’s contents, Expose events normally are not generated, but the X server may stop maintaining contents at any time.

When the contents of obscured regions of a window are being maintained, regions obscured by noninferior windows are included in the destination of graphics requests (and source, when the window is the source). However, regions obscured by inferior windows are not included.

3.2.5. Save Under Flag

Some server implementations may preserve contents of InputOutput windows under other InputOutput windows. This is not the same as preserving the contents of a window for you. You may get better visual appeal if transient windows (for example, pop-up menus) request that the system preserve the screen contents under them, so the temporarily obscured applications do not have to repaint.

You can set the save-under flag to True or False (default). If save-under is True, the X server is advised that, when this window is mapped, saving the contents of windows it obscures would be beneficial.

3.2.6. Backing Planes and Backing Pixel Attributes

You can set backing planes to indicate (with bits set to 1) which bit planes of an InputOutput window hold dynamic data that must be preserved in backing store and during save unders. The default value for the backing-planes attribute is all bits set to 1. You can set backing pixel to specify what bits to use in planes not covered by backing planes. The default value for the backing-pixel attribute is all bits set to 0. The X server is free to save only the specified bit planes in the backing store or the save under and is free to regenerate the remaining planes with the specified pixel value. Any extraneous bits in these values (that is, those bits beyond the specified depth of the window) may be simply ignored. If you request backing store or save unders, you should use these members to minimize the amount of off-screen memory required to store your window.

3.2.7. Event Mask and Do Not Propagate Mask Attributes

The event mask defines which events the client is interested in for this InputOutput or InputOnly window (or, for some event types, inferiors of this window). The event mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of zero or more of the valid event mask bits. You can specify that no maskable events are reported by setting NoEventMask (default).

The do-not-propagate-mask attribute defines which events should not be propagated to ancestor windows when no client has the event type selected in this InputOutput or InputOnly window. The do-not-propagate-mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of zero or more of the following masks: KeyPress, KeyRelease, ButtonPress, ButtonRelease, PointerMotion, Button1Motion, Button2Motion, Button3Motion, Button4Motion, Button5Motion, and ButtonMotion. You can specify that all events are propagated by setting NoEventMask (default).

3.2.8. Override Redirect Flag

To control window placement or to add decoration, a window manager often needs to intercept (redirect) any map or configure request. Pop-up windows, however, often need to be mapped without a window manager getting in the way. To control whether an InputOutput or InputOnly window is to ignore these structure control facilities, use the override-redirect flag.

The override-redirect flag specifies whether map and configure requests on this window should override a SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent. You can set the override-redirect flag to True or False (default). Window managers use this information to avoid tampering with pop-up windows (see also chapter 14).

3.2.9. Colormap Attribute

The colormap attribute specifies which colormap best reflects the true colors of the InputOutput window. The colormap must have the same visual type as the window, or a BadMatch error results. X servers capable of supporting multiple hardware colormaps can use this information, and window managers can use it for calls to XInstallColormap. You can set the colormap attribute to a colormap or to CopyFromParent (default).

If you set the colormap to CopyFromParent, the parent window’s colormap is copied and used by its child. However, the child window must have the same visual type as the parent, or a BadMatch error results. The parent window must not have a colormap of None, or a BadMatch error results. The colormap is copied by sharing the colormap object between the child and parent, not by making a complete copy of the colormap contents. Subsequent changes to the parent window’s colormap attribute do not affect the child window.

3.2.10. Cursor Attribute

The cursor attribute specifies which cursor is to be used when the pointer is in the InputOutput or InputOnly window. You can set the cursor to a cursor or None (default).

If you set the cursor to None, the parent’s cursor is used when the pointer is in the InputOutput or InputOnly window, and any change in the parent’s cursor will cause an immediate change in the displayed cursor. By calling XFreeCursor, the cursor can be freed immediately as long as no further explicit reference to it is made.

3.3. Creating Windows

Xlib provides basic ways for creating windows, and toolkits often supply higher-level functions specifically for creating and placing top-level windows, which are discussed in the appropriate toolkit documentation. If you do not use a toolkit, however, you must provide some standard information or hints for the window manager by using the Xlib inter-client communication functions (see chapter 14).

If you use Xlib to create your own top-level windows (direct children of the root window), you must observe the following rules so that all applications interact reasonably across the different styles of window management:

You must never fight with the window manager for the size or placement of your top-level window.

You must be able to deal with whatever size window you get, even if this means that your application just prints a message like ‘‘Please make me bigger’’ in its window.

You should only attempt to resize or move top-level windows in direct response to a user request. If a request to change the size of a top-level window fails, you must be prepared to live with what you get. You are free to resize or move the children of top-level windows as necessary. (Toolkits often have facilities for automatic relayout.)

If you do not use a toolkit that automatically sets standard window properties, you should set these properties for top-level windows before mapping them.

For further information, see chapter 14 and the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual.

XCreateWindow is the more general function that allows you to set specific window attributes when you create a window. XCreateSimpleWindow creates a window that inherits its attributes from its parent window.

The X server acts as if InputOnly windows do not exist for the purposes of graphics requests, exposure processing, and VisibilityNotify events. An InputOnly window cannot be used as a drawable (that is, as a source or destination for graphics requests). InputOnly and InputOutput windows act identically in other respects (properties, grabs, input control, and so on). Extension packages can define other classes of windows.

To create an unmapped window and set its window attributes, use XCreateWindow. __ │

Window XCreateWindow(display, parent, x, y, width, height, border_width, depth,
class
, visual, valuemask, attributes)
Display *display;
Window parent;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int border_width;
int depth;
unsigned int class;
Visual *visual;
unsigned long valuemask;
XSetWindowAttributes *attributes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

parent

Specifies the parent window.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are the

top-left outside corner of the created window’s
borders and are relative to the inside of the par-
ent window’s borders.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the creat-

ed window’s inside dimensions and do not include
the created window’s borders. The dimensions must
be nonzero, or a BadValue error results.

border_width
Specifies the width of the created window’s border
in pixels.

depth

Specifies the window’s depth. A depth of Copy-

FromParent means the depth is taken from the par-
ent.

class

Specifies the created window’s class. You can

pass InputOutput, InputOnly, or CopyFromParent. A
class of CopyFromParent means the class is taken
from the parent.

visual

Specifies the visual type. A visual of Copy-

FromParent means the visual type is taken from the
parent.

valuemask

Specifies which window attributes are defined in

the attributes argument. This mask is the bitwise
inclusive OR of the valid attribute mask bits. If
valuemask is zero, the attributes are ignored and
are not referenced.

attributesSpecifies the structure from which the values (as
specified by the value mask) are to be taken. The
value mask should have the appropriate bits set to
indicate which attributes have been set in the
structure. │__

The XCreateWindow function creates an unmapped subwindow for a specified parent window, returns the window ID of the created window, and causes the X server to generate a CreateNotify event. The created window is placed on top in the stacking order with respect to siblings.

The coordinate system has the X axis horizontal and the Y axis vertical with the origin [0, 0] at the upper-left corner. Coordinates are integral, in terms of pixels, and coincide with pixel centers. Each window and pixmap has its own coordinate system. For a window, the origin is inside the border at the inside, upper-left corner.

The border_width for an InputOnly window must be zero, or a BadMatch error results. For class InputOutput, the visual type and depth must be a combination supported for the screen, or a BadMatch error results. The depth need not be the same as the parent, but the parent must not be a window of class InputOnly, or a BadMatch error results. For an InputOnly window, the depth must be zero, and the visual must be one supported by the screen. If either condition is not met, a BadMatch error results. The parent window, however, may have any depth and class. If you specify any invalid window attribute for a window, a BadMatch error results.

The created window is not yet displayed (mapped) on the user’s display. To display the window, call XMapWindow. The new window initially uses the same cursor as its parent. A new cursor can be defined for the new window by calling XDefineCursor. The window will not be visible on the screen unless it and all of its ancestors are mapped and it is not obscured by any of its ancestors.

XCreateWindow can generate BadAlloc, BadColor, BadCursor, BadMatch, BadPixmap, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To create an unmapped InputOutput subwindow of a given parent window, use XCreateSimpleWindow. __ │

Window XCreateSimpleWindow(display, parent, x, y, width, height, border_width,
border
, background)
Display *display;
Window parent;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int border_width;
unsigned long border;
unsigned long background;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

parent

Specifies the parent window.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are the

top-left outside corner of the new window’s bor-
ders and are relative to the inside of the parent
window’s borders.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the creat-

ed window’s inside dimensions and do not include
the created window’s borders. The dimensions must
be nonzero, or a BadValue error results.

border_width
Specifies the width of the created window’s border
in pixels.

border

Specifies the border pixel value of the window.

backgroundSpecifies the background pixel value of the win-
dow. │__

The XCreateSimpleWindow function creates an unmapped InputOutput subwindow for a specified parent window, returns the window ID of the created window, and causes the X server to generate a CreateNotify event. The created window is placed on top in the stacking order with respect to siblings. Any part of the window that extends outside its parent window is clipped. The border_width for an InputOnly window must be zero, or a BadMatch error results. XCreateSimpleWindow inherits its depth, class, and visual from its parent. All other window attributes, except background and border, have their default values.

XCreateSimpleWindow can generate BadAlloc, BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

3.4. Destroying Windows

Xlib provides functions that you can use to destroy a window or destroy all subwindows of a window.

To destroy a window and all of its subwindows, use XDestroyWindow. __ │

XDestroyWindow(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XDestroyWindow function destroys the specified window as well as all of its subwindows and causes the X server to generate a DestroyNotify event for each window. The window should never be referenced again. If the window specified by the w argument is mapped, it is unmapped automatically. The ordering of the DestroyNotify events is such that for any given window being destroyed, DestroyNotify is generated on any inferiors of the window before being generated on the window itself. The ordering among siblings and across subhierarchies is not otherwise constrained. If the window you specified is a root window, no windows are destroyed. Destroying a mapped window will generate Expose events on other windows that were obscured by the window being destroyed.

XDestroyWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To destroy all subwindows of a specified window, use XDestroySubwindows. __ │

XDestroySubwindows(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XDestroySubwindows function destroys all inferior windows of the specified window, in bottom-to-top stacking order. It causes the X server to generate a DestroyNotify event for each window. If any mapped subwindows were actually destroyed, XDestroySubwindows causes the X server to generate Expose events on the specified window. This is much more efficient than deleting many windows one at a time because much of the work need be performed only once for all of the windows, rather than for each window. The subwindows should never be referenced again.

XDestroySubwindows can generate a BadWindow error.

3.5. Mapping Windows

A window is considered mapped if an XMapWindow call has been made on it. It may not be visible on the screen for one of the following reasons:

It is obscured by another opaque window.

One of its ancestors is not mapped.

It is entirely clipped by an ancestor.

Expose events are generated for the window when part or all of it becomes visible on the screen. A client receives the Expose events only if it has asked for them. Windows retain their position in the stacking order when they are unmapped.

A window manager may want to control the placement of subwindows. If SubstructureRedirectMask has been selected by a window manager on a parent window (usually a root window), a map request initiated by other clients on a child window is not performed, and the window manager is sent a MapRequest event. However, if the override-redirect flag on the child had been set to True (usually only on pop-up menus), the map request is performed.

A tiling window manager might decide to reposition and resize other clients’ windows and then decide to map the window to its final location. A window manager that wants to provide decoration might reparent the child into a frame first. For further information, see sections 3.2.8 and 10.10. Only a single client at a time can select for SubstructureRedirectMask.

Similarly, a single client can select for ResizeRedirectMask on a parent window. Then, any attempt to resize the window by another client is suppressed, and the client receives a ResizeRequest event.

To map a given window, use XMapWindow. __ │

XMapWindow(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XMapWindow function maps the window and all of its subwindows that have had map requests. Mapping a window that has an unmapped ancestor does not display the window but marks it as eligible for display when the ancestor becomes mapped. Such a window is called unviewable. When all its ancestors are mapped, the window becomes viewable and will be visible on the screen if it is not obscured by another window. This function has no effect if the window is already mapped.

If the override-redirect of the window is False and if some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent window, then the X server generates a MapRequest event, and the XMapWindow function does not map the window. Otherwise, the window is mapped, and the X server generates a MapNotify event.

If the window becomes viewable and no earlier contents for it are remembered, the X server tiles the window with its background. If the window’s background is undefined, the existing screen contents are not altered, and the X server generates zero or more Expose events. If backing-store was maintained while the window was unmapped, no Expose events are generated. If backing-store will now be maintained, a full-window exposure is always generated. Otherwise, only visible regions may be reported. Similar tiling and exposure take place for any newly viewable inferiors.

If the window is an InputOutput window, XMapWindow generates Expose events on each InputOutput window that it causes to be displayed. If the client maps and paints the window and if the client begins processing events, the window is painted twice. To avoid this, first ask for Expose events and then map the window, so the client processes input events as usual. The event list will include Expose for each window that has appeared on the screen. The client’s normal response to an Expose event should be to repaint the window. This method usually leads to simpler programs and to proper interaction with window managers.

XMapWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To map and raise a window, use XMapRaised. __ │

XMapRaised(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XMapRaised function essentially is similar to XMapWindow in that it maps the window and all of its subwindows that have had map requests. However, it also raises the specified window to the top of the stack. For additional information, see XMapWindow.

XMapRaised can generate multiple BadWindow errors.

To map all subwindows for a specified window, use XMapSubwindows. __ │

XMapSubwindows(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XMapSubwindows function maps all subwindows for a specified window in top-to-bottom stacking order. The X server generates Expose events on each newly displayed window. This may be much more efficient than mapping many windows one at a time because the server needs to perform much of the work only once, for all of the windows, rather than for each window.

XMapSubwindows can generate a BadWindow error.

3.6. Unmapping Windows

Xlib provides functions that you can use to unmap a window or all subwindows.

To unmap a window, use XUnmapWindow. __ │

XUnmapWindow(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XUnmapWindow function unmaps the specified window and causes the X server to generate an UnmapNotify event. If the specified window is already unmapped, XUnmapWindow has no effect. Normal exposure processing on formerly obscured windows is performed. Any child window will no longer be visible until another map call is made on the parent. In other words, the subwindows are still mapped but are not visible until the parent is mapped. Unmapping a window will generate Expose events on windows that were formerly obscured by it.

XUnmapWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To unmap all subwindows for a specified window, use XUnmapSubwindows. __ │

XUnmapSubwindows(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XUnmapSubwindows function unmaps all subwindows for the specified window in bottom-to-top stacking order. It causes the X server to generate an UnmapNotify event on each subwindow and Expose events on formerly obscured windows. Using this function is much more efficient than unmapping multiple windows one at a time because the server needs to perform much of the work only once, for all of the windows, rather than for each window.

XUnmapSubwindows can generate a BadWindow error.

3.7. Configuring Windows

Xlib provides functions that you can use to move a window, resize a window, move and resize a window, or change a window’s border width. To change one of these parameters, set the appropriate member of the XWindowChanges structure and OR in the corresponding value mask in subsequent calls to XConfigureWindow. The symbols for the value mask bits and the XWindowChanges structure are: __ │

/* Configure window value mask bits */

#de-
fine
CWX

(1<<0)

#de-
fine
CWY

(1<<1)

#de-
fine
CWWidth

(1<<2)

#de-
fine
CWHeight

(1<<3)

#de-
fine
CWBorderWidth

(1<<4)

#de-
fine
CWSibling

(1<<5)

#de-
fine
CWStackMode

(1<<6)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

int x, y;

int width, height;

int border_width;

Window sibling;

int stack_mode;

} XWindowChanges; │__

The x and y members are used to set the window’s x and y coordinates, which are relative to the parent’s origin and indicate the position of the upper-left outer corner of the window. The width and height members are used to set the inside size of the window, not including the border, and must be nonzero, or a BadValue error results. Attempts to configure a root window have no effect.

The border_width member is used to set the width of the border in pixels. Note that setting just the border width leaves the outer-left corner of the window in a fixed position but moves the absolute position of the window’s origin. If you attempt to set the border-width attribute of an InputOnly window nonzero, a BadMatch error results.

The sibling member is used to set the sibling window for stacking operations. The stack_mode member is used to set how the window is to be restacked and can be set to Above, Below, TopIf, BottomIf, or Opposite.

If the override-redirect flag of the window is False and if some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates a ConfigureRequest event, and no further processing is performed. Otherwise, if some other client has selected ResizeRedirectMask on the window and the inside width or height of the window is being changed, a ResizeRequest event is generated, and the current inside width and height are used instead. Note that the override-redirect flag of the window has no effect on ResizeRedirectMask and that SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent has precedence over ResizeRedirectMask on the window.

When the geometry of the window is changed as specified, the window is restacked among siblings, and a ConfigureNotify event is generated if the state of the window actually changes. GravityNotify events are generated after ConfigureNotify events. If the inside width or height of the window has actually changed, children of the window are affected as specified.

If a window’s size actually changes, the window’s subwindows move according to their window gravity. Depending on the window’s bit gravity, the contents of the window also may be moved (see section 3.2.3).

If regions of the window were obscured but now are not, exposure processing is performed on these formerly obscured windows, including the window itself and its inferiors. As a result of increasing the width or height, exposure processing is also performed on any new regions of the window and any regions where window contents are lost.

The restack check (specifically, the computation for BottomIf, TopIf, and Opposite) is performed with respect to the window’s final size and position (as controlled by the other arguments of the request), not its initial position. If a sibling is specified without a stack_mode, a BadMatch error results.

If a sibling and a stack_mode are specified, the window is restacked as follows:
Above

The window is placed just above the sibling.
Below

The window is placed just below the sibling.
TopIf

If the sibling occludes the window, the window is
placed at the top of the stack.
BottomIf

If the window occludes the sibling, the window is
placed at the bottom of the stack.
Opposite

If the sibling occludes the window, the window is
placed at the top of the stack. If the window
occludes the sibling, the window is placed at the
bottom of the stack.

If a stack_mode is specified but no sibling is specified, the window is restacked as follows:
Above

The window is placed at the top of the stack.
Below

The window is placed at the bottom of the stack.
TopIf

If any sibling occludes the window, the window is
placed at the top of the stack.
BottomIf

If the window occludes any sibling, the window is
placed at the bottom of the stack.
Opposite

If any sibling occludes the window, the window is
placed at the top of the stack. If the window
occludes any sibling, the window is placed at the
bottom of the stack.

Attempts to configure a root window have no effect.

To configure a window’s size, location, stacking, or border, use XConfigureWindow. __ │

XConfigureWindow(display, w, value_mask, values)
Display *display;
Window w;
unsigned int value_mask;
XWindowChanges *values;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window to be reconfigured.

value_maskSpecifies which values are to be set using infor-
mation in the values structure. This mask is the
bitwise inclusive OR of the valid configure window
values bits.

values

Specifies the XWindowChanges structure. │__

The XConfigureWindow function uses the values specified in the XWindowChanges structure to reconfigure a window’s size, position, border, and stacking order. Values not specified are taken from the existing geometry of the window.

If a sibling is specified without a stack_mode or if the window is not actually a sibling, a BadMatch error results. Note that the computations for BottomIf, TopIf, and Opposite are performed with respect to the window’s final geometry (as controlled by the other arguments passed to XConfigureWindow), not its initial geometry. Any backing store contents of the window, its inferiors, and other newly visible windows are either discarded or changed to reflect the current screen contents (depending on the implementation).

XConfigureWindow can generate BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To move a window without changing its size, use XMoveWindow. __ │

XMoveWindow(display, w, x, y)
Display *display;
Window w;
int x, y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window to be moved.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which define the

new location of the top-left pixel of the window’s
border or the window itself if it has no border. │__

The XMoveWindow function moves the specified window to the specified x and y coordinates, but it does not change the window’s size, raise the window, or change the mapping state of the window. Moving a mapped window may or may not lose the window’s contents depending on if the window is obscured by nonchildren and if no backing store exists. If the contents of the window are lost, the X server generates Expose events. Moving a mapped window generates Expose events on any formerly obscured windows.

If the override-redirect flag of the window is False and some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates a ConfigureRequest event, and no further processing is performed. Otherwise, the window is moved.

XMoveWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To change a window’s size without changing the upper-left coordinate, use XResizeWindow. __ │

XResizeWindow(display, w, width, height)
Display *display;
Window w;
unsigned int width, height;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the inte-

rior dimensions of the window after the call com-
pletes. │__

The XResizeWindow function changes the inside dimensions of the specified window, not including its borders. This function does not change the window’s upper-left coordinate or the origin and does not restack the window. Changing the size of a mapped window may lose its contents and generate Expose events. If a mapped window is made smaller, changing its size generates Expose events on windows that the mapped window formerly obscured.

If the override-redirect flag of the window is False and some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates a ConfigureRequest event, and no further processing is performed. If either width or height is zero, a BadValue error results.

XResizeWindow can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

To change the size and location of a window, use XMoveResizeWindow. __ │

XMoveResizeWindow(display, w, x, y, width, height)
Display *display;
Window w;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window to be reconfigured.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which define the

new position of the window relative to its parent.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which define the in-

terior size of the window. │__

The XMoveResizeWindow function changes the size and location of the specified window without raising it. Moving and resizing a mapped window may generate an Expose event on the window. Depending on the new size and location parameters, moving and resizing a window may generate Expose events on windows that the window formerly obscured.

If the override-redirect flag of the window is False and some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates a ConfigureRequest event, and no further processing is performed. Otherwise, the window size and location are changed.

XMoveResizeWindow can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

To change the border width of a given window, use XSetWindowBorderWidth. __ │

XSetWindowBorderWidth(display, w, width)
Display *display;
Window w;
unsigned int width;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

width

Specifies the width of the window border. │__

The XSetWindowBorderWidth function sets the specified window’s border width to the specified width.

XSetWindowBorderWidth can generate a BadWindow error.

3.8. Changing Window Stacking Order

Xlib provides functions that you can use to raise, lower, circulate, or restack windows.

To raise a window so that no sibling window obscures it, use XRaiseWindow. __ │

XRaiseWindow(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XRaiseWindow function raises the specified window to the top of the stack so that no sibling window obscures it. If the windows are regarded as overlapping sheets of paper stacked on a desk, then raising a window is analogous to moving the sheet to the top of the stack but leaving its x and y location on the desk constant. Raising a mapped window may generate Expose events for the window and any mapped subwindows that were formerly obscured.

If the override-redirect attribute of the window is False and some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates a ConfigureRequest event, and no processing is performed. Otherwise, the window is raised.

XRaiseWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To lower a window so that it does not obscure any sibling windows, use XLowerWindow. __ │

XLowerWindow(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XLowerWindow function lowers the specified window to the bottom of the stack so that it does not obscure any sibling windows. If the windows are regarded as overlapping sheets of paper stacked on a desk, then lowering a window is analogous to moving the sheet to the bottom of the stack but leaving its x and y location on the desk constant. Lowering a mapped window will generate Expose events on any windows it formerly obscured.

If the override-redirect attribute of the window is False and some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates a ConfigureRequest event, and no processing is performed. Otherwise, the window is lowered to the bottom of the stack.

XLowerWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To circulate a subwindow up or down, use XCirculateSubwindows. __ │

XCirculateSubwindows(display, w, direction)
Display *display;
Window w;
int direction;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

direction

Specifies the direction (up or down) that you want

to circulate the window. You can pass RaiseLowest
or LowerHighest. │__

The XCirculateSubwindows function circulates children of the specified window in the specified direction. If you specify RaiseLowest, XCirculateSubwindows raises the lowest mapped child (if any) that is occluded by another child to the top of the stack. If you specify LowerHighest, XCirculateSubwindows lowers the highest mapped child (if any) that occludes another child to the bottom of the stack. Exposure processing is then performed on formerly obscured windows. If some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the window, the X server generates a CirculateRequest event, and no further processing is performed. If a child is actually restacked, the X server generates a CirculateNotify event.

XCirculateSubwindows can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

To raise the lowest mapped child of a window that is partially or completely occluded by another child, use XCirculateSubwindowsUp. __ │

XCirculateSubwindowsUp(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XCirculateSubwindowsUp function raises the lowest mapped child of the specified window that is partially or completely occluded by another child. Completely unobscured children are not affected. This is a convenience function equivalent to XCirculateSubwindows with RaiseLowest specified.

XCirculateSubwindowsUp can generate a BadWindow error.

To lower the highest mapped child of a window that partially or completely occludes another child, use XCirculateSubwindowsDown. __ │

XCirculateSubwindowsDown(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XCirculateSubwindowsDown function lowers the highest mapped child of the specified window that partially or completely occludes another child. Completely unobscured children are not affected. This is a convenience function equivalent to XCirculateSubwindows with LowerHighest specified.

XCirculateSubwindowsDown can generate a BadWindow error.

To restack a set of windows from top to bottom, use XRestackWindows. __ │

XRestackWindows(display, windows, nwindows);
Display *display;
Window windows[];
int nwindows;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

windows

Specifies an array containing the windows to be

restacked.

nwindows

Specifies the number of windows to be restacked. │__

The XRestackWindows function restacks the windows in the order specified, from top to bottom. The stacking order of the first window in the windows array is unaffected, but the other windows in the array are stacked underneath the first window, in the order of the array. The stacking order of the other windows is not affected. For each window in the window array that is not a child of the specified window, a BadMatch error results.

If the override-redirect attribute of a window is False and some other client has selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent, the X server generates ConfigureRequest events for each window whose override-redirect flag is not set, and no further processing is performed. Otherwise, the windows will be restacked in top-to-bottom order.

XRestackWindows can generate a BadWindow error.

3.9. Changing Window Attributes

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set window attributes. XChangeWindowAttributes is the more general function that allows you to set one or more window attributes provided by the XSetWindowAttributes structure. The other functions described in this section allow you to set one specific window attribute, such as a window’s background.

To change one or more attributes for a given window, use XChangeWindowAttributes. __ │

XChangeWindowAttributes(display, w, valuemask, attributes)
Display *display;
Window w;
unsigned long valuemask;
XSetWindowAttributes *attributes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

valuemask

Specifies which window attributes are defined in

the attributes argument. This mask is the bitwise
inclusive OR of the valid attribute mask bits. If
valuemask is zero, the attributes are ignored and
are not referenced. The values and restrictions
are the same as for XCreateWindow.

attributesSpecifies the structure from which the values (as
specified by the value mask) are to be taken. The
value mask should have the appropriate bits set to
indicate which attributes have been set in the
structure (see section 3.2). │__

Depending on the valuemask, the XChangeWindowAttributes function uses the window attributes in the XSetWindowAttributes structure to change the specified window attributes. Changing the background does not cause the window contents to be changed. To repaint the window and its background, use XClearWindow. Setting the border or changing the background such that the border tile origin changes causes the border to be repainted. Changing the background of a root window to None or ParentRelative restores the default background pixmap. Changing the border of a root window to CopyFromParent restores the default border pixmap. Changing the win-gravity does not affect the current position of the window. Changing the backing-store of an obscured window to WhenMapped or Always, or changing the backing-planes, backing-pixel, or save-under of a mapped window may have no immediate effect. Changing the colormap of a window (that is, defining a new map, not changing the contents of the existing map) generates a ColormapNotify event. Changing the colormap of a visible window may have no immediate effect on the screen because the map may not be installed (see XInstallColormap). Changing the cursor of a root window to None restores the default cursor. Whenever possible, you are encouraged to share colormaps.

Multiple clients can select input on the same window. Their event masks are maintained separately. When an event is generated, it is reported to all interested clients. However, only one client at a time can select for SubstructureRedirectMask, ResizeRedirectMask, and ButtonPressMask. If a client attempts to select any of these event masks and some other client has already selected one, a BadAccess error results. There is only one do-not-propagate-mask for a window, not one per client.

XChangeWindowAttributes can generate BadAccess, BadColor, BadCursor, BadMatch, BadPixmap, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To set the background of a window to a given pixel, use XSetWindowBackground. __ │

XSetWindowBackground(display, w, background_pixel)
Display *display;
Window w;
unsigned long background_pixel;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

background_pixel
Specifies the pixel that is to be used for the
background. │__

The XSetWindowBackground function sets the background of the window to the specified pixel value. Changing the background does not cause the window contents to be changed. XSetWindowBackground uses a pixmap of undefined size filled with the pixel value you passed. If you try to change the background of an InputOnly window, a BadMatch error results.

XSetWindowBackground can generate BadMatch and BadWindow errors.

To set the background of a window to a given pixmap, use XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap. __ │

XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap(display, w, background_pixmap)
Display *display;
Window w;
Pixmap background_pixmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

background_pixmap
Specifies the background pixmap, ParentRelative,
or None. │__

The XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap function sets the background pixmap of the window to the specified pixmap. The background pixmap can immediately be freed if no further explicit references to it are to be made. If ParentRelative is specified, the background pixmap of the window’s parent is used, or on the root window, the default background is restored. If you try to change the background of an InputOnly window, a BadMatch error results. If the background is set to None, the window has no defined background.

XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap can generate BadMatch, BadPixmap, and BadWindow errors.

Note

XSetWindowBackground and XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap do not change the current contents of the window.

To change and repaint a window’s border to a given pixel, use XSetWindowBorder. __ │

XSetWindowBorder(display, w, border_pixel)
Display *display;
Window w;
unsigned long border_pixel;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

border_pixel
Specifies the entry in the colormap. │__

The XSetWindowBorder function sets the border of the window to the pixel value you specify. If you attempt to perform this on an InputOnly window, a BadMatch error results.

XSetWindowBorder can generate BadMatch and BadWindow errors.

To change and repaint the border tile of a given window, use XSetWindowBorderPixmap. __ │

XSetWindowBorderPixmap(display, w, border_pixmap)
Display *display;
Window w;
Pixmap border_pixmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

border_pixmap
Specifies the border pixmap or CopyFromParent. │__

The XSetWindowBorderPixmap function sets the border pixmap of the window to the pixmap you specify. The border pixmap can be freed immediately if no further explicit references to it are to be made. If you specify CopyFromParent, a copy of the parent window’s border pixmap is used. If you attempt to perform this on an InputOnly window, a BadMatch error results.

XSetWindowBorderPixmap can generate BadMatch, BadPixmap, and BadWindow errors.

To set the colormap of a given window, use XSetWindowColormap. __ │

XSetWindowColormap(display, w, colormap)
Display *display;
Window w;
Colormap colormap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

colormap

Specifies the colormap. │__

The XSetWindowColormap function sets the specified colormap of the specified window. The colormap must have the same visual type as the window, or a BadMatch error results.

XSetWindowColormap can generate BadColor, BadMatch, and BadWindow errors.

To define which cursor will be used in a window, use XDefineCursor. __ │

XDefineCursor(display, w, cursor)
Display *display;
Window w;
Cursor cursor;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

cursor

Specifies the cursor that is to be displayed or

None. │__

If a cursor is set, it will be used when the pointer is in the window. If the cursor is None, it is equivalent to XUndefineCursor.

XDefineCursor can generate BadCursor and BadWindow errors.

To undefine the cursor in a given window, use XUndefineCursor. __ │

XUndefineCursor(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XUndefineCursor function undoes the effect of a previous XDefineCursor for this window. When the pointer is in the window, the parent’s cursor will now be used. On the root window, the default cursor is restored.

XUndefineCursor can generate a BadWindow error.

3

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 4

Window Information Functions

After you connect the display to the X server and create a window, you can use the Xlib window information functions to:

Obtain information about a window

Translate screen coordinates

Manipulate property lists

Obtain and change window properties

Manipulate selections

4.1. Obtaining Window Information

Xlib provides functions that you can use to obtain information about the window tree, the window’s current attributes, the window’s current geometry, or the current pointer coordinates. Because they are most frequently used by window managers, these functions all return a status to indicate whether the window still exists.

To obtain the parent, a list of children, and number of children for a given window, use XQueryTree. __ │

Status XQueryTree(display, w, root_return, parent_return, children_return, nchildren_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window *root_return;
Window *parent_return;
Window **children_return;
unsigned int *nchildren_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose list of children, root,

parent, and number of children you want to obtain.

root_returnReturns the root window.

parent_return
Returns the parent window.

children_return
Returns the list of children.

nchildren_return
Returns the number of children. │__

The XQueryTree function returns the root ID, the parent window ID, a pointer to the list of children windows (NULL when there are no children), and the number of children in the list for the specified window. The children are listed in current stacking order, from bottom-most (first) to top-most (last). XQueryTree returns zero if it fails and nonzero if it succeeds. To free a non-NULL children list when it is no longer needed, use XFree.

XQueryTree can generate a BadWindow error.

To obtain the current attributes of a given window, use XGetWindowAttributes. __ │

Status XGetWindowAttributes(display, w, window_attributes_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XWindowAttributes *window_attributes_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose current attributes you

want to obtain.

window_attributes_return
Returns the specified window’s attributes in the
XWindowAttributes
structure. │__

The XGetWindowAttributes function returns the current attributes for the specified window to an XWindowAttributes structure. __ │

typedef struct {

int x, y;

/* location of window */

int width, height;

/* width and height of window */

int border_width;

/* border width of window */

int depth;

/* depth of window */

Visual *visual;

/* the associated visual structure */

Window root;

/* root of screen containing window */

int class;

/* InputOutput, InputOnly*/

int bit_gravity;

/* one of the bit gravity values */

int win_gravity;

/* one of the window gravity values */

int backing_store;

/* NotUseful, WhenMapped, Always */

unsigned long backing_planes;/* planes to be preserved if possible */

unsigned long backing_pixel;/* value to be used when restoring planes */

Bool save_under;

/* boolean, should bits under be saved? */

Colormap colormap;

/* color map to be associated with window */

Bool map_installed;

/* boolean, is color map currently installed*/

int map_state;

/* IsUnmapped, IsUnviewable, IsViewable */

long all_event_masks;

/* set of events all people have interest in*/

long your_event_mask;

/* my event mask */

long do_not_propagate_mask;/* set of events that should not propagate */

Bool override_redirect;

/* boolean value for override-redirect */

Screen *screen;

/* back pointer to correct screen */

} XWindowAttributes; │__

The x and y members are set to the upper-left outer corner relative to the parent window’s origin. The width and height members are set to the inside size of the window, not including the border. The border_width member is set to the window’s border width in pixels. The depth member is set to the depth of the window (that is, bits per pixel for the object). The visual member is a pointer to the screen’s associated Visual structure. The root member is set to the root window of the screen containing the window. The class member is set to the window’s class and can be either InputOutput or InputOnly.

The bit_gravity member is set to the window’s bit gravity and can be one of the following:
ForgetGravity
EastGravity
NorthWestGravity
SouthWestGravity
NorthGravity
SouthGravity
NorthEastGravity
SouthEastGravity
WestGravity
StaticGravity
CenterGravity

The win_gravity member is set to the window’s window gravity and can be one of the following:
UnmapGravity
EastGravity
NorthWestGravity
SouthWestGravity
NorthGravity
SouthGravity
NorthEastGravity
SouthEastGravity
WestGravity
StaticGravity
CenterGravity

For additional information on gravity, see section 3.2.3.

The backing_store member is set to indicate how the X server should maintain the contents of a window and can be WhenMapped, Always, or NotUseful. The backing_planes member is set to indicate (with bits set to 1) which bit planes of the window hold dynamic data that must be preserved in backing_stores and during save_unders. The backing_pixel member is set to indicate what values to use for planes not set in backing_planes.

The save_under member is set to True or False. The colormap member is set to the colormap for the specified window and can be a colormap ID or None. The map_installed member is set to indicate whether the colormap is currently installed and can be True or False. The map_state member is set to indicate the state of the window and can be IsUnmapped, IsUnviewable, or IsViewable. IsUnviewable is used if the window is mapped but some ancestor is unmapped.

The all_event_masks member is set to the bitwise inclusive OR of all event masks selected on the window by all clients. The your_event_mask member is set to the bitwise inclusive OR of all event masks selected by the querying client. The do_not_propagate_mask member is set to the bitwise inclusive OR of the set of events that should not propagate.

The override_redirect member is set to indicate whether this window overrides structure control facilities and can be True or False. Window manager clients should ignore the window if this member is True.

The screen member is set to a screen pointer that gives you a back pointer to the correct screen. This makes it easier to obtain the screen information without having to loop over the root window fields to see which field matches.

XGetWindowAttributes can generate BadDrawable and BadWindow errors.

To obtain the current geometry of a given drawable, use XGetGeometry. __ │

Status XGetGeometry(display, d, root_return, x_return, y_return, width_return,
height_return
, border_width_return, depth_return)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
Window *root_return;
int *x_return, *y_return;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;
unsigned int *border_width_return;
unsigned int *depth_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable, which can be a window or a

pixmap.

root_returnReturns the root window.

x_return

y_return

Return the x and y coordinates that define the lo-

cation of the drawable. For a window, these coor-
dinates specify the upper-left outer corner rela-
tive to its parent’s origin. For pixmaps, these
coordinates are always zero.

width_return
height_return

Return the drawable’s dimensions (width and
height). For a window, these dimensions specify
the inside size, not including the border.

border_width_return
Returns the border width in pixels. If the draw-
able is a pixmap, it returns zero.

depth_return
Returns the depth of the drawable (bits per pixel
for the object). │__

The XGetGeometry function returns the root window and the current geometry of the drawable. The geometry of the drawable includes the x and y coordinates, width and height, border width, and depth. These are described in the argument list. It is legal to pass to this function a window whose class is InputOnly.

XGetGeometry can generate a BadDrawable error.

4.2. Translating Screen Coordinates

Applications sometimes need to perform a coordinate transformation from the coordinate space of one window to another window or need to determine which window the pointing device is in. XTranslateCoordinates and XQueryPointer fulfill these needs (and avoid any race conditions) by asking the X server to perform these operations.

To translate a coordinate in one window to the coordinate space of another window, use XTranslateCoordinates. __ │

Bool XTranslateCoordinates(display, src_w, dest_w, src_x, src_y, dest_x_return,
dest_y_return
, child_return)
Display *display;
Window src_w, dest_w;
int src_x, src_y;
int *dest_x_return, *dest_y_return;
Window *child_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

src_w

Specifies the source window.

dest_w

Specifies the destination window.

src_x

src_y

Specify the x and y coordinates within the source

window.

dest_x_return
dest_y_return

Return the x and y coordinates within the destina-
tion window.

child_return
Returns the child if the coordinates are contained
in a mapped child of the destination window. │__

If XTranslateCoordinates returns True, it takes the src_x and src_y coordinates relative to the source window’s origin and returns these coordinates to dest_x_return and dest_y_return relative to the destination window’s origin. If XTranslateCoordinates returns False, src_w and dest_w are on different screens, and dest_x_return and dest_y_return are zero. If the coordinates are contained in a mapped child of dest_w, that child is returned to child_return. Otherwise, child_return is set to None.

XTranslateCoordinates can generate a BadWindow error.

To obtain the screen coordinates of the pointer or to determine the pointer coordinates relative to a specified window, use XQueryPointer. __ │

Bool XQueryPointer(display, w, root_return, child_return, root_x_return, root_y_return,
win_x_return
, win_y_return, mask_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window *root_return, *child_return;
int *root_x_return, *root_y_return;
int *win_x_return, *win_y_return;
unsigned int *mask_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

root_returnReturns the root window that the pointer is in.

child_return
Returns the child window that the pointer is lo-
cated in, if any.

root_x_return
root_y_return

Return the pointer coordinates relative to the
root window’s origin.

win_x_return
win_y_return

Return the pointer coordinates relative to the
specified window.

mask_returnReturns the current state of the modifier keys
and pointer buttons. │__

The XQueryPointer function returns the root window the pointer is logically on and the pointer coordinates relative to the root window’s origin. If XQueryPointer returns False, the pointer is not on the same screen as the specified window, and XQueryPointer returns None to child_return and zero to win_x_return and win_y_return. If XQueryPointer returns True, the pointer coordinates returned to win_x_return and win_y_return are relative to the origin of the specified window. In this case, XQueryPointer returns the child that contains the pointer, if any, or else None to child_return.

XQueryPointer returns the current logical state of the keyboard buttons and the modifier keys in mask_return. It sets mask_return to the bitwise inclusive OR of one or more of the button or modifier key bitmasks to match the current state of the mouse buttons and the modifier keys.

Note that the logical state of a device (as seen through Xlib) may lag the physical state if device event processing is frozen (see section 12.1).

XQueryPointer can generate a BadWindow error.

4.3. Properties and Atoms

A property is a collection of named, typed data. The window system has a set of predefined properties (for example, the name of a window, size hints, and so on), and users can define any other arbitrary information and associate it with windows. Each property has a name, which is an ISO Latin-1 string. For each named property, a unique identifier (atom) is associated with it. A property also has a type, for example, string or integer. These types are also indicated using atoms, so arbitrary new types can be defined. Data of only one type may be associated with a single property name. Clients can store and retrieve properties associated with windows. For efficiency reasons, an atom is used rather than a character string. XInternAtom can be used to obtain the atom for property names.

A property is also stored in one of several possible formats. The X server can store the information as 8-bit quantities, 16-bit quantities, or 32-bit quantities. This permits the X server to present the data in the byte order that the client expects.

Note

If you define further properties of complex type, you must encode and decode them yourself. These functions must be carefully written if they are to be portable. For further information about how to write a library extension, see appendix C.

The type of a property is defined by an atom, which allows for arbitrary extension in this type scheme.

Certain property names are predefined in the server for commonly used functions. The atoms for these properties are defined in <X11/Xatom.h>. To avoid name clashes with user symbols, the #define name for each atom has the XA_ prefix. For an explanation of the functions that let you get and set much of the information stored in these predefined properties, see chapter 14.

The core protocol imposes no semantics on these property names, but semantics are specified in other X Consortium standards, such as the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual and the X Logical Font Description Conventions.

You can use properties to communicate other information between applications. The functions described in this section let you define new properties and get the unique atom IDs in your applications.

Although any particular atom can have some client interpretation within each of the name spaces, atoms occur in five distinct name spaces within the protocol:

Selections

Property names

Property types

Font properties

Type of a ClientMessage event (none are built into the X server)

The built-in selection property names are:

PRIMARY
SECONDARY

The built-in property names are:
CUT_BUFFER0 RESOURCE_MANAGER
CUT_BUFFER1 WM_CLASS
CUT_BUFFER2 WM_CLIENT_MACHINE
CUT_BUFFER3 WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS
CUT_BUFFER4 WM_COMMAND
CUT_BUFFER5 WM_HINTS
CUT_BUFFER6 WM_ICON_NAME
CUT_BUFFER7 WM_ICON_SIZE
RGB_BEST_MAP WM_NAME
RGB_BLUE_MAP WM_NORMAL_HINTS
RGB_DEFAULT_MAP WM_PROTOCOLS
RGB_GRAY_MAP WM_STATE
RGB_GREEN_MAP WM_TRANSIENT_FOR
RGB_RED_MAP WM_ZOOM_HINTS

The built-in property types are:
ARC POINT
ATOM RGB_COLOR_MAP
BITMAP RECTANGLE
CARDINAL STRING
COLORMAP VISUALID
CURSOR WINDOW
DRAWABLE WM_HINTS
FONT WM_SIZE_HINTS
INTEGER
PIXMAP

The built-in font property names are:
MIN_SPACE STRIKEOUT_DESCENT
NORM_SPACE STRIKEOUT_ASCENT
MAX_SPACE ITALIC_ANGLE
END_SPACE X_HEIGHT
SUPERSCRIPT_X QUAD_WIDTH
SUPERSCRIPT_Y WEIGHT
SUBSCRIPT_X POINT_SIZE
SUBSCRIPT_Y RESOLUTION
UNDERLINE_POSITION COPYRIGHT
UNDERLINE_THICKNESS NOTICE
FONT_NAME FAMILY_NAME
FULL_NAME CAP_HEIGHT

For further information about font properties, see section 8.5.

To return an atom for a given name, use XInternAtom. __ │

Atom XInternAtom(display, atom_name, only_if_exists)
Display *display;
char *atom_name;
Bool only_if_exists;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

atom_name

Specifies the name associated with the atom you

want returned.

only_if_exists
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
the atom must be created. │__

The XInternAtom function returns the atom identifier associated with the specified atom_name string. If only_if_exists is False, the atom is created if it does not exist. Therefore, XInternAtom can return None. If the atom name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Uppercase and lowercase matter; the strings ‘‘thing’’, ‘‘Thing’’, and ‘‘thinG’’ all designate different atoms. The atom will remain defined even after the client’s connection closes. It will become undefined only when the last connection to the X server closes.

XInternAtom can generate BadAlloc and BadValue errors.

To return atoms for an array of names, use XInternAtoms. __ │

Status XInternAtoms(display, names, count, only_if_exists, atoms_return)
Display *display;
char **names;
int count;
Bool only_if_exists;
Atom *atoms_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

names

Specifies the array of atom names.

count

Specifies the number of atom names in the array.

only_if_exists
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
the atom must be created.

atoms_return
Returns the atoms. │__

The XInternAtoms function returns the atom identifiers associated with the specified names. The atoms are stored in the atoms_return array supplied by the caller. Calling this function is equivalent to calling XInternAtom for each of the names in turn with the specified value of only_if_exists, but this function minimizes the number of round-trip protocol exchanges between the client and the X server.

This function returns a nonzero status if atoms are returned for all of the names; otherwise, it returns zero.

XInternAtoms can generate BadAlloc and BadValue errors.

To return a name for a given atom identifier, use XGetAtomName. __ │

char *XGetAtomName(display, atom)
Display *display;
Atom atom;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

atom

Specifies the atom for the property name you want

returned. │__

The XGetAtomName function returns the name associated with the specified atom. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned string is in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. To free the resulting string, call XFree.

XGetAtomName can generate a BadAtom error.

To return the names for an array of atom identifiers, use XGetAtomNames. __ │

Status XGetAtomNames(display, atoms, count, names_return)
Display *display;
Atom *atoms;
int count;
char **names_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

atoms

Specifies the array of atoms.

count

Specifies the number of atoms in the array.

names_return
Returns the atom names. │__

The XGetAtomNames function returns the names associated with the specified atoms. The names are stored in the names_return array supplied by the caller. Calling this function is equivalent to calling XGetAtomName for each of the atoms in turn, but this function minimizes the number of round-trip protocol exchanges between the client and the X server.

This function returns a nonzero status if names are returned for all of the atoms; otherwise, it returns zero.

XGetAtomNames can generate a BadAtom error.

4.4. Obtaining and Changing Window Properties

You can attach a property list to every window. Each property has a name, a type, and a value (see section 4.3). The value is an array of 8-bit, 16-bit, or 32-bit quantities, whose interpretation is left to the clients. The type char is used to represent 8-bit quantities, the type short is used to represent 16-bit quantities, and the type long is used to represent 32-bit quantities.

Xlib provides functions that you can use to obtain, change, update, or interchange window properties. In addition, Xlib provides other utility functions for inter-client communication (see chapter 14).

To obtain the type, format, and value of a property of a given window, use XGetWindowProperty. __ │

int XGetWindowProperty(display, w, property, long_offset, long_length, delete, req_type,
actual_type_return
, actual_format_return, nitems_return, bytes_after_return,
prop_return
)
Display *display;
Window w;
Atom property;
long long_offset, long_length;
Bool delete;
Atom req_type;
Atom *actual_type_return;
int *actual_format_return;
unsigned long *nitems_return;
unsigned long *bytes_after_return;
unsigned char **prop_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose property you want to

obtain.

property

Specifies the property name.

long_offsetSpecifies the offset in the specified property
(in 32-bit quantities) where the data is to be re-
trieved.

long_lengthSpecifies the length in 32-bit multiples of the
data to be retrieved.

delete

Specifies a Boolean value that determines whether

the property is deleted.

req_type

Specifies the atom identifier associated with the

property type or AnyPropertyType.

actual_type_return
Returns the atom identifier that defines the ac-
tual type of the property.

actual_format_return
Returns the actual format of the property.

nitems_return
Returns the actual number of 8-bit, 16-bit, or
32-bit items stored in the prop_return data.

bytes_after_return
Returns the number of bytes remaining to be read
in the property if a partial read was performed.

prop_returnReturns the data in the specified format. │__

The XGetWindowProperty function returns the actual type of the property; the actual format of the property; the number of 8-bit, 16-bit, or 32-bit items transferred; the number of bytes remaining to be read in the property; and a pointer to the data actually returned. XGetWindowProperty sets the return arguments as follows:

If the specified property does not exist for the specified window, XGetWindowProperty returns None to actual_type_return and the value zero to actual_format_return and bytes_after_return. The nitems_return argument is empty. In this case, the delete argument is ignored.

If the specified property exists but its type does not match the specified type, XGetWindowProperty returns the actual property type to actual_type_return, the actual property format (never zero) to actual_format_return, and the property length in bytes (even if the actual_format_return is 16 or 32) to bytes_after_return. It also ignores the delete argument. The nitems_return argument is empty.

If the specified property exists and either you assign AnyPropertyType to the req_type argument or the specified type matches the actual property type, XGetWindowProperty returns the actual property type to actual_type_return and the actual property format (never zero) to actual_format_return. It also returns a value to bytes_after_return and nitems_return, by defining the following values:

N = actual length of the stored property in bytes

(even if the format is 16 or 32)

I = 4 * long_offset

T = N - I

L = MINIMUM(T, 4 * long_length)

A = N - (I + L)

The returned value starts at byte index I in the property (indexing from zero), and its length in bytes is L. If the value for long_offset causes L to be negative, a BadValue error results. The value of bytes_after_return is A, giving the number of trailing unread bytes in the stored property.

If the returned format is 8, the returned data is represented as a char array. If the returned format is 16, the returned data is represented as a short array and should be cast to that type to obtain the elements. If the returned format is 32, the returned data is represented as a long array and should be cast to that type to obtain the elements.

XGetWindowProperty always allocates one extra byte in prop_return (even if the property is zero length) and sets it to zero so that simple properties consisting of characters do not have to be copied into yet another string before use.

If delete is True and bytes_after_return is zero, XGetWindowProperty deletes the property from the window and generates a PropertyNotify event on the window.

The function returns Success if it executes successfully. To free the resulting data, use XFree.

XGetWindowProperty can generate BadAtom, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To obtain a given window’s property list, use XListProperties. __ │

Atom *XListProperties(display, w, num_prop_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
int *num_prop_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose property list you want

to obtain.

num_prop_return
Returns the length of the properties array. │__

The XListProperties function returns a pointer to an array of atom properties that are defined for the specified window or returns NULL if no properties were found. To free the memory allocated by this function, use XFree.

XListProperties can generate a BadWindow error.

To change a property of a given window, use XChangeProperty. __ │

XChangeProperty(display, w, property, type, format, mode, data, nelements)
Display *display;
Window w;
Atom property, type;
int format;
int mode;
unsigned char *data;
int nelements;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose property you want to

change.

property

Specifies the property name.

type

Specifies the type of the property. The X server

does not interpret the type but simply passes it
back to an application that later calls XGetWin-
dowProperty
.

format

Specifies whether the data should be viewed as a

list of 8-bit, 16-bit, or 32-bit quantities. Pos-
sible values are 8, 16, and 32. This information
allows the X server to correctly perform byte-swap
operations as necessary. If the format is 16-bit
or 32-bit, you must explicitly cast your data
pointer to an (unsigned char *) in the call to
XChangeProperty
.

mode

Specifies the mode of the operation. You can pass

PropModeReplace, PropModePrepend, or PropModeAp-
pend
.

data

Specifies the property data.

nelements

Specifies the number of elements of the specified

data format. │__

The XChangeProperty function alters the property for the specified window and causes the X server to generate a PropertyNotify event on that window. XChangeProperty performs the following:

If mode is PropModeReplace, XChangeProperty discards the previous property value and stores the new data.

If mode is PropModePrepend or PropModeAppend, XChangeProperty inserts the specified data before the beginning of the existing data or onto the end of the existing data, respectively. The type and format must match the existing property value, or a BadMatch error results. If the property is undefined, it is treated as defined with the correct type and format with zero-length data.

If the specified format is 8, the property data must be a char array. If the specified format is 16, the property data must be a short array. If the specified format is 32, the property data must be a long array.

The lifetime of a property is not tied to the storing client. Properties remain until explicitly deleted, until the window is destroyed, or until the server resets. For a discussion of what happens when the connection to the X server is closed, see section 2.6. The maximum size of a property is server dependent and can vary dynamically depending on the amount of memory the server has available. (If there is insufficient space, a BadAlloc error results.)

XChangeProperty can generate BadAlloc, BadAtom, BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To rotate a window’s property list, use XRotateWindowProperties. __ │

XRotateWindowProperties(display, w, properties, num_prop, npositions)
Display *display;
Window w;
Atom properties[];
int num_prop;
int npositions;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

propertiesSpecifies the array of properties that are to be
rotated.

num_prop

Specifies the length of the properties array.

npositionsSpecifies the rotation amount. │__

The XRotateWindowProperties function allows you to rotate properties on a window and causes the X server to generate PropertyNotify events. If the property names in the properties array are viewed as being numbered starting from zero and if there are num_prop property names in the list, then the value associated with property name I becomes the value associated with property name (I + npositions) mod N for all I from zero to N − 1. The effect is to rotate the states by npositions places around the virtual ring of property names (right for positive npositions, left for negative npositions). If npositions mod N is nonzero, the X server generates a PropertyNotify event for each property in the order that they are listed in the array. If an atom occurs more than once in the list or no property with that name is defined for the window, a BadMatch error results. If a BadAtom or BadMatch error results, no properties are changed.

XRotateWindowProperties can generate BadAtom, BadMatch, and BadWindow errors.

To delete a property on a given window, use XDeleteProperty. __ │

XDeleteProperty(display, w, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose property you want to

delete.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XDeleteProperty function deletes the specified property only if the property was defined on the specified window and causes the X server to generate a PropertyNotify event on the window unless the property does not exist.

XDeleteProperty can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

4.5. Selections

Selections are one method used by applications to exchange data. By using the property mechanism, applications can exchange data of arbitrary types and can negotiate the type of the data. A selection can be thought of as an indirect property with a dynamic type. That is, rather than having the property stored in the X server, the property is maintained by some client (the owner). A selection is global in nature (considered to belong to the user but be maintained by clients) rather than being private to a particular window subhierarchy or a particular set of clients.

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set, get, or request conversion of selections. This allows applications to implement the notion of current selection, which requires that notification be sent to applications when they no longer own the selection. Applications that support selection often highlight the current selection and so must be informed when another application has acquired the selection so that they can unhighlight the selection.

When a client asks for the contents of a selection, it specifies a selection target type. This target type can be used to control the transmitted representation of the contents. For example, if the selection is ‘‘the last thing the user clicked on’’ and that is currently an image, then the target type might specify whether the contents of the image should be sent in XY format or Z format.

The target type can also be used to control the class of contents transmitted, for example, asking for the ‘‘looks’’ (fonts, line spacing, indentation, and so forth) of a paragraph selection, not the text of the paragraph. The target type can also be used for other purposes. The protocol does not constrain the semantics.

To set the selection owner, use XSetSelectionOwner. __ │

XSetSelectionOwner(display, selection, owner, time)
Display *display;
Atom selection;
Window owner;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

selection

Specifies the selection atom.

owner

Specifies the owner of the specified selection

atom. You can pass a window or None.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XSetSelectionOwner function changes the owner and last-change time for the specified selection and has no effect if the specified time is earlier than the current last-change time of the specified selection or is later than the current X server time. Otherwise, the last-change time is set to the specified time, with CurrentTime replaced by the current server time. If the owner window is specified as None, then the owner of the selection becomes None (that is, no owner). Otherwise, the owner of the selection becomes the client executing the request.

If the new owner (whether a client or None) is not the same as the current owner of the selection and the current owner is not None, the current owner is sent a SelectionClear event. If the client that is the owner of a selection is later terminated (that is, its connection is closed) or if the owner window it has specified in the request is later destroyed, the owner of the selection automatically reverts to None, but the last-change time is not affected. The selection atom is uninterpreted by the X server. XGetSelectionOwner returns the owner window, which is reported in SelectionRequest and SelectionClear events. Selections are global to the X server.

XSetSelectionOwner can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

To return the selection owner, use XGetSelectionOwner. __ │

Window XGetSelectionOwner(display, selection)
Display *display;
Atom selection;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

selection

Specifies the selection atom whose owner you want

returned. │__

The XGetSelectionOwner function returns the window ID associated with the window that currently owns the specified selection. If no selection was specified, the function returns the constant None. If None is returned, there is no owner for the selection.

XGetSelectionOwner can generate a BadAtom error.

To request conversion of a selection, use XConvertSelection. __ │

XConvertSelection(display, selection, target, property, requestor, time)
Display *display;
Atom selection, target;
Atom property;
Window requestor;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

selection

Specifies the selection atom.

target

Specifies the target atom.

property

Specifies the property name. You also can pass

None.

requestor

Specifies the requestor.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

XConvertSelection requests that the specified selection be converted to the specified target type:

If the specified selection has an owner, the X server sends a SelectionRequest event to that owner.

If no owner for the specified selection exists, the X server generates a SelectionNotify event to the requestor with property None.

The arguments are passed on unchanged in either of the events. There are two predefined selection atoms: PRIMARY and SECONDARY.

XConvertSelection can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

4

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 5

Pixmap and Cursor Functions

Once you have connected to an X server, you can use the Xlib functions to:

Create and free pixmaps

Create, recolor, and free cursors

5.1. Creating and Freeing Pixmaps

Pixmaps can only be used on the screen on which they were created. Pixmaps are off-screen resources that are used for various operations, such as defining cursors as tiling patterns or as the source for certain raster operations. Most graphics requests can operate either on a window or on a pixmap. A bitmap is a single bit-plane pixmap.

To create a pixmap of a given size, use XCreatePixmap. __ │

Pixmap XCreatePixmap(display, d, width, height, depth)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int depth;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies which screen the pixmap is created on.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which define the di-

mensions of the pixmap.

depth

Specifies the depth of the pixmap. │__

The XCreatePixmap function creates a pixmap of the width, height, and depth you specified and returns a pixmap ID that identifies it. It is valid to pass an InputOnly window to the drawable argument. The width and height arguments must be nonzero, or a BadValue error results. The depth argument must be one of the depths supported by the screen of the specified drawable, or a BadValue error results.

The server uses the specified drawable to determine on which screen to create the pixmap. The pixmap can be used only on this screen and only with other drawables of the same depth (see XCopyPlane for an exception to this rule). The initial contents of the pixmap are undefined.

XCreatePixmap can generate BadAlloc, BadDrawable, and BadValue errors.

To free all storage associated with a specified pixmap, use XFreePixmap. __ │

XFreePixmap(display, pixmap)
Display *display;
Pixmap pixmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

pixmap

Specifies the pixmap. │__

The XFreePixmap function first deletes the association between the pixmap ID and the pixmap. Then, the X server frees the pixmap storage when there are no references to it. The pixmap should never be referenced again.

XFreePixmap can generate a BadPixmap error.

5.2. Creating, Recoloring, and Freeing Cursors

Each window can have a different cursor defined for it. Whenever the pointer is in a visible window, it is set to the cursor defined for that window. If no cursor was defined for that window, the cursor is the one defined for the parent window.

From X’s perspective, a cursor consists of a cursor source, mask, colors, and a hotspot. The mask pixmap determines the shape of the cursor and must be a depth of one. The source pixmap must have a depth of one, and the colors determine the colors of the source. The hotspot defines the point on the cursor that is reported when a pointer event occurs. There may be limitations imposed by the hardware on cursors as to size and whether a mask is implemented. XQueryBestCursor can be used to find out what sizes are possible. There is a standard font for creating cursors, but Xlib provides functions that you can use to create cursors from an arbitrary font or from bitmaps.

To create a cursor from the standard cursor font, use XCreateFontCursor. __ │

#include <X11/cursorfont.h>
Cursor XCreateFontCursor(display, shape)
Display *display;
unsigned int shape;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

shape

Specifies the shape of the cursor. │__

X provides a set of standard cursor shapes in a special font named cursor. Applications are encouraged to use this interface for their cursors because the font can be customized for the individual display type. The shape argument specifies which glyph of the standard fonts to use.

The hotspot comes from the information stored in the cursor font. The initial colors of a cursor are a black foreground and a white background (see XRecolorCursor). For further information about cursor shapes, see appendix B.

XCreateFontCursor can generate BadAlloc and BadValue errors.

To create a cursor from font glyphs, use XCreateGlyphCursor. __ │

Cursor XCreateGlyphCursor(display, source_font, mask_font, source_char, mask_char,
foreground_color
, background_color)
Display *display;
Font source_font, mask_font;
unsigned int source_char, mask_char;
XColor *foreground_color;
XColor *background_color;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

source_fontSpecifies the font for the source glyph.

mask_font

Specifies the font for the mask glyph or None.

source_charSpecifies the character glyph for the source.

mask_char

Specifies the glyph character for the mask.

foreground_color
Specifies the RGB values for the foreground of the
source.

background_color
Specifies the RGB values for the background of the
source. │__

The XCreateGlyphCursor function is similar to XCreatePixmapCursor except that the source and mask bitmaps are obtained from the specified font glyphs. The source_char must be a defined glyph in source_font, or a BadValue error results. If mask_font is given, mask_char must be a defined glyph in mask_font, or a BadValue error results. The mask_font and character are optional. The origins of the source_char and mask_char (if defined) glyphs are positioned coincidently and define the hotspot. The source_char and mask_char need not have the same bounding box metrics, and there is no restriction on the placement of the hotspot relative to the bounding boxes. If no mask_char is given, all pixels of the source are displayed. You can free the fonts immediately by calling XFreeFont if no further explicit references to them are to be made.

For 2-byte matrix fonts, the 16-bit value should be formed with the byte1 member in the most significant byte and the byte2 member in the least significant byte.

XCreateGlyphCursor can generate BadAlloc, BadFont, and BadValue errors.

To create a cursor from two bitmaps, use XCreatePixmapCursor. __ │

Cursor XCreatePixmapCursor(display, source, mask, foreground_color, background_color, x, y)
Display *display;
Pixmap source;
Pixmap mask;
XColor *foreground_color;
XColor *background_color;
unsigned int x, y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

source

Specifies the shape of the source cursor.

mask

Specifies the cursor’s source bits to be displayed

or None.

foreground_color
Specifies the RGB values for the foreground of the
source.

background_color
Specifies the RGB values for the background of the
source.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which indicate

the hotspot relative to the source’s origin. │__

The XCreatePixmapCursor function creates a cursor and returns the cursor ID associated with it. The foreground and background RGB values must be specified using foreground_color and background_color, even if the X server only has a StaticGray or GrayScale screen. The foreground color is used for the pixels set to 1 in the source, and the background color is used for the pixels set to 0. Both source and mask, if specified, must have depth one (or a BadMatch error results) but can have any root. The mask argument defines the shape of the cursor. The pixels set to 1 in the mask define which source pixels are displayed, and the pixels set to 0 define which pixels are ignored. If no mask is given, all pixels of the source are displayed. The mask, if present, must be the same size as the pixmap defined by the source argument, or a BadMatch error results. The hotspot must be a point within the source, or a BadMatch error results.

The components of the cursor can be transformed arbitrarily to meet display limitations. The pixmaps can be freed immediately if no further explicit references to them are to be made. Subsequent drawing in the source or mask pixmap has an undefined effect on the cursor. The X server might or might not make a copy of the pixmap.

XCreatePixmapCursor can generate BadAlloc and BadPixmap errors.

To determine useful cursor sizes, use XQueryBestCursor. __ │

Status XQueryBestCursor(display, d, width, height, width_return, height_return)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable, which indicates the

screen.

width

height

Specify the width and height of the cursor that

you want the size information for.

width_return
height_return

Return the best width and height that is closest
to the specified width and height. │__

Some displays allow larger cursors than other displays. The XQueryBestCursor function provides a way to find out what size cursors are actually possible on the display. It returns the largest size that can be displayed. Applications should be prepared to use smaller cursors on displays that cannot support large ones.

XQueryBestCursor can generate a BadDrawable error.

To change the color of a given cursor, use XRecolorCursor. __ │

XRecolorCursor(display, cursor, foreground_color, background_color)
Display *display;
Cursor cursor;
XColor *foreground_color, *background_color;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

cursor

Specifies the cursor.

foreground_color
Specifies the RGB values for the foreground of the
source.

background_color
Specifies the RGB values for the background of the
source. │__

The XRecolorCursor function changes the color of the specified cursor, and if the cursor is being displayed on a screen, the change is visible immediately. The pixel members of the XColor structures are ignored; only the RGB values are used.

XRecolorCursor can generate a BadCursor error.

To free (destroy) a given cursor, use XFreeCursor. __ │

XFreeCursor(display, cursor)
Display *display;
Cursor cursor;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

cursor

Specifies the cursor. │__

The XFreeCursor function deletes the association between the cursor resource ID and the specified cursor. The cursor storage is freed when no other resource references it. The specified cursor ID should not be referred to again.

XFreeCursor can generate a BadCursor error.

5

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 6

Color Management Functions

Each X window always has an associated colormap that provides a level of indirection between pixel values and colors displayed on the screen. Xlib provides functions that you can use to manipulate a colormap. The X protocol defines colors using values in the RGB color space. The RGB color space is device dependent; rendering an RGB value on differing output devices typically results in different colors. Xlib also provides a means for clients to specify color using device-independent color spaces for consistent results across devices. Xlib supports device-independent color spaces derivable from the CIE XYZ color space. This includes the CIE XYZ, xyY, L*u*v*, and L*a*b* color spaces as well as the TekHVC color space.

This chapter discusses how to:

Create, copy, and destroy a colormap

Specify colors by name or value

Allocate, modify, and free color cells

Read entries in a colormap

Convert between color spaces

Control aspects of color conversion

Query the color gamut of a screen

Add new color spaces

All functions, types, and symbols in this chapter with the prefix ‘‘Xcms’’ are defined in <X11/Xcms.h>. The remaining functions and types are defined in <X11/Xlib.h>.

Functions in this chapter manipulate the representation of color on the screen. For each possible value that a pixel can take in a window, there is a color cell in the colormap. For example, if a window is 4 bits deep, pixel values 0 through 15 are defined. A colormap is a collection of color cells. A color cell consists of a triple of red, green, and blue (RGB) values. The hardware imposes limits on the number of significant bits in these values. As each pixel is read out of display memory, the pixel is looked up in a colormap. The RGB value of the cell determines what color is displayed on the screen. On a grayscale display with a black-and-white monitor, the values are combined to determine the brightness on the screen.

Typically, an application allocates color cells or sets of color cells to obtain the desired colors. The client can allocate read-only cells. In which case, the pixel values for these colors can be shared among multiple applications, and the RGB value of the cell cannot be changed. If the client allocates read/write cells, they are exclusively owned by the client, and the color associated with the pixel value can be changed at will. Cells must be allocated (and, if read/write, initialized with an RGB value) by a client to obtain desired colors. The use of pixel value for an unallocated cell results in an undefined color.

Because colormaps are associated with windows, X supports displays with multiple colormaps and, indeed, different types of colormaps. If there are insufficient colormap resources in the display, some windows will display in their true colors, and others will display with incorrect colors. A window manager usually controls which windows are displayed in their true colors if more than one colormap is required for the color resources the applications are using. At any time, there is a set of installed colormaps for a screen. Windows using one of the installed colormaps display with true colors, and windows using other colormaps generally display with incorrect colors. You can control the set of installed colormaps by using XInstallColormap and XUninstallColormap.

Colormaps are local to a particular screen. Screens always have a default colormap, and programs typically allocate cells out of this colormap. Generally, you should not write applications that monopolize color resources. Although some hardware supports multiple colormaps installed at one time, many of the hardware displays built today support only a single installed colormap, so the primitives are written to encourage sharing of colormap entries between applications.

The DefaultColormap macro returns the default colormap. The DefaultVisual macro returns the default visual type for the specified screen. Possible visual types are StaticGray, GrayScale, StaticColor, PseudoColor, TrueColor, or DirectColor (see section 3.1).

6.1. Color Structures

Functions that operate only on RGB color space values use an XColor structure, which contains: __ │

typedef struct {

unsigned long pixel;/* pixel value */

unsigned short red, green, blue;/* rgb values */

char flags;

/* DoRed, DoGreen, DoBlue */

char pad;

} XColor; │__

The red, green, and blue values are always in the range 0 to 65535 inclusive, independent of the number of bits actually used in the display hardware. The server scales these values down to the range used by the hardware. Black is represented by (0,0,0), and white is represented by (65535,65535,65535). In some functions, the flags member controls which of the red, green, and blue members is used and can be the inclusive OR of zero or more of DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue.

Functions that operate on all color space values use an XcmsColor structure. This structure contains a union of substructures, each supporting color specification encoding for a particular color space. Like the XColor structure, the XcmsColor structure contains pixel and color specification information (the spec member in the XcmsColor structure). __ │

typedef unsigned long XcmsColorFormat;/* Color Specification Format */

typedef struct {

union {

XcmsRGB RGB;

XcmsRGBi RGBi;

XcmsCIEXYZ CIEXYZ;

XcmsCIEuvY CIEuvY;

XcmsCIExyY CIExyY;

XcmsCIELab CIELab;

XcmsCIELuv CIELuv;

XcmsTekHVC TekHVC;

XcmsPad Pad;

} spec;

unsigned long pixel;

XcmsColorFormat format;

} XcmsColor;

/* Xcms Color Structure */ │__

Because the color specification can be encoded for the various color spaces, encoding for the spec member is identified by the format member, which is of type XcmsColorFormat. The following macros define standard formats. __ │
#de-
fine
XcmsUndefined-
Format

0x00000000

#de-
fine
XcmsCIEXYZFormat

0x00000001
/* CIE XYZ */

#de-
fine
XcmsCIEuvYFormat

0x00000002
/* CIE u’v’Y */

#de-
fine
XcmsCIExyYFormat

0x00000003
/* CIE xyY */

#de-
fine
XcmsCIELabFormat

0x00000004
/* CIE L*a*b*
*/
#de-
fine
XcmsCIELuvFormat

0x00000005
/* CIE L*u*v*
*/
#de-
fine
XcmsTekHVCFormat

0x00000006
/* TekHVC */

#de-
fine
XcmsRGBFormat

0x80000000
/* RGB Device
*/
#de-
fine
XcmsRGBiFormat

0x80000001
/* RGB Intensi-
ty */ │__

Formats for device-independent color spaces are distinguishable from those for device-dependent spaces by the 32nd bit. If this bit is set, it indicates that the color specification is in a device-dependent form; otherwise, it is in a device-independent form. If the 31st bit is set, this indicates that the color space has been added to Xlib at run time (see section 6.12.4). The format value for a color space added at run time may be different each time the program is executed. If references to such a color space must be made outside the client (for example, storing a color specification in a file), then reference should be made by color space string prefix (see XcmsFormatOfPrefix and XcmsPrefixOfFormat).

Data types that describe the color specification encoding for the various color spaces are defined as follows: __ │

typedef double XcmsFloat;

typedef struct {

unsigned short red;

/* 0x0000 to 0xffff */

unsigned short green;/* 0x0000 to 0xffff */

unsigned short blue;/* 0x0000 to 0xffff */

} XcmsRGB;

/* RGB Device */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat red;

/* 0.0 to 1.0 */

XcmsFloat green;

/* 0.0 to 1.0 */

XcmsFloat blue;

/* 0.0 to 1.0 */

} XcmsRGBi;

/* RGB Intensity */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat X;

XcmsFloat Y;

/* 0.0 to 1.0 */

XcmsFloat Z;

} XcmsCIEXYZ;

/* CIE XYZ */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat u_prime;

/* 0.0 to ~0.6 */

XcmsFloat v_prime;

/* 0.0 to ~0.6 */

XcmsFloat Y;

/* 0.0 to 1.0 */

} XcmsCIEuvY;

/* CIE u’v’Y */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat x;

/* 0.0 to ~.75 */

XcmsFloat y;

/* 0.0 to ~.85 */

XcmsFloat Y;

/* 0.0 to 1.0 */

} XcmsCIExyY;

/* CIE xyY */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat L_star;

/* 0.0 to 100.0 */

XcmsFloat a_star;

XcmsFloat b_star;

} XcmsCIELab;

/* CIE L*a*b* */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat L_star;

/* 0.0 to 100.0 */

XcmsFloat u_star;

XcmsFloat v_star;

} XcmsCIELuv;

/* CIE L*u*v* */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat H;

/* 0.0 to 360.0 */

XcmsFloat V;

/* 0.0 to 100.0 */

XcmsFloat C;

/* 0.0 to 100.0 */

} XcmsTekHVC;

/* TekHVC */

typedef struct {

XcmsFloat pad0;

XcmsFloat pad1;

XcmsFloat pad2;

XcmsFloat pad3;

} XcmsPad;

/* four doubles */ │__

The device-dependent formats provided allow color specification in:

RGB Intensity (XcmsRGBi)

Red, green, and blue linear intensity values, floating-point values from 0.0 to 1.0, where 1.0 indicates full intensity, 0.5 half intensity, and so on.

RGB Device (XcmsRGB)

Red, green, and blue values appropriate for the specified output device. XcmsRGB values are of type unsigned short, scaled from 0 to 65535 inclusive, and are interchangeable with the red, green, and blue values in an XColor structure.

It is important to note that RGB Intensity values are not gamma corrected values. In contrast, RGB Device values generated as a result of converting color specifications are always gamma corrected, and RGB Device values acquired as a result of querying a colormap or passed in by the client are assumed by Xlib to be gamma corrected. The term RGB value in this manual always refers to an RGB Device value.

6.2. Color Strings

Xlib provides a mechanism for using string names for colors. A color string may either contain an abstract color name or a numerical color specification. Color strings are case-insensitive.

Color strings are used in the following functions:

XAllocNamedColor

XcmsAllocNamedColor

XLookupColor

XcmsLookupColor

XParseColor

XStoreNamedColor

Xlib supports the use of abstract color names, for example, red or blue. A value for this abstract name is obtained by searching one or more color name databases. Xlib first searches zero or more client-side databases; the number, location, and content of these databases is implementation-dependent and might depend on the current locale. If the name is not found, Xlib then looks for the color in the X server’s database. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

A numerical color specification consists of a color space name and a set of values in the following syntax: __ │

<color_space_name>:<value>/.../<value> │__

The following are examples of valid color strings.

"CIEXYZ:0.3227/0.28133/0.2493"
"RGBi:1.0/0.0/0.0"
"rgb:00/ff/00"
"CIELuv:50.0/0.0/0.0"

The syntax and semantics of numerical specifications are given for each standard color space in the following sections.

6.2.1. RGB Device String Specification

An RGB Device specification is identified by the prefix ‘‘rgb:’’ and conforms to the following syntax:

rgb:<red>/<green>/<blue>

<red>, <green>, <blue> := h | hh | hhh | hhhh
h
:= single hexadecimal digits (case insignificant)

Note that h indicates the value scaled in 4 bits, hh the value scaled in 8 bits, hhh the value scaled in 12 bits, and hhhh the value scaled in 16 bits, respectively.

Typical examples are the strings ‘‘rgb:ea/75/52’’ and ‘‘rgb:ccc/320/320’’, but mixed numbers of hexadecimal digit strings (‘‘rgb:ff/a5/0’’ and ‘‘rgb:ccc/32/0’’) are also allowed.

For backward compatibility, an older syntax for RGB Device is supported, but its continued use is not encouraged. The syntax is an initial sharp sign character followed by a numeric specification, in one of the following formats:

#RGB

(4 bits each)

#RRGGBB

(8 bits each)

#RRRGGGBBB

(12 bits each)

#RRRRGGGGBBBB

(16 bits each)

The R, G, and B represent single hexadecimal digits. When fewer than 16 bits each are specified, they represent the most significant bits of the value (unlike the ‘‘rgb:’’ syntax, in which values are scaled). For example, the string ‘‘#3a7’’ is the same as ‘‘#3000a0007000’’.

6.2.2. RGB Intensity String Specification

An RGB intensity specification is identified by the prefix ‘‘rgbi:’’ and conforms to the following syntax:

rgbi:<red>/<green>/<blue>

Note that red, green, and blue are floating-point values between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive. The input format for these values is an optional sign, a string of numbers possibly containing a decimal point, and an optional exponent field containing an E or e followed by a possibly signed integer string.

6.2.3. Device-Independent String Specifications

The standard device-independent string specifications have the following syntax:

CIEXYZ:<X>/<Y>/<Z>
CIEuvY:<u>/<v>/<Y>
CIExyY:<x>/<y>/<Y>
CIELab:<L>/<a>/<b>
CIELuv:<L>/<u>/<v>
TekHVC:<H>/<V>/<C>

All of the values (C, H, V, X, Y, Z, a, b, u, v, y, x) are floating-point values. The syntax for these values is an optional plus or minus sign, a string of digits possibly containing a decimal point, and an optional exponent field consisting of an ‘‘E’’ or ‘‘e’’ followed by an optional plus or minus followed by a string of digits.

6.3. Color Conversion Contexts and Gamut Mapping

When Xlib converts device-independent color specifications into device-dependent specifications and vice versa, it uses knowledge about the color limitations of the screen hardware. This information, typically called the device profile, is available in a Color Conversion Context (CCC).

Because a specified color may be outside the color gamut of the target screen and the white point associated with the color specification may differ from the white point inherent to the screen, Xlib applies gamut mapping when it encounters certain conditions:

Gamut compression occurs when conversion of device-independent color specifications to device-dependent color specifications results in a color out of the target screen’s gamut.

White adjustment occurs when the inherent white point of the screen differs from the white point assumed by the client.

Gamut handling methods are stored as callbacks in the CCC, which in turn are used by the color space conversion routines. Client data is also stored in the CCC for each callback. The CCC also contains the white point the client assumes to be associated with color specifications (that is, the Client White Point). The client can specify the gamut handling callbacks and client data as well as the Client White Point. Xlib does not preclude the X client from performing other forms of gamut handling (for example, gamut expansion); however, Xlib does not provide direct support for gamut handling other than white adjustment and gamut compression.

Associated with each colormap is an initial CCC transparently generated by Xlib. Therefore, when you specify a colormap as an argument to an Xlib function, you are indirectly specifying a CCC. There is a default CCC associated with each screen. Newly created CCCs inherit attributes from the default CCC, so the default CCC attributes can be modified to affect new CCCs.

Xcms functions in which gamut mapping can occur return Status and have specific status values defined for them, as follows:

XcmsFailure indicates that the function failed.

XcmsSuccess indicates that the function succeeded. In addition, if the function performed any color conversion, the colors did not need to be compressed.

XcmsSuccessWithCompression indicates the function performed color conversion and at least one of the colors needed to be compressed. The gamut compression method is determined by the gamut compression procedure in the CCC that is specified directly as a function argument or in the CCC indirectly specified by means of the colormap argument.

6.4. Creating, Copying, and Destroying Colormaps

To create a colormap for a screen, use XCreateColormap. __ │

Colormap XCreateColormap(display, w, visual, alloc)
Display *display;
Window w;
Visual *visual;
int alloc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window on whose screen you want to

create a colormap.

visual

Specifies a visual type supported on the screen.

If the visual type is not one supported by the
screen, a BadMatch error results.

alloc

Specifies the colormap entries to be allocated.

You can pass AllocNone or AllocAll. │__

The XCreateColormap function creates a colormap of the specified visual type for the screen on which the specified window resides and returns the colormap ID associated with it. Note that the specified window is only used to determine the screen.

The initial values of the colormap entries are undefined for the visual classes GrayScale, PseudoColor, and DirectColor. For StaticGray, StaticColor, and TrueColor, the entries have defined values, but those values are specific to the visual and are not defined by X. For StaticGray, StaticColor, and TrueColor, alloc must be AllocNone, or a BadMatch error results. For the other visual classes, if alloc is AllocNone, the colormap initially has no allocated entries, and clients can allocate them. For information about the visual types, see section 3.1.

If alloc is AllocAll, the entire colormap is allocated writable. The initial values of all allocated entries are undefined. For GrayScale and PseudoColor, the effect is as if an XAllocColorCells call returned all pixel values from zero to N − 1, where N is the colormap entries value in the specified visual. For DirectColor, the effect is as if an XAllocColorPlanes call returned a pixel value of zero and red_mask, green_mask, and blue_mask values containing the same bits as the corresponding masks in the specified visual. However, in all cases, none of these entries can be freed by using XFreeColors.

XCreateColormap can generate BadAlloc, BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To create a new colormap when the allocation out of a previously shared colormap has failed because of resource exhaustion, use XCopyColormapAndFree. __ │

Colormap XCopyColormapAndFree(display, colormap)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap. │__

The XCopyColormapAndFree function creates a colormap of the same visual type and for the same screen as the specified colormap and returns the new colormap ID. It also moves all of the client’s existing allocation from the specified colormap to the new colormap with their color values intact and their read-only or writable characteristics intact and frees those entries in the specified colormap. Color values in other entries in the new colormap are undefined. If the specified colormap was created by the client with alloc set to AllocAll, the new colormap is also created with AllocAll, all color values for all entries are copied from the specified colormap, and then all entries in the specified colormap are freed. If the specified colormap was not created by the client with AllocAll, the allocations to be moved are all those pixels and planes that have been allocated by the client using XAllocColor, XAllocNamedColor, XAllocColorCells, or XAllocColorPlanes and that have not been freed since they were allocated.

XCopyColormapAndFree can generate BadAlloc and BadColor errors.

To destroy a colormap, use XFreeColormap. __ │

XFreeColormap(display, colormap)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap that you want to destroy. │__

The XFreeColormap function deletes the association between the colormap resource ID and the colormap and frees the colormap storage. However, this function has no effect on the default colormap for a screen. If the specified colormap is an installed map for a screen, it is uninstalled (see XUninstallColormap). If the specified colormap is defined as the colormap for a window (by XCreateWindow, XSetWindowColormap, or XChangeWindowAttributes), XFreeColormap changes the colormap associated with the window to None and generates a ColormapNotify event. X does not define the colors displayed for a window with a colormap of None.

XFreeColormap can generate a BadColor error.

6.5. Mapping Color Names to Values

To map a color name to an RGB value, use XLookupColor. __ │

Status XLookupColor(display, colormap, color_name, exact_def_return, screen_def_return)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
char *color_name;
XColor *exact_def_return, *screen_def_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color_nameSpecifies the color name string (for example, red)
whose color definition structure you want re-
turned.

exact_def_return
Returns the exact RGB values.

screen_def_return
Returns the closest RGB values provided by the
hardware. │__

The XLookupColor function looks up the string name of a color with respect to the screen associated with the specified colormap. It returns both the exact color values and the closest values provided by the screen with respect to the visual type of the specified colormap. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. XLookupColor returns nonzero if the name is resolved; otherwise, it returns zero.

XLookupColor can generate a BadColor error.

To map a color name to the exact RGB value, use XParseColor. __ │

Status XParseColor(display, colormap, spec, exact_def_return)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
char *spec;
XColor *exact_def_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

spec

Specifies the color name string; case is ignored.

exact_def_return
Returns the exact color value for later use and
sets the DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue flags. │__

The XParseColor function looks up the string name of a color with respect to the screen associated with the specified colormap. It returns the exact color value. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. XParseColor returns nonzero if the name is resolved; otherwise, it returns zero.

XParseColor can generate a BadColor error.

To map a color name to a value in an arbitrary color space, use XcmsLookupColor. __ │

Status XcmsLookupColor(display, colormap, color_string, color_exact_return, color_screen_return,

result_format)

Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
char *color_string;
XcmsColor *color_exact_return, *color_screen_return;
XcmsColorFormat result_format;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color_string
Specifies the color string.

color_exact_return
Returns the color specification parsed from the
color string or parsed from the corresponding
string found in a color-name database.

color_screen_return
Returns the color that can be reproduced on the
screen.

result_format
Specifies the color format for the returned color
specifications (color_screen_return and color_ex-
act_return arguments). If the format is XcmsUnde-
finedFormat
and the color string contains a numer-
ical color specification, the specification is re-
turned in the format used in that numerical color
specification. If the format is XcmsUndefinedFor-
mat
and the color string contains a color name,
the specification is returned in the format used
to store the color in the database. │__

The XcmsLookupColor function looks up the string name of a color with respect to the screen associated with the specified colormap. It returns both the exact color values and the closest values provided by the screen with respect to the visual type of the specified colormap. The values are returned in the format specified by result_format. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. XcmsLookupColor returns XcmsSuccess or XcmsSuccessWithCompression if the name is resolved; otherwise, it returns XcmsFailure. If XcmsSuccessWithCompression is returned, the color specification returned in color_screen_return is the result of gamut compression.

6.6. Allocating and Freeing Color Cells

There are two ways of allocating color cells: explicitly as read-only entries, one pixel value at a time, or read/write, where you can allocate a number of color cells and planes simultaneously. A read-only cell has its RGB value set by the server. Read/write cells do not have defined colors initially; functions described in the next section must be used to store values into them. Although it is possible for any client to store values into a read/write cell allocated by another client, read/write cells normally should be considered private to the client that allocated them.

Read-only colormap cells are shared among clients. The server counts each allocation and freeing of the cell by clients. When the last client frees a shared cell, the cell is finally deallocated. If a single client allocates the same read-only cell multiple times, the server counts each such allocation, not just the first one.

To allocate a read-only color cell with an RGB value, use XAllocColor. __ │

Status XAllocColor(display, colormap, screen_in_out)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XColor *screen_in_out;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

screen_in_out
Specifies and returns the values actually used in
the colormap. │__

The XAllocColor function allocates a read-only colormap entry corresponding to the closest RGB value supported by the hardware. XAllocColor returns the pixel value of the color closest to the specified RGB elements supported by the hardware and returns the RGB value actually used. The corresponding colormap cell is read-only. In addition, XAllocColor returns nonzero if it succeeded or zero if it failed. Multiple clients that request the same effective RGB value can be assigned the same read-only entry, thus allowing entries to be shared. When the last client deallocates a shared cell, it is deallocated. XAllocColor does not use or affect the flags in the XColor structure.

XAllocColor can generate a BadColor error.

To allocate a read-only color cell with a color in arbitrary format, use XcmsAllocColor. __ │

Status XcmsAllocColor(display, colormap, color_in_out, result_format)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XcmsColor *color_in_out;
XcmsColorFormat result_format;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color_in_out
Specifies the color to allocate and returns the
pixel and color that is actually used in the col-
ormap.

result_format
Specifies the color format for the returned color
specification. │__

The XcmsAllocColor function is similar to XAllocColor except the color can be specified in any format. The XcmsAllocColor function ultimately calls XAllocColor to allocate a read-only color cell (colormap entry) with the specified color. XcmsAllocColor first converts the color specified to an RGB value and then passes this to XAllocColor. XcmsAllocColor returns the pixel value of the color cell and the color specification actually allocated. This returned color specification is the result of converting the RGB value returned by XAllocColor into the format specified with the result_format argument. If there is no interest in a returned color specification, unnecessary computation can be bypassed if result_format is set to XcmsRGBFormat. The corresponding colormap cell is read-only. If this routine returns XcmsFailure, the color_in_out color specification is left unchanged.

XcmsAllocColor can generate a BadColor error.

To allocate a read-only color cell using a color name and return the closest color supported by the hardware in RGB format, use XAllocNamedColor. __ │

Status XAllocNamedColor(display, colormap, color_name, screen_def_return, exact_def_return)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
char *color_name;
XColor *screen_def_return, *exact_def_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color_nameSpecifies the color name string (for example, red)
whose color definition structure you want re-
turned.

screen_def_return
Returns the closest RGB values provided by the
hardware.

exact_def_return
Returns the exact RGB values. │__

The XAllocNamedColor function looks up the named color with respect to the screen that is associated with the specified colormap. It returns both the exact database definition and the closest color supported by the screen. The allocated color cell is read-only. The pixel value is returned in screen_def_return. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. If screen_def_return and exact_def_return point to the same structure, the pixel field will be set correctly, but the color values are undefined. XAllocNamedColor returns nonzero if a cell is allocated; otherwise, it returns zero.

XAllocNamedColor can generate a BadColor error.

To allocate a read-only color cell using a color name and return the closest color supported by the hardware in an arbitrary format, use XcmsAllocNamedColor. __ │

Status XcmsAllocNamedColor(display, colormap, color_string, color_screen_return, color_exact_return,
result_format
)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
char *color_string;
XcmsColor *color_screen_return;
XcmsColor *color_exact_return;
XcmsColorFormat result_format;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color_string
Specifies the color string whose color definition
structure is to be returned.

color_screen_return
Returns the pixel value of the color cell and col-
or specification that actually is stored for that
cell.

color_exact_return
Returns the color specification parsed from the
color string or parsed from the corresponding
string found in a color-name database.

result_format
Specifies the color format for the returned color
specifications (color_screen_return and color_ex-
act_return arguments). If the format is XcmsUnde-
finedFormat
and the color string contains a numer-
ical color specification, the specification is re-
turned in the format used in that numerical color
specification. If the format is XcmsUndefinedFor-
mat
and the color string contains a color name,
the specification is returned in the format used
to store the color in the database. │__

The XcmsAllocNamedColor function is similar to XAllocNamedColor except that the color returned can be in any format specified. This function ultimately calls XAllocColor to allocate a read-only color cell with the color specified by a color string. The color string is parsed into an XcmsColor structure (see XcmsLookupColor), converted to an RGB value, and finally passed to XAllocColor. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter.

This function returns both the color specification as a result of parsing (exact specification) and the actual color specification stored (screen specification). This screen specification is the result of converting the RGB value returned by XAllocColor into the format specified in result_format. If there is no interest in a returned color specification, unnecessary computation can be bypassed if result_format is set to XcmsRGBFormat. If color_screen_return and color_exact_return point to the same structure, the pixel field will be set correctly, but the color values are undefined.

XcmsAllocNamedColor can generate a BadColor error.

To allocate read/write color cell and color plane combinations for a PseudoColor model, use XAllocColorCells. __ │

Status XAllocColorCells(display, colormap, contig, plane_masks_return, nplanes,
pixels_return
, npixels)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
Bool contig;
unsigned long plane_masks_return[];
unsigned int nplanes;
unsigned long pixels_return[];
unsigned int npixels;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

contig

Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether

the planes must be contiguous.

plane_mask_return
Returns an array of plane masks.

nplanes

Specifies the number of plane masks that are to be

returned in the plane masks array.

pixels_return
Returns an array of pixel values.

npixels

Specifies the number of pixel values that are to

be returned in the pixels_return array. │__

The XAllocColorCells function allocates read/write color cells. The number of colors must be positive and the number of planes nonnegative, or a BadValue error results. If ncolors and nplanes are requested, then ncolors pixels and nplane plane masks are returned. No mask will have any bits set to 1 in common with any other mask or with any of the pixels. By ORing together each pixel with zero or more masks, ncolors * Image grohtml-19291-1.png distinct pixels can be produced. All of these are allocated writable by the request. For GrayScale or PseudoColor, each mask has exactly one bit set to 1. For DirectColor, each has exactly three bits set to 1. If contig is True and if all masks are ORed together, a single contiguous set of bits set to 1 will be formed for GrayScale or PseudoColor and three contiguous sets of bits set to 1 (one within each pixel subfield) for DirectColor. The RGB values of the allocated entries are undefined. XAllocColorCells returns nonzero if it succeeded or zero if it failed.

XAllocColorCells can generate BadColor and BadValue errors.

To allocate read/write color resources for a DirectColor model, use XAllocColorPlanes. __ │

Status XAllocColorPlanes(display, colormap, contig, pixels_return, ncolors, nreds, ngreens,
nblues
, rmask_return, gmask_return, bmask_return)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
Bool contig;
unsigned long pixels_return[];
int ncolors;
int nreds, ngreens, nblues;
unsigned long *rmask_return, *gmask_return, *bmask_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

contig

Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether

the planes must be contiguous.

pixels_return
Returns an array of pixel values. XAllocColor-
Planes
returns the pixel values in this array.

ncolors

Specifies the number of pixel values that are to

be returned in the pixels_return array.

nreds

ngreens

nblues

Specify the number of red, green, and blue planes.
The value you pass must be nonnegative.

rmask_return
gmask_return
bmask_return

Return bit masks for the red, green, and blue
planes. │__

The specified ncolors must be positive; and nreds, ngreens, and nblues must be nonnegative, or a BadValue error results. If ncolors colors, nreds reds, ngreens greens, and nblues blues are requested, ncolors pixels are returned; and the masks have nreds, ngreens, and nblues bits set to 1, respectively. If contig is True, each mask will have a contiguous set of bits set to 1. No mask will have any bits set to 1 in common with any other mask or with any of the pixels. For DirectColor, each mask will lie within the corresponding pixel subfield. By ORing together subsets of masks with each pixel value, ncolors * Image grohtml-19291-2.png distinct pixel values can be produced. All of these are allocated by the request. However, in the colormap, there are only ncolors * Image grohtml-19291-3.png independent red entries, ncolors * Image grohtml-19291-4.png independent green entries, and ncolors * Image grohtml-19291-5.png independent blue entries. This is true even for PseudoColor. When the colormap entry of a pixel value is changed (using XStoreColors, XStoreColor, or XStoreNamedColor), the pixel is decomposed according to the masks, and the corresponding independent entries are updated. XAllocColorPlanes returns nonzero if it succeeded or zero if it failed.

XAllocColorPlanes can generate BadColor and BadValue errors.

To free colormap cells, use XFreeColors. __ │

XFreeColors(display, colormap, pixels, npixels, planes)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
unsigned long pixels[];
int npixels;
unsigned long planes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

pixels

Specifies an array of pixel values that map to the

cells in the specified colormap.

npixels

Specifies the number of pixels.

planes

Specifies the planes you want to free. │__

The XFreeColors function frees the cells represented by pixels whose values are in the pixels array. The planes argument should not have any bits set to 1 in common with any of the pixels. The set of all pixels is produced by ORing together subsets of the planes argument with the pixels. The request frees all of these pixels that were allocated by the client (using XAllocColor, XAllocNamedColor, XAllocColorCells, and XAllocColorPlanes). Note that freeing an individual pixel obtained from XAllocColorPlanes may not actually allow it to be reused until all of its related pixels are also freed. Similarly, a read-only entry is not actually freed until it has been freed by all clients, and if a client allocates the same read-only entry multiple times, it must free the entry that many times before the entry is actually freed.

All specified pixels that are allocated by the client in the colormap are freed, even if one or more pixels produce an error. If a specified pixel is not a valid index into the colormap, a BadValue error results. If a specified pixel is not allocated by the client (that is, is unallocated or is only allocated by another client) or if the colormap was created with all entries writable (by passing AllocAll to XCreateColormap), a BadAccess error results. If more than one pixel is in error, the one that gets reported is arbitrary.

XFreeColors can generate BadAccess, BadColor, and BadValue errors.

6.7. Modifying and Querying Colormap Cells

To store an RGB value in a single colormap cell, use XStoreColor. __ │

XStoreColor(display, colormap, color)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XColor *color;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color

Specifies the pixel and RGB values. │__

The XStoreColor function changes the colormap entry of the pixel value specified in the pixel member of the XColor structure. You specified this value in the pixel member of the XColor structure. This pixel value must be a read/write cell and a valid index into the colormap. If a specified pixel is not a valid index into the colormap, a BadValue error results. XStoreColor also changes the red, green, and/or blue color components. You specify which color components are to be changed by setting DoRed, DoGreen, and/or DoBlue in the flags member of the XColor structure. If the colormap is an installed map for its screen, the changes are visible immediately.

XStoreColor can generate BadAccess, BadColor, and BadValue errors.

To store multiple RGB values in multiple colormap cells, use XStoreColors. __ │

XStoreColors(display, colormap, color, ncolors)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XColor color[];
int ncolors;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color

Specifies an array of color definition structures

to be stored.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XColor structures in the

color definition array. │__

The XStoreColors function changes the colormap entries of the pixel values specified in the pixel members of the XColor structures. You specify which color components are to be changed by setting DoRed, DoGreen, and/or DoBlue in the flags member of the XColor structures. If the colormap is an installed map for its screen, the changes are visible immediately. XStoreColors changes the specified pixels if they are allocated writable in the colormap by any client, even if one or more pixels generates an error. If a specified pixel is not a valid index into the colormap, a BadValue error results. If a specified pixel either is unallocated or is allocated read-only, a BadAccess error results. If more than one pixel is in error, the one that gets reported is arbitrary.

XStoreColors can generate BadAccess, BadColor, and BadValue errors.

To store a color of arbitrary format in a single colormap cell, use XcmsStoreColor. __ │

Status XcmsStoreColor(display, colormap, color)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XcmsColor *color;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color

Specifies the color cell and the color to store.

Values specified in this XcmsColor structure re-
main unchanged on return. │__

The XcmsStoreColor function converts the color specified in the XcmsColor structure into RGB values. It then uses this RGB specification in an XColor structure, whose three flags (DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue) are set, in a call to XStoreColor to change the color cell specified by the pixel member of the XcmsColor structure. This pixel value must be a valid index for the specified colormap, and the color cell specified by the pixel value must be a read/write cell. If the pixel value is not a valid index, a BadValue error results. If the color cell is unallocated or is allocated read-only, a BadAccess error results. If the colormap is an installed map for its screen, the changes are visible immediately.

Note that XStoreColor has no return value; therefore, an XcmsSuccess return value from this function indicates that the conversion to RGB succeeded and the call to XStoreColor was made. To obtain the actual color stored, use XcmsQueryColor. Because of the screen’s hardware limitations or gamut compression, the color stored in the colormap may not be identical to the color specified.

XcmsStoreColor can generate BadAccess, BadColor, and BadValue errors.

To store multiple colors of arbitrary format in multiple colormap cells, use XcmsStoreColors. __ │

Status XcmsStoreColors(display, colormap, colors, ncolors, compression_flags_return)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XcmsColor colors[];
int ncolors;
Bool compression_flags_return[];

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

colors

Specifies the color specification array of Xcms-

Color structures, each specifying a color cell and
the color to store in that cell. Values specified
in the array remain unchanged upon return.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array.

compression_flags_return
Returns an array of Boolean values indicating com-
pression status. If a non-NULL pointer is sup-
plied, each element of the array is set to True if
the corresponding color was compressed and False
otherwise. Pass NULL if the compression status is
not useful. │__

The XcmsStoreColors function converts the colors specified in the array of XcmsColor structures into RGB values and then uses these RGB specifications in XColor structures, whose three flags (DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue) are set, in a call to XStoreColors to change the color cells specified by the pixel member of the corresponding XcmsColor structure. Each pixel value must be a valid index for the specified colormap, and the color cell specified by each pixel value must be a read/write cell. If a pixel value is not a valid index, a BadValue error results. If a color cell is unallocated or is allocated read-only, a BadAccess error results. If more than one pixel is in error, the one that gets reported is arbitrary. If the colormap is an installed map for its screen, the changes are visible immediately.

Note that XStoreColors has no return value; therefore, an XcmsSuccess return value from this function indicates that conversions to RGB succeeded and the call to XStoreColors was made. To obtain the actual colors stored, use XcmsQueryColors. Because of the screen’s hardware limitations or gamut compression, the colors stored in the colormap may not be identical to the colors specified.

XcmsStoreColors can generate BadAccess, BadColor, and BadValue errors.

To store a color specified by name in a single colormap cell, use XStoreNamedColor. __ │

XStoreNamedColor(display, colormap, color, pixel, flags)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
char *color;
unsigned long pixel;
int flags;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color

Specifies the color name string (for example,

red).

pixel

Specifies the entry in the colormap.

flags

Specifies which red, green, and blue components

are set. │__

The XStoreNamedColor function looks up the named color with respect to the screen associated with the colormap and stores the result in the specified colormap. The pixel argument determines the entry in the colormap. The flags argument determines which of the red, green, and blue components are set. You can set this member to the bitwise inclusive OR of the bits DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue. If the color name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. If the specified pixel is not a valid index into the colormap, a BadValue error results. If the specified pixel either is unallocated or is allocated read-only, a BadAccess error results.

XStoreNamedColor can generate BadAccess, BadColor, BadName, and BadValue errors.

The XQueryColor and XQueryColors functions take pixel values in the pixel member of XColor structures and store in the structures the RGB values for those pixels from the specified colormap. The values returned for an unallocated entry are undefined. These functions also set the flags member in the XColor structure to all three colors. If a pixel is not a valid index into the specified colormap, a BadValue error results. If more than one pixel is in error, the one that gets reported is arbitrary.

To query the RGB value of a single colormap cell, use XQueryColor. __ │

XQueryColor(display, colormap, def_in_out)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XColor *def_in_out;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

def_in_outSpecifies and returns the RGB values for the pixel
specified in the structure. │__

The XQueryColor function returns the current RGB value for the pixel in the XColor structure and sets the DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue flags.

XQueryColor can generate BadColor and BadValue errors.

To query the RGB values of multiple colormap cells, use XQueryColors. __ │

XQueryColors(display, colormap, defs_in_out, ncolors)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XColor defs_in_out[];
int ncolors;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

defs_in_outSpecifies and returns an array of color defini-
tion structures for the pixel specified in the
structure.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XColor structures in the

color definition array. │__

The XQueryColors function returns the RGB value for each pixel in each XColor structure and sets the DoRed, DoGreen, and DoBlue flags in each structure.

XQueryColors can generate BadColor and BadValue errors.

To query the color of a single colormap cell in an arbitrary format, use XcmsQueryColor. __ │

Status XcmsQueryColor(display, colormap, color_in_out, result_format)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XcmsColor *color_in_out;
XcmsColorFormat result_format;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

color_in_out
Specifies the pixel member that indicates the col-
or cell to query. The color specification stored
for the color cell is returned in this XcmsColor
structure.

result_format
Specifies the color format for the returned color
specification. │__

The XcmsQueryColor function obtains the RGB value for the pixel value in the pixel member of the specified XcmsColor structure and then converts the value to the target format as specified by the result_format argument. If the pixel is not a valid index in the specified colormap, a BadValue error results.

XcmsQueryColor can generate BadColor and BadValue errors.

To query the color of multiple colormap cells in an arbitrary format, use XcmsQueryColors. __ │

Status XcmsQueryColors(display, colormap, colors_in_out, ncolors, result_format)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XcmsColor colors_in_out[];
unsigned int ncolors;
XcmsColorFormat result_format;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

colors_in_out
Specifies an array of XcmsColor structures, each
pixel member indicating the color cell to query.
The color specifications for the color cells are
returned in these structures.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array.

result_format
Specifies the color format for the returned color
specification. │__

The XcmsQueryColors function obtains the RGB values for pixel values in the pixel members of XcmsColor structures and then converts the values to the target format as specified by the result_format argument. If a pixel is not a valid index into the specified colormap, a BadValue error results. If more than one pixel is in error, the one that gets reported is arbitrary.

XcmsQueryColors can generate BadColor and BadValue errors.

6.8. Color Conversion Context Functions

This section describes functions to create, modify, and query Color Conversion Contexts (CCCs).

Associated with each colormap is an initial CCC transparently generated by Xlib. Therefore, when you specify a colormap as an argument to a function, you are indirectly specifying a CCC. The CCC attributes that can be modified by the X client are:

Client White Point

Gamut compression procedure and client data

White point adjustment procedure and client data

The initial values for these attributes are implementation specific. The CCC attributes for subsequently created CCCs can be defined by changing the CCC attributes of the default CCC. There is a default CCC associated with each screen.

6.8.1. Getting and Setting the Color Conversion Context of a Colormap

To obtain the CCC associated with a colormap, use XcmsCCCOfColormap. __ │

XcmsCCC XcmsCCCOfColormap(display, colormap)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap. │__

The XcmsCCCOfColormap function returns the CCC associated with the specified colormap. Once obtained, the CCC attributes can be queried or modified. Unless the CCC associated with the specified colormap is changed with XcmsSetCCCOfColormap, this CCC is used when the specified colormap is used as an argument to color functions.

To change the CCC associated with a colormap, use XcmsSetCCCOfColormap. __ │

XcmsCCC XcmsSetCCCOfColormap(display, colormap, ccc)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;
XcmsCCC ccc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

The XcmsSetCCCOfColormap function changes the CCC associated with the specified colormap. It returns the CCC previously associated with the colormap. If they are not used again in the application, CCCs should be freed by calling XcmsFreeCCC. Several colormaps may share the same CCC without restriction; this includes the CCCs generated by Xlib with each colormap. Xlib, however, creates a new CCC with each new colormap.

6.8.2. Obtaining the Default Color Conversion Context

You can change the default CCC attributes for subsequently created CCCs by changing the CCC attributes of the default CCC. A default CCC is associated with each screen.

To obtain the default CCC for a screen, use XcmsDefaultCCC. __ │

XcmsCCC XcmsDefaultCCC(display, screen_number)
Display *display;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

The XcmsDefaultCCC function returns the default CCC for the specified screen. Its visual is the default visual of the screen. Its initial gamut compression and white point adjustment procedures as well as the associated client data are implementation specific.

6.8.3. Color Conversion Context Macros

Applications should not directly modify any part of the XcmsCCC. The following lists the C language macros, their corresponding function equivalents for other language bindings, and what data they both can return. __ │

DisplayOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

Display *XcmsDisplayOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

Both return the display associated with the specified CCC. __ │

VisualOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

Visual *XcmsVisualOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

Both return the visual associated with the specified CCC. __ │

ScreenNumberOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

int XcmsScreenNumberOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

Both return the number of the screen associated with the specified CCC. __ │

ScreenWhitePointOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

XcmsColor *XcmsScreenWhitePointOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

Both return the white point of the screen associated with the specified CCC. __ │

ClientWhitePointOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

XcmsColor *XcmsClientWhitePointOfCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

Both return the Client White Point of the specified CCC.

6.8.4. Modifying Attributes of a Color Conversion Context

To set the Client White Point in the CCC, use XcmsSetWhitePoint. __ │

Status XcmsSetWhitePoint(ccc, color)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColor *color;

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

color

Specifies the new Client White Point. │__

The XcmsSetWhitePoint function changes the Client White Point in the specified CCC. Note that the pixel member is ignored and that the color specification is left unchanged upon return. The format for the new white point must be XcmsCIEXYZFormat, XcmsCIEuvYFormat, XcmsCIExyYFormat, or XcmsUndefinedFormat. If the color argument is NULL, this function sets the format component of the Client White Point specification to XcmsUndefinedFormat, indicating that the Client White Point is assumed to be the same as the Screen White Point.

This function returns nonzero status if the format for the new white point is valid; otherwise, it returns zero.

To set the gamut compression procedure and corresponding client data in a specified CCC, use XcmsSetCompressionProc. __ │

XcmsCompressionProc XcmsSetCompressionProc(ccc, compression_proc, client_data)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsCompressionProc compression_proc;
XPointer client_data;

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

compression_proc
Specifies the gamut compression procedure that is
to be applied when a color lies outside the
screen’s color gamut. If NULL is specified and a
function using this CCC must convert a color spec-
ification to a device-dependent format and encoun-
ters a color that lies outside the screen’s color
gamut, that function will return XcmsFailure.

client_dataSpecifies client data for the gamut compression
procedure or NULL. │__

The XcmsSetCompressionProc function first sets the gamut compression procedure and client data in the specified CCC with the newly specified procedure and client data and then returns the old procedure.

To set the white point adjustment procedure and corresponding client data in a specified CCC, use XcmsSetWhiteAdjustProc. __ │
XcmsWhiteAdjustProc XcmsSetWhiteAdjustProc(ccc, white_adjust_proc, client_data)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsWhiteAdjustProc white_adjust_proc;
XPointer client_data;

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

white_adjust_proc
Specifies the white point adjustment procedure.

client_dataSpecifies client data for the white point adjust-
ment procedure or NULL. │__

The XcmsSetWhiteAdjustProc function first sets the white point adjustment procedure and client data in the specified CCC with the newly specified procedure and client data and then returns the old procedure.

6.8.5. Creating and Freeing a Color Conversion Context

You can explicitly create a CCC within your application by calling XcmsCreateCCC. These created CCCs can then be used by those functions that explicitly call for a CCC argument. Old CCCs that will not be used by the application should be freed using XcmsFreeCCC.

To create a CCC, use XcmsCreateCCC. __ │

XcmsCCC XcmsCreateCCC(display, screen_number, visual, client_white_point, compression_proc,
compression_client_data
, white_adjust_proc, white_adjust_client_data)
Display *display;
int screen_number;
Visual *visual;
XcmsColor *client_white_point;
XcmsCompressionProc compression_proc;
XPointer compression_client_data;
XcmsWhiteAdjustProc white_adjust_proc;
XPointer white_adjust_client_data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server.

visual

Specifies the visual type.

client_white_point
Specifies the Client White Point. If NULL is
specified, the Client White Point is to be assumed
to be the same as the Screen White Point. Note
that the pixel member is ignored.

compression_proc
Specifies the gamut compression procedure that is
to be applied when a color lies outside the
screen’s color gamut. If NULL is specified and a
function using this CCC must convert a color spec-
ification to a device-dependent format and encoun-
ters a color that lies outside the screen’s color
gamut, that function will return XcmsFailure.

compression_client_data
Specifies client data for use by the gamut com-
pression procedure or NULL.

white_adjust_proc
Specifies the white adjustment procedure that is
to be applied when the Client White Point differs
from the Screen White Point. NULL indicates that
no white point adjustment is desired.

white_adjust_client_data
Specifies client data for use with the white point
adjustment procedure or NULL. │__

The XcmsCreateCCC function creates a CCC for the specified display, screen, and visual.

To free a CCC, use XcmsFreeCCC. __ │

void XcmsFreeCCC(ccc)
XcmsCCC ccc;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. │__

The XcmsFreeCCC function frees the memory used for the specified CCC. Note that default CCCs and those currently associated with colormaps are ignored.

6.9. Converting between Color Spaces

To convert an array of color specifications in arbitrary color formats to a single destination format, use XcmsConvertColors. __ │

Status XcmsConvertColors(ccc, colors_in_out, ncolors, target_format, compression_flags_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColor colors_in_out[];
unsigned int ncolors;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
Bool compression_flags_return[];

ccc

Specifies the CCC. If conversion is between de-

vice-independent color spaces only (for example,
TekHVC to CIELuv), the CCC is necessary only to
specify the Client White Point.

colors_in_out
Specifies an array of color specifications. Pixel
members are ignored and remain unchanged upon re-
turn.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

compression_flags_return
Returns an array of Boolean values indicating com-
pression status. If a non-NULL pointer is sup-
plied, each element of the array is set to True if
the corresponding color was compressed and False
otherwise. Pass NULL if the compression status is
not useful. │__

The XcmsConvertColors function converts the color specifications in the specified array of XcmsColor structures from their current format to a single target format, using the specified CCC. When the return value is XcmsFailure, the contents of the color specification array are left unchanged.

The array may contain a mixture of color specification formats (for example, 3 CIE XYZ, 2 CIE Luv, and so on). When the array contains both device-independent and device-dependent color specifications and the target_format argument specifies a device-dependent format (for example, XcmsRGBiFormat, XcmsRGBFormat), all specifications are converted to CIE XYZ format and then to the target device-dependent format.

6.10. Callback Functions

This section describes the gamut compression and white point adjustment callbacks.

The gamut compression procedure specified in the CCC is called when an attempt to convert a color specification from XcmsCIEXYZ to a device-dependent format (typically XcmsRGBi) results in a color that lies outside the screen’s color gamut. If the gamut compression procedure requires client data, this data is passed via the gamut compression client data in the CCC.

During color specification conversion between device-independent and device-dependent color spaces, if a white point adjustment procedure is specified in the CCC, it is triggered when the Client White Point and Screen White Point differ. If required, the client data is obtained from the CCC.

6.10.1. Prototype Gamut Compression Procedure

The gamut compression callback interface must adhere to the following: __ │

typedef Status (*XcmsCompressionProc)(ccc, colors_in_out, ncolors, index, compression_flags_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColor colors_in_out[];
unsigned int ncolors;
unsigned int index;
Bool compression_flags_return[];

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

colors_in_out
Specifies an array of color specifications. Pixel
members should be ignored and must remain un-
changed upon return.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array.

index

Specifies the index into the array of XcmsColor

structures for the encountered color specification
that lies outside the screen’s color gamut. Valid
values are 0 (for the first element) to ncolors −
1.

compression_flags_return
Returns an array of Boolean values for indicating
compression status. If a non-NULL pointer is sup-
plied and a color at a given index is compressed,
then True should be stored at the corresponding
index in this array; otherwise, the array should
not be modified. │__

When implementing a gamut compression procedure, consider the following rules and assumptions:

The gamut compression procedure can attempt to compress one or multiple specifications at a time.

When called, elements 0 to index − 1 in the color specification array can be assumed to fall within the screen’s color gamut. In addition, these color specifications are already in some device-dependent format (typically XcmsRGBi). If any modifications are made to these color specifications, they must be in their initial device-dependent format upon return.

When called, the element in the color specification array specified by the index argument contains the color specification outside the screen’s color gamut encountered by the calling routine. In addition, this color specification can be assumed to be in XcmsCIEXYZ. Upon return, this color specification must be in XcmsCIEXYZ.

When called, elements from index to ncolors − 1 in the color specification array may or may not fall within the screen’s color gamut. In addition, these color specifications can be assumed to be in XcmsCIEXYZ. If any modifications are made to these color specifications, they must be in XcmsCIEXYZ upon return.

The color specifications passed to the gamut compression procedure have already been adjusted to the Screen White Point. This means that at this point the color specification’s white point is the Screen White Point.

If the gamut compression procedure uses a device-independent color space not initially accessible for use in the color management system, use XcmsAddColorSpace to ensure that it is added.

6.10.2. Supplied Gamut Compression Procedures

The following equations are useful in describing gamut compression functions:

Image grohtml-19291-6.png

Image grohtml-19291-7.png

Image grohtml-19291-8.png

Image grohtml-19291-9.png

The gamut compression callback procedures provided by Xlib are as follows:

XcmsCIELabClipL

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by reducing or increasing CIE metric lightness (L*) in the CIE L*a*b* color space until the color is within the gamut. If the Psychometric Chroma of the color specification is beyond maximum for the Psychometric Hue Angle, then while maintaining the same Psychometric Hue Angle, the color will be clipped to the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum Psychometric Chroma. See XcmsCIELabQueryMaxC. No client data is necessary.

XcmsCIELabClipab

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by reducing Psychometric Chroma, while maintaining Psychometric Hue Angle, until the color is within the gamut. No client data is necessary.

XcmsCIELabClipLab

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by replacing it with CIE L*a*b* coordinates that fall within the color gamut while maintaining the original Psychometric Hue Angle and whose vector to the original coordinates is the shortest attainable. No client data is necessary.

XcmsCIELuvClipL

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by reducing or increasing CIE metric lightness (L*) in the CIE L*u*v* color space until the color is within the gamut. If the Psychometric Chroma of the color specification is beyond maximum for the Psychometric Hue Angle, then, while maintaining the same Psychometric Hue Angle, the color will be clipped to the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum Psychometric Chroma. See XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxC. No client data is necessary.

XcmsCIELuvClipuv

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by reducing Psychometric Chroma, while maintaining Psychometric Hue Angle, until the color is within the gamut. No client data is necessary.

XcmsCIELuvClipLuv

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by replacing it with CIE L*u*v* coordinates that fall within the color gamut while maintaining the original Psychometric Hue Angle and whose vector to the original coordinates is the shortest attainable. No client data is necessary.

XcmsTekHVCClipV

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by reducing or increasing the Value dimension in the TekHVC color space until the color is within the gamut. If Chroma of the color specification is beyond maximum for the particular Hue, then, while maintaining the same Hue, the color will be clipped to the Value and Chroma coordinates that represent maximum Chroma for that particular Hue. No client data is necessary.

XcmsTekHVCClipC

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by reducing the Chroma dimension in the TekHVC color space until the color is within the gamut. No client data is necessary.

XcmsTekHVCClipVC

This brings the encountered out-of-gamut color specification into the screen’s color gamut by replacing it with TekHVC coordinates that fall within the color gamut while maintaining the original Hue and whose vector to the original coordinates is the shortest attainable. No client data is necessary.

6.10.3. Prototype White Point Adjustment Procedure

The white point adjustment procedure interface must adhere to the following: __ │

typedef Status (*XcmsWhiteAdjustProc)(ccc, initial_white_point, target_white_point, target_format,
colors_in_out
, ncolors, compression_flags_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColor *initial_white_point;
XcmsColor *target_white_point;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
XcmsColor colors_in_out[];
unsigned int ncolors;
Bool compression_flags_return[];

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

initial_white_point
Specifies the initial white point.

target_white_point
Specifies the target white point.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

colors_in_out
Specifies an array of color specifications. Pixel
members should be ignored and must remain un-
changed upon return.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array.

compression_flags_return
Returns an array of Boolean values for indicating
compression status. If a non-NULL pointer is sup-
plied and a color at a given index is compressed,
then True should be stored at the corresponding
index in this array; otherwise, the array should
not be modified. │__

6.10.4. Supplied White Point Adjustment Procedures

White point adjustment procedures provided by Xlib are as follows:

XcmsCIELabWhiteShiftColors

This uses the CIE L*a*b* color space for adjusting the chromatic character of colors to compensate for the chromatic differences between the source and destination white points. This procedure simply converts the color specifications to XcmsCIELab using the source white point and then converts to the target specification format using the destination’s white point. No client data is necessary.

XcmsCIELuvWhiteShiftColors

This uses the CIE L*u*v* color space for adjusting the chromatic character of colors to compensate for the chromatic differences between the source and destination white points. This procedure simply converts the color specifications to XcmsCIELuv using the source white point and then converts to the target specification format using the destination’s white point. No client data is necessary.

XcmsTekHVCWhiteShiftColors

This uses the TekHVC color space for adjusting the chromatic character of colors to compensate for the chromatic differences between the source and destination white points. This procedure simply converts the color specifications to XcmsTekHVC using the source white point and then converts to the target specification format using the destination’s white point. An advantage of this procedure over those previously described is an attempt to minimize hue shift. No client data is necessary.

From an implementation point of view, these white point adjustment procedures convert the color specifications to a device-independent but white-point-dependent color space (for example, CIE L*u*v*, CIE L*a*b*, TekHVC) using one white point and then converting those specifications to the target color space using another white point. In other words, the specification goes in the color space with one white point but comes out with another white point, resulting in a chromatic shift based on the chromatic displacement between the initial white point and target white point. The CIE color spaces that are assumed to be white-point-independent are CIE u’v’Y, CIE XYZ, and CIE xyY. When developing a custom white point adjustment procedure that uses a device-independent color space not initially accessible for use in the color management system, use XcmsAddColorSpace to ensure that it is added.

As an example, if the CCC specifies a white point adjustment procedure and if the Client White Point and Screen White Point differ, the XcmsAllocColor function will use the white point adjustment procedure twice:

Once to convert to XcmsRGB

A second time to convert from XcmsRGB

For example, assume the specification is in XcmsCIEuvY and the adjustment procedure is XcmsCIELuvWhiteShiftColors. During conversion to XcmsRGB, the call to XcmsAllocColor results in the following series of color specification conversions:

From XcmsCIEuvY to XcmsCIELuv using the Client White Point

From XcmsCIELuv to XcmsCIEuvY using the Screen White Point

From XcmsCIEuvY to XcmsCIEXYZ (CIE u’v’Y and XYZ are white-point-independent color spaces)

From XcmsCIEXYZ to XcmsRGBi

From XcmsRGBi to XcmsRGB

The resulting RGB specification is passed to XAllocColor, and the RGB specification returned by XAllocColor is converted back to XcmsCIEuvY by reversing the color conversion sequence.

6.11. Gamut Querying Functions

This section describes the gamut querying functions that Xlib provides. These functions allow the client to query the boundary of the screen’s color gamut in terms of the CIE L*a*b*, CIE L*u*v*, and TekHVC color spaces. Functions are also provided that allow you to query the color specification of:

White (full-intensity red, green, and blue)

Red (full-intensity red while green and blue are zero)

Green (full-intensity green while red and blue are zero)

Blue (full-intensity blue while red and green are zero)

Black (zero-intensity red, green, and blue)

The white point associated with color specifications passed to and returned from these gamut querying functions is assumed to be the Screen White Point. This is a reasonable assumption, because the client is trying to query the screen’s color gamut.

The following naming convention is used for the Max and Min functions:

Xcms<color_space>QueryMax<dimensions>

Xcms<color_space>QueryMin<dimensions>

The <dimensions> consists of a letter or letters that identify the dimensions of the color space that are not fixed. For example, XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxC is given a fixed Hue and Value for which maximum Chroma is found.

6.11.1. Red, Green, and Blue Queries

To obtain the color specification for black (zero-intensity red, green, and blue), use XcmsQueryBlack. __ │

Status XcmsQueryBlack(ccc, target_format, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

color_return
Returns the color specification in the specified
target format for zero-intensity red, green, and
blue. The white point associated with the re-
turned color specification is the Screen White
Point. The value returned in the pixel member is
undefined. │__

The XcmsQueryBlack function returns the color specification in the specified target format for zero-intensity red, green, and blue.

To obtain the color specification for blue (full-intensity blue while red and green are zero), use XcmsQueryBlue. __ │

Status XcmsQueryBlue(ccc, target_format, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

color_return
Returns the color specification in the specified
target format for full-intensity blue while red
and green are zero. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsQueryBlue function returns the color specification in the specified target format for full-intensity blue while red and green are zero.

To obtain the color specification for green (full-intensity green while red and blue are zero), use XcmsQueryGreen. __ │

Status XcmsQueryGreen(ccc, target_format, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

color_return
Returns the color specification in the specified
target format for full-intensity green while red
and blue are zero. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsQueryGreen function returns the color specification in the specified target format for full-intensity green while red and blue are zero.

To obtain the color specification for red (full-intensity red while green and blue are zero), use XcmsQueryRed. __ │

Status XcmsQueryRed(ccc, target_format, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

color_return
Returns the color specification in the specified
target format for full-intensity red while green
and blue are zero. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsQueryRed function returns the color specification in the specified target format for full-intensity red while green and blue are zero.

To obtain the color specification for white (full-intensity red, green, and blue), use XcmsQueryWhite. __ │

Status XcmsQueryWhite(ccc, target_format, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColorFormat target_format;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

target_format
Specifies the target color specification format.

color_return
Returns the color specification in the specified
target format for full-intensity red, green, and
blue. The white point associated with the re-
turned color specification is the Screen White
Point. The value returned in the pixel member is
undefined. │__

The XcmsQueryWhite function returns the color specification in the specified target format for full-intensity red, green, and blue.

6.11.2. CIELab Queries

The following equations are useful in describing the CIELab query functions:

Image grohtml-19291-10.png

Image grohtml-19291-11.png

To obtain the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum Psychometric Chroma for a given Psychometric Hue Angle and CIE metric lightness (L*), use XcmsCIELabQueryMaxC. __ │

Status XcmsCIELabQueryMaxC(ccc, hue_angle, L_star, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsFloat L_star;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find maximum chroma.

L_star

Specifies the lightness (L*) at which to find max-

imum chroma.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum
chroma displayable by the screen for the given hue
angle and lightness. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELabQueryMaxC function, given a hue angle and lightness, finds the point of maximum chroma displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*a*b* coordinates.

To obtain the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum CIE metric lightness (L*) for a given Psychometric Hue Angle and Psychometric Chroma, use XcmsCIELabQueryMaxL. __ │

Status XcmsCIELabQueryMaxL(ccc, hue_angle, chroma, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsFloat chroma;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find maximum lightness.

chroma

Specifies the chroma at which to find maximum

lightness.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum
lightness displayable by the screen for the given
hue angle and chroma. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELabQueryMaxL function, given a hue angle and chroma, finds the point in CIE L*a*b* color space of maximum lightness (L*) displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*a*b* coordinates. An XcmsFailure return value usually indicates that the given chroma is beyond maximum for the given hue angle.

To obtain the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum Psychometric Chroma for a given Psychometric Hue Angle, use XcmsCIELabQueryMaxLC. __ │

Status XcmsCIELabQueryMaxLC(ccc, hue_angle, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find maximum chroma.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of maximum
chroma displayable by the screen for the given hue
angle. The white point associated with the re-
turned color specification is the Screen White
Point. The value returned in the pixel member is
undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELabQueryMaxLC function, given a hue angle, finds the point of maximum chroma displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*a*b* coordinates.

To obtain the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of minimum CIE metric lightness (L*) for a given Psychometric Hue Angle and Psychometric Chroma, use XcmsCIELabQueryMinL. __ │

Status XcmsCIELabQueryMinL(ccc, hue_angle, chroma, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsFloat chroma;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find minimum lightness.

chroma

Specifies the chroma at which to find minimum

lightness.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*a*b* coordinates of minimum
lightness displayable by the screen for the given
hue angle and chroma. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELabQueryMinL function, given a hue angle and chroma, finds the point of minimum lightness (L*) displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*a*b* coordinates. An XcmsFailure return value usually indicates that the given chroma is beyond maximum for the given hue angle.

6.11.3. CIELuv Queries

The following equations are useful in describing the CIELuv query functions:

Image grohtml-19291-12.png

Image grohtml-19291-13.png

To obtain the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum Psychometric Chroma for a given Psychometric Hue Angle and CIE metric lightness (L*), use XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxC. __ │

Status XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxC(ccc, hue_angle, L_star, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsFloat L_star;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find maximum chroma.

L_star

Specifies the lightness (L*) at which to find max-

imum chroma.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum
chroma displayable by the screen for the given hue
angle and lightness. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxC function, given a hue angle and lightness, finds the point of maximum chroma displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*u*v* coordinates.

To obtain the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum CIE metric lightness (L*) for a given Psychometric Hue Angle and Psychometric Chroma, use XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxL. __ │

Status XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxL(ccc, hue_angle, chroma, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsFloat chroma;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find maximum lightness.

L_star

Specifies the lightness (L*) at which to find max-

imum lightness.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum
lightness displayable by the screen for the given
hue angle and chroma. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxL function, given a hue angle and chroma, finds the point in CIE L*u*v* color space of maximum lightness (L*) displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*u*v* coordinates. An XcmsFailure return value usually indicates that the given chroma is beyond maximum for the given hue angle.

To obtain the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum Psychometric Chroma for a given Psychometric Hue Angle, use XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxLC. __ │

Status XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxLC(ccc, hue_angle, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find maximum chroma.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of maximum
chroma displayable by the screen for the given hue
angle. The white point associated with the re-
turned color specification is the Screen White
Point. The value returned in the pixel member is
undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELuvQueryMaxLC function, given a hue angle, finds the point of maximum chroma displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*u*v* coordinates.

To obtain the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of minimum CIE metric lightness (L*) for a given Psychometric Hue Angle and Psychometric Chroma, use XcmsCIELuvQueryMinL. __ │

Status XcmsCIELuvQueryMinL(ccc, hue_angle, chroma, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue_angle;
XcmsFloat chroma;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue_angle

Specifies the hue angle (in degrees) at which to

find minimum lightness.

chroma

Specifies the chroma at which to find minimum

lightness.

color_return
Returns the CIE L*u*v* coordinates of minimum
lightness displayable by the screen for the given
hue angle and chroma. The white point associated
with the returned color specification is the
Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsCIELuvQueryMinL function, given a hue angle and chroma, finds the point of minimum lightness (L*) displayable by the screen. It returns this point in CIE L*u*v* coordinates. An XcmsFailure return value usually indicates that the given chroma is beyond maximum for the given hue angle.

6.11.4. TekHVC Queries

To obtain the maximum Chroma for a given Hue and Value, use XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxC. __ │

Status XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxC(ccc, hue, value, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue;
XcmsFloat value;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue

Specifies the Hue in which to find the maximum

Chroma.

value

Specifies the Value in which to find the maximum

Chroma.

color_return
Returns the maximum Chroma along with the actual
Hue and Value at which the maximum Chroma was
found. The white point associated with the re-
turned color specification is the Screen White
Point. The value returned in the pixel member is
undefined. │__

The XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxC function, given a Hue and Value, determines the maximum Chroma in TekHVC color space displayable by the screen. It returns the maximum Chroma along with the actual Hue and Value at which the maximum Chroma was found.

To obtain the maximum Value for a given Hue and Chroma, use XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxV. __ │

Status XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxV(ccc, hue, chroma, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue;
XcmsFloat chroma;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue

Specifies the Hue in which to find the maximum

Value.

chroma

Specifies the chroma at which to find maximum Val-

ue.

color_return
Returns the maximum Value along with the Hue and
Chroma at which the maximum Value was found. The
white point associated with the returned color
specification is the Screen White Point. The val-
ue returned in the pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxV function, given a Hue and Chroma, determines the maximum Value in TekHVC color space displayable by the screen. It returns the maximum Value and the actual Hue and Chroma at which the maximum Value was found.

To obtain the maximum Chroma and Value at which it is reached for a specified Hue, use XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxVC. __ │

Status XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxVC(ccc, hue, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue

Specifies the Hue in which to find the maximum

Chroma.

color_return
Returns the color specification in XcmsTekHVC for
the maximum Chroma, the Value at which that maxi-
mum Chroma is reached, and the actual Hue at which
the maximum Chroma was found. The white point as-
sociated with the returned color specification is
the Screen White Point. The value returned in the
pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxVC function, given a Hue, determines the maximum Chroma in TekHVC color space displayable by the screen and the Value at which that maximum Chroma is reached. It returns the maximum Chroma, the Value at which that maximum Chroma is reached, and the actual Hue for which the maximum Chroma was found.

To obtain a specified number of TekHVC specifications such that they contain maximum Values for a specified Hue and the Chroma at which the maximum Values are reached, use XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxVSamples. __ │

Status XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxVSamples(ccc, hue, colors_return, nsamples)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue;
XcmsColor colors_return[];
unsigned int nsamples;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue

Specifies the Hue for maximum Chroma/Value sam-

ples.

nsamples

Specifies the number of samples.

colors_return
Returns nsamples of color specifications in Xcm-
sTekHVC such that the Chroma is the maximum at-
tainable for the Value and Hue. The white point
associated with the returned color specification
is the Screen White Point. The value returned in
the pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsTekHVCQueryMaxVSamples returns nsamples of maximum Value, the Chroma at which that maximum Value is reached, and the actual Hue for which the maximum Chroma was found. These sample points may then be used to plot the maximum Value/Chroma boundary of the screen’s color gamut for the specified Hue in TekHVC color space.

To obtain the minimum Value for a given Hue and Chroma, use XcmsTekHVCQueryMinV. __ │

Status XcmsTekHVCQueryMinV(ccc, hue, chroma, color_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsFloat hue;
XcmsFloat chroma;
XcmsColor *color_return;

ccc

Specifies the CCC. The CCC’s Client White Point

and white point adjustment procedures are ignored.

hue

Specifies the Hue in which to find the minimum

Value.

value

Specifies the Value in which to find the minimum

Value.

color_return
Returns the minimum Value and the actual Hue and
Chroma at which the minimum Value was found. The
white point associated with the returned color
specification is the Screen White Point. The val-
ue returned in the pixel member is undefined. │__

The XcmsTekHVCQueryMinV function, given a Hue and Chroma, determines the minimum Value in TekHVC color space displayable by the screen. It returns the minimum Value and the actual Hue and Chroma at which the minimum Value was found.

6.12. Color Management Extensions

The Xlib color management facilities can be extended in two ways:

Device-Independent Color Spaces

Device-independent color spaces that are derivable to CIE XYZ space can be added using the XcmsAddColorSpace function.

Color Characterization Function Set

A Color Characterization Function Set consists of device-dependent color spaces and their functions that convert between these color spaces and the CIE XYZ color space, bundled together for a specific class of output devices. A function set can be added using the XcmsAddFunctionSet function.

6.12.1. Color Spaces

The CIE XYZ color space serves as the hub for all conversions between device-independent and device-dependent color spaces. Therefore, the knowledge to convert an XcmsColor structure to and from CIE XYZ format is associated with each color space. For example, conversion from CIE L*u*v* to RGB requires the knowledge to convert from CIE L*u*v* to CIE XYZ and from CIE XYZ to RGB. This knowledge is stored as an array of functions that, when applied in series, will convert the XcmsColor structure to or from CIE XYZ format. This color specification conversion mechanism facilitates the addition of color spaces.

Of course, when converting between only device-independent color spaces or only device-dependent color spaces, shortcuts are taken whenever possible. For example, conversion from TekHVC to CIE L*u*v* is performed by intermediate conversion to CIE u*v*Y and then to CIE L*u*v*, thus bypassing conversion between CIE u*v*Y and CIE XYZ.

6.12.2. Adding Device-Independent Color Spaces

To add a device-independent color space, use XcmsAddColorSpace. __ │

Status XcmsAddColorSpace(color_space)
XcmsColorSpace *color_space;

color_spaceSpecifies the device-independent color space to
add. │__

The XcmsAddColorSpace function makes a device-independent color space (actually an XcmsColorSpace structure) accessible by the color management system. Because format values for unregistered color spaces are assigned at run time, they should be treated as private to the client. If references to an unregistered color space must be made outside the client (for example, storing color specifications in a file using the unregistered color space), then reference should be made by color space prefix (see XcmsFormatOfPrefix and XcmsPrefixOfFormat).

If the XcmsColorSpace structure is already accessible in the color management system, XcmsAddColorSpace returns XcmsSuccess.

Note that added XcmsColorSpaces must be retained for reference by Xlib.

6.12.3. Querying Color Space Format and Prefix

To obtain the format associated with the color space associated with a specified color string prefix, use XcmsFormatOfPrefix. __ │

XcmsColorFormat XcmsFormatOfPrefix(prefix)
char *prefix;

prefix

Specifies the string that contains the color space

prefix. │__

The XcmsFormatOfPrefix function returns the format for the specified color space prefix (for example, the string ‘‘CIEXYZ’’). The prefix is case-insensitive. If the color space is not accessible in the color management system, XcmsFormatOfPrefix returns XcmsUndefinedFormat.

To obtain the color string prefix associated with the color space specified by a color format, use XcmsPrefixOfFormat. __ │

char *XcmsPrefixOfFormat(format)
XcmsColorFormat format;

format

Specifies the color specification format. │__

The XcmsPrefixOfFormat function returns the string prefix associated with the color specification encoding specified by the format argument. Otherwise, if no encoding is found, it returns NULL. The returned string must be treated as read-only.

6.12.4. Creating Additional Color Spaces

Color space specific information necessary for color space conversion and color string parsing is stored in an XcmsColorSpace structure. Therefore, a new structure containing this information is required for each additional color space. In the case of device-independent color spaces, a handle to this new structure (that is, by means of a global variable) is usually made accessible to the client program for use with the XcmsAddColorSpace function.

If a new XcmsColorSpace structure specifies a color space not registered with the X Consortium, they should be treated as private to the client because format values for unregistered color spaces are assigned at run time. If references to an unregistered color space must be made outside the client (for example, storing color specifications in a file using the unregistered color space), then reference should be made by color space prefix (see XcmsFormatOfPrefix and XcmsPrefixOfFormat). __ │

typedef (*XcmsConversionProc)();
typedef XcmsConversionProc *XcmsFuncListPtr;

/* A NULL terminated list of function pointers*/

typedef struct _XcmsColorSpace {

char *prefix;

XcmsColorFormat format;

XcmsParseStringProc parseString;

XcmsFuncListPtr to_CIEXYZ;

XcmsFuncListPtr from_CIEXYZ;

int inverse_flag;

} XcmsColorSpace; │__

The prefix member specifies the prefix that indicates a color string is in this color space’s string format. For example, the strings ‘‘ciexyz’’ or ‘‘CIEXYZ’’ for CIE XYZ, and ‘‘rgb’’ or ‘‘RGB’’ for RGB. The prefix is case insensitive. The format member specifies the color specification format. Formats for unregistered color spaces are assigned at run time. The parseString member contains a pointer to the function that can parse a color string into an XcmsColor structure. This function returns an integer (int): nonzero if it succeeded and zero otherwise. The to_CIEXYZ and from_CIEXYZ members contain pointers, each to a NULL terminated list of function pointers. When the list of functions is executed in series, it will convert the color specified in an XcmsColor structure from/to the current color space format to/from the CIE XYZ format. Each function returns an integer (int): nonzero if it succeeded and zero otherwise. The white point to be associated with the colors is specified explicitly, even though white points can be found in the CCC. The inverse_flag member, if nonzero, specifies that for each function listed in to_CIEXYZ, its inverse function can be found in from_CIEXYZ such that:

Given: n = number of functions in each list

for each i, such that 0 <= i < n
from_CIEXYZ[n - i - 1] is the inverse of to_CIEXYZ[i].

This allows Xlib to use the shortest conversion path, thus bypassing CIE XYZ if possible (for example, TekHVC to CIE L*u*v*).

6.12.5. Parse String Callback

The callback in the XcmsColorSpace structure for parsing a color string for the particular color space must adhere to the following software interface specification: __ │

typedef int (*XcmsParseStringProc)(color_string, color_return)
char *color_string;
XcmsColor *color_return;

color_string
Specifies the color string to parse.

color_return
Returns the color specification in the color
space’s format. │__

6.12.6. Color Specification Conversion Callback

Callback functions in the XcmsColorSpace structure for converting a color specification between device-independent spaces must adhere to the following software interface specification: __ │

Status ConversionProc(ccc, white_point, colors_in_out, ncolors)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColor *white_point;
XcmsColor *colors_in_out;
unsigned int ncolors;

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

white_pointSpecifies the white point associated with color
specifications. The pixel member should be ig-
nored, and the entire structure remain unchanged
upon return.

colors_in_out
Specifies an array of color specifications. Pixel
members should be ignored and must remain un-
changed upon return.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array. │__

Callback functions in the XcmsColorSpace structure for converting a color specification to or from a device-dependent space must adhere to the following software interface specification: __ │

Status ConversionProc(ccc, colors_in_out, ncolors, compression_flags_return)
XcmsCCC ccc;
XcmsColor *colors_in_out;
unsigned int ncolors;
Bool compression_flags_return[];

ccc

Specifies the CCC.

colors_in_out
Specifies an array of color specifications. Pixel
members should be ignored and must remain un-
changed upon return.

ncolors

Specifies the number of XcmsColor structures in

the color-specification array.

compression_flags_return
Returns an array of Boolean values for indicating
compression status. If a non-NULL pointer is sup-
plied and a color at a given index is compressed,
then True should be stored at the corresponding
index in this array; otherwise, the array should
not be modified. │__

Conversion functions are available globally for use by other color spaces. The conversion functions provided by Xlib are:
Function Converts from Converts to
XcmsCIELabToCIEXYZ
XcmsCIELabFormat
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsCIELuvToCIEuvY
XcmsCIELuvFormat
XcmsCIEuvYFormat
XcmsCIEXYZToCIELab
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsCIELabFormat
XcmsCIEXYZToCIEuvY
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsCIEuvYFormat
XcmsCIEXYZToCIExyY
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsCIExyYFormat
XcmsCIEXYZToRGBi
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsRGBiFormat
XcmsCIEuvYToCIELuv
XcmsCIEuvYFormat
XcmsCIELabFormat
XcmsCIEuvYToCIEXYZ
XcmsCIEuvYFormat
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsCIEuvYToTekHVC
XcmsCIEuvYFormat
XcmsTekHVCFormat
XcmsCIExyYToCIEXYZ
XcmsCIExyYFormat
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsRGBToRGBi
XcmsRGBFormat
XcmsRGBiFormat
XcmsRGBiToCIEXYZ
XcmsRGBiFormat
XcmsCIEXYZFormat
XcmsRGBiToRGB
XcmsRGBiFormat
XcmsRGBFormat
XcmsTekHVCToCIEuvY
XcmsTekHVCFormat
XcmsCIEuvYFormat

6.12.7. Function Sets

Functions to convert between device-dependent color spaces and CIE XYZ may differ for different classes of output devices (for example, color versus gray monitors). Therefore, the notion of a Color Characterization Function Set has been developed. A function set consists of device-dependent color spaces and the functions that convert color specifications between these device-dependent color spaces and the CIE XYZ color space appropriate for a particular class of output devices. The function set also contains a function that reads color characterization data off root window properties. It is this characterization data that will differ between devices within a class of output devices. For details about how color characterization data is stored in root window properties, see the section on Device Color Characterization in the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual. The LINEAR_RGB function set is provided by Xlib and will support most color monitors. Function sets may require data that differs from those needed for the LINEAR_RGB function set. In that case, its corresponding data may be stored on different root window properties.

6.12.8. Adding Function Sets

To add a function set, use XcmsAddFunctionSet. __ │

Status XcmsAddFunctionSet(function_set)
XcmsFunctionSet *function_set;

function_set
Specifies the function set to add. │__

The XcmsAddFunctionSet function adds a function set to the color management system. If the function set uses device-dependent XcmsColorSpace structures not accessible in the color management system, XcmsAddFunctionSet adds them. If an added XcmsColorSpace structure is for a device-dependent color space not registered with the X Consortium, they should be treated as private to the client because format values for unregistered color spaces are assigned at run time. If references to an unregistered color space must be made outside the client (for example, storing color specifications in a file using the unregistered color space), then reference should be made by color space prefix (see XcmsFormatOfPrefix and XcmsPrefixOfFormat).

Additional function sets should be added before any calls to other Xlib routines are made. If not, the XcmsPerScrnInfo member of a previously created XcmsCCC does not have the opportunity to initialize with the added function set.

6.12.9. Creating Additional Function Sets

The creation of additional function sets should be required only when an output device does not conform to existing function sets or when additional device-dependent color spaces are necessary. A function set consists primarily of a collection of device-dependent XcmsColorSpace structures and a means to read and store a screen’s color characterization data. This data is stored in an XcmsFunctionSet structure. A handle to this structure (that is, by means of global variable) is usually made accessible to the client program for use with XcmsAddFunctionSet.

If a function set uses new device-dependent XcmsColorSpace structures, they will be transparently processed into the color management system. Function sets can share an XcmsColorSpace structure for a device-dependent color space. In addition, multiple XcmsColorSpace structures are allowed for a device-dependent color space; however, a function set can reference only one of them. These XcmsColorSpace structures will differ in the functions to convert to and from CIE XYZ, thus tailored for the specific function set. __ │

typedef struct _XcmsFunctionSet {

XcmsColorSpace **DDColorSpaces;

XcmsScreenInitProc screenInitProc;

XcmsScreenFreeProc screenFreeProc;

} XcmsFunctionSet; │__

The DDColorSpaces member is a pointer to a NULL terminated list of pointers to XcmsColorSpace structures for the device-dependent color spaces that are supported by the function set. The screenInitProc member is set to the callback procedure (see the following interface specification) that initializes the XcmsPerScrnInfo structure for a particular screen.

The screen initialization callback must adhere to the following software interface specification: __ │

typedef Status (*XcmsScreenInitProc)(display, screen_number, screen_info)
Display *display;
int screen_number;
XcmsPerScrnInfo *screen_info;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server.

screen_infoSpecifies the XcmsPerScrnInfo structure, which
contains the per screen information. │__

The screen initialization callback in the XcmsFunctionSet structure fetches the color characterization data (device profile) for the specified screen, typically off properties on the screen’s root window. It then initializes the specified XcmsPerScrnInfo structure. If successful, the procedure fills in the XcmsPerScrnInfo structure as follows:

It sets the screenData member to the address of the created device profile data structure (contents known only by the function set).

It next sets the screenWhitePoint member.

It next sets the functionSet member to the address of the XcmsFunctionSet structure.

It then sets the state member to XcmsInitSuccess and finally returns XcmsSuccess.

If unsuccessful, the procedure sets the state member to XcmsInitFailure and returns XcmsFailure.

The XcmsPerScrnInfo structure contains: __ │

typedef struct _XcmsPerScrnInfo {

XcmsColor screenWhitePoint;

XPointer functionSet;

XPointer screenData;

unsigned char state;

char pad[3];

} XcmsPerScrnInfo; │__

The screenWhitePoint member specifies the white point inherent to the screen. The functionSet member specifies the appropriate function set. The screenData member specifies the device profile. The state member is set to one of the following:

XcmsInitNone indicates initialization has not been previously attempted.

XcmsInitFailure indicates initialization has been previously attempted but failed.

XcmsInitSuccess indicates initialization has been previously attempted and succeeded.

The screen free callback must adhere to the following software interface specification: __ │

typedef void (*XcmsScreenFreeProc)(screenData)
XPointer screenData;

screenDataSpecifies the data to be freed. │__

This function is called to free the screenData stored in an XcmsPerScrnInfo structure.

6

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 7

Graphics Context Functions

A number of resources are used when performing graphics operations in X. Most information about performing graphics (for example, foreground color, background color, line style, and so on) is stored in resources called graphics contexts (GCs). Most graphics operations (see chapter 8) take a GC as an argument. Although in theory the X protocol permits sharing of GCs between applications, it is expected that applications will use their own GCs when performing operations. Sharing of GCs is highly discouraged because the library may cache GC state.

Graphics operations can be performed to either windows or pixmaps, which collectively are called drawables. Each drawable exists on a single screen. A GC is created for a specific screen and drawable depth and can only be used with drawables of matching screen and depth.

This chapter discusses how to:

Manipulate graphics context/state

Use graphics context convenience functions

7.1. Manipulating Graphics Context/State

Most attributes of graphics operations are stored in GCs. These include line width, line style, plane mask, foreground, background, tile, stipple, clipping region, end style, join style, and so on. Graphics operations (for example, drawing lines) use these values to determine the actual drawing operation. Extensions to X may add additional components to GCs. The contents of a GC are private to Xlib.

Xlib implements a write-back cache for all elements of a GC that are not resource IDs to allow Xlib to implement the transparent coalescing of changes to GCs. For example, a call to XSetForeground of a GC followed by a call to XSetLineAttributes results in only a single-change GC protocol request to the server. GCs are neither expected nor encouraged to be shared between client applications, so this write-back caching should present no problems. Applications cannot share GCs without external synchronization. Therefore, sharing GCs between applications is highly discouraged.

To set an attribute of a GC, set the appropriate member of the XGCValues structure and OR in the corresponding value bitmask in your subsequent calls to XCreateGC. The symbols for the value mask bits and the XGCValues structure are: __ │

/* GC attribute value mask bits */

#define
GCFunction

(1L<<0)
#define
GCPlaneMask

(1L<<1)
#define
GCForeground

(1L<<2)
#define
GCBackground

(1L<<3)
#define
GCLineWidth

(1L<<4)
#define
GCLineStyle

(1L<<5)
#define
GCCapStyle

(1L<<6)
#define
GCJoinStyle

(1L<<7)
#define
GCFillStyle

(1L<<8)
#define
GCFillRule

(1L<<9)
#define
GCTile

(1L<<10)
#define
GCStipple

(1L<<11)
#define
GCTileStipXOrigin

(1L<<12)
#define
GCTileStipYOrigin

(1L<<13)
#define
GCFont

(1L<<14)
#define
GCSubwindowMode

(1L<<15)
#define
GCGraphicsExposures

(1L<<16)
#define
GCClipXOrigin

(1L<<17)
#define
GCClipYOrigin

(1L<<18)
#define
GCClipMask

(1L<<19)
#define
GCDashOffset

(1L<<20)
#define
GCDashList

(1L<<21)
#define
GCArcMode

(1L<<22)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

int function;

/* logical operation */

unsigned long plane_mask;/* plane mask */

unsigned long foreground;/* foreground pixel */

unsigned long background;/* background pixel */

int line_width;

/* line width (in pixels) */

int line_style;

/* LineSolid, LineOnOffDash, LineDoubleDash */

int cap_style;

/* CapNotLast, CapButt, CapRound, CapProjecting */

int join_style;

/* JoinMiter, JoinRound, JoinBevel */

int fill_style;

/* FillSolid, FillTiled, FillStippled FillOpaqueStippled*/

int fill_rule;

/* EvenOddRule, WindingRule */

int arc_mode;

/* ArcChord, ArcPieSlice */

Pixmap tile;

/* tile pixmap for tiling operations */

Pixmap stipple;

/* stipple 1 plane pixmap for stippling */

int ts_x_origin;

/* offset for tile or stipple operations */

int ts_y_origin;

Font font;

/* default text font for text operations */

int subwindow_mode;

/* ClipByChildren, IncludeInferiors */

Bool graphics_exposures;

/* boolean, should exposures be generated */

int clip_x_origin;

/* origin for clipping */

int clip_y_origin;

Pixmap clip_mask;

/* bitmap clipping; other calls for rects */

int dash_offset;

/* patterned/dashed line information */

char dashes;

} XGCValues; │__

The default GC values are:
Component Default

function
GXcopy

plane_mask All ones
foreground 0
background 1
line_width 0
line_style
LineSolid

cap_style
CapButt

join_style
JoinMiter

fill_style
FillSolid

fill_rule
EvenOddRule

arc_mode
ArcPieSlice

tile Pixmap of unspecified size filled with foreground pixel
(that is, client specified pixel if any, else 0)
(subsequent changes to foreground do not affect this pixmap)
stipple Pixmap of unspecified size filled with ones
ts_x_origin 0
ts_y_origin 0
font <implementation dependent>
subwindow_mode
ClipByChildren

graphics_exposures
True

clip_x_origin 0
clip_y_origin 0
clip_mask
None

dash_offset 0
dashes 4 (that is, the list [4, 4])

Note that foreground and background are not set to any values likely to be useful in a window.

The function attributes of a GC are used when you update a section of a drawable (the destination) with bits from somewhere else (the source). The function in a GC defines how the new destination bits are to be computed from the source bits and the old destination bits. GXcopy is typically the most useful because it will work on a color display, but special applications may use other functions, particularly in concert with particular planes of a color display. The 16 GC functions, defined in <X11/X.h>, are:
Function Name Value Operation
GXclear

0x0
0
GXand

0x1
src AND dst
GXandReverse

0x2
src AND NOT dst
GXcopy

0x3
src
GXandInverted

0x4
(NOT src) AND dst
GXnoop

0x5
dst
GXxor

0x6
src XOR dst
GXor

0x7
src OR dst
GXnor

0x8
(NOT src) AND (NOT
dst)
GXequiv

0x9
(NOT src) XOR dst
GXinvert

0xa
NOT dst
GXorReverse

0xb
src OR (NOT dst)
GXcopyInverted

0xc
NOT src
GXorInverted

0xd
(NOT src) OR dst
GXnand

0xe
(NOT src) OR (NOT
dst)
GXset

0xf
1

Many graphics operations depend on either pixel values or planes in a GC. The planes attribute is of type long, and it specifies which planes of the destination are to be modified, one bit per plane. A monochrome display has only one plane and will be the least significant bit of the word. As planes are added to the display hardware, they will occupy more significant bits in the plane mask.

In graphics operations, given a source and destination pixel, the result is computed bitwise on corresponding bits of the pixels. That is, a Boolean operation is performed in each bit plane. The plane_mask restricts the operation to a subset of planes. A macro constant AllPlanes can be used to refer to all planes of the screen simultaneously. The result is computed by the following:

((src FUNC dst) AND plane-mask) OR (dst AND (NOT plane-mask))

Range checking is not performed on the values for foreground, background, or plane_mask. They are simply truncated to the appropriate number of bits. The line-width is measured in pixels and either can be greater than or equal to one (wide line) or can be the special value zero (thin line).

Wide lines are drawn centered on the path described by the graphics request. Unless otherwise specified by the join-style or cap-style, the bounding box of a wide line with endpoints [x1, y1], [x2, y2] and width w is a rectangle with vertices at the following real coordinates:

[x1-(w*sn/2), y1+(w*cs/2)], [x1+(w*sn/2), y1-(w*cs/2)],
[x2-(w*sn/2), y2+(w*cs/2)], [x2+(w*sn/2), y2-(w*cs/2)]

Here sn is the sine of the angle of the line, and cs is the cosine of the angle of the line. A pixel is part of the line and so is drawn if the center of the pixel is fully inside the bounding box (which is viewed as having infinitely thin edges). If the center of the pixel is exactly on the bounding box, it is part of the line if and only if the interior is immediately to its right (x increasing direction). Pixels with centers on a horizontal edge are a special case and are part of the line if and only if the interior or the boundary is immediately below (y increasing direction) and the interior or the boundary is immediately to the right (x increasing direction).

Thin lines (zero line-width) are one-pixel-wide lines drawn using an unspecified, device-dependent algorithm. There are only two constraints on this algorithm.

1.

If a line is drawn unclipped from [x1,y1] to [x2,y2] and if another line is drawn unclipped from [x1+dx,y1+dy] to [x2+dx,y2+dy], a point [x,y] is touched by drawing the first line if and only if the point [x+dx,y+dy] is touched by drawing the second line.

2.

The effective set of points comprising a line cannot be affected by clipping. That is, a point is touched in a clipped line if and only if the point lies inside the clipping region and the point would be touched by the line when drawn unclipped.

A wide line drawn from [x1,y1] to [x2,y2] always draws the same pixels as a wide line drawn from [x2,y2] to [x1,y1], not counting cap-style and join-style. It is recommended that this property be true for thin lines, but this is not required. A line-width of zero may differ from a line-width of one in which pixels are drawn. This permits the use of many manufacturers’ line drawing hardware, which may run many times faster than the more precisely specified wide lines.

In general, drawing a thin line will be faster than drawing a wide line of width one. However, because of their different drawing algorithms, thin lines may not mix well aesthetically with wide lines. If it is desirable to obtain precise and uniform results across all displays, a client should always use a line-width of one rather than a line-width of zero.

The line-style defines which sections of a line are drawn:
LineSolid

The full path of the line is drawn.
LineDoubleDash

The full path of the line is drawn, but the
even dashes are filled differently from the
odd dashes (see fill-style) with CapButt
style used where even and odd dashes meet.
LineOnOffDash

Only the even dashes are drawn, and cap-style
applies to all internal ends of the
individual dashes, except CapNotLast is
treated as CapButt.

The cap-style defines how the endpoints of a path are drawn:
CapNotLast

This is equivalent to CapButt except that for
a line-width of zero the final endpoint is
not drawn.
CapButt

The line is square at the endpoint
(perpendicular to the slope of the line) with
no projection beyond.
CapRound

The line has a circular arc with the diameter
equal to the line-width, centered on the
endpoint. (This is equivalent to CapButt for
line-width of zero).
CapProjecting

The line is square at the end, but the path
continues beyond the endpoint for a distance
equal to half the line-width. (This is
equivalent to CapButt for line-width of
zero).

The join-style defines how corners are drawn for wide lines:
JoinMiter

The outer edges of two lines extend to meet
at an angle. However, if the angle is less
than 11 degrees, then a JoinBevel join-style
is used instead.
JoinRound

The corner is a circular arc with the
diameter equal to the line-width, centered on
the joinpoint.
JoinBevel

The corner has CapButt endpoint styles with
the triangular notch filled.

For a line with coincident endpoints (x1=x2, y1=y2), when the cap-style is applied to both endpoints, the semantics depends on the line-width and the cap-style:
CapNotLast

thin
The results are device dependent, but
the desired effect is that nothing is
drawn.
CapButt

thin
The results are device dependent, but
the desired effect is that a single
pixel is drawn.
CapRound

thin
The results are the same as for
CapButt
/thin.
CapProjecting

thin
The results are the same as for
CapButt
/thin.
CapButt

wide
Nothing is drawn.
CapRound

wide
The closed path is a circle, centered at
the endpoint, and with the diameter
equal to the line-width.
CapProjecting

wide
The closed path is a square, aligned
with the coordinate axes, centered at
the endpoint, and with the sides equal
to the line-width.

For a line with coincident endpoints (x1=x2, y1=y2), when the join-style is applied at one or both endpoints, the effect is as if the line was removed from the overall path. However, if the total path consists of or is reduced to a single point joined with itself, the effect is the same as when the cap-style is applied at both endpoints.

The tile/stipple represents an infinite two-dimensional plane, with the tile/stipple replicated in all dimensions. When that plane is superimposed on the drawable for use in a graphics operation, the upper-left corner of some instance of the tile/stipple is at the coordinates within the drawable specified by the tile/stipple origin. The tile/stipple and clip origins are interpreted relative to the origin of whatever destination drawable is specified in a graphics request. The tile pixmap must have the same root and depth as the GC, or a BadMatch error results. The stipple pixmap must have depth one and must have the same root as the GC, or a BadMatch error results. For stipple operations where the fill-style is FillStippled but not FillOpaqueStippled, the stipple pattern is tiled in a single plane and acts as an additional clip mask to be ANDed with the clip-mask. Although some sizes may be faster to use than others, any size pixmap can be used for tiling or stippling.

The fill-style defines the contents of the source for line, text, and fill requests. For all text and fill requests (for example, XDrawText, XDrawText16, XFillRectangle, XFillPolygon, and XFillArc); for line requests with line-style LineSolid (for example, XDrawLine, XDrawSegments, XDrawRectangle, XDrawArc); and for the even dashes for line requests with line-style LineOnOffDash or LineDoubleDash, the following apply:
FillSolid

Foreground
FillTiled

Tile
FillOpaqueStippled

A tile with the same width and height as
stipple, but with background everywhere
stipple has a zero and with foreground
everywhere stipple has a one
FillStippled

Foreground masked by stipple

When drawing lines with line-style LineDoubleDash, the odd dashes are controlled by the fill-style in the following manner:
FillSolid

Background
FillTiled

Same as for even dashes
FillOpaqueStippled

Same as for even dashes
FillStippled

Background masked by stipple

Storing a pixmap in a GC might or might not result in a copy being made. If the pixmap is later used as the destination for a graphics request, the change might or might not be reflected in the GC. If the pixmap is used simultaneously in a graphics request both as a destination and as a tile or stipple, the results are undefined.

For optimum performance, you should draw as much as possible with the same GC (without changing its components). The costs of changing GC components relative to using different GCs depend on the display hardware and the server implementation. It is quite likely that some amount of GC information will be cached in display hardware and that such hardware can only cache a small number of GCs.

The dashes value is actually a simplified form of the more general patterns that can be set with XSetDashes. Specifying a value of N is equivalent to specifying the two-element list [N, N] in XSetDashes. The value must be nonzero, or a BadValue error results.

The clip-mask restricts writes to the destination drawable. If the clip-mask is set to a pixmap, it must have depth one and have the same root as the GC, or a BadMatch error results. If clip-mask is set to None, the pixels are always drawn regardless of the clip origin. The clip-mask also can be set by calling the XSetClipRectangles or XSetRegion functions. Only pixels where the clip-mask has a bit set to 1 are drawn. Pixels are not drawn outside the area covered by the clip-mask or where the clip-mask has a bit set to 0. The clip-mask affects all graphics requests. The clip-mask does not clip sources. The clip-mask origin is interpreted relative to the origin of whatever destination drawable is specified in a graphics request.

You can set the subwindow-mode to ClipByChildren or IncludeInferiors. For ClipByChildren, both source and destination windows are additionally clipped by all viewable InputOutput children. For IncludeInferiors, neither source nor destination window is clipped by inferiors. This will result in including subwindow contents in the source and drawing through subwindow boundaries of the destination. The use of IncludeInferiors on a window of one depth with mapped inferiors of differing depth is not illegal, but the semantics are undefined by the core protocol.

The fill-rule defines what pixels are inside (drawn) for paths given in XFillPolygon requests and can be set to EvenOddRule or WindingRule. For EvenOddRule, a point is inside if an infinite ray with the point as origin crosses the path an odd number of times. For WindingRule, a point is inside if an infinite ray with the point as origin crosses an unequal number of clockwise and counterclockwise directed path segments. A clockwise directed path segment is one that crosses the ray from left to right as observed from the point. A counterclockwise segment is one that crosses the ray from right to left as observed from the point. The case where a directed line segment is coincident with the ray is uninteresting because you can simply choose a different ray that is not coincident with a segment.

For both EvenOddRule and WindingRule, a point is infinitely small, and the path is an infinitely thin line. A pixel is inside if the center point of the pixel is inside and the center point is not on the boundary. If the center point is on the boundary, the pixel is inside if and only if the polygon interior is immediately to its right (x increasing direction). Pixels with centers on a horizontal edge are a special case and are inside if and only if the polygon interior is immediately below (y increasing direction).

The arc-mode controls filling in the XFillArcs function and can be set to ArcPieSlice or ArcChord. For ArcPieSlice, the arcs are pie-slice filled. For ArcChord, the arcs are chord filled.

The graphics-exposure flag controls GraphicsExpose event generation for XCopyArea and XCopyPlane requests (and any similar requests defined by extensions).

To create a new GC that is usable on a given screen with a depth of drawable, use XCreateGC. __ │

GC XCreateGC(display, d, valuemask, values)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
unsigned long valuemask;
XGCValues *values;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

valuemask

Specifies which components in the GC are to be set

using the information in the specified values
structure. This argument is the bitwise inclusive
OR of zero or more of the valid GC component mask
bits.

values

Specifies any values as specified by the value-

mask. │__

The XCreateGC function creates a graphics context and returns a GC. The GC can be used with any destination drawable having the same root and depth as the specified drawable. Use with other drawables results in a BadMatch error.

XCreateGC can generate BadAlloc, BadDrawable, BadFont, BadMatch, BadPixmap, and BadValue errors.

To copy components from a source GC to a destination GC, use XCopyGC. __ │

XCopyGC(display, src, valuemask, dest)
Display *display;
GC src, dest;
unsigned long valuemask;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

src

Specifies the components of the source GC.

valuemask

Specifies which components in the GC are to be

copied to the destination GC. This argument is
the bitwise inclusive OR of zero or more of the
valid GC component mask bits.

dest

Specifies the destination GC. │__

The XCopyGC function copies the specified components from the source GC to the destination GC. The source and destination GCs must have the same root and depth, or a BadMatch error results. The valuemask specifies which component to copy, as for XCreateGC.

XCopyGC can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

To change the components in a given GC, use XChangeGC. __ │

XChangeGC(display, gc, valuemask, values)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned long valuemask;
XGCValues *values;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

valuemask

Specifies which components in the GC are to be

changed using information in the specified values
structure. This argument is the bitwise inclusive
OR of zero or more of the valid GC component mask
bits.

values

Specifies any values as specified by the value-

mask. │__

The XChangeGC function changes the components specified by valuemask for the specified GC. The values argument contains the values to be set. The values and restrictions are the same as for XCreateGC. Changing the clip-mask overrides any previous XSetClipRectangles request on the context. Changing the dash-offset or dash-list overrides any previous XSetDashes request on the context. The order in which components are verified and altered is server dependent. If an error is generated, a subset of the components may have been altered.

XChangeGC can generate BadAlloc, BadFont, BadGC, BadMatch, BadPixmap, and BadValue errors.

To obtain components of a given GC, use XGetGCValues. __ │

Status XGetGCValues(display, gc, valuemask, values_return)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned long valuemask;
XGCValues *values_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

valuemask

Specifies which components in the GC are to be re-

turned in the values_return argument. This argu-
ment is the bitwise inclusive OR of zero or more
of the valid GC component mask bits.

values_return
Returns the GC values in the specified XGCValues
structure. │__

The XGetGCValues function returns the components specified by valuemask for the specified GC. If the valuemask contains a valid set of GC mask bits (GCFunction, GCPlaneMask, GCForeground, GCBackground, GCLineWidth, GCLineStyle, GCCapStyle, GCJoinStyle, GCFillStyle, GCFillRule, GCTile, GCStipple, GCTileStipXOrigin, GCTileStipYOrigin, GCFont, GCSubwindowMode, GCGraphicsExposures, GCClipXOrigin, GCCLipYOrigin, GCDashOffset, or GCArcMode) and no error occurs, XGetGCValues sets the requested components in values_return and returns a nonzero status. Otherwise, it returns a zero status. Note that the clip-mask and dash-list (represented by the GCClipMask and GCDashList bits, respectively, in the valuemask) cannot be requested. Also note that an invalid resource ID (with one or more of the three most significant bits set to 1) will be returned for GCFont, GCTile, and GCStipple if the component has never been explicitly set by the client.

To free a given GC, use XFreeGC. __ │

XFreeGC(display, gc)
Display *display;
GC gc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC. │__

The XFreeGC function destroys the specified GC as well as all the associated storage.

XFreeGC can generate a BadGC error.

To obtain the GContext resource ID for a given GC, use XGContextFromGC. __ │

GContext XGContextFromGC(gc)
GC gc;

gc

Specifies the GC for which you want the resource

ID. │__

Xlib usually defers sending changes to the components of a GC to the server until a graphics function is actually called with that GC. This permits batching of component changes into a single server request. In some circumstances, however, it may be necessary for the client to explicitly force sending the changes to the server. An example might be when a protocol extension uses the GC indirectly, in such a way that the extension interface cannot know what GC will be used. To force sending GC component changes, use XFlushGC. __ │

void XFlushGC(display, gc)
Display *display;
GC gc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC. │__

7.2. Using Graphics Context Convenience Routines

This section discusses how to set the:

Foreground, background, plane mask, or function components

Line attributes and dashes components

Fill style and fill rule components

Fill tile and stipple components

Font component

Clip region component

Arc mode, subwindow mode, and graphics exposure components

7.2.1. Setting the Foreground, Background, Function, or Plane Mask

To set the foreground, background, plane mask, and function components for a given GC, use XSetState. __ │

XSetState(display, gc, foreground, background, function, plane_mask)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned long foreground, background;
int function;
unsigned long plane_mask;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

foregroundSpecifies the foreground you want to set for the
specified GC.

backgroundSpecifies the background you want to set for the
specified GC.

function

Specifies the function you want to set for the

specified GC.

plane_maskSpecifies the plane mask. │__

XSetState can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To set the foreground of a given GC, use XSetForeground. __ │

XSetForeground(display, gc, foreground)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned long foreground;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

foregroundSpecifies the foreground you want to set for the
specified GC. │__

XSetForeground can generate BadAlloc and BadGC errors.

To set the background of a given GC, use XSetBackground. __ │

XSetBackground(display, gc, background)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned long background;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

backgroundSpecifies the background you want to set for the
specified GC. │__

XSetBackground can generate BadAlloc and BadGC errors.

To set the display function in a given GC, use XSetFunction. __ │

XSetFunction(display, gc, function)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int function;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

function

Specifies the function you want to set for the

specified GC. │__

XSetFunction can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To set the plane mask of a given GC, use XSetPlaneMask. __ │

XSetPlaneMask(display, gc, plane_mask)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned long plane_mask;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

plane_maskSpecifies the plane mask. │__

XSetPlaneMask can generate BadAlloc and BadGC errors.

7.2.2. Setting the Line Attributes and Dashes

To set the line drawing components of a given GC, use XSetLineAttributes. __ │

XSetLineAttributes(display, gc, line_width, line_style, cap_style, join_style)
Display *display;
GC gc;
unsigned int line_width;
int line_style;
int cap_style;
int join_style;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

line_widthSpecifies the line-width you want to set for the
specified GC.

line_styleSpecifies the line-style you want to set for the
specified GC. You can pass LineSolid, LineOnOff-
Dash
, or LineDoubleDash.

cap_style

Specifies the line-style and cap-style you want to

set for the specified GC. You can pass CapNot-
Last
, CapButt, CapRound, or CapProjecting.

join_styleSpecifies the line join-style you want to set for
the specified GC. You can pass JoinMiter, Join-
Round
, or JoinBevel. │__

XSetLineAttributes can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To set the dash-offset and dash-list for dashed line styles of a given GC, use XSetDashes. __ │

XSetDashes(display, gc, dash_offset, dash_list, n)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int dash_offset;
char dash_list[];
int n;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

dash_offsetSpecifies the phase of the pattern for the dashed
line-style you want to set for the specified GC.

dash_list

Specifies the dash-list for the dashed line-style

you want to set for the specified GC.

n

Specifies the number of elements in dash_list. │__

The XSetDashes function sets the dash-offset and dash-list attributes for dashed line styles in the specified GC. There must be at least one element in the specified dash_list, or a BadValue error results. The initial and alternating elements (second, fourth, and so on) of the dash_list are the even dashes, and the others are the odd dashes. Each element specifies a dash length in pixels. All of the elements must be nonzero, or a BadValue error results. Specifying an odd-length list is equivalent to specifying the same list concatenated with itself to produce an even-length list.

The dash-offset defines the phase of the pattern, specifying how many pixels into the dash-list the pattern should actually begin in any single graphics request. Dashing is continuous through path elements combined with a join-style but is reset to the dash-offset between each sequence of joined lines.

The unit of measure for dashes is the same for the ordinary coordinate system. Ideally, a dash length is measured along the slope of the line, but implementations are only required to match this ideal for horizontal and vertical lines. Failing the ideal semantics, it is suggested that the length be measured along the major axis of the line. The major axis is defined as the x axis for lines drawn at an angle of between −45 and +45 degrees or between 135 and 225 degrees from the x axis. For all other lines, the major axis is the y axis.

XSetDashes can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

7.2.3. Setting the Fill Style and Fill Rule

To set the fill-style of a given GC, use XSetFillStyle. __ │

XSetFillStyle(display, gc, fill_style)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int fill_style;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

fill_styleSpecifies the fill-style you want to set for the
specified GC. You can pass FillSolid, FillTiled,
FillStippled
, or FillOpaqueStippled. │__

XSetFillStyle can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To set the fill-rule of a given GC, use XSetFillRule. __ │

XSetFillRule(display, gc, fill_rule)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int fill_rule;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

fill_rule

Specifies the fill-rule you want to set for the

specified GC. You can pass EvenOddRule or Windin-
gRule
. │__

XSetFillRule can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

7.2.4. Setting the Fill Tile and Stipple

Some displays have hardware support for tiling or stippling with patterns of specific sizes. Tiling and stippling operations that restrict themselves to those specific sizes run much faster than such operations with arbitrary size patterns. Xlib provides functions that you can use to determine the best size, tile, or stipple for the display as well as to set the tile or stipple shape and the tile or stipple origin.

To obtain the best size of a tile, stipple, or cursor, use XQueryBestSize. __ │

Status XQueryBestSize(display, class, which_screen, width, height, width_return, height_return)
Display *display;
int class;
Drawable which_screen;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

class

Specifies the class that you are interested in.

You can pass TileShape, CursorShape, or Stipple-
Shape
.

which_screen
Specifies any drawable on the screen.

width

height

Specify the width and height.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height of the object best
supported by the display hardware. │__

The XQueryBestSize function returns the best or closest size to the specified size. For CursorShape, this is the largest size that can be fully displayed on the screen specified by which_screen. For TileShape, this is the size that can be tiled fastest. For StippleShape, this is the size that can be stippled fastest. For CursorShape, the drawable indicates the desired screen. For TileShape and StippleShape, the drawable indicates the screen and possibly the window class and depth. An InputOnly window cannot be used as the drawable for TileShape or StippleShape, or a BadMatch error results.

XQueryBestSize can generate BadDrawable, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

To obtain the best fill tile shape, use XQueryBestTile. __ │

Status XQueryBestTile(display, which_screen, width, height, width_return, height_return)
Display *display;
Drawable which_screen;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

which_screen
Specifies any drawable on the screen.

width

height

Specify the width and height.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height of the object best
supported by the display hardware. │__

The XQueryBestTile function returns the best or closest size, that is, the size that can be tiled fastest on the screen specified by which_screen. The drawable indicates the screen and possibly the window class and depth. If an InputOnly window is used as the drawable, a BadMatch error results.

XQueryBestTile can generate BadDrawable and BadMatch errors.

To obtain the best stipple shape, use XQueryBestStipple. __ │

Status XQueryBestStipple(display, which_screen, width, height, width_return, height_return)
Display *display;
Drawable which_screen;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

which_screen
Specifies any drawable on the screen.

width

height

Specify the width and height.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height of the object best
supported by the display hardware. │__

The XQueryBestStipple function returns the best or closest size, that is, the size that can be stippled fastest on the screen specified by which_screen. The drawable indicates the screen and possibly the window class and depth. If an InputOnly window is used as the drawable, a BadMatch error results.

XQueryBestStipple can generate BadDrawable and BadMatch errors.

To set the fill tile of a given GC, use XSetTile. __ │

XSetTile(display, gc, tile)
Display *display;
GC gc;
Pixmap tile;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

tile

Specifies the fill tile you want to set for the

specified GC. │__

The tile and GC must have the same depth, or a BadMatch error results.

XSetTile can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadPixmap errors.

To set the stipple of a given GC, use XSetStipple. __ │

XSetStipple(display, gc, stipple)
Display *display;
GC gc;
Pixmap stipple;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

stipple

Specifies the stipple you want to set for the

specified GC. │__

The stipple must have a depth of one, or a BadMatch error results.

XSetStipple can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadPixmap errors.

To set the tile or stipple origin of a given GC, use XSetTSOrigin. __ │

XSetTSOrigin(display, gc, ts_x_origin, ts_y_origin)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int ts_x_origin, ts_y_origin;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

ts_x_origin
ts_y_origin
Specify the x and y coordinates of the tile and
stipple origin. │__

When graphics requests call for tiling or stippling, the parent’s origin will be interpreted relative to whatever destination drawable is specified in the graphics request.

XSetTSOrigin can generate BadAlloc and BadGC errors.

7.2.5. Setting the Current Font

To set the current font of a given GC, use XSetFont. __ │

XSetFont(display, gc, font)
Display *display;
GC gc;
Font font;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

font

Specifies the font. │__

XSetFont can generate BadAlloc, BadFont, and BadGC errors.

7.2.6. Setting the Clip Region

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set the clip-origin and the clip-mask or set the clip-mask to a list of rectangles.

To set the clip-origin of a given GC, use XSetClipOrigin. __ │

XSetClipOrigin(display, gc, clip_x_origin, clip_y_origin)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int clip_x_origin, clip_y_origin;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

clip_x_origin
clip_y_origin

Specify the x and y coordinates of the clip-mask
origin. │__

The clip-mask origin is interpreted relative to the origin of whatever destination drawable is specified in the graphics request.

XSetClipOrigin can generate BadAlloc and BadGC errors.

To set the clip-mask of a given GC to the specified pixmap, use XSetClipMask. __ │

XSetClipMask(display, gc, pixmap)
Display *display;
GC gc;
Pixmap pixmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

pixmap

Specifies the pixmap or None. │__

If the clip-mask is set to None, the pixels are always drawn (regardless of the clip-origin).

XSetClipMask can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadPixmap errors.

To set the clip-mask of a given GC to the specified list of rectangles, use XSetClipRectangles. __ │

XSetClipRectangles(display, gc, clip_x_origin, clip_y_origin, rectangles, n, ordering)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int clip_x_origin, clip_y_origin;
XRectangle rectangles[];
int n;
int ordering;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

clip_x_origin
clip_y_origin

Specify the x and y coordinates of the clip-mask
origin.

rectanglesSpecifies an array of rectangles that define the
clip-mask.

n

Specifies the number of rectangles.

ordering

Specifies the ordering relations on the rectan-

gles. You can pass Unsorted, YSorted, YXSorted,
or YXBanded. │__

The XSetClipRectangles function changes the clip-mask in the specified GC to the specified list of rectangles and sets the clip origin. The output is clipped to remain contained within the rectangles. The clip-origin is interpreted relative to the origin of whatever destination drawable is specified in a graphics request. The rectangle coordinates are interpreted relative to the clip-origin. The rectangles should be nonintersecting, or the graphics results will be undefined. Note that the list of rectangles can be empty, which effectively disables output. This is the opposite of passing None as the clip-mask in XCreateGC, XChangeGC, and XSetClipMask.

If known by the client, ordering relations on the rectangles can be specified with the ordering argument. This may provide faster operation by the server. If an incorrect ordering is specified, the X server may generate a BadMatch error, but it is not required to do so. If no error is generated, the graphics results are undefined. Unsorted means the rectangles are in arbitrary order. YSorted means that the rectangles are nondecreasing in their Y origin. YXSorted additionally constrains YSorted order in that all rectangles with an equal Y origin are nondecreasing in their X origin. YXBanded additionally constrains YXSorted by requiring that, for every possible Y scanline, all rectangles that include that scanline have an identical Y origins and Y extents.

XSetClipRectangles can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

Xlib provides a set of basic functions for performing region arithmetic. For information about these functions, see section 16.5.

7.2.7. Setting the Arc Mode, Subwindow Mode, and Graphics Exposure

To set the arc mode of a given GC, use XSetArcMode. __ │

XSetArcMode(display, gc, arc_mode)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int arc_mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

arc_mode

Specifies the arc mode. You can pass ArcChord or

ArcPieSlice. │__

XSetArcMode can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To set the subwindow mode of a given GC, use XSetSubwindowMode. __ │

XSetSubwindowMode(display, gc, subwindow_mode)
Display *display;
GC gc;
int subwindow_mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

subwindow_mode
Specifies the subwindow mode. You can pass Clip-
ByChildren
or IncludeInferiors. │__

XSetSubwindowMode can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To set the graphics-exposures flag of a given GC, use XSetGraphicsExposures. __ │

XSetGraphicsExposures(display, gc, graphics_exposures)
Display *display;
GC gc;
Bool graphics_exposures;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

graphics_exposures
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
you want GraphicsExpose and NoExpose events to be
reported when calling XCopyArea and XCopyPlane
with this GC. │__

XSetGraphicsExposures can generate BadAlloc, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

7

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 8

Graphics Functions

Once you have established a connection to a display, you can use the Xlib graphics functions to:

Clear and copy areas

Draw points, lines, rectangles, and arcs

Fill areas

Manipulate fonts

Draw text

Transfer images between clients and the server

If the same drawable and GC is used for each call, Xlib batches back-to-back calls to XDrawPoint, XDrawLine, XDrawRectangle, XFillArc, and XFillRectangle. Note that this reduces the total number of requests sent to the server.

8.1. Clearing Areas

Xlib provides functions that you can use to clear an area or the entire window. Because pixmaps do not have defined backgrounds, they cannot be filled by using the functions described in this section. Instead, to accomplish an analogous operation on a pixmap, you should use XFillRectangle, which sets the pixmap to a known value.

To clear a rectangular area of a given window, use XClearArea. __ │

XClearArea(display, w, x, y, width, height, exposures)
Display *display;
Window w;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
Bool exposures;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the window and specify the
upper-left corner of the rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the dimen-

sions of the rectangle.

exposures

Specifies a Boolean value that indicates if Expose

events are to be generated. │__

The XClearArea function paints a rectangular area in the specified window according to the specified dimensions with the window’s background pixel or pixmap. The subwindow-mode effectively is ClipByChildren. If width is zero, it is replaced with the current width of the window minus x. If height is zero, it is replaced with the current height of the window minus y. If the window has a defined background tile, the rectangle clipped by any children is filled with this tile. If the window has background None, the contents of the window are not changed. In either case, if exposures is True, one or more Expose events are generated for regions of the rectangle that are either visible or are being retained in a backing store. If you specify a window whose class is InputOnly, a BadMatch error results.

XClearArea can generate BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To clear the entire area in a given window, use XClearWindow. __ │

XClearWindow(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XClearWindow function clears the entire area in the specified window and is equivalent to XClearArea (display, w, 0, 0, 0, 0, False). If the window has a defined background tile, the rectangle is tiled with a plane-mask of all ones and GXcopy function. If the window has background None, the contents of the window are not changed. If you specify a window whose class is InputOnly, a BadMatch error results.

XClearWindow can generate BadMatch and BadWindow errors.

8.2. Copying Areas

Xlib provides functions that you can use to copy an area or a bit plane.

To copy an area between drawables of the same root and depth, use XCopyArea. __ │

XCopyArea(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, dest_y)
Display *display;
Drawable src, dest;
GC gc;
int src_x, src_y;
unsigned int width, height;
int dest_x, dest_y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

src

dest

Specify the source and destination rectangles to

be combined.

gc

Specifies the GC.

src_x

src_y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the source rectangle and
specify its upper-left corner.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the dimen-

sions of both the source and destination rectan-
gles.

dest_x

dest_y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the destination rectangle
and specify its upper-left corner. │__

The XCopyArea function combines the specified rectangle of src with the specified rectangle of dest. The drawables must have the same root and depth, or a BadMatch error results.

If regions of the source rectangle are obscured and have not been retained in backing store or if regions outside the boundaries of the source drawable are specified, those regions are not copied. Instead, the following occurs on all corresponding destination regions that are either visible or are retained in backing store. If the destination is a window with a background other than None, corresponding regions of the destination are tiled with that background (with plane-mask of all ones and GXcopy function). Regardless of tiling or whether the destination is a window or a pixmap, if graphics-exposures is True, then GraphicsExpose events for all corresponding destination regions are generated. If graphics-exposures is True but no GraphicsExpose events are generated, a NoExpose event is generated. Note that by default graphics-exposures is True in new GCs.

This function uses these GC components: function, plane-mask, subwindow-mode, graphics-exposures, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask.

XCopyArea can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

To copy a single bit plane of a given drawable, use XCopyPlane. __ │

XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, dest_y, plane)
Display *display;
Drawable src, dest;
GC gc;
int src_x, src_y;
unsigned int width, height;
int dest_x, dest_y;
unsigned long plane;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

src

dest

Specify the source and destination rectangles to

be combined.

gc

Specifies the GC.

src_x

src_y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the source rectangle and
specify its upper-left corner.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the dimen-

sions of both the source and destination rectan-
gles.

dest_x

dest_y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the destination rectangle
and specify its upper-left corner.

plane

Specifies the bit plane. You must set exactly one

bit to 1. │__

The XCopyPlane function uses a single bit plane of the specified source rectangle combined with the specified GC to modify the specified rectangle of dest. The drawables must have the same root but need not have the same depth. If the drawables do not have the same root, a BadMatch error results. If plane does not have exactly one bit set to 1 and the value of plane is not less than Image grohtml-19291-14.png , where n is the depth of src, a BadValue error results.

Effectively, XCopyPlane forms a pixmap of the same depth as the rectangle of dest and with a size specified by the source region. It uses the foreground/background pixels in the GC (foreground everywhere the bit plane in src contains a bit set to 1, background everywhere the bit plane in src contains a bit set to 0) and the equivalent of a CopyArea protocol request is performed with all the same exposure semantics. This can also be thought of as using the specified region of the source bit plane as a stipple with a fill-style of FillOpaqueStippled for filling a rectangular area of the destination.

This function uses these GC components: function, plane-mask, foreground, background, subwindow-mode, graphics-exposures, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask.

XCopyPlane can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

8.3. Drawing Points, Lines, Rectangles, and Arcs

Xlib provides functions that you can use to draw:

A single point or multiple points

A single line or multiple lines

A single rectangle or multiple rectangles

A single arc or multiple arcs

Some of the functions described in the following sections use these structures: __ │

typedef struct {

short x1, y1, x2, y2;

} XSegment; │__ __ │

typedef struct {

short x, y;

} XPoint; │__ __ │

typedef struct {

short x, y;

unsigned short width, height;

} XRectangle; │__ __ │

typedef struct {

short x, y;

unsigned short width, height;

short angle1, angle2; /* Degrees * 64 */

} XArc; │__

All x and y members are signed integers. The width and height members are 16-bit unsigned integers. You should be careful not to generate coordinates and sizes out of the 16-bit ranges, because the protocol only has 16-bit fields for these values.

8.3.1. Drawing Single and Multiple Points

To draw a single point in a given drawable, use XDrawPoint. __ │

XDrawPoint(display, d, gc, x, y)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates where you want the

point drawn. │__

To draw multiple points in a given drawable, use XDrawPoints. __ │

XDrawPoints(display, d, gc, points, npoints, mode)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XPoint *points;
int npoints;
int mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

points

Specifies an array of points.

npoints

Specifies the number of points in the array.

mode

Specifies the coordinate mode. You can pass Co-

ordModeOrigin or CoordModePrevious. │__

The XDrawPoint function uses the foreground pixel and function components of the GC to draw a single point into the specified drawable; XDrawPoints draws multiple points this way. CoordModeOrigin treats all coordinates as relative to the origin, and CoordModePrevious treats all coordinates after the first as relative to the previous point. XDrawPoints draws the points in the order listed in the array.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, foreground, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask.

XDrawPoint can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors. XDrawPoints can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

8.3.2. Drawing Single and Multiple Lines

To draw a single line between two points in a given drawable, use XDrawLine. __ │

XDrawLine(display, d, gc, x1, y1, x2, y2)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x1, y1, x2, y2;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x1

y1

x2

y2

Specify the points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) to be

connected. │__

To draw multiple lines in a given drawable, use XDrawLines. __ │

XDrawLines(display, d, gc, points, npoints, mode)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XPoint *points;
int npoints;
int mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

points

Specifies an array of points.

npoints

Specifies the number of points in the array.

mode

Specifies the coordinate mode. You can pass Co-

ordModeOrigin or CoordModePrevious. │__

To draw multiple, unconnected lines in a given drawable, use XDrawSegments. __ │

XDrawSegments(display, d, gc, segments, nsegments)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XSegment *segments;
int nsegments;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

segments

Specifies an array of segments.

nsegments

Specifies the number of segments in the array. │__

The XDrawLine function uses the components of the specified GC to draw a line between the specified set of points (x1, y1) and (x2, y2). It does not perform joining at coincident endpoints. For any given line, XDrawLine does not draw a pixel more than once. If lines intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times.

The XDrawLines function uses the components of the specified GC to draw npoints−1 lines between each pair of points (point[i], point[i+1]) in the array of XPoint structures. It draws the lines in the order listed in the array. The lines join correctly at all intermediate points, and if the first and last points coincide, the first and last lines also join correctly. For any given line, XDrawLines does not draw a pixel more than once. If thin (zero line-width) lines intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times. If wide lines intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn only once, as though the entire PolyLine protocol request were a single, filled shape. CoordModeOrigin treats all coordinates as relative to the origin, and CoordModePrevious treats all coordinates after the first as relative to the previous point.

The XDrawSegments function draws multiple, unconnected lines. For each segment, XDrawSegments draws a line between (x1, y1) and (x2, y2). It draws the lines in the order listed in the array of XSegment structures and does not perform joining at coincident endpoints. For any given line, XDrawSegments does not draw a pixel more than once. If lines intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times.

All three functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, line-width, line-style, cap-style, fill-style, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. The XDrawLines function also uses the join-style GC component. All three functions also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, tile-stipple-y-origin, dash-offset, and dash-list.

XDrawLine, XDrawLines, and XDrawSegments can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors. XDrawLines also can generate BadValue errors.

8.3.3. Drawing Single and Multiple Rectangles

To draw the outline of a single rectangle in a given drawable, use XDrawRectangle. __ │

XDrawRectangle(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which specify the

upper-left corner of the rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which specify the

dimensions of the rectangle. │__

To draw the outline of multiple rectangles in a given drawable, use XDrawRectangles. __ │

XDrawRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XRectangle rectangles[];
int nrectangles;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

rectanglesSpecifies an array of rectangles.

nrectanglesSpecifies the number of rectangles in the array. │__

The XDrawRectangle and XDrawRectangles functions draw the outlines of the specified rectangle or rectangles as if a five-point PolyLine protocol request were specified for each rectangle:

[x,y] [x+width,y] [x+width,y+height] [x,y+height] [x,y]

For the specified rectangle or rectangles, these functions do not draw a pixel more than once. XDrawRectangles draws the rectangles in the order listed in the array. If rectangles intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, line-width, line-style, cap-style, join-style, fill-style, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. They also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, tile-stipple-y-origin, dash-offset, and dash-list.

XDrawRectangle and XDrawRectangles can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.3.4. Drawing Single and Multiple Arcs

To draw a single arc in a given drawable, use XDrawArc. __ │

XDrawArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, angle1, angle2)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
int angle1, angle2;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the drawable and specify the
upper-left corner of the bounding rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the major

and minor axes of the arc.

angle1

Specifies the start of the arc relative to the

three-o’clock position from the center, in units
of degrees * 64.

angle2

Specifies the path and extent of the arc relative

to the start of the arc, in units of degrees * 64. │__

To draw multiple arcs in a given drawable, use XDrawArcs. __ │

XDrawArcs(display, d, gc, arcs, narcs)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XArc *arcs;
int narcs;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

arcs

Specifies an array of arcs.

narcs

Specifies the number of arcs in the array. │__

XDrawArc draws a single circular or elliptical arc, and XDrawArcs draws multiple circular or elliptical arcs. Each arc is specified by a rectangle and two angles. The center of the circle or ellipse is the center of the rectangle, and the major and minor axes are specified by the width and height. Positive angles indicate counterclockwise motion, and negative angles indicate clockwise motion. If the magnitude of angle2 is greater than 360 degrees, XDrawArc or XDrawArcs truncates it to 360 degrees.

For an arc specified as Image grohtml-19291-15.png , the origin of the major and minor axes is at Image grohtml-19291-16.png , and the infinitely thin path describing the entire circle or ellipse intersects the horizontal axis at Image grohtml-19291-17.png and Image grohtml-19291-18.png and intersects the vertical axis at Image grohtml-19291-19.png and Image grohtml-19291-20.png . These coordinates can be fractional and so are not truncated to discrete coordinates. The path should be defined by the ideal mathematical path. For a wide line with line-width lw, the bounding outlines for filling are given by the two infinitely thin paths consisting of all points whose perpendicular distance from the path of the circle/ellipse is equal to lw/2 (which may be a fractional value). The cap-style and join-style are applied the same as for a line corresponding to the tangent of the circle/ellipse at the endpoint.

For an arc specified as Image grohtml-19291-21.png , the angles must be specified in the effectively skewed coordinate system of the ellipse (for a circle, the angles and coordinate systems are identical). The relationship between these angles and angles expressed in the normal coordinate system of the screen (as measured with a protractor) is as follows:

Image grohtml-19291-22.png

The skewed-angle and normal-angle are expressed in radians (rather than in degrees scaled by 64) in the range Image grohtml-19291-23.png and where atan returns a value in the range Image grohtml-19291-24.png and adjust is:

Image grohtml-19291-25.png for normal-angle in the range Image grohtml-19291-26.png

Image grohtml-19291-27.png

for normal-angle in the range Image grohtml-19291-28.png
Image grohtml-19291-29.png

for normal-angle in the range

Image grohtml-19291-30.png

For any given arc, XDrawArc and XDrawArcs do not draw a pixel more than once. If two arcs join correctly and if the line-width is greater than zero and the arcs intersect, XDrawArc and XDrawArcs do not draw a pixel more than once. Otherwise, the intersecting pixels of intersecting arcs are drawn multiple times. Specifying an arc with one endpoint and a clockwise extent draws the same pixels as specifying the other endpoint and an equivalent counterclockwise extent, except as it affects joins.

If the last point in one arc coincides with the first point in the following arc, the two arcs will join correctly. If the first point in the first arc coincides with the last point in the last arc, the two arcs will join correctly. By specifying one axis to be zero, a horizontal or vertical line can be drawn. Angles are computed based solely on the coordinate system and ignore the aspect ratio.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, line-width, line-style, cap-style, join-style, fill-style, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. They also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, tile-stipple-y-origin, dash-offset, and dash-list.

XDrawArc and XDrawArcs can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.4. Filling Areas

Xlib provides functions that you can use to fill:

A single rectangle or multiple rectangles

A single polygon

A single arc or multiple arcs

8.4.1. Filling Single and Multiple Rectangles

To fill a single rectangular area in a given drawable, use XFillRectangle. __ │

XFillRectangle(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the drawable and specify the
upper-left corner of the rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the dimen-

sions of the rectangle to be filled. │__

To fill multiple rectangular areas in a given drawable, use XFillRectangles. __ │

XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XRectangle *rectangles;
int nrectangles;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

rectanglesSpecifies an array of rectangles.

nrectanglesSpecifies the number of rectangles in the array. │__

The XFillRectangle and XFillRectangles functions fill the specified rectangle or rectangles as if a four-point FillPolygon protocol request were specified for each rectangle:

[x,y] [x+width,y] [x+width,y+height] [x,y+height]

Each function uses the x and y coordinates, width and height dimensions, and GC you specify.

XFillRectangles fills the rectangles in the order listed in the array. For any given rectangle, XFillRectangle and XFillRectangles do not draw a pixel more than once. If rectangles intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, fill-style, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. They also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, and tile-stipple-y-origin.

XFillRectangle and XFillRectangles can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.4.2. Filling a Single Polygon

To fill a polygon area in a given drawable, use XFillPolygon. __ │

XFillPolygon(display, d, gc, points, npoints, shape, mode)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XPoint *points;
int npoints;
int shape;
int mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

points

Specifies an array of points.

npoints

Specifies the number of points in the array.

shape

Specifies a shape that helps the server to improve

performance. You can pass Complex, Convex, or
Nonconvex
.

mode

Specifies the coordinate mode. You can pass Co-

ordModeOrigin or CoordModePrevious. │__

XFillPolygon fills the region closed by the specified path. The path is closed automatically if the last point in the list does not coincide with the first point. XFillPolygon does not draw a pixel of the region more than once. CoordModeOrigin treats all coordinates as relative to the origin, and CoordModePrevious treats all coordinates after the first as relative to the previous point.

Depending on the specified shape, the following occurs:

If shape is Complex, the path may self-intersect. Note that contiguous coincident points in the path are not treated as self-intersection.

If shape is Convex, for every pair of points inside the polygon, the line segment connecting them does not intersect the path. If known by the client, specifying Convex can improve performance. If you specify Convex for a path that is not convex, the graphics results are undefined.

If shape is Nonconvex, the path does not self-intersect, but the shape is not wholly convex. If known by the client, specifying Nonconvex instead of Complex may improve performance. If you specify Nonconvex for a self-intersecting path, the graphics results are undefined.

The fill-rule of the GC controls the filling behavior of self-intersecting polygons.

This function uses these GC components: function, plane-mask, fill-style, fill-rule, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. It also uses these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, and tile-stipple-y-origin.

XFillPolygon can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

8.4.3. Filling Single and Multiple Arcs

To fill a single arc in a given drawable, use XFillArc. __ │

XFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, angle1, angle2)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
int angle1, angle2;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the drawable and specify the
upper-left corner of the bounding rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which are the major

and minor axes of the arc.

angle1

Specifies the start of the arc relative to the

three-o’clock position from the center, in units
of degrees * 64.

angle2

Specifies the path and extent of the arc relative

to the start of the arc, in units of degrees * 64. │__

To fill multiple arcs in a given drawable, use XFillArcs. __ │

XFillArcs(display, d, gc, arcs, narcs)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XArc *arcs;
int narcs;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

arcs

Specifies an array of arcs.

narcs

Specifies the number of arcs in the array. │__

For each arc, XFillArc or XFillArcs fills the region closed by the infinitely thin path described by the specified arc and, depending on the arc-mode specified in the GC, one or two line segments. For ArcChord, the single line segment joining the endpoints of the arc is used. For ArcPieSlice, the two line segments joining the endpoints of the arc with the center point are used. XFillArcs fills the arcs in the order listed in the array. For any given arc, XFillArc and XFillArcs do not draw a pixel more than once. If regions intersect, the intersecting pixels are drawn multiple times.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, fill-style, arc-mode, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. They also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, and tile-stipple-y-origin.

XFillArc and XFillArcs can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.5. Font Metrics

A font is a graphical description of a set of characters that are used to increase efficiency whenever a set of small, similar sized patterns are repeatedly used.

This section discusses how to:

Load and free fonts

Obtain and free font names

Compute character string sizes

Compute logical extents

Query character string sizes

The X server loads fonts whenever a program requests a new font. The server can cache fonts for quick lookup. Fonts are global across all screens in a server. Several levels are possible when dealing with fonts. Most applications simply use XLoadQueryFont to load a font and query the font metrics.

Characters in fonts are regarded as masks. Except for image text requests, the only pixels modified are those in which bits are set to 1 in the character. This means that it makes sense to draw text using stipples or tiles (for example, many menus gray-out unusable entries). __ │
The XFontStruct structure contains all of the information
for the font and consists of the font-specific information
as well as a pointer to an array of XCharStruct structures
for the characters contained in the font. The XFontStruct,
XFontProp
, and XCharStruct structures contain:

typedef struct {

short lbearing;

/* origin to left edge of raster */

short rbearing;

/* origin to right edge of raster */

short width;

/* advance to next char’s origin */

short ascent;

/* baseline to top edge of raster */

short descent;

/* baseline to bottom edge of raster */

unsigned short attributes;/* per char flags (not predefined) */

} XCharStruct;

typedef struct {

Atom

name;

unsigned long card32;

} XFontProp;

typedef struct {

/* normal 16 bit characters are two bytes */

unsigned char byte1;
unsigned char byte2;
} XChar2b;

typedef struct {

XExtData *ext_data;

/* hook for extension to hang data */

Font fid;

/* Font id for this font */

unsigned direction;

/* hint about the direction font is painted */

unsigned min_char_or_byte2;/* first character */

unsigned max_char_or_byte2;/* last character */

unsigned min_byte1;

/* first row that exists */

unsigned max_byte1;

/* last row that exists */

Bool all_chars_exist;

/* flag if all characters have nonzero size */

unsigned default_char;

/* char to print for undefined character */

int n_properties;

/* how many properties there are */

XFontProp *properties;

/* pointer to array of additional properties */

XCharStruct min_bounds;

/* minimum bounds over all existing char */

XCharStruct max_bounds;

/* maximum bounds over all existing char */

XCharStruct *per_char;

/* first_char to last_char information */

int ascent;

/* logical extent above baseline for spacing */

int descent;

/* logical descent below baseline for spacing */

} XFontStruct; │__

X supports single byte/character, two bytes/character matrix, and 16-bit character text operations. Note that any of these forms can be used with a font, but a single byte/character text request can only specify a single byte (that is, the first row of a 2-byte font). You should view 2-byte fonts as a two-dimensional matrix of defined characters: byte1 specifies the range of defined rows and byte2 defines the range of defined columns of the font. Single byte/character fonts have one row defined, and the byte2 range specified in the structure defines a range of characters.

The bounding box of a character is defined by the XCharStruct of that character. When characters are absent from a font, the default_char is used. When fonts have all characters of the same size, only the information in the XFontStruct min and max bounds are used.

The members of the XFontStruct have the following semantics:

The direction member can be either FontLeftToRight or FontRightToLeft. It is just a hint as to whether most XCharStruct elements have a positive (FontLeftToRight) or a negative (FontRightToLeft) character width metric. The core protocol defines no support for vertical text.

If the min_byte1 and max_byte1 members are both zero, min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index corresponding to the first element of the per_char array, and max_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index of the last element.

If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:

byte1 = N/D + min_byte1

byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2

where:

D = max_char_or_byte2 − min_char_or_byte2 + 1
/ = integer division
\ = integer modulus

If the per_char pointer is NULL, all glyphs between the first and last character indexes inclusive have the same information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds.

If all_chars_exist is True, all characters in the per_char array have nonzero bounding boxes.

The default_char member specifies the character that will be used when an undefined or nonexistent character is printed. The default_char is a 16-bit character (not a 2-byte character). For a font using 2-byte matrix format, the default_char has byte1 in the most-significant byte and byte2 in the least significant byte. If the default_char itself specifies an undefined or nonexistent character, no printing is performed for an undefined or nonexistent character.

The min_bounds and max_bounds members contain the most extreme values of each individual XCharStruct component over all elements of this array (and ignore nonexistent characters). The bounding box of the font (the smallest rectangle enclosing the shape obtained by superimposing all of the characters at the same origin [x,y]) has its upper-left coordinate at:

[x + min_bounds.lbearing, y − max_bounds.ascent]

Its width is:

max_bounds.rbearing − min_bounds.lbearing

Its height is:

max_bounds.ascent + max_bounds.descent

The ascent member is the logical extent of the font above the baseline that is used for determining line spacing. Specific characters may extend beyond this.

The descent member is the logical extent of the font at or below the baseline that is used for determining line spacing. Specific characters may extend beyond this.

If the baseline is at Y-coordinate y, the logical extent of the font is inclusive between the Y-coordinate values (y − font.ascent) and (y + font.descent − 1). Typically, the minimum interline spacing between rows of text is given by ascent + descent.

For a character origin at [x,y], the bounding box of a character (that is, the smallest rectangle that encloses the character’s shape) described in terms of XCharStruct components is a rectangle with its upper-left corner at:

[x + lbearing, y − ascent]

Its width is:

rbearing − lbearing

Its height is:

ascent + descent

The origin for the next character is defined to be:

[x + width, y]

The lbearing member defines the extent of the left edge of the character ink from the origin. The rbearing member defines the extent of the right edge of the character ink from the origin. The ascent member defines the extent of the top edge of the character ink from the origin. The descent member defines the extent of the bottom edge of the character ink from the origin. The width member defines the logical width of the character.

Note that the baseline (the y position of the character origin) is logically viewed as being the scanline just below nondescending characters. When descent is zero, only pixels with Y-coordinates less than y are drawn, and the origin is logically viewed as being coincident with the left edge of a nonkerned character. When lbearing is zero, no pixels with X-coordinate less than x are drawn. Any of the XCharStruct metric members could be negative. If the width is negative, the next character will be placed to the left of the current origin.

The X protocol does not define the interpretation of the attributes member in the XCharStruct structure. A nonexistent character is represented with all members of its XCharStruct set to zero.

A font is not guaranteed to have any properties. The interpretation of the property value (for example, long or unsigned long) must be derived from a priori knowledge of the property. A basic set of font properties is specified in the X Consortium standard X Logical Font Description Conventions.

8.5.1. Loading and Freeing Fonts

Xlib provides functions that you can use to load fonts, get font information, unload fonts, and free font information. A few font functions use a GContext resource ID or a font ID interchangeably.

To load a given font, use XLoadFont. __ │

Font XLoadFont(display, name)
Display *display;
char *name;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

name

Specifies the name of the font, which is a

null-terminated string. │__

The XLoadFont function loads the specified font and returns its associated font ID. If the font name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. When the characters ‘‘?’’ and ‘‘*’’ are used in a font name, a pattern match is performed and any matching font is used. In the pattern, the ‘‘?’’ character will match any single character, and the ‘‘*’’ character will match any number of characters. A structured format for font names is specified in the X Consortium standard X Logical Font Description Conventions. If XLoadFont was unsuccessful at loading the specified font, a BadName error results. Fonts are not associated with a particular screen and can be stored as a component of any GC. When the font is no longer needed, call XUnloadFont.

XLoadFont can generate BadAlloc and BadName errors.

To return information about an available font, use XQueryFont. __ │

XFontStruct *XQueryFont(display, font_ID)
Display *display;
XID font_ID;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

font_ID

Specifies the font ID or the GContext ID. │__

The XQueryFont function returns a pointer to the XFontStruct structure, which contains information associated with the font. You can query a font or the font stored in a GC. The font ID stored in the XFontStruct structure will be the GContext ID, and you need to be careful when using this ID in other functions (see XGContextFromGC). If the font does not exist, XQueryFont returns NULL. To free this data, use XFreeFontInfo.

To perform a XLoadFont and XQueryFont in a single operation, use XLoadQueryFont. __ │

XFontStruct *XLoadQueryFont(display, name)
Display *display;
char *name;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

name

Specifies the name of the font, which is a

null-terminated string. │__

The XLoadQueryFont function provides the most common way for accessing a font. XLoadQueryFont both opens (loads) the specified font and returns a pointer to the appropriate XFontStruct structure. If the font name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. If the font does not exist, XLoadQueryFont returns NULL.

XLoadQueryFont can generate a BadAlloc error.

To unload the font and free the storage used by the font structure that was allocated by XQueryFont or XLoadQueryFont, use XFreeFont. __ │

XFreeFont(display, font_struct)
Display *display;
XFontStruct *font_struct;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

font_structSpecifies the storage associated with the font. │__

The XFreeFont function deletes the association between the font resource ID and the specified font and frees the XFontStruct structure. The font itself will be freed when no other resource references it. The data and the font should not be referenced again.

XFreeFont can generate a BadFont error.

To return a given font property, use XGetFontProperty. __ │

Bool XGetFontProperty(font_struct, atom, value_return)
XFontStruct *font_struct;
Atom atom;
unsigned long *value_return;

font_structSpecifies the storage associated with the font.

atom

Specifies the atom for the property name you want

returned.

value_return
Returns the value of the font property. │__

Given the atom for that property, the XGetFontProperty function returns the value of the specified font property. XGetFontProperty also returns False if the property was not defined or True if it was defined. A set of predefined atoms exists for font properties, which can be found in <X11/Xatom.h>. This set contains the standard properties associated with a font. Although it is not guaranteed, it is likely that the predefined font properties will be present.

To unload a font that was loaded by XLoadFont, use XUnloadFont. __ │

XUnloadFont(display, font)
Display *display;
Font font;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

font

Specifies the font. │__

The XUnloadFont function deletes the association between the font resource ID and the specified font. The font itself will be freed when no other resource references it. The font should not be referenced again.

XUnloadFont can generate a BadFont error.

8.5.2. Obtaining and Freeing Font Names and Information

You obtain font names and information by matching a wildcard specification when querying a font type for a list of available sizes and so on.

To return a list of the available font names, use XListFonts. __ │

char **XListFonts(display, pattern, maxnames, actual_count_return)
Display *display;
char *pattern;
int maxnames;
int *actual_count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

pattern

Specifies the null-terminated pattern string that

can contain wildcard characters.

maxnames

Specifies the maximum number of names to be re-

turned.

actual_count_return
Returns the actual number of font names. │__

The XListFonts function returns an array of available font names (as controlled by the font search path; see XSetFontPath) that match the string you passed to the pattern argument. The pattern string can contain any characters, but each asterisk (*) is a wildcard for any number of characters, and each question mark (?) is a wildcard for a single character. If the pattern string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. Each returned string is null-terminated. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned strings are in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. If there are no matching font names, XListFonts returns NULL. The client should call XFreeFontNames when finished with the result to free the memory.

To free a font name array, use XFreeFontNames. __ │

XFreeFontNames(list)
char *list[];

list

Specifies the array of strings you want to free. │__

The XFreeFontNames function frees the array and strings returned by XListFonts or XListFontsWithInfo.

To obtain the names and information about available fonts, use XListFontsWithInfo. __ │

char **XListFontsWithInfo(display, pattern, maxnames, count_return, info_return)
Display *display;
char *pattern;
int maxnames;
int *count_return;
XFontStruct **info_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

pattern

Specifies the null-terminated pattern string that

can contain wildcard characters.

maxnames

Specifies the maximum number of names to be re-

turned.

count_return
Returns the actual number of matched font names.

info_returnReturns the font information. │__

The XListFontsWithInfo function returns a list of font names that match the specified pattern and their associated font information. The list of names is limited to size specified by maxnames. The information returned for each font is identical to what XLoadQueryFont would return except that the per-character metrics are not returned. The pattern string can contain any characters, but each asterisk (*) is a wildcard for any number of characters, and each question mark (?) is a wildcard for a single character. If the pattern string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Use of uppercase or lowercase does not matter. Each returned string is null-terminated. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned strings are in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. If there are no matching font names, XListFontsWithInfo returns NULL.

To free only the allocated name array, the client should call XFreeFontNames. To free both the name array and the font information array or to free just the font information array, the client should call XFreeFontInfo.

To free font structures and font names, use XFreeFontInfo. __ │

XFreeFontInfo(names, free_info, actual_count)
char **names;
XFontStruct *free_info;
int actual_count;

names

Specifies the list of font names.

free_info

Specifies the font information.

actual_count
Specifies the actual number of font names. │__

The XFreeFontInfo function frees a font structure or an array of font structures and optionally an array of font names. If NULL is passed for names, no font names are freed. If a font structure for an open font (returned by XLoadQueryFont) is passed, the structure is freed, but the font is not closed; use XUnloadFont to close the font.

8.5.3. Computing Character String Sizes

Xlib provides functions that you can use to compute the width, the logical extents, and the server information about 8-bit and 2-byte text strings. The width is computed by adding the character widths of all the characters. It does not matter if the font is an 8-bit or 2-byte font. These functions return the sum of the character metrics in pixels.

To determine the width of an 8-bit character string, use XTextWidth. __ │

int XTextWidth(font_struct, string, count)
XFontStruct *font_struct;
char *string;
int count;

font_structSpecifies the font used for the width computa-
tion.

string

Specifies the character string.

count

Specifies the character count in the specified

string. │__

To determine the width of a 2-byte character string, use XTextWidth16. __ │

int XTextWidth16(font_struct, string, count)
XFontStruct *font_struct;
XChar2b *string;
int count;

font_structSpecifies the font used for the width computa-
tion.

string

Specifies the character string.

count

Specifies the character count in the specified

string. │__

8.5.4. Computing Logical Extents

To compute the bounding box of an 8-bit character string in a given font, use XTextExtents. __ │

XTextExtents(font_struct, string, nchars, direction_return, font_ascent_return,
font_descent_return
, overall_return)
XFontStruct *font_struct;
char *string;
int nchars;
int *direction_return;
int *font_ascent_return, *font_descent_return;
XCharStruct *overall_return;

font_structSpecifies the XFontStruct structure.

string

Specifies the character string.

nchars

Specifies the number of characters in the charac-

ter string.

direction_return
Returns the value of the direction hint (FontLeft-
ToRight
or FontRightToLeft).

font_ascent_return
Returns the font ascent.

font_descent_return
Returns the font descent.

overall_return
Returns the overall size in the specified
XCharStruct
structure. │__

To compute the bounding box of a 2-byte character string in a given font, use XTextExtents16. __ │

XTextExtents16(font_struct, string, nchars, direction_return, font_ascent_return,
font_descent_return
, overall_return)
XFontStruct *font_struct;
XChar2b *string;
int nchars;
int *direction_return;
int *font_ascent_return, *font_descent_return;
XCharStruct *overall_return;

font_structSpecifies the XFontStruct structure.

string

Specifies the character string.

nchars

Specifies the number of characters in the charac-

ter string.

direction_return
Returns the value of the direction hint (FontLeft-
ToRight
or FontRightToLeft).

font_ascent_return
Returns the font ascent.

font_descent_return
Returns the font descent.

overall_return
Returns the overall size in the specified
XCharStruct
structure. │__

The XTextExtents and XTextExtents16 functions perform the size computation locally and, thereby, avoid the round-trip overhead of XQueryTextExtents and XQueryTextExtents16. Both functions return an XCharStruct structure, whose members are set to the values as follows.

The ascent member is set to the maximum of the ascent metrics of all characters in the string. The descent member is set to the maximum of the descent metrics. The width member is set to the sum of the character-width metrics of all characters in the string. For each character in the string, let W be the sum of the character-width metrics of all characters preceding it in the string. Let L be the left-side-bearing metric of the character plus W. Let R be the right-side-bearing metric of the character plus W. The lbearing member is set to the minimum L of all characters in the string. The rbearing member is set to the maximum R.

For fonts defined with linear indexing rather than 2-byte matrix indexing, each XChar2b structure is interpreted as a 16-bit number with byte1 as the most significant byte. If the font has no defined default character, undefined characters in the string are taken to have all zero metrics.

8.5.5. Querying Character String Sizes

To query the server for the bounding box of an 8-bit character string in a given font, use XQueryTextExtents. __ │

XQueryTextExtents(display, font_ID, string, nchars, direction_return, font_ascent_return,
font_descent_return
, overall_return)
Display *display;
XID font_ID;
char *string;
int nchars;
int *direction_return;
int *font_ascent_return, *font_descent_return;
XCharStruct *overall_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

font_ID

Specifies either the font ID or the GContext ID

that contains the font.

string

Specifies the character string.

nchars

Specifies the number of characters in the charac-

ter string.

direction_return
Returns the value of the direction hint (FontLeft-
ToRight
or FontRightToLeft).

font_ascent_return
Returns the font ascent.

font_descent_return
Returns the font descent.

overall_return
Returns the overall size in the specified
XCharStruct
structure. │__

To query the server for the bounding box of a 2-byte character string in a given font, use XQueryTextExtents16. __ │

XQueryTextExtents16(display, font_ID, string, nchars, direction_return, font_ascent_return,
font_descent_return
, overall_return)
Display *display;
XID font_ID;
XChar2b *string;
int nchars;
int *direction_return;
int *font_ascent_return, *font_descent_return;
XCharStruct *overall_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

font_ID

Specifies either the font ID or the GContext ID

that contains the font.

string

Specifies the character string.

nchars

Specifies the number of characters in the charac-

ter string.

direction_return
Returns the value of the direction hint (FontLeft-
ToRight
or FontRightToLeft).

font_ascent_return
Returns the font ascent.

font_descent_return
Returns the font descent.

overall_return
Returns the overall size in the specified
XCharStruct
structure. │__

The XQueryTextExtents and XQueryTextExtents16 functions return the bounding box of the specified 8-bit and 16-bit character string in the specified font or the font contained in the specified GC. These functions query the X server and, therefore, suffer the round-trip overhead that is avoided by XTextExtents and XTextExtents16. Both functions return a XCharStruct structure, whose members are set to the values as follows.

The ascent member is set to the maximum of the ascent metrics of all characters in the string. The descent member is set to the maximum of the descent metrics. The width member is set to the sum of the character-width metrics of all characters in the string. For each character in the string, let W be the sum of the character-width metrics of all characters preceding it in the string. Let L be the left-side-bearing metric of the character plus W. Let R be the right-side-bearing metric of the character plus W. The lbearing member is set to the minimum L of all characters in the string. The rbearing member is set to the maximum R.

For fonts defined with linear indexing rather than 2-byte matrix indexing, each XChar2b structure is interpreted as a 16-bit number with byte1 as the most significant byte. If the font has no defined default character, undefined characters in the string are taken to have all zero metrics.

Characters with all zero metrics are ignored. If the font has no defined default_char, the undefined characters in the string are also ignored.

XQueryTextExtents and XQueryTextExtents16 can generate BadFont and BadGC errors.

8.6. Drawing Text

This section discusses how to draw:

Complex text

Text characters

Image text characters

The fundamental text functions XDrawText and XDrawText16 use the following structures: __ │

typedef struct {

char *chars;

/* pointer to string */

int nchars;

/* number of characters */

int delta;

/* delta between strings */

Font font;

/* Font to print it in, None don’t change */

} XTextItem;

typedef struct {

XChar2b *chars;

/* pointer to two-byte characters */

int nchars;

/* number of characters */

int delta;

/* delta between strings */

Font font;

/* font to print it in, None don’t change */

} XTextItem16; │__

If the font member is not None, the font is changed before printing and also is stored in the GC. If an error was generated during text drawing, the previous items may have been drawn. The baseline of the characters are drawn starting at the x and y coordinates that you pass in the text drawing functions.

For example, consider the background rectangle drawn by XDrawImageString. If you want the upper-left corner of the background rectangle to be at pixel coordinate (x,y), pass the (x,y + ascent) as the baseline origin coordinates to the text functions. The ascent is the font ascent, as given in the XFontStruct structure. If you want the lower-left corner of the background rectangle to be at pixel coordinate (x,y), pass the (x,y − descent + 1) as the baseline origin coordinates to the text functions. The descent is the font descent, as given in the XFontStruct structure.

8.6.1. Drawing Complex Text

To draw 8-bit characters in a given drawable, use XDrawText. __ │

XDrawText(display, d, gc, x, y, items, nitems)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
XTextItem *items;
int nitems;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the specified drawable and
define the origin of the first character.

items

Specifies an array of text items.

nitems

Specifies the number of text items in the array. │__

To draw 2-byte characters in a given drawable, use XDrawText16. __ │

XDrawText16(display, d, gc, x, y, items, nitems)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
XTextItem16 *items;
int nitems;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the specified drawable and
define the origin of the first character.

items

Specifies an array of text items.

nitems

Specifies the number of text items in the array. │__

The XDrawText16 function is similar to XDrawText except that it uses 2-byte or 16-bit characters. Both functions allow complex spacing and font shifts between counted strings.

Each text item is processed in turn. A font member other than None in an item causes the font to be stored in the GC and used for subsequent text. A text element delta specifies an additional change in the position along the x axis before the string is drawn. The delta is always added to the character origin and is not dependent on any characteristics of the font. Each character image, as defined by the font in the GC, is treated as an additional mask for a fill operation on the drawable. The drawable is modified only where the font character has a bit set to 1. If a text item generates a BadFont error, the previous text items may have been drawn.

For fonts defined with linear indexing rather than 2-byte matrix indexing, each XChar2b structure is interpreted as a 16-bit number with byte1 as the most significant byte.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, fill-style, font, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. They also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, and tile-stipple-y-origin.

XDrawText and XDrawText16 can generate BadDrawable, BadFont, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.6.2. Drawing Text Characters

To draw 8-bit characters in a given drawable, use XDrawString. __ │

XDrawString(display, d, gc, x, y, string, length)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
char *string;
int length;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the specified drawable and
define the origin of the first character.

string

Specifies the character string.

length

Specifies the number of characters in the string

argument. │__

To draw 2-byte characters in a given drawable, use XDrawString16. __ │

XDrawString16(display, d, gc, x, y, string, length)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
XChar2b *string;
int length;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the specified drawable and
define the origin of the first character.

string

Specifies the character string.

length

Specifies the number of characters in the string

argument. │__

Each character image, as defined by the font in the GC, is treated as an additional mask for a fill operation on the drawable. The drawable is modified only where the font character has a bit set to 1. For fonts defined with 2-byte matrix indexing and used with XDrawString16, each byte is used as a byte2 with a byte1 of zero.

Both functions use these GC components: function, plane-mask, fill-style, font, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. They also use these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, and tile-stipple-y-origin.

XDrawString and XDrawString16 can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.6.3. Drawing Image Text Characters

Some applications, in particular terminal emulators, need to print image text in which both the foreground and background bits of each character are painted. This prevents annoying flicker on many displays.

To draw 8-bit image text characters in a given drawable, use XDrawImageString. __ │

XDrawImageString(display, d, gc, x, y, string, length)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
char *string;
int length;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the specified drawable and
define the origin of the first character.

string

Specifies the character string.

length

Specifies the number of characters in the string

argument. │__

To draw 2-byte image text characters in a given drawable, use XDrawImageString16. __ │

XDrawImageString16(display, d, gc, x, y, string, length)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
XChar2b *string;
int length;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the specified drawable and
define the origin of the first character.

string

Specifies the character string.

length

Specifies the number of characters in the string

argument. │__

The XDrawImageString16 function is similar to XDrawImageString except that it uses 2-byte or 16-bit characters. Both functions also use both the foreground and background pixels of the GC in the destination.

The effect is first to fill a destination rectangle with the background pixel defined in the GC and then to paint the text with the foreground pixel. The upper-left corner of the filled rectangle is at:

[x, y − font-ascent]

The width is:

overall-width

The height is:

font-ascent + font-descent

The overall-width, font-ascent, and font-descent are as would be returned by XQueryTextExtents using gc and string. The function and fill-style defined in the GC are ignored for these functions. The effective function is GXcopy, and the effective fill-style is FillSolid.

For fonts defined with 2-byte matrix indexing and used with XDrawImageString, each byte is used as a byte2 with a byte1 of zero.

Both functions use these GC components: plane-mask, foreground, background, font, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask.

XDrawImageString and XDrawImageString16 can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadMatch errors.

8.7. Transferring Images between Client and Server

Xlib provides functions that you can use to transfer images between a client and the server. Because the server may require diverse data formats, Xlib provides an image object that fully describes the data in memory and that provides for basic operations on that data. You should reference the data through the image object rather than referencing the data directly. However, some implementations of the Xlib library may efficiently deal with frequently used data formats by replacing functions in the procedure vector with special case functions. Supported operations include destroying the image, getting a pixel, storing a pixel, extracting a subimage of an image, and adding a constant to an image (see section 16.8).

All the image manipulation functions discussed in this section make use of the XImage structure, which describes an image as it exists in the client’s memory. __ │

typedef struct _XImage {

int width, height;

/* size of image */

int xoffset;

/* number of pixels offset in X direction */

int format;

/* XYBitmap, XYPixmap, ZPixmap */

char *data;

/* pointer to image data */

int byte_order;

/* data byte order, LSBFirst, MSBFirst */

int bitmap_unit;

/* quant. of scanline 8, 16, 32 */

int bitmap_bit_order;

/* LSBFirst, MSBFirst */

int bitmap_pad;

/* 8, 16, 32 either XY or ZPixmap */

int depth;

/* depth of image */

int bytes_per_line;

/* accelerator to next scanline */

int bits_per_pixel;

/* bits per pixel (ZPixmap) */

unsigned long red_mask;

/* bits in z arrangement */

unsigned long green_mask;

unsigned long blue_mask;

XPointer obdata;

/* hook for the object routines to hang on */

struct funcs {

/* image manipulation routines */

struct _XImage *(*create_image)();

int (*destroy_image)();

unsigned long (*get_pixel)();

int (*put_pixel)();

struct _XImage *(*sub_image)();

int (*add_pixel)();

} f;

} XImage; │__

To initialize the image manipulation routines of an image structure, use XInitImage. __ │

Status XInitImage(image)
XImage *image;

ximage

Specifies the image. │__

The XInitImage function initializes the internal image manipulation routines of an image structure, based on the values of the various structure members. All fields other than the manipulation routines must already be initialized. If the bytes_per_line member is zero, XInitImage will assume the image data is contiguous in memory and set the bytes_per_line member to an appropriate value based on the other members; otherwise, the value of bytes_per_line is not changed. All of the manipulation routines are initialized to functions that other Xlib image manipulation functions need to operate on the type of image specified by the rest of the structure.

This function must be called for any image constructed by the client before passing it to any other Xlib function. Image structures created or returned by Xlib do not need to be initialized in this fashion.

This function returns a nonzero status if initialization of the structure is successful. It returns zero if it detected some error or inconsistency in the structure, in which case the image is not changed.

To combine an image with a rectangle of a drawable on the display, use XPutImage. __ │

XPutImage(display, d, gc, image, src_x, src_y, dest_x, dest_y, width, height)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
XImage *image;
int src_x, src_y;
int dest_x, dest_y;
unsigned int width, height;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

image

Specifies the image you want combined with the

rectangle.

src_x

Specifies the offset in X from the left edge of

the image defined by the XImage structure.

src_y

Specifies the offset in Y from the top edge of the

image defined by the XImage structure.

dest_x

dest_y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the drawable and are the co-
ordinates of the subimage.

width

height

Specify the width and height of the subimage,

which define the dimensions of the rectangle. │__

The XPutImage function combines an image with a rectangle of the specified drawable. The section of the image defined by the src_x, src_y, width, and height arguments is drawn on the specified part of the drawable. If XYBitmap format is used, the depth of the image must be one, or a BadMatch error results. The foreground pixel in the GC defines the source for the one bits in the image, and the background pixel defines the source for the zero bits. For XYPixmap and ZPixmap, the depth of the image must match the depth of the drawable, or a BadMatch error results.

If the characteristics of the image (for example, byte_order and bitmap_unit) differ from what the server requires, XPutImage automatically makes the appropriate conversions.

This function uses these GC components: function, plane-mask, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. It also uses these GC mode-dependent components: foreground and background.

XPutImage can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

To return the contents of a rectangle in a given drawable on the display, use XGetImage. This function specifically supports rudimentary screen dumps. __ │

XImage *XGetImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned long plane_mask;
int format;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the drawable and define the
upper-left corner of the rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height of the subimage,

which define the dimensions of the rectangle.

plane_maskSpecifies the plane mask.

format

Specifies the format for the image. You can pass

XYPixmap or ZPixmap. │__

The XGetImage function returns a pointer to an XImage structure. This structure provides you with the contents of the specified rectangle of the drawable in the format you specify. If the format argument is XYPixmap, the image contains only the bit planes you passed to the plane_mask argument. If the plane_mask argument only requests a subset of the planes of the display, the depth of the returned image will be the number of planes requested. If the format argument is ZPixmap, XGetImage returns as zero the bits in all planes not specified in the plane_mask argument. The function performs no range checking on the values in plane_mask and ignores extraneous bits.

XGetImage returns the depth of the image to the depth member of the XImage structure. The depth of the image is as specified when the drawable was created, except when getting a subset of the planes in XYPixmap format, when the depth is given by the number of bits set to 1 in plane_mask.

If the drawable is a pixmap, the given rectangle must be wholly contained within the pixmap, or a BadMatch error results. If the drawable is a window, the window must be viewable, and it must be the case that if there were no inferiors or overlapping windows, the specified rectangle of the window would be fully visible on the screen and wholly contained within the outside edges of the window, or a BadMatch error results. Note that the borders of the window can be included and read with this request. If the window has backing-store, the backing-store contents are returned for regions of the window that are obscured by noninferior windows. If the window does not have backing-store, the returned contents of such obscured regions are undefined. The returned contents of visible regions of inferiors of a different depth than the specified window’s depth are also undefined. The pointer cursor image is not included in the returned contents. If a problem occurs, XGetImage returns NULL.

XGetImage can generate BadDrawable, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

To copy the contents of a rectangle on the display to a location within a preexisting image structure, use XGetSubImage. __ │

XImage *XGetSubImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format, dest_image, dest_x,
dest_y
)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned long plane_mask;
int format;
XImage *dest_image;
int dest_x, dest_y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the drawable and define the
upper-left corner of the rectangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height of the subimage,

which define the dimensions of the rectangle.

plane_maskSpecifies the plane mask.

format

Specifies the format for the image. You can pass

XYPixmap or ZPixmap.

dest_imageSpecifies the destination image.

dest_x

dest_y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which are rela-

tive to the origin of the destination rectangle,
specify its upper-left corner, and determine where
the subimage is placed in the destination image. │__

The XGetSubImage function updates dest_image with the specified subimage in the same manner as XGetImage. If the format argument is XYPixmap, the image contains only the bit planes you passed to the plane_mask argument. If the format argument is ZPixmap, XGetSubImage returns as zero the bits in all planes not specified in the plane_mask argument. The function performs no range checking on the values in plane_mask and ignores extraneous bits. As a convenience, XGetSubImage returns a pointer to the same XImage structure specified by dest_image.

The depth of the destination XImage structure must be the same as that of the drawable. If the specified subimage does not fit at the specified location on the destination image, the right and bottom edges are clipped. If the drawable is a pixmap, the given rectangle must be wholly contained within the pixmap, or a BadMatch error results. If the drawable is a window, the window must be viewable, and it must be the case that if there were no inferiors or overlapping windows, the specified rectangle of the window would be fully visible on the screen and wholly contained within the outside edges of the window, or a BadMatch error results. If the window has backing-store, then the backing-store contents are returned for regions of the window that are obscured by noninferior windows. If the window does not have backing-store, the returned contents of such obscured regions are undefined. The returned contents of visible regions of inferiors of a different depth than the specified window’s depth are also undefined. If a problem occurs, XGetSubImage returns NULL.

XGetSubImage can generate BadDrawable, BadGC, BadMatch, and BadValue errors.

8

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 9

Window and Session Manager Functions

Although it is difficult to categorize functions as exclusively for an application, a window manager, or a session manager, the functions in this chapter are most often used by window managers and session managers. It is not expected that these functions will be used by most application programs. Xlib provides management functions to:

Change the parent of a window

Control the lifetime of a window

Manage installed colormaps

Set and retrieve the font search path

Grab the server

Kill a client

Control the screen saver

Control host access

9.1. Changing the Parent of a Window

To change a window’s parent to another window on the same screen, use XReparentWindow. There is no way to move a window between screens. __ │

XReparentWindow(display, w, parent, x, y)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window parent;
int x, y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

parent

Specifies the parent window.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates of the position in

the new parent window. │__

If the specified window is mapped, XReparentWindow automatically performs an UnmapWindow request on it, removes it from its current position in the hierarchy, and inserts it as the child of the specified parent. The window is placed in the stacking order on top with respect to sibling windows.

After reparenting the specified window, XReparentWindow causes the X server to generate a ReparentNotify event. The override_redirect member returned in this event is set to the window’s corresponding attribute. Window manager clients usually should ignore this window if this member is set to True. Finally, if the specified window was originally mapped, the X server automatically performs a MapWindow request on it.

The X server performs normal exposure processing on formerly obscured windows. The X server might not generate Expose events for regions from the initial UnmapWindow request that are immediately obscured by the final MapWindow request. A BadMatch error results if:

The new parent window is not on the same screen as the old parent window.

The new parent window is the specified window or an inferior of the specified window.

The new parent is InputOnly, and the window is not.

The specified window has a ParentRelative background, and the new parent window is not the same depth as the specified window.

XReparentWindow can generate BadMatch and BadWindow errors.

9.2. Controlling the Lifetime of a Window

The save-set of a client is a list of other clients’ windows that, if they are inferiors of one of the client’s windows at connection close, should not be destroyed and should be remapped if they are unmapped. For further information about close-connection processing, see section 2.6. To allow an application’s window to survive when a window manager that has reparented a window fails, Xlib provides the save-set functions that you can use to control the longevity of subwindows that are normally destroyed when the parent is destroyed. For example, a window manager that wants to add decoration to a window by adding a frame might reparent an application’s window. When the frame is destroyed, the application’s window should not be destroyed but be returned to its previous place in the window hierarchy.

The X server automatically removes windows from the save-set when they are destroyed.

To add or remove a window from the client’s save-set, use XChangeSaveSet. __ │

XChangeSaveSet(display, w, change_mode)
Display *display;
Window w;
int change_mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window that you want to add to or

delete from the client’s save-set.

change_modeSpecifies the mode. You can pass SetModeInsert
or SetModeDelete. │__

Depending on the specified mode, XChangeSaveSet either inserts or deletes the specified window from the client’s save-set. The specified window must have been created by some other client, or a BadMatch error results.

XChangeSaveSet can generate BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To add a window to the client’s save-set, use XAddToSaveSet. __ │

XAddToSaveSet(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window that you want to add to the

client’s save-set. │__

The XAddToSaveSet function adds the specified window to the client’s save-set. The specified window must have been created by some other client, or a BadMatch error results.

XAddToSaveSet can generate BadMatch and BadWindow errors.

To remove a window from the client’s save-set, use XRemoveFromSaveSet. __ │

XRemoveFromSaveSet(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window that you want to delete from

the client’s save-set. │__

The XRemoveFromSaveSet function removes the specified window from the client’s save-set. The specified window must have been created by some other client, or a BadMatch error results.

XRemoveFromSaveSet can generate BadMatch and BadWindow errors.

9.3. Managing Installed Colormaps

The X server maintains a list of installed colormaps. Windows using these colormaps are guaranteed to display with correct colors; windows using other colormaps may or may not display with correct colors. Xlib provides functions that you can use to install a colormap, uninstall a colormap, and obtain a list of installed colormaps.

At any time, there is a subset of the installed maps that is viewed as an ordered list and is called the required list. The length of the required list is at most M, where M is the minimum number of installed colormaps specified for the screen in the connection setup. The required list is maintained as follows. When a colormap is specified to XInstallColormap, it is added to the head of the list; the list is truncated at the tail, if necessary, to keep its length to at most M. When a colormap is specified to XUninstallColormap and it is in the required list, it is removed from the list. A colormap is not added to the required list when it is implicitly installed by the X server, and the X server cannot implicitly uninstall a colormap that is in the required list.

To install a colormap, use XInstallColormap. __ │

XInstallColormap(display, colormap)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap. │__

The XInstallColormap function installs the specified colormap for its associated screen. All windows associated with this colormap immediately display with true colors. You associated the windows with this colormap when you created them by calling XCreateWindow, XCreateSimpleWindow, XChangeWindowAttributes, or XSetWindowColormap.

If the specified colormap is not already an installed colormap, the X server generates a ColormapNotify event on each window that has that colormap. In addition, for every other colormap that is installed as a result of a call to XInstallColormap, the X server generates a ColormapNotify event on each window that has that colormap.

XInstallColormap can generate a BadColor error.

To uninstall a colormap, use XUninstallColormap. __ │

XUninstallColormap(display, colormap)
Display *display;
Colormap colormap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

colormap

Specifies the colormap. │__

The XUninstallColormap function removes the specified colormap from the required list for its screen. As a result, the specified colormap might be uninstalled, and the X server might implicitly install or uninstall additional colormaps. Which colormaps get installed or uninstalled is server dependent except that the required list must remain installed.

If the specified colormap becomes uninstalled, the X server generates a ColormapNotify event on each window that has that colormap. In addition, for every other colormap that is installed or uninstalled as a result of a call to XUninstallColormap, the X server generates a ColormapNotify event on each window that has that colormap.

XUninstallColormap can generate a BadColor error.

To obtain a list of the currently installed colormaps for a given screen, use XListInstalledColormaps. __ │

Colormap *XListInstalledColormaps(display, w, num_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
int *num_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window that determines the screen.

num_returnReturns the number of currently installed col-
ormaps. │__

The XListInstalledColormaps function returns a list of the currently installed colormaps for the screen of the specified window. The order of the colormaps in the list is not significant and is no explicit indication of the required list. When the allocated list is no longer needed, free it by using XFree.

XListInstalledColormaps can generate a BadWindow error.

9.4. Setting and Retrieving the Font Search Path

The set of fonts available from a server depends on a font search path. Xlib provides functions to set and retrieve the search path for a server.

To set the font search path, use XSetFontPath. __ │

XSetFontPath(display, directories, ndirs)
Display *display;
char **directories;
int ndirs;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

directoriesSpecifies the directory path used to look for a
font. Setting the path to the empty list restores
the default path defined for the X server.

ndirs

Specifies the number of directories in the path. │__

The XSetFontPath function defines the directory search path for font lookup. There is only one search path per X server, not one per client. The encoding and interpretation of the strings are implementation-dependent, but typically they specify directories or font servers to be searched in the order listed. An X server is permitted to cache font information internally; for example, it might cache an entire font from a file and not check on subsequent opens of that font to see if the underlying font file has changed. However, when the font path is changed, the X server is guaranteed to flush all cached information about fonts for which there currently are no explicit resource IDs allocated. The meaning of an error from this request is implementation-dependent.

XSetFontPath can generate a BadValue error.

To get the current font search path, use XGetFontPath. __ │

char **XGetFontPath(display, npaths_return)
Display *display;
int *npaths_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

npaths_return
Returns the number of strings in the font path ar-
ray. │__

The XGetFontPath function allocates and returns an array of strings containing the search path. The contents of these strings are implementation-dependent and are not intended to be interpreted by client applications. When it is no longer needed, the data in the font path should be freed by using XFreeFontPath.

To free data returned by XGetFontPath, use XFreeFontPath. __ │

XFreeFontPath(list)
char **list;

list

Specifies the array of strings you want to free. │__

The XFreeFontPath function frees the data allocated by XGetFontPath.

9.5. Grabbing the Server

Xlib provides functions that you can use to grab and ungrab the server. These functions can be used to control processing of output on other connections by the window system server. While the server is grabbed, no processing of requests or close downs on any other connection will occur. A client closing its connection automatically ungrabs the server. Although grabbing the server is highly discouraged, it is sometimes necessary.

To grab the server, use XGrabServer. __ │

XGrabServer(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XGrabServer function disables processing of requests and close downs on all other connections than the one this request arrived on. You should not grab the X server any more than is absolutely necessary.

To ungrab the server, use XUngrabServer. __ │

XUngrabServer(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XUngrabServer function restarts processing of requests and close downs on other connections. You should avoid grabbing the X server as much as possible.

9.6. Killing Clients

Xlib provides a function to cause the connection to a client to be closed and its resources to be destroyed. To destroy a client, use XKillClient. __ │

XKillClient(display, resource)
Display *display;
XID resource;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

resource

Specifies any resource associated with the client

that you want to destroy or AllTemporary. │__

The XKillClient function forces a close down of the client that created the resource if a valid resource is specified. If the client has already terminated in either RetainPermanent or RetainTemporary mode, all of the client’s resources are destroyed. If AllTemporary is specified, the resources of all clients that have terminated in RetainTemporary are destroyed (see section 2.5). This permits implementation of window manager facilities that aid debugging. A client can set its close-down mode to RetainTemporary. If the client then crashes, its windows would not be destroyed. The programmer can then inspect the application’s window tree and use the window manager to destroy the zombie windows.

XKillClient can generate a BadValue error.

9.7. Controlling the Screen Saver

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set or reset the mode of the screen saver, to force or activate the screen saver, or to obtain the current screen saver values.

To set the screen saver mode, use XSetScreenSaver. __ │

XSetScreenSaver(display, timeout, interval, prefer_blanking, allow_exposures)
Display *display;
int timeout, interval;
int prefer_blanking;
int allow_exposures;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

timeout

Specifies the timeout, in seconds, until the

screen saver turns on.

interval

Specifies the interval, in seconds, between screen

saver alterations.

prefer_blanking
Specifies how to enable screen blanking. You can
pass DontPreferBlanking, PreferBlanking, or De-
faultBlanking
.

allow_exposures
Specifies the screen save control values. You can
pass DontAllowExposures, AllowExposures, or De-
faultExposures
. │__

Timeout and interval are specified in seconds. A timeout of 0 disables the screen saver (but an activated screen saver is not deactivated), and a timeout of −1 restores the default. Other negative values generate a BadValue error. If the timeout value is nonzero, XSetScreenSaver enables the screen saver. An interval of 0 disables the random-pattern motion. If no input from devices (keyboard, mouse, and so on) is generated for the specified number of timeout seconds once the screen saver is enabled, the screen saver is activated.

For each screen, if blanking is preferred and the hardware supports video blanking, the screen simply goes blank. Otherwise, if either exposures are allowed or the screen can be regenerated without sending Expose events to clients, the screen is tiled with the root window background tile randomly re-origined each interval seconds. Otherwise, the screens’ state do not change, and the screen saver is not activated. The screen saver is deactivated, and all screen states are restored at the next keyboard or pointer input or at the next call to XForceScreenSaver with mode ScreenSaverReset.

If the server-dependent screen saver method supports periodic change, the interval argument serves as a hint about how long the change period should be, and zero hints that no periodic change should be made. Examples of ways to change the screen include scrambling the colormap periodically, moving an icon image around the screen periodically, or tiling the screen with the root window background tile, randomly re-origined periodically.

XSetScreenSaver can generate a BadValue error.

To force the screen saver on or off, use XForceScreenSaver. __ │

XForceScreenSaver(display, mode)
Display *display;
int mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

mode

Specifies the mode that is to be applied. You can

pass ScreenSaverActive or ScreenSaverReset. │__

If the specified mode is ScreenSaverActive and the screen saver currently is deactivated, XForceScreenSaver activates the screen saver even if the screen saver had been disabled with a timeout of zero. If the specified mode is ScreenSaverReset and the screen saver currently is enabled, XForceScreenSaver deactivates the screen saver if it was activated, and the activation timer is reset to its initial state (as if device input had been received).

XForceScreenSaver can generate a BadValue error.

To activate the screen saver, use XActivateScreenSaver. __ │

XActivateScreenSaver(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

To reset the screen saver, use XResetScreenSaver. __ │

XResetScreenSaver(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

To get the current screen saver values, use XGetScreenSaver. __ │

XGetScreenSaver(display, timeout_return, interval_return, prefer_blanking_return,
allow_exposures_return
)
Display *display;
int *timeout_return, *interval_return;
int *prefer_blanking_return;
int *allow_exposures_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

timeout_return
Returns the timeout, in seconds, until the screen
saver turns on.

interval_return
Returns the interval between screen saver invoca-
tions.

prefer_blanking_return
Returns the current screen blanking preference
(DontPreferBlanking, PreferBlanking, or Default-
Blanking
).

allow_exposures_return
Returns the current screen save control value
(DontAllowExposures, AllowExposures, or DefaultEx-
posures
). │__

9.8. Controlling Host Access

This section discusses how to:

Add, get, or remove hosts from the access control list

Change, enable, or disable access

X does not provide any protection on a per-window basis. If you find out the resource ID of a resource, you can manipulate it. To provide some minimal level of protection, however, connections are permitted only from machines you trust. This is adequate on single-user workstations but obviously breaks down on timesharing machines. Although provisions exist in the X protocol for proper connection authentication, the lack of a standard authentication server leaves host-level access control as the only common mechanism.

The initial set of hosts allowed to open connections typically consists of:

The host the window system is running on.

On POSIX-conformant systems, each host listed in the /etc/X?.hosts file. The ? indicates the number of the display. This file should consist of host names separated by newlines. DECnet nodes must terminate in :: to distinguish them from Internet hosts.

If a host is not in the access control list when the access control mechanism is enabled and if the host attempts to establish a connection, the server refuses the connection. To change the access list, the client must reside on the same host as the server and/or must have been granted permission in the initial authorization at connection setup.

Servers also can implement other access control policies in addition to or in place of this host access facility. For further information about other access control implementations, see ‘‘X Window System Protocol.’’

9.8.1. Adding, Getting, or Removing Hosts

Xlib provides functions that you can use to add, get, or remove hosts from the access control list. All the host access control functions use the XHostAddress structure, which contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int family;

/* for example FamilyInternet */

int length;

/* length of address, in bytes */

char *address;

/* pointer to where to find the address */

} XHostAddress; │__

The family member specifies which protocol address family to use (for example, TCP/IP or DECnet) and can be FamilyInternet, FamilyInternet6, FamilyServerInterpreted, FamilyDECnet, or FamilyChaos. The length member specifies the length of the address in bytes. The address member specifies a pointer to the address.

For TCP/IP, the address should be in network byte order. For IP version 4 addresses, the family should be FamilyInternet and the length should be 4 bytes. For IP version 6 addresses, the family should be FamilyInternet6 and the length should be 16 bytes.

For the DECnet family, the server performs no automatic swapping on the address bytes. A Phase IV address is 2 bytes long. The first byte contains the least significant 8 bits of the node number. The second byte contains the most significant 2 bits of the node number in the least significant 2 bits of the byte and the area in the most significant 6 bits of the byte.

For the ServerInterpreted family, the length is ignored and the address member is a pointer to a XServerInterpretedAddress structure, which contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int typelength;

/* length of type string, in bytes */

int valuelength;/* length of value string, in bytes */

char *type;

/* pointer to where to find the type string */

char *value;

/* pointer to where to find the address */

} XServerInterpretedAddress; │__

The type and value members point to strings representing the type and value of the server interpreted entry. These strings may not be NULL-terminated so care should be used when accessing them. The typelength and valuelength members specify the length in byte of the type and value strings.

To add a single host, use XAddHost. __ │

XAddHost(display, host)
Display *display;

XHostAddress *host;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

host

Specifies the host that is to be added. │__

The XAddHost function adds the specified host to the access control list for that display. The server must be on the same host as the client issuing the command, or a BadAccess error results.

XAddHost can generate BadAccess and BadValue errors.

To add multiple hosts at one time, use XAddHosts. __ │

XAddHosts(display, hosts, num_hosts)
Display *display;
XHostAddress *hosts;
int num_hosts;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

hosts

Specifies each host that is to be added.

num_hosts

Specifies the number of hosts. │__

The XAddHosts function adds each specified host to the access control list for that display. The server must be on the same host as the client issuing the command, or a BadAccess error results.

XAddHosts can generate BadAccess and BadValue errors.

To obtain a host list, use XListHosts. __ │

XHostAddress *XListHosts(display, nhosts_return, state_return)
Display *display;
int *nhosts_return;
Bool *state_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

nhosts_return
Returns the number of hosts currently in the ac-
cess control list.

state_return
Returns the state of the access control. │__

The XListHosts function returns the current access control list as well as whether the use of the list at connection setup was enabled or disabled. XListHosts allows a program to find out what machines can make connections. It also returns a pointer to a list of host structures that were allocated by the function. When no longer needed, this memory should be freed by calling XFree.

To remove a single host, use XRemoveHost. __ │

XRemoveHost(display, host)
Display *display;
XHostAddress *host;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

host

Specifies the host that is to be removed. │__

The XRemoveHost function removes the specified host from the access control list for that display. The server must be on the same host as the client process, or a BadAccess error results. If you remove your machine from the access list, you can no longer connect to that server, and this operation cannot be reversed unless you reset the server.

XRemoveHost can generate BadAccess and BadValue errors.

To remove multiple hosts at one time, use XRemoveHosts. __ │

XRemoveHosts(display, hosts, num_hosts)
Display *display;
XHostAddress *hosts;
int num_hosts;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

hosts

Specifies each host that is to be removed.

num_hosts

Specifies the number of hosts. │__

The XRemoveHosts function removes each specified host from the access control list for that display. The X server must be on the same host as the client process, or a BadAccess error results. If you remove your machine from the access list, you can no longer connect to that server, and this operation cannot be reversed unless you reset the server.

XRemoveHosts can generate BadAccess and BadValue errors.

9.8.2. Changing, Enabling, or Disabling Access Control

Xlib provides functions that you can use to enable, disable, or change access control.

For these functions to execute successfully, the client application must reside on the same host as the X server and/or have been given permission in the initial authorization at connection setup.

To change access control, use XSetAccessControl. __ │

XSetAccessControl(display, mode)
Display *display;
int mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

mode

Specifies the mode. You can pass EnableAccess or

DisableAccess. │__

The XSetAccessControl function either enables or disables the use of the access control list at each connection setup.

XSetAccessControl can generate BadAccess and BadValue errors.

To enable access control, use XEnableAccessControl. __ │

XEnableAccessControl(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XEnableAccessControl function enables the use of the access control list at each connection setup.

XEnableAccessControl can generate a BadAccess error.

To disable access control, use XDisableAccessControl. __ │

XDisableAccessControl(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XDisableAccessControl function disables the use of the access control list at each connection setup.

XDisableAccessControl can generate a BadAccess error.

9

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 10

Events

A client application communicates with the X server through the connection you establish with the XOpenDisplay function. A client application sends requests to the X server over this connection. These requests are made by the Xlib functions that are called in the client application. Many Xlib functions cause the X server to generate events, and the user’s typing or moving the pointer can generate events asynchronously. The X server returns events to the client on the same connection.

This chapter discusses the following topics associated with events:

Event types

Event structures

Event masks

Event processing

Functions for handling events are dealt with in the next chapter.

10.1. Event Types

An event is data generated asynchronously by the X server as a result of some device activity or as side effects of a request sent by an Xlib function. Device-related events propagate from the source window to ancestor windows until some client application has selected that event type or until the event is explicitly discarded. The X server generally sends an event to a client application only if the client has specifically asked to be informed of that event type, typically by setting the event-mask attribute of the window. The mask can also be set when you create a window or by changing the window’s event-mask. You can also mask out events that would propagate to ancestor windows by manipulating the do-not-propagate mask of the window’s attributes. However, MappingNotify events are always sent to all clients.

An event type describes a specific event generated by the X server. For each event type, a corresponding constant name is defined in <X11/X.h>, which is used when referring to an event type. The following table lists the event category and its associated event type or types. The processing associated with these events is discussed in section 10.5.
Event Category Event Type

Keyboard events
KeyPress
, KeyRelease
Pointer events
ButtonPress
, ButtonRelease,
MotionNotify

Window crossing events
EnterNotify
, LeaveNotify
Input focus events
FocusIn
, FocusOut
Keymap state
notification event
KeymapNotify

Exposure events

Expose, GraphicsExpose, NoExpose
Structure control
events
CirculateRequest
, ConfigureRequest,
MapRequest
, ResizeRequest
Window state
notification events
CirculateNotify
, ConfigureNotify,
CreateNotify
, DestroyNotify,
GravityNotify
, MapNotify,
MappingNotify
, ReparentNotify,
UnmapNotify
,
VisibilityNotify

Colormap state
notification event
ColormapNotify

Client communication
events
ClientMessage
, PropertyNotify,
SelectionClear
, SelectionNotify,
SelectionRequest

10.2. Event Structures

For each event type, a corresponding structure is declared in <X11/Xlib.h>. All the event structures have the following common members: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

} XAnyEvent; │__

The type member is set to the event type constant name that uniquely identifies it. For example, when the X server reports a GraphicsExpose event to a client application, it sends an XGraphicsExposeEvent structure with the type member set to GraphicsExpose. The display member is set to a pointer to the display the event was read on. The send_event member is set to True if the event came from a SendEvent protocol request. The serial member is set from the serial number reported in the protocol but expanded from the 16-bit least-significant bits to a full 32-bit value. The window member is set to the window that is most useful to toolkit dispatchers.

The X server can send events at any time in the input stream. Xlib stores any events received while waiting for a reply in an event queue for later use. Xlib also provides functions that allow you to check events in the event queue (see section 11.3).

In addition to the individual structures declared for each event type, the XEvent structure is a union of the individual structures declared for each event type. Depending on the type, you should access members of each event by using the XEvent union. __ │

typedef union _XEvent {

int type;

/* must not be changed */

XAnyEvent xany;

XKeyEvent xkey;

XButtonEvent xbutton;

XMotionEvent xmotion;

XCrossingEvent xcrossing;

XFocusChangeEvent xfocus;

XExposeEvent xexpose;

XGraphicsExposeEvent xgraphicsexpose;

XNoExposeEvent xnoexpose;

XVisibilityEvent xvisibility;

XCreateWindowEvent xcreatewindow;

XDestroyWindowEvent xdestroywindow;

XUnmapEvent xunmap;

XMapEvent xmap;

XMapRequestEvent xmaprequest;

XReparentEvent xreparent;

XConfigureEvent xconfigure;

XGravityEvent xgravity;

XResizeRequestEvent xresizerequest;

XConfigureRequestEvent xconfigurerequest;

XCirculateEvent xcirculate;

XCirculateRequestEvent xcirculaterequest;

XPropertyEvent xproperty;

XSelectionClearEvent xselectionclear;

XSelectionRequestEvent xselectionrequest;

XSelectionEvent xselection;

XColormapEvent xcolormap;

XClientMessageEvent xclient;

XMappingEvent xmapping;

XErrorEvent xerror;

XKeymapEvent xkeymap;

long pad[24];

} XEvent; │__

An XEvent structure’s first entry always is the type member, which is set to the event type. The second member always is the serial number of the protocol request that generated the event. The third member always is send_event, which is a Bool that indicates if the event was sent by a different client. The fourth member always is a display, which is the display that the event was read from. Except for keymap events, the fifth member always is a window, which has been carefully selected to be useful to toolkit dispatchers. To avoid breaking toolkits, the order of these first five entries is not to change. Most events also contain a time member, which is the time at which an event occurred. In addition, a pointer to the generic event must be cast before it is used to access any other information in the structure.

10.3. Event Masks

Clients select event reporting of most events relative to a window. To do this, pass an event mask to an Xlib event-handling function that takes an event_mask argument. The bits of the event mask are defined in <X11/X.h>. Each bit in the event mask maps to an event mask name, which describes the event or events you want the X server to return to a client application.

Unless the client has specifically asked for them, most events are not reported to clients when they are generated. Unless the client suppresses them by setting graphics-exposures in the GC to False, GraphicsExpose and NoExpose are reported by default as a result of XCopyPlane and XCopyArea. SelectionClear, SelectionRequest, SelectionNotify, or ClientMessage cannot be masked. Selection-related events are only sent to clients cooperating with selections (see section 4.5). When the keyboard or pointer mapping is changed, MappingNotify is always sent to clients.

The following table lists the event mask constants you can pass to the event_mask argument and the circumstances in which you would want to specify the event mask:
Event Mask Circumstances
NoEventMask

No events wanted
KeyPressMask

Keyboard down events wanted
KeyReleaseMask

Keyboard up events wanted
ButtonPressMask

Pointer button down events wanted
ButtonReleaseMask

Pointer button up events wanted
EnterWindowMask

Pointer window entry events wanted
LeaveWindowMask

Pointer window leave events wanted
PointerMotionMask

Pointer motion events wanted
PointerMotionHintMask

Pointer motion hints wanted
Button1MotionMask

Pointer motion while button 1 down
Button2MotionMask

Pointer motion while button 2 down
Button3MotionMask

Pointer motion while button 3 down
Button4MotionMask

Pointer motion while button 4 down
Button5MotionMask

Pointer motion while button 5 down
ButtonMotionMask

Pointer motion while any button
down
KeymapStateMask

Keyboard state wanted at window
entry and focus in
ExposureMask

Any exposure wanted
VisibilityChangeMask

Any change in visibility wanted
StructureNotifyMask

Any change in window structure
wanted
ResizeRedirectMask

Redirect resize of this window
SubstructureNotifyMask

Substructure notification wanted
SubstructureRedirectMask

Redirect structure requests on
children
FocusChangeMask

Any change in input focus wanted
PropertyChangeMask

Any change in property wanted
ColormapChangeMask

Any change in colormap wanted
OwnerGrabButtonMask

Automatic grabs should activate
with owner_events set to True

10.4. Event Processing Overview

The event reported to a client application during event processing depends on which event masks you provide as the event-mask attribute for a window. For some event masks, there is a one-to-one correspondence between the event mask constant and the event type constant. For example, if you pass the event mask ButtonPressMask, the X server sends back only ButtonPress events. Most events contain a time member, which is the time at which an event occurred.

In other cases, one event mask constant can map to several event type constants. For example, if you pass the event mask SubstructureNotifyMask, the X server can send back CirculateNotify, ConfigureNotify, CreateNotify, DestroyNotify, GravityNotify, MapNotify, ReparentNotify, or UnmapNotify events.

In another case, two event masks can map to one event type. For example, if you pass either PointerMotionMask or ButtonMotionMask, the X server sends back a MotionNotify event.

The following table lists the event mask, its associated event type or types, and the structure name associated with the event type. Some of these structures actually are typedefs to a generic structure that is shared between two event types. Note that N.A. appears in columns for which the information is not applicable.
Event Mask Event Type Structure Generic Structure

ButtonMotionMask MotionNotify XPointerMovedEvent XMotionEvent
Button1MotionMask
Button2MotionMask
Button3MotionMask
Button4MotionMask
Button5MotionMask
ButtonPressMask ButtonPress XButtonPressedEvent XButtonEvent
ButtonReleaseMask ButtonRelease XButtonReleasedEvent XButtonEvent
ColormapChangeMask ColormapNotify XColormapEvent
EnterWindowMask EnterNotify XEnterWindowEvent XCrossingEvent
LeaveWindowMask LeaveNotify XLeaveWindowEvent XCrossingEvent
ExposureMask Expose XExposeEvent
GCGraphicsExposures in GC GraphicsExpose XGraphicsExposeEvent
NoExpose XNoExposeEvent
FocusChangeMask FocusIn XFocusInEvent XFocusChangeEvent
FocusOut XFocusOutEvent XFocusChangeEvent
KeymapStateMask KeymapNotify XKeymapEvent
KeyPressMask KeyPress XKeyPressedEvent XKeyEvent
KeyReleaseMask KeyRelease XKeyReleasedEvent XKeyEvent
OwnerGrabButtonMask N.A. N.A.
PointerMotionMask MotionNotify XPointerMovedEvent XMotionEvent
PointerMotionHintMask N.A. N.A.
PropertyChangeMask PropertyNotify XPropertyEvent
ResizeRedirectMask ResizeRequest XResizeRequestEvent
StructureNotifyMask CirculateNotify XCirculateEvent
ConfigureNotify XConfigureEvent
DestroyNotify XDestroyWindowEvent
GravityNotify XGravityEvent
MapNotify XMapEvent
ReparentNotify XReparentEvent
UnmapNotify XUnmapEvent
SubstructureNotifyMask CirculateNotify XCirculateEvent
ConfigureNotify XConfigureEvent
CreateNotify XCreateWindowEvent
DestroyNotify XDestroyWindowEvent
GravityNotify XGravityEvent
MapNotify XMapEvent
ReparentNotify XReparentEvent
UnmapNotify XUnmapEvent
SubstructureRedirectMask CirculateRequest XCirculateRequestEvent
ConfigureRequest XConfigureRequestEvent
MapRequest XMapRequestEvent
N.A. ClientMessage XClientMessageEvent
N.A. MappingNotify XMappingEvent
N.A. SelectionClear XSelectionClearEvent
N.A. SelectionNotify XSelectionEvent
N.A. SelectionRequest XSelectionRequestEvent
VisibilityChangeMask VisibilityNotify XVisibilityEvent

The sections that follow describe the processing that occurs when you select the different event masks. The sections are organized according to these processing categories:

Keyboard and pointer events

Window crossing events

Input focus events

Keymap state notification events

Exposure events

Window state notification events

Structure control events

Colormap state notification events

Client communication events

10.5. Keyboard and Pointer Events

This section discusses:

Pointer button events

Keyboard and pointer events

10.5.1. Pointer Button Events

The following describes the event processing that occurs when a pointer button press is processed with the pointer in some window w and when no active pointer grab is in progress.

The X server searches the ancestors of w from the root down, looking for a passive grab to activate. If no matching passive grab on the button exists, the X server automatically starts an active grab for the client receiving the event and sets the last-pointer-grab time to the current server time. The effect is essentially equivalent to an XGrabButton with these client passed arguments:
Argument Value
w

The event window
event_mask

The client’s selected pointer
events on the event window
pointer_mode
GrabModeAsync
keyboard_mode
GrabModeAsync
owner_events
True
, if the client has selected
OwnerGrabButtonMask
on the event
window, otherwise False
confine_to
None
cursor
None

The active grab is automatically terminated when the logical state of the pointer has all buttons released. Clients can modify the active grab by calling XUngrabPointer and XChangeActivePointerGrab.

10.5.2. Keyboard and Pointer Events

This section discusses the processing that occurs for the keyboard events KeyPress and KeyRelease and the pointer events ButtonPress, ButtonRelease, and MotionNotify. For information about the keyboard event-handling utilities, see chapter 11.

The X server reports KeyPress or KeyRelease events to clients wanting information about keys that logically change state. Note that these events are generated for all keys, even those mapped to modifier bits. The X server reports ButtonPress or ButtonRelease events to clients wanting information about buttons that logically change state.

The X server reports MotionNotify events to clients wanting information about when the pointer logically moves. The X server generates this event whenever the pointer is moved and the pointer motion begins and ends in the window. The granularity of MotionNotify events is not guaranteed, but a client that selects this event type is guaranteed to receive at least one event when the pointer moves and then rests.

The generation of the logical changes lags the physical changes if device event processing is frozen.

To receive KeyPress, KeyRelease, ButtonPress, and ButtonRelease events, set KeyPressMask, KeyReleaseMask, ButtonPressMask, and ButtonReleaseMask bits in the event-mask attribute of the window.

To receive MotionNotify events, set one or more of the following event masks bits in the event-mask attribute of the window.

Button1MotionMask Button5MotionMask

The client application receives MotionNotify events only when one or more of the specified buttons is pressed.

ButtonMotionMask

The client application receives MotionNotify events only when at least one button is pressed.

PointerMotionMask

The client application receives MotionNotify events independent of the state of the pointer buttons.

PointerMotionHintMask

If PointerMotionHintMask is selected in combination with one or more of the above masks, the X server is free to send only one MotionNotify event (with the is_hint member of the XPointerMovedEvent structure set to NotifyHint) to the client for the event window, until either the key or button state changes, the pointer leaves the event window, or the client calls XQueryPointer or XGetMotionEvents. The server still may send MotionNotify events without is_hint set to NotifyHint.

The source of the event is the viewable window that the pointer is in. The window used by the X server to report these events depends on the window’s position in the window hierarchy and whether any intervening window prohibits the generation of these events. Starting with the source window, the X server searches up the window hierarchy until it locates the first window specified by a client as having an interest in these events. If one of the intervening windows has its do-not-propagate-mask set to prohibit generation of the event type, the events of those types will be suppressed. Clients can modify the actual window used for reporting by performing active grabs and, in the case of keyboard events, by using the focus window.

The structures for these event types contain: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ButtonPress or ButtonRelease */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

/* ‘‘event’’ window it is reported relative to */

Window root;

/* root window that the event occurred on */

Window subwindow;

/* child window */

Time time;

/* milliseconds */

int x, y;

/* pointer x, y coordinates in event window */

int x_root, y_root;

/* coordinates relative to root */

unsigned int state;

/* key or button mask */

unsigned int button;

/* detail */

Bool same_screen;

/* same screen flag */

} XButtonEvent;
typedef XButtonEvent XButtonPressedEvent;
typedef XButtonEvent XButtonReleasedEvent;

typedef struct {

int type;

/* KeyPress or KeyRelease */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

/* ‘‘event’’ window it is reported relative to */

Window root;

/* root window that the event occurred on */

Window subwindow;

/* child window */

Time time;

/* milliseconds */

int x, y;

/* pointer x, y coordinates in event window */

int x_root, y_root;

/* coordinates relative to root */

unsigned int state;

/* key or button mask */

unsigned int keycode;

/* detail */

Bool same_screen;

/* same screen flag */

} XKeyEvent;
typedef XKeyEvent XKeyPressedEvent;
typedef XKeyEvent XKeyReleasedEvent;

typedef struct {

int type;

/* MotionNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

/* ‘‘event’’ window reported relative to */

Window root;

/* root window that the event occurred on */

Window subwindow;

/* child window */

Time time;

/* milliseconds */

int x, y;

/* pointer x, y coordinates in event window */

int x_root, y_root;

/* coordinates relative to root */

unsigned int state;

/* key or button mask */

char is_hint;

/* detail */

Bool same_screen;

/* same screen flag */

} XMotionEvent;
typedef XMotionEvent XPointerMovedEvent; │__

These structures have the following common members: window, root, subwindow, time, x, y, x_root, y_root, state, and same_screen. The window member is set to the window on which the event was generated and is referred to as the event window. As long as the conditions previously discussed are met, this is the window used by the X server to report the event. The root member is set to the source window’s root window. The x_root and y_root members are set to the pointer’s coordinates relative to the root window’s origin at the time of the event.

The same_screen member is set to indicate whether the event window is on the same screen as the root window and can be either True or False. If True, the event and root windows are on the same screen. If False, the event and root windows are not on the same screen.

If the source window is an inferior of the event window, the subwindow member of the structure is set to the child of the event window that is the source window or the child of the event window that is an ancestor of the source window. Otherwise, the X server sets the subwindow member to None. The time member is set to the time when the event was generated and is expressed in milliseconds.

If the event window is on the same screen as the root window, the x and y members are set to the coordinates relative to the event window’s origin. Otherwise, these members are set to zero.

The state member is set to indicate the logical state of the pointer buttons and modifier keys just prior to the event, which is the bitwise inclusive OR of one or more of the button or modifier key masks: Button1Mask, Button2Mask, Button3Mask, Button4Mask, Button5Mask, ShiftMask, LockMask, ControlMask, Mod1Mask, Mod2Mask, Mod3Mask, Mod4Mask, and Mod5Mask.

Each of these structures also has a member that indicates the detail. For the XKeyPressedEvent and XKeyReleasedEvent structures, this member is called a keycode. It is set to a number that represents a physical key on the keyboard. The keycode is an arbitrary representation for any key on the keyboard (see sections 12.7 and 16.1).

For the XButtonPressedEvent and XButtonReleasedEvent structures, this member is called button. It represents the pointer button that changed state and can be the Button1, Button2, Button3, Button4, or Button5 value. For the XPointerMovedEvent structure, this member is called is_hint. It can be set to NotifyNormal or NotifyHint.

Some of the symbols mentioned in this section have fixed values, as follows:
Symbol Value
Button1MotionMask

(1L<<8)
Button2MotionMask

(1L<<9)
Button3MotionMask

(1L<<10)
Button4MotionMask

(1L<<11)
Button5MotionMask

(1L<<12)
Button1Mask

(1<<8)
Button2Mask

(1<<9)
Button3Mask

(1<<10)
Button4Mask

(1<<11)
Button5Mask

(1<<12)
ShiftMask

(1<<0)
LockMask

(1<<1)
ControlMask

(1<<2)
Mod1Mask

(1<<3)
Mod2Mask

(1<<4)
Mod3Mask

(1<<5)
Mod4Mask

(1<<6)
Mod5Mask

(1<<7)
Button1

1
Button2

2
Button3

3
Button4

4
Button5

5

10.6. Window Entry/Exit Events

This section describes the processing that occurs for the window crossing events EnterNotify and LeaveNotify. If a pointer motion or a window hierarchy change causes the pointer to be in a different window than before, the X server reports EnterNotify or LeaveNotify events to clients who have selected for these events. All EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events caused by a hierarchy change are generated after any hierarchy event (UnmapNotify, MapNotify, ConfigureNotify, GravityNotify, CirculateNotify) caused by that change; however, the X protocol does not constrain the ordering of EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events with respect to FocusOut, VisibilityNotify, and Expose events.

This contrasts with MotionNotify events, which are also generated when the pointer moves but only when the pointer motion begins and ends in a single window. An EnterNotify or LeaveNotify event also can be generated when some client application calls XGrabPointer and XUngrabPointer.

To receive EnterNotify or LeaveNotify events, set the EnterWindowMask or LeaveWindowMask bits of the event-mask attribute of the window.

The structure for these event types contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* EnterNotify or LeaveNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

/* ‘‘event’’ window reported relative to */

Window root;

/* root window that the event occurred on */

Window subwindow;

/* child window */

Time time;

/* milliseconds */

int x, y;

/* pointer x, y coordinates in event window */

int x_root, y_root;

/* coordinates relative to root */

int mode;

/* NotifyNormal, NotifyGrab, NotifyUngrab */

int detail;

/*

* NotifyAncestor, NotifyVirtual, NotifyInferior,

* NotifyNonlinear,NotifyNonlinearVirtual

*/

Bool same_screen;

/* same screen flag */

Bool focus;

/* boolean focus */

unsigned int state;

/* key or button mask */

} XCrossingEvent;
typedef XCrossingEvent XEnterWindowEvent;
typedef XCrossingEvent XLeaveWindowEvent; │__

The window member is set to the window on which the EnterNotify or LeaveNotify event was generated and is referred to as the event window. This is the window used by the X server to report the event, and is relative to the root window on which the event occurred. The root member is set to the root window of the screen on which the event occurred.

For a LeaveNotify event, if a child of the event window contains the initial position of the pointer, the subwindow component is set to that child. Otherwise, the X server sets the subwindow member to None. For an EnterNotify event, if a child of the event window contains the final pointer position, the subwindow component is set to that child or None.

The time member is set to the time when the event was generated and is expressed in milliseconds. The x and y members are set to the coordinates of the pointer position in the event window. This position is always the pointer’s final position, not its initial position. If the event window is on the same screen as the root window, x and y are the pointer coordinates relative to the event window’s origin. Otherwise, x and y are set to zero. The x_root and y_root members are set to the pointer’s coordinates relative to the root window’s origin at the time of the event.

The same_screen member is set to indicate whether the event window is on the same screen as the root window and can be either True or False. If True, the event and root windows are on the same screen. If False, the event and root windows are not on the same screen.

The focus member is set to indicate whether the event window is the focus window or an inferior of the focus window. The X server can set this member to either True or False. If True, the event window is the focus window or an inferior of the focus window. If False, the event window is not the focus window or an inferior of the focus window.

The state member is set to indicate the state of the pointer buttons and modifier keys just prior to the event. The X server can set this member to the bitwise inclusive OR of one or more of the button or modifier key masks: Button1Mask, Button2Mask, Button3Mask, Button4Mask, Button5Mask, ShiftMask, LockMask, ControlMask, Mod1Mask, Mod2Mask, Mod3Mask, Mod4Mask, Mod5Mask.

The mode member is set to indicate whether the events are normal events, pseudo-motion events when a grab activates, or pseudo-motion events when a grab deactivates. The X server can set this member to NotifyNormal, NotifyGrab, or NotifyUngrab.

The detail member is set to indicate the notify detail and can be NotifyAncestor, NotifyVirtual, NotifyInferior, NotifyNonlinear, or NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

10.6.1. Normal Entry/Exit Events

EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events are generated when the pointer moves from one window to another window. Normal events are identified by XEnterWindowEvent or XLeaveWindowEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyNormal.

When the pointer moves from window A to window B and A is an inferior of B, the X server does the following:

It generates a LeaveNotify event on window A, with the detail member of the XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyAncestor.

It generates a LeaveNotify event on each window between window A and window B, exclusive, with the detail member of each XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyVirtual.

It generates an EnterNotify event on window B, with the detail member of the XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyInferior.

When the pointer moves from window A to window B and B is an inferior of A, the X server does the following:

− It generates a LeaveNotify event on window A, with the detail member of the XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyInferior.

− It generates an EnterNotify event on each window between window A and window B, exclusive, with the detail member of each XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyVirtual.

− It generates an EnterNotify event on window B, with the detail member of the XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyAncestor.

When the pointer moves from window A to window B and window C is their least common ancestor, the X server does the following:

− It generates a LeaveNotify event on window A, with the detail member of the XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− It generates a LeaveNotify event on each window between window A and window C, exclusive, with the detail member of each XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates an EnterNotify event on each window between window C and window B, exclusive, with the detail member of each XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates an EnterNotify event on window B, with the detail member of the XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

When the pointer moves from window A to window B on different screens, the X server does the following:

− It generates a LeaveNotify event on window A, with the detail member of the XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− If window A is not a root window, it generates a LeaveNotify event on each window above window A up to and including its root, with the detail member of each XLeaveWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− If window B is not a root window, it generates an EnterNotify event on each window from window B’s root down to but not including window B, with the detail member of each XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates an EnterNotify event on window B, with the detail member of the XEnterWindowEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

10.6.2. Grab and Ungrab Entry/Exit Events

Pseudo-motion mode EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events are generated when a pointer grab activates or deactivates. Events in which the pointer grab activates are identified by XEnterWindowEvent or XLeaveWindowEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyGrab. Events in which the pointer grab deactivates are identified by XEnterWindowEvent or XLeaveWindowEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyUngrab (see XGrabPointer).

When a pointer grab activates after any initial warp into a confine_to window and before generating any actual ButtonPress event that activates the grab, G is the grab_window for the grab, and P is the window the pointer is in, the X server does the following:

It generates EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events (see section 10.6.1) with the mode members of the XEnterWindowEvent and XLeaveWindowEvent structures set to NotifyGrab. These events are generated as if the pointer were to suddenly warp from its current position in P to some position in G. However, the pointer does not warp, and the X server uses the pointer position as both the initial and final positions for the events.

When a pointer grab deactivates after generating any actual ButtonRelease event that deactivates the grab, G is the grab_window for the grab, and P is the window the pointer is in, the X server does the following:

It generates EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events (see section 10.6.1) with the mode members of the XEnterWindowEvent and XLeaveWindowEvent structures set to NotifyUngrab. These events are generated as if the pointer were to suddenly warp from some position in G to its current position in P. However, the pointer does not warp, and the X server uses the current pointer position as both the initial and final positions for the events.

10.7. Input Focus Events

This section describes the processing that occurs for the input focus events FocusIn and FocusOut. The X server can report FocusIn or FocusOut events to clients wanting information about when the input focus changes. The keyboard is always attached to some window (typically, the root window or a top-level window), which is called the focus window. The focus window and the position of the pointer determine the window that receives keyboard input. Clients may need to know when the input focus changes to control highlighting of areas on the screen.

To receive FocusIn or FocusOut events, set the FocusChangeMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window.

The structure for these event types contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* FocusIn or FocusOut */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

/* window of event */

int mode;

/* NotifyNormal, NotifyGrab, NotifyUngrab */

int detail;

/*

* NotifyAncestor, NotifyVirtual, NotifyInferior,

* NotifyNonlinear,NotifyNonlinearVirtual, NotifyPointer,

* NotifyPointerRoot, NotifyDetailNone

*/

} XFocusChangeEvent;
typedef XFocusChangeEvent XFocusInEvent;
typedef XFocusChangeEvent XFocusOutEvent; │__

The window member is set to the window on which the FocusIn or FocusOut event was generated. This is the window used by the X server to report the event. The mode member is set to indicate whether the focus events are normal focus events, focus events while grabbed, focus events when a grab activates, or focus events when a grab deactivates. The X server can set the mode member to NotifyNormal, NotifyWhileGrabbed, NotifyGrab, or NotifyUngrab.

All FocusOut events caused by a window unmap are generated after any UnmapNotify event; however, the X protocol does not constrain the ordering of FocusOut events with respect to generated EnterNotify, LeaveNotify, VisibilityNotify, and Expose events.

Depending on the event mode, the detail member is set to indicate the notify detail and can be NotifyAncestor, NotifyVirtual, NotifyInferior, NotifyNonlinear, NotifyNonlinearVirtual, NotifyPointer, NotifyPointerRoot, or NotifyDetailNone.

10.7.1. Normal Focus Events and Focus Events While Grabbed

Normal focus events are identified by XFocusInEvent or XFocusOutEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyNormal. Focus events while grabbed are identified by XFocusInEvent or XFocusOutEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyWhileGrabbed. The X server processes normal focus and focus events while grabbed according to the following:

When the focus moves from window A to window B, A is an inferior of B, and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

It generates a FocusOut event on window A, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyAncestor.

It generates a FocusOut event on each window between window A and window B, exclusive, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyVirtual.

It generates a FocusIn event on window B, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyInferior.

If window P is an inferior of window B but window P is not window A or an inferior or ancestor of window A, it generates a FocusIn event on each window below window B, down to and including window P, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

When the focus moves from window A to window B, B is an inferior of A, and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

− If window P is an inferior of window A but P is not an inferior of window B or an ancestor of B, it generates a FocusOut event on each window from window P up to but not including window A, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

− It generates a FocusOut event on window A, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyInferior.

− It generates a FocusIn event on each window between window A and window B, exclusive, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyVirtual.

− It generates a FocusIn event on window B, with the detail member of the XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyAncestor.

When the focus moves from window A to window B, window C is their least common ancestor, and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

− If window P is an inferior of window A, it generates a FocusOut event on each window from window P up to but not including window A, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

− It generates a FocusOut event on window A, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− It generates a FocusOut event on each window between window A and window C, exclusive, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates a FocusIn event on each window between C and B, exclusive, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates a FocusIn event on window B, with the detail member of the XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− If window P is an inferior of window B, it generates a FocusIn event on each window below window B down to and including window P, with the detail member of the XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

When the focus moves from window A to window B on different screens and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

− If window P is an inferior of window A, it generates a FocusOut event on each window from window P up to but not including window A, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

− It generates a FocusOut event on window A, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− If window A is not a root window, it generates a FocusOut event on each window above window A up to and including its root, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− If window B is not a root window, it generates a FocusIn event on each window from window B’s root down to but not including window B, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates a FocusIn event on window B, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− If window P is an inferior of window B, it generates a FocusIn event on each window below window B down to and including window P, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

When the focus moves from window A to PointerRoot (events sent to the window under the pointer) or None (discard), and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

− If window P is an inferior of window A, it generates a FocusOut event on each window from window P up to but not including window A, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

− It generates a FocusOut event on window A, with the detail member of the XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− If window A is not a root window, it generates a FocusOut event on each window above window A up to and including its root, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates a FocusIn event on the root window of all screens, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointerRoot (or NotifyDetailNone).

− If the new focus is PointerRoot, it generates a FocusIn event on each window from window P’s root down to and including window P, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

When the focus moves from PointerRoot (events sent to the window under the pointer) or None to window A, and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

− If the old focus is PointerRoot, it generates a FocusOut event on each window from window P up to and including window P’s root, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

− It generates a FocusOut event on all root windows, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointerRoot (or NotifyDetailNone).

− If window A is not a root window, it generates a FocusIn event on each window from window A’s root down to but not including window A, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinearVirtual.

− It generates a FocusIn event on window A, with the detail member of the XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyNonlinear.

− If window P is an inferior of window A, it generates a FocusIn event on each window below window A down to and including window P, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

When the focus moves from PointerRoot (events sent to the window under the pointer) to None (or vice versa), and the pointer is in window P, the X server does the following:

− If the old focus is PointerRoot, it generates a FocusOut event on each window from window P up to and including window P’s root, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

− It generates a FocusOut event on all root windows, with the detail member of each XFocusOutEvent structure set to either NotifyPointerRoot or NotifyDetailNone.

− It generates a FocusIn event on all root windows, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyDetailNone or NotifyPointerRoot.

− If the new focus is PointerRoot, it generates a FocusIn event on each window from window P’s root down to and including window P, with the detail member of each XFocusInEvent structure set to NotifyPointer.

10.7.2. Focus Events Generated by Grabs

Focus events in which the keyboard grab activates are identified by XFocusInEvent or XFocusOutEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyGrab. Focus events in which the keyboard grab deactivates are identified by XFocusInEvent or XFocusOutEvent structures whose mode member is set to NotifyUngrab (see XGrabKeyboard).

When a keyboard grab activates before generating any actual KeyPress event that activates the grab, G is the grab_window, and F is the current focus, the X server does the following:

It generates FocusIn and FocusOut events, with the mode members of the XFocusInEvent and XFocusOutEvent structures set to NotifyGrab. These events are generated as if the focus were to change from F to G.

When a keyboard grab deactivates after generating any actual KeyRelease event that deactivates the grab, G is the grab_window, and F is the current focus, the X server does the following:

It generates FocusIn and FocusOut events, with the mode members of the XFocusInEvent and XFocusOutEvent structures set to NotifyUngrab. These events are generated as if the focus were to change from G to F.

10.8. Key Map State Notification Events

The X server can report KeymapNotify events to clients that want information about changes in their keyboard state.

To receive KeymapNotify events, set the KeymapStateMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window. The X server generates this event immediately after every EnterNotify and FocusIn event.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

/* generated on EnterWindow and FocusIn when KeymapState selected */
typedef struct {

int type;

/* KeymapNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

char key_vector[32];

} XKeymapEvent;

│__

The window member is not used but is present to aid some toolkits. The key_vector member is set to the bit vector of the keyboard. Each bit set to 1 indicates that the corresponding key is currently pressed. The vector is represented as 32 bytes. Byte N (from 0) contains the bits for keys 8N to 8N + 7 with the least significant bit in the byte representing key 8N.

10.9. Exposure Events

The X protocol does not guarantee to preserve the contents of window regions when the windows are obscured or reconfigured. Some implementations may preserve the contents of windows. Other implementations are free to destroy the contents of windows when exposed. X expects client applications to assume the responsibility for restoring the contents of an exposed window region. (An exposed window region describes a formerly obscured window whose region becomes visible.) Therefore, the X server sends Expose events describing the window and the region of the window that has been exposed. A naive client application usually redraws the entire window. A more sophisticated client application redraws only the exposed region.

10.9.1. Expose Events

The X server can report Expose events to clients wanting information about when the contents of window regions have been lost. The circumstances in which the X server generates Expose events are not as definite as those for other events. However, the X server never generates Expose events on windows whose class you specified as InputOnly. The X server can generate Expose events when no valid contents are available for regions of a window and either the regions are visible, the regions are viewable and the server is (perhaps newly) maintaining backing store on the window, or the window is not viewable but the server is (perhaps newly) honoring the window’s backing-store attribute of Always or WhenMapped. The regions decompose into an (arbitrary) set of rectangles, and an Expose event is generated for each rectangle. For any given window, the X server guarantees to report contiguously all of the regions exposed by some action that causes Expose events, such as raising a window.

To receive Expose events, set the ExposureMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* Expose */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

int x, y;

int width, height;

int count;

/* if nonzero, at least this many more */

} XExposeEvent; │__

The window member is set to the exposed (damaged) window. The x and y members are set to the coordinates relative to the window’s origin and indicate the upper-left corner of the rectangle. The width and height members are set to the size (extent) of the rectangle. The count member is set to the number of Expose events that are to follow. If count is zero, no more Expose events follow for this window. However, if count is nonzero, at least that number of Expose events (and possibly more) follow for this window. Simple applications that do not want to optimize redisplay by distinguishing between subareas of its window can just ignore all Expose events with nonzero counts and perform full redisplays on events with zero counts.

10.9.2. GraphicsExpose and NoExpose Events

The X server can report GraphicsExpose events to clients wanting information about when a destination region could not be computed during certain graphics requests: XCopyArea or XCopyPlane. The X server generates this event whenever a destination region could not be computed because of an obscured or out-of-bounds source region. In addition, the X server guarantees to report contiguously all of the regions exposed by some graphics request (for example, copying an area of a drawable to a destination drawable).

The X server generates a NoExpose event whenever a graphics request that might produce a GraphicsExpose event does not produce any. In other words, the client is really asking for a GraphicsExpose event but instead receives a NoExpose event.

To receive GraphicsExpose or NoExpose events, you must first set the graphics-exposure attribute of the graphics context to True. You also can set the graphics-expose attribute when creating a graphics context using XCreateGC or by calling XSetGraphicsExposures.

The structures for these event types contain: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* GraphicsExpose */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Drawable drawable;

int x, y;

int width, height;

int count;

/* if nonzero, at least this many more */

int major_code;

/* core is CopyArea or CopyPlane */

int minor_code;

/* not defined in the core */

} XGraphicsExposeEvent;

typedef struct {

int type;

/* NoExpose */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Drawable drawable;

int major_code;

/* core is CopyArea or CopyPlane */

int minor_code;

/* not defined in the core */

} XNoExposeEvent; │__

Both structures have these common members: drawable, major_code, and minor_code. The drawable member is set to the drawable of the destination region on which the graphics request was to be performed. The major_code member is set to the graphics request initiated by the client and can be either X_CopyArea or X_CopyPlane. If it is X_CopyArea, a call to XCopyArea initiated the request. If it is X_CopyPlane, a call to XCopyPlane initiated the request. These constants are defined in <X11/Xproto.h>. The minor_code member, like the major_code member, indicates which graphics request was initiated by the client. However, the minor_code member is not defined by the core X protocol and will be zero in these cases, although it may be used by an extension.

The XGraphicsExposeEvent structure has these additional members: x, y, width, height, and count. The x and y members are set to the coordinates relative to the drawable’s origin and indicate the upper-left corner of the rectangle. The width and height members are set to the size (extent) of the rectangle. The count member is set to the number of GraphicsExpose events to follow. If count is zero, no more GraphicsExpose events follow for this window. However, if count is nonzero, at least that number of GraphicsExpose events (and possibly more) are to follow for this window.

10.10. Window State Change Events

The following sections discuss:

CirculateNotify events

ConfigureNotify events

CreateNotify events

DestroyNotify events

GravityNotify events

MapNotify events

MappingNotify events

ReparentNotify events

UnmapNotify events

VisibilityNotify events

10.10.1. CirculateNotify Events

The X server can report CirculateNotify events to clients wanting information about when a window changes its position in the stack. The X server generates this event type whenever a window is actually restacked as a result of a client application calling XCirculateSubwindows, XCirculateSubwindowsUp, or XCirculateSubwindowsDown.

To receive CirculateNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the parent window (in which case, circulating any child generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* CirculateNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

int place;

/* PlaceOnTop, PlaceOnBottom */

} XCirculateEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the restacked window or to its parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. The window member is set to the window that was restacked. The place member is set to the window’s position after the restack occurs and is either PlaceOnTop or PlaceOnBottom. If it is PlaceOnTop, the window is now on top of all siblings. If it is PlaceOnBottom, the window is now below all siblings.

10.10.2. ConfigureNotify Events

The X server can report ConfigureNotify events to clients wanting information about actual changes to a window’s state, such as size, position, border, and stacking order. The X server generates this event type whenever one of the following configure window requests made by a client application actually completes:

A window’s size, position, border, and/or stacking order is reconfigured by calling XConfigureWindow.

The window’s position in the stacking order is changed by calling XLowerWindow, XRaiseWindow, or XRestackWindows.

A window is moved by calling XMoveWindow.

A window’s size is changed by calling XResizeWindow.

A window’s size and location is changed by calling XMoveResizeWindow.

A window is mapped and its position in the stacking order is changed by calling XMapRaised.

A window’s border width is changed by calling XSetWindowBorderWidth.

To receive ConfigureNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the parent window (in which case, configuring any child generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ConfigureNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

int x, y;

int width, height;

int border_width;

Window above;

Bool override_redirect;

} XConfigureEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the reconfigured window or to its parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. The window member is set to the window whose size, position, border, and/or stacking order was changed.

The x and y members are set to the coordinates relative to the parent window’s origin and indicate the position of the upper-left outside corner of the window. The width and height members are set to the inside size of the window, not including the border. The border_width member is set to the width of the window’s border, in pixels.

The above member is set to the sibling window and is used for stacking operations. If the X server sets this member to None, the window whose state was changed is on the bottom of the stack with respect to sibling windows. However, if this member is set to a sibling window, the window whose state was changed is placed on top of this sibling window.

The override_redirect member is set to the override-redirect attribute of the window. Window manager clients normally should ignore this window if the override_redirect member is True.

10.10.3. CreateNotify Events

The X server can report CreateNotify events to clients wanting information about creation of windows. The X server generates this event whenever a client application creates a window by calling XCreateWindow or XCreateSimpleWindow.

To receive CreateNotify events, set the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window. Creating any children then generates an event.

The structure for the event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* CreateNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window parent;

/* parent of the window */

Window window;

/* window id of window created */

int x, y;

/* window location */

int width, height;

/* size of window */

int border_width;

/* border width */

Bool override_redirect;

/* creation should be overridden */

} XCreateWindowEvent; │__

The parent member is set to the created window’s parent. The window member specifies the created window. The x and y members are set to the created window’s coordinates relative to the parent window’s origin and indicate the position of the upper-left outside corner of the created window. The width and height members are set to the inside size of the created window (not including the border) and are always nonzero. The border_width member is set to the width of the created window’s border, in pixels. The override_redirect member is set to the override-redirect attribute of the window. Window manager clients normally should ignore this window if the override_redirect member is True.

10.10.4. DestroyNotify Events

The X server can report DestroyNotify events to clients wanting information about which windows are destroyed. The X server generates this event whenever a client application destroys a window by calling XDestroyWindow or XDestroySubwindows.

The ordering of the DestroyNotify events is such that for any given window, DestroyNotify is generated on all inferiors of the window before being generated on the window itself. The X protocol does not constrain the ordering among siblings and across subhierarchies.

To receive DestroyNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the parent window (in which case, destroying any child generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* DestroyNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

} XDestroyWindowEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the destroyed window or to its parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. The window member is set to the window that is destroyed.

10.10.5. GravityNotify Events

The X server can report GravityNotify events to clients wanting information about when a window is moved because of a change in the size of its parent. The X server generates this event whenever a client application actually moves a child window as a result of resizing its parent by calling XConfigureWindow, XMoveResizeWindow, or XResizeWindow.

To receive GravityNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the parent window (in which case, any child that is moved because its parent has been resized generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* GravityNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

int x, y;

} XGravityEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the window that was moved or to its parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. The window member is set to the child window that was moved. The x and y members are set to the coordinates relative to the new parent window’s origin and indicate the position of the upper-left outside corner of the window.

10.10.6. MapNotify Events

The X server can report MapNotify events to clients wanting information about which windows are mapped. The X server generates this event type whenever a client application changes the window’s state from unmapped to mapped by calling XMapWindow, XMapRaised, XMapSubwindows, XReparentWindow, or as a result of save-set processing.

To receive MapNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the parent window (in which case, mapping any child generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* MapNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

Bool override_redirect;

/* boolean, is override set... */

} XMapEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the window that was mapped or to its parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. The window member is set to the window that was mapped. The override_redirect member is set to the override-redirect attribute of the window. Window manager clients normally should ignore this window if the override-redirect attribute is True, because these events usually are generated from pop-ups, which override structure control.

10.10.7. MappingNotify Events

The X server reports MappingNotify events to all clients. There is no mechanism to express disinterest in this event. The X server generates this event type whenever a client application successfully calls:

XSetModifierMapping to indicate which KeyCodes are to be used as modifiers

XChangeKeyboardMapping to change the keyboard mapping

XSetPointerMapping to set the pointer mapping

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* MappingNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

/* unused */

int request;

/* one of MappingModifier, MappingKeyboard,

MappingPointer */

int first_keycode;

/* first keycode */

int count;

/* defines range of change w. first_keycode*/

} XMappingEvent; │__

The request member is set to indicate the kind of mapping change that occurred and can be MappingModifier, MappingKeyboard, or MappingPointer. If it is MappingModifier, the modifier mapping was changed. If it is MappingKeyboard, the keyboard mapping was changed. If it is MappingPointer, the pointer button mapping was changed. The first_keycode and count members are set only if the request member was set to MappingKeyboard. The number in first_keycode represents the first number in the range of the altered mapping, and count represents the number of keycodes altered.

To update the client application’s knowledge of the keyboard, you should call XRefreshKeyboardMapping.

10.10.8. ReparentNotify Events

The X server can report ReparentNotify events to clients wanting information about changing a window’s parent. The X server generates this event whenever a client application calls XReparentWindow and the window is actually reparented.

To receive ReparentNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of either the old or the new parent window (in which case, reparenting any child generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ReparentNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

Window parent;

int x, y;

Bool override_redirect;

} XReparentEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the reparented window or to the old or the new parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. The window member is set to the window that was reparented. The parent member is set to the new parent window. The x and y members are set to the reparented window’s coordinates relative to the new parent window’s origin and define the upper-left outer corner of the reparented window. The override_redirect member is set to the override-redirect attribute of the window specified by the window member. Window manager clients normally should ignore this window if the override_redirect member is True.

10.10.9. UnmapNotify Events

The X server can report UnmapNotify events to clients wanting information about which windows are unmapped. The X server generates this event type whenever a client application changes the window’s state from mapped to unmapped.

To receive UnmapNotify events, set the StructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window or the SubstructureNotifyMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the parent window (in which case, unmapping any child window generates an event).

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* UnmapNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window event;

Window window;

Bool from_configure;

} XUnmapEvent; │__

The event member is set either to the unmapped window or to its parent, depending on whether StructureNotify or SubstructureNotify was selected. This is the window used by the X server to report the event. The window member is set to the window that was unmapped. The from_configure member is set to True if the event was generated as a result of a resizing of the window’s parent when the window itself had a win_gravity of UnmapGravity.

10.10.10. VisibilityNotify Events

The X server can report VisibilityNotify events to clients wanting any change in the visibility of the specified window. A region of a window is visible if someone looking at the screen can actually see it. The X server generates this event whenever the visibility changes state. However, this event is never generated for windows whose class is InputOnly.

All VisibilityNotify events caused by a hierarchy change are generated after any hierarchy event (UnmapNotify, MapNotify, ConfigureNotify, GravityNotify, CirculateNotify) caused by that change. Any VisibilityNotify event on a given window is generated before any Expose events on that window, but it is not required that all VisibilityNotify events on all windows be generated before all Expose events on all windows. The X protocol does not constrain the ordering of VisibilityNotify events with respect to FocusOut, EnterNotify, and LeaveNotify events.

To receive VisibilityNotify events, set the VisibilityChangeMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* VisibilityNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

int state;

} XVisibilityEvent; │__

The window member is set to the window whose visibility state changes. The state member is set to the state of the window’s visibility and can be VisibilityUnobscured, VisibilityPartiallyObscured, or VisibilityFullyObscured. The X server ignores all of a window’s subwindows when determining the visibility state of the window and processes VisibilityNotify events according to the following:

When the window changes state from partially obscured, fully obscured, or not viewable to viewable and completely unobscured, the X server generates the event with the state member of the XVisibilityEvent structure set to VisibilityUnobscured.

When the window changes state from viewable and completely unobscured or not viewable to viewable and partially obscured, the X server generates the event with the state member of the XVisibilityEvent structure set to VisibilityPartiallyObscured.

When the window changes state from viewable and completely unobscured, viewable and partially obscured, or not viewable to viewable and fully obscured, the X server generates the event with the state member of the XVisibilityEvent structure set to VisibilityFullyObscured.

10.11. Structure Control Events

This section discusses:

CirculateRequest events

ConfigureRequest events

MapRequest events

ResizeRequest events

10.11.1. CirculateRequest Events

The X server can report CirculateRequest events to clients wanting information about when another client initiates a circulate window request on a specified window. The X server generates this event type whenever a client initiates a circulate window request on a window and a subwindow actually needs to be restacked. The client initiates a circulate window request on the window by calling XCirculateSubwindows, XCirculateSubwindowsUp, or XCirculateSubwindowsDown.

To receive CirculateRequest events, set the SubstructureRedirectMask in the event-mask attribute of the window. Then, in the future, the circulate window request for the specified window is not executed, and thus, any subwindow’s position in the stack is not changed. For example, suppose a client application calls XCirculateSubwindowsUp to raise a subwindow to the top of the stack. If you had selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the window, the X server reports to you a CirculateRequest event and does not raise the subwindow to the top of the stack.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* CirculateRequest */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window parent;

Window window;

int place;

/* PlaceOnTop, PlaceOnBottom */

} XCirculateRequestEvent; │__

The parent member is set to the parent window. The window member is set to the subwindow to be restacked. The place member is set to what the new position in the stacking order should be and is either PlaceOnTop or PlaceOnBottom. If it is PlaceOnTop, the subwindow should be on top of all siblings. If it is PlaceOnBottom, the subwindow should be below all siblings.

10.11.2. ConfigureRequest Events

The X server can report ConfigureRequest events to clients wanting information about when a different client initiates a configure window request on any child of a specified window. The configure window request attempts to reconfigure a window’s size, position, border, and stacking order. The X server generates this event whenever a different client initiates a configure window request on a window by calling XConfigureWindow, XLowerWindow, XRaiseWindow, XMapRaised, XMoveResizeWindow, XMoveWindow, XResizeWindow, XRestackWindows, or XSetWindowBorderWidth.

To receive ConfigureRequest events, set the SubstructureRedirectMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window. ConfigureRequest events are generated when a ConfigureWindow protocol request is issued on a child window by another client. For example, suppose a client application calls XLowerWindow to lower a window. If you had selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent window and if the override-redirect attribute of the window is set to False, the X server reports a ConfigureRequest event to you and does not lower the specified window.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ConfigureRequest */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window parent;

Window window;

int x, y;

int width, height;

int border_width;

Window above;

int detail;

/* Above, Below, TopIf, BottomIf, Opposite */

unsigned long value_mask;

} XConfigureRequestEvent; │__

The parent member is set to the parent window. The window member is set to the window whose size, position, border width, and/or stacking order is to be reconfigured. The value_mask member indicates which components were specified in the ConfigureWindow protocol request. The corresponding values are reported as given in the request. The remaining values are filled in from the current geometry of the window, except in the case of above (sibling) and detail (stack-mode), which are reported as None and Above, respectively, if they are not given in the request.

10.11.3. MapRequest Events

The X server can report MapRequest events to clients wanting information about a different client’s desire to map windows. A window is considered mapped when a map window request completes. The X server generates this event whenever a different client initiates a map window request on an unmapped window whose override_redirect member is set to False. Clients initiate map window requests by calling XMapWindow, XMapRaised, or XMapSubwindows.

To receive MapRequest events, set the SubstructureRedirectMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window. This means another client’s attempts to map a child window by calling one of the map window request functions is intercepted, and you are sent a MapRequest instead. For example, suppose a client application calls XMapWindow to map a window. If you (usually a window manager) had selected SubstructureRedirectMask on the parent window and if the override-redirect attribute of the window is set to False, the X server reports a MapRequest event to you and does not map the specified window. Thus, this event gives your window manager client the ability to control the placement of subwindows.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* MapRequest */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window parent;

Window window;

} XMapRequestEvent; │__

The parent member is set to the parent window. The window member is set to the window to be mapped.

10.11.4. ResizeRequest Events

The X server can report ResizeRequest events to clients wanting information about another client’s attempts to change the size of a window. The X server generates this event whenever some other client attempts to change the size of the specified window by calling XConfigureWindow, XResizeWindow, or XMoveResizeWindow.

To receive ResizeRequest events, set the ResizeRedirect bit in the event-mask attribute of the window. Any attempts to change the size by other clients are then redirected.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ResizeRequest */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

int width, height;

} XResizeRequestEvent; │__

The window member is set to the window whose size another client attempted to change. The width and height members are set to the inside size of the window, excluding the border.

10.12. Colormap State Change Events

The X server can report ColormapNotify events to clients wanting information about when the colormap changes and when a colormap is installed or uninstalled. The X server generates this event type whenever a client application:

Changes the colormap member of the XSetWindowAttributes structure by calling XChangeWindowAttributes, XFreeColormap, or XSetWindowColormap

Installs or uninstalls the colormap by calling XInstallColormap or XUninstallColormap

To receive ColormapNotify events, set the ColormapChangeMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ColormapNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

Colormap colormap;

/* colormap or None */

Bool new;

int state;

/* ColormapInstalled, ColormapUninstalled */

} XColormapEvent; │__

The window member is set to the window whose associated colormap is changed, installed, or uninstalled. For a colormap that is changed, installed, or uninstalled, the colormap member is set to the colormap associated with the window. For a colormap that is changed by a call to XFreeColormap, the colormap member is set to None. The new member is set to indicate whether the colormap for the specified window was changed or installed or uninstalled and can be True or False. If it is True, the colormap was changed. If it is False, the colormap was installed or uninstalled. The state member is always set to indicate whether the colormap is installed or uninstalled and can be ColormapInstalled or ColormapUninstalled.

10.13. Client Communication Events

This section discusses:

ClientMessage events

PropertyNotify events

SelectionClear events

SelectionNotify events

SelectionRequest events

10.13.1. ClientMessage Events

The X server generates ClientMessage events only when a client calls the function XSendEvent.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* ClientMessage */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

Atom message_type;

int format;

union {

char b[20];

short s[10];

long l[5];

} data;

} XClientMessageEvent; │__

The message_type member is set to an atom that indicates how the data should be interpreted by the receiving client. The format member is set to 8, 16, or 32 and specifies whether the data should be viewed as a list of bytes, shorts, or longs. The data member is a union that contains the members b, s, and l. The b, s, and l members represent data of twenty 8-bit values, ten 16-bit values, and five 32-bit values. Particular message types might not make use of all these values. The X server places no interpretation on the values in the window, message_type, or data members.

10.13.2. PropertyNotify Events

The X server can report PropertyNotify events to clients wanting information about property changes for a specified window.

To receive PropertyNotify events, set the PropertyChangeMask bit in the event-mask attribute of the window.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* PropertyNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

Atom atom;

Time time;

int state;

/* PropertyNewValue or PropertyDelete */

} XPropertyEvent; │__

The window member is set to the window whose associated property was changed. The atom member is set to the property’s atom and indicates which property was changed or desired. The time member is set to the server time when the property was changed. The state member is set to indicate whether the property was changed to a new value or deleted and can be PropertyNewValue or PropertyDelete. The state member is set to PropertyNewValue when a property of the window is changed using XChangeProperty or XRotateWindowProperties (even when adding zero-length data using XChangeProperty) and when replacing all or part of a property with identical data using XChangeProperty or XRotateWindowProperties. The state member is set to PropertyDelete when a property of the window is deleted using XDeleteProperty or, if the delete argument is True, XGetWindowProperty.

10.13.3. SelectionClear Events

The X server reports SelectionClear events to the client losing ownership of a selection. The X server generates this event type when another client asserts ownership of the selection by calling XSetSelectionOwner.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* SelectionClear */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window window;

Atom selection;

Time time;

} XSelectionClearEvent; │__

The selection member is set to the selection atom. The time member is set to the last change time recorded for the selection. The window member is the window that was specified by the current owner (the owner losing the selection) in its XSetSelectionOwner call.

10.13.4. SelectionRequest Events

The X server reports SelectionRequest events to the owner of a selection. The X server generates this event whenever a client requests a selection conversion by calling XConvertSelection for the owned selection.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* SelectionRequest */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window owner;

Window requestor;

Atom selection;

Atom target;

Atom property;

Time time;

} XSelectionRequestEvent; │__

The owner member is set to the window that was specified by the current owner in its XSetSelectionOwner call. The requestor member is set to the window requesting the selection. The selection member is set to the atom that names the selection. For example, PRIMARY is used to indicate the primary selection. The target member is set to the atom that indicates the type the selection is desired in. The property member can be a property name or None. The time member is set to the timestamp or CurrentTime value from the ConvertSelection request.

The owner should convert the selection based on the specified target type and send a SelectionNotify event back to the requestor. A complete specification for using selections is given in the X Consortium standard Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual.

10.13.5. SelectionNotify Events

This event is generated by the X server in response to a ConvertSelection protocol request when there is no owner for the selection. When there is an owner, it should be generated by the owner of the selection by using XSendEvent. The owner of a selection should send this event to a requestor when a selection has been converted and stored as a property or when a selection conversion could not be performed (which is indicated by setting the property member to None).

If None is specified as the property in the ConvertSelection protocol request, the owner should choose a property name, store the result as that property on the requestor window, and then send a SelectionNotify giving that actual property name.

The structure for this event type contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int type;

/* SelectionNotify */

unsigned long serial;

/* # of last request processed by server */

Bool send_event;

/* true if this came from a SendEvent request */

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

Window requestor;

Atom selection;

Atom target;

Atom property;

/* atom or None */

Time time;

} XSelectionEvent; │__

The requestor member is set to the window associated with the requestor of the selection. The selection member is set to the atom that indicates the selection. For example, PRIMARY is used for the primary selection. The target member is set to the atom that indicates the converted type. For example, PIXMAP is used for a pixmap. The property member is set to the atom that indicates which property the result was stored on. If the conversion failed, the property member is set to None. The time member is set to the time the conversion took place and can be a timestamp or CurrentTime.

10

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 11

Event Handling Functions

This chapter discusses the Xlib functions you can use to:

Select events

Handle the output buffer and the event queue

Select events from the event queue

Send and get events

Handle protocol errors

Note

Some toolkits use their own event-handling functions and do not allow you to interchange these event-handling functions with those in Xlib. For further information, see the documentation supplied with the toolkit.

Most applications simply are event loops: they wait for an event, decide what to do with it, execute some amount of code that results in changes to the display, and then wait for the next event.

11.1. Selecting Events

There are two ways to select the events you want reported to your client application. One way is to set the event_mask member of the XSetWindowAttributes structure when you call XCreateWindow and XChangeWindowAttributes. Another way is to use XSelectInput. __ │

XSelectInput(display, w, event_mask)
Display *display;
Window w;
long event_mask;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose events you are inter-

ested in.

event_maskSpecifies the event mask. │__

The XSelectInput function requests that the X server report the events associated with the specified event mask. Initially, X will not report any of these events. Events are reported relative to a window. If a window is not interested in a device event, it usually propagates to the closest ancestor that is interested, unless the do_not_propagate mask prohibits it.

Setting the event-mask attribute of a window overrides any previous call for the same window but not for other clients. Multiple clients can select for the same events on the same window with the following restrictions:

Multiple clients can select events on the same window because their event masks are disjoint. When the X server generates an event, it reports it to all interested clients.

Only one client at a time can select CirculateRequest, ConfigureRequest, or MapRequest events, which are associated with the event mask SubstructureRedirectMask.

Only one client at a time can select a ResizeRequest event, which is associated with the event mask ResizeRedirectMask.

Only one client at a time can select a ButtonPress event, which is associated with the event mask ButtonPressMask.

The server reports the event to all interested clients.

XSelectInput can generate a BadWindow error.

11.2. Handling the Output Buffer

The output buffer is an area used by Xlib to store requests. The functions described in this section flush the output buffer if the function would block or not return an event. That is, all requests residing in the output buffer that have not yet been sent are transmitted to the X server. These functions differ in the additional tasks they might perform.

To flush the output buffer, use XFlush. __ │

XFlush(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XFlush function flushes the output buffer. Most client applications need not use this function because the output buffer is automatically flushed as needed by calls to XPending, XNextEvent, and XWindowEvent. Events generated by the server may be enqueued into the library’s event queue.

To flush the output buffer and then wait until all requests have been processed, use XSync. __ │

XSync(display, discard)
Display *display;
Bool discard;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

discard

Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether

XSync discards all events on the event queue. │__

The XSync function flushes the output buffer and then waits until all requests have been received and processed by the X server. Any errors generated must be handled by the error handler. For each protocol error received by Xlib, XSync calls the client application’s error handling routine (see section 11.8.2). Any events generated by the server are enqueued into the library’s event queue.

Finally, if you passed False, XSync does not discard the events in the queue. If you passed True, XSync discards all events in the queue, including those events that were on the queue before XSync was called. Client applications seldom need to call XSync.

11.3. Event Queue Management

Xlib maintains an event queue. However, the operating system also may be buffering data in its network connection that is not yet read into the event queue.

To check the number of events in the event queue, use XEventsQueued. __ │

int XEventsQueued(display, mode)
Display *display;
int mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

mode

Specifies the mode. You can pass QueuedAlready,

QueuedAfterFlush, or QueuedAfterReading. │__

If mode is QueuedAlready, XEventsQueued returns the number of events already in the event queue (and never performs a system call). If mode is QueuedAfterFlush, XEventsQueued returns the number of events already in the queue if the number is nonzero. If there are no events in the queue, XEventsQueued flushes the output buffer, attempts to read more events out of the application’s connection, and returns the number read. If mode is QueuedAfterReading, XEventsQueued returns the number of events already in the queue if the number is nonzero. If there are no events in the queue, XEventsQueued attempts to read more events out of the application’s connection without flushing the output buffer and returns the number read.

XEventsQueued always returns immediately without I/O if there are events already in the queue. XEventsQueued with mode QueuedAfterFlush is identical in behavior to XPending. XEventsQueued with mode QueuedAlready is identical to the XQLength function.

To return the number of events that are pending, use XPending. __ │

int XPending(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XPending function returns the number of events that have been received from the X server but have not been removed from the event queue. XPending is identical to XEventsQueued with the mode QueuedAfterFlush specified.

11.4. Manipulating the Event Queue

Xlib provides functions that let you manipulate the event queue. This section discusses how to:

Obtain events, in order, and remove them from the queue

Peek at events in the queue without removing them

Obtain events that match the event mask or the arbitrary predicate procedures that you provide

11.4.1. Returning the Next Event

To get the next event and remove it from the queue, use XNextEvent. __ │

XNextEvent(display, event_return)
Display *display;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_return
Returns the next event in the queue. │__

The XNextEvent function copies the first event from the event queue into the specified XEvent structure and then removes it from the queue. If the event queue is empty, XNextEvent flushes the output buffer and blocks until an event is received.

To peek at the event queue, use XPeekEvent. __ │

XPeekEvent(display, event_return)
Display *display;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_return
Returns a copy of the matched event’s associated
structure. │__

The XPeekEvent function returns the first event from the event queue, but it does not remove the event from the queue. If the queue is empty, XPeekEvent flushes the output buffer and blocks until an event is received. It then copies the event into the client-supplied XEvent structure without removing it from the event queue.

11.4.2. Selecting Events Using a Predicate Procedure

Each of the functions discussed in this section requires you to pass a predicate procedure that determines if an event matches what you want. Your predicate procedure must decide if the event is useful without calling any Xlib functions. If the predicate directly or indirectly causes the state of the event queue to change, the result is not defined. If Xlib has been initialized for threads, the predicate is called with the display locked and the result of a call by the predicate to any Xlib function that locks the display is not defined unless the caller has first called XLockDisplay.

The predicate procedure and its associated arguments are: __ │

Bool (*predicate)(display, event, arg)
Display *display;
XEvent *event;
XPointer arg;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event

Specifies the XEvent structure.

arg

Specifies the argument passed in from the

XIfEvent, XCheckIfEvent, or XPeekIfEvent function. │__

The predicate procedure is called once for each event in the queue until it finds a match. After finding a match, the predicate procedure must return True. If it did not find a match, it must return False.

To check the event queue for a matching event and, if found, remove the event from the queue, use XIfEvent. __ │

XIfEvent(display, event_return, predicate, arg)
Display *display;
XEvent *event_return;
Bool (*predicate)();
XPointer arg;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure.

predicate

Specifies the procedure that is to be called to

determine if the next event in the queue matches
what you want.

arg

Specifies the user-supplied argument that will be

passed to the predicate procedure. │__

The XIfEvent function completes only when the specified predicate procedure returns True for an event, which indicates an event in the queue matches. XIfEvent flushes the output buffer if it blocks waiting for additional events. XIfEvent removes the matching event from the queue and copies the structure into the client-supplied XEvent structure.

To check the event queue for a matching event without blocking, use XCheckIfEvent. __ │

Bool XCheckIfEvent(display, event_return, predicate, arg)
Display *display;
XEvent *event_return;
Bool (*predicate)();
XPointer arg;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_return
Returns a copy of the matched event’s associated
structure.

predicate

Specifies the procedure that is to be called to

determine if the next event in the queue matches
what you want.

arg

Specifies the user-supplied argument that will be

passed to the predicate procedure. │__

When the predicate procedure finds a match, XCheckIfEvent copies the matched event into the client-supplied XEvent structure and returns True. (This event is removed from the queue.) If the predicate procedure finds no match, XCheckIfEvent returns False, and the output buffer will have been flushed. All earlier events stored in the queue are not discarded.

To check the event queue for a matching event without removing the event from the queue, use XPeekIfEvent. __ │

XPeekIfEvent(display, event_return, predicate, arg)
Display *display;
XEvent *event_return;
Bool (*predicate)();
XPointer arg;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_return
Returns a copy of the matched event’s associated
structure.

predicate

Specifies the procedure that is to be called to

determine if the next event in the queue matches
what you want.

arg

Specifies the user-supplied argument that will be

passed to the predicate procedure. │__

The XPeekIfEvent function returns only when the specified predicate procedure returns True for an event. After the predicate procedure finds a match, XPeekIfEvent copies the matched event into the client-supplied XEvent structure without removing the event from the queue. XPeekIfEvent flushes the output buffer if it blocks waiting for additional events.

11.4.3. Selecting Events Using a Window or Event Mask

The functions discussed in this section let you select events by window or event types, allowing you to process events out of order.

To remove the next event that matches both a window and an event mask, use XWindowEvent. __ │

XWindowEvent(display, w, event_mask, event_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
long event_mask;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose events you are inter-

ested in.

event_maskSpecifies the event mask.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure. │__

The XWindowEvent function searches the event queue for an event that matches both the specified window and event mask. When it finds a match, XWindowEvent removes that event from the queue and copies it into the specified XEvent structure. The other events stored in the queue are not discarded. If a matching event is not in the queue, XWindowEvent flushes the output buffer and blocks until one is received.

To remove the next event that matches both a window and an event mask (if any), use XCheckWindowEvent. This function is similar to XWindowEvent except that it never blocks and it returns a Bool indicating if the event was returned. __ │

Bool XCheckWindowEvent(display, w, event_mask, event_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
long event_mask;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window whose events you are inter-

ested in.

event_maskSpecifies the event mask.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure. │__

The XCheckWindowEvent function searches the event queue and then the events available on the server connection for the first event that matches the specified window and event mask. If it finds a match, XCheckWindowEvent removes that event, copies it into the specified XEvent structure, and returns True. The other events stored in the queue are not discarded. If the event you requested is not available, XCheckWindowEvent returns False, and the output buffer will have been flushed.

To remove the next event that matches an event mask, use XMaskEvent. __ │

XMaskEvent(display, event_mask, event_return)
Display *display;
long event_mask;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_maskSpecifies the event mask.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure. │__

The XMaskEvent function searches the event queue for the events associated with the specified mask. When it finds a match, XMaskEvent removes that event and copies it into the specified XEvent structure. The other events stored in the queue are not discarded. If the event you requested is not in the queue, XMaskEvent flushes the output buffer and blocks until one is received.

To return and remove the next event that matches an event mask (if any), use XCheckMaskEvent. This function is similar to XMaskEvent except that it never blocks and it returns a Bool indicating if the event was returned. __ │

Bool XCheckMaskEvent(display, event_mask, event_return)
Display *display;
long event_mask;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_maskSpecifies the event mask.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure. │__

The XCheckMaskEvent function searches the event queue and then any events available on the server connection for the first event that matches the specified mask. If it finds a match, XCheckMaskEvent removes that event, copies it into the specified XEvent structure, and returns True. The other events stored in the queue are not discarded. If the event you requested is not available, XCheckMaskEvent returns False, and the output buffer will have been flushed.

To return and remove the next event in the queue that matches an event type, use XCheckTypedEvent. __ │

Bool XCheckTypedEvent(display, event_type, event_return)
Display *display;
int event_type;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_typeSpecifies the event type to be compared.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure. │__

The XCheckTypedEvent function searches the event queue and then any events available on the server connection for the first event that matches the specified type. If it finds a match, XCheckTypedEvent removes that event, copies it into the specified XEvent structure, and returns True. The other events in the queue are not discarded. If the event is not available, XCheckTypedEvent returns False, and the output buffer will have been flushed.

To return and remove the next event in the queue that matches an event type and a window, use XCheckTypedWindowEvent. __ │

Bool XCheckTypedWindowEvent(display, w, event_type, event_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
int event_type;
XEvent *event_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

event_typeSpecifies the event type to be compared.

event_return
Returns the matched event’s associated structure. │__

The XCheckTypedWindowEvent function searches the event queue and then any events available on the server connection for the first event that matches the specified type and window. If it finds a match, XCheckTypedWindowEvent removes the event from the queue, copies it into the specified XEvent structure, and returns True. The other events in the queue are not discarded. If the event is not available, XCheckTypedWindowEvent returns False, and the output buffer will have been flushed.

11.5. Putting an Event Back into the Queue

To push an event back into the event queue, use XPutBackEvent. __ │

XPutBackEvent(display, event)
Display *display;
XEvent *event;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event

Specifies the event. │__

The XPutBackEvent function pushes an event back onto the head of the display’s event queue by copying the event into the queue. This can be useful if you read an event and then decide that you would rather deal with it later. There is no limit to the number of times in succession that you can call XPutBackEvent.

11.6. Sending Events to Other Applications

To send an event to a specified window, use XSendEvent. This function is often used in selection processing. For example, the owner of a selection should use XSendEvent to send a SelectionNotify event to a requestor when a selection has been converted and stored as a property. __ │

Status XSendEvent(display, w, propagate, event_mask, event_send)
Display *display;
Window w;
Bool propagate;
long event_mask;
XEvent *event_send;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window the event is to be sent to,

or PointerWindow, or InputFocus.

propagate

Specifies a Boolean value.

event_maskSpecifies the event mask.

event_sendSpecifies the event that is to be sent. │__

The XSendEvent function identifies the destination window, determines which clients should receive the specified events, and ignores any active grabs. This function requires you to pass an event mask. For a discussion of the valid event mask names, see section 10.3. This function uses the w argument to identify the destination window as follows:

If w is PointerWindow, the destination window is the window that contains the pointer.

If w is InputFocus and if the focus window contains the pointer, the destination window is the window that contains the pointer; otherwise, the destination window is the focus window.

To determine which clients should receive the specified events, XSendEvent uses the propagate argument as follows:

If event_mask is the empty set, the event is sent to the client that created the destination window. If that client no longer exists, no event is sent.

If propagate is False, the event is sent to every client selecting on destination any of the event types in the event_mask argument.

If propagate is True and no clients have selected on destination any of the event types in event-mask, the destination is replaced with the closest ancestor of destination for which some client has selected a type in event-mask and for which no intervening window has that type in its do-not-propagate-mask. If no such window exists or if the window is an ancestor of the focus window and InputFocus was originally specified as the destination, the event is not sent to any clients. Otherwise, the event is reported to every client selecting on the final destination any of the types specified in event_mask.

The event in the XEvent structure must be one of the core events or one of the events defined by an extension (or a BadValue error results) so that the X server can correctly byte-swap the contents as necessary. The contents of the event are otherwise unaltered and unchecked by the X server except to force send_event to True in the forwarded event and to set the serial number in the event correctly; therefore these fields and the display field are ignored by XSendEvent.

XSendEvent returns zero if the conversion to wire protocol format failed and returns nonzero otherwise.

XSendEvent can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

11.7. Getting Pointer Motion History

Some X server implementations will maintain a more complete history of pointer motion than is reported by event notification. The pointer position at each pointer hardware interrupt may be stored in a buffer for later retrieval. This buffer is called the motion history buffer. For example, a few applications, such as paint programs, want to have a precise history of where the pointer traveled. However, this historical information is highly excessive for most applications.

To determine the approximate maximum number of elements in the motion buffer, use XDisplayMotionBufferSize. __ │

unsigned long XDisplayMotionBufferSize(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The server may retain the recent history of the pointer motion and do so to a finer granularity than is reported by MotionNotify events. The XGetMotionEvents function makes this history available.

To get the motion history for a specified window and time, use XGetMotionEvents. __ │

XTimeCoord *XGetMotionEvents(display, w, start, stop, nevents_return)
Display *display;
Window w;

Time start, stop;

int *nevents_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

start

stop

Specify the time interval in which the events are

returned from the motion history buffer. You can
pass a timestamp or CurrentTime.

nevents_return
Returns the number of events from the motion his-
tory buffer. │__

The XGetMotionEvents function returns all events in the motion history buffer that fall between the specified start and stop times, inclusive, and that have coordinates that lie within the specified window (including its borders) at its present placement. If the server does not support motion history, if the start time is later than the stop time, or if the start time is in the future, no events are returned; XGetMotionEvents returns NULL. If the stop time is in the future, it is equivalent to specifying CurrentTime. The return type for this function is a structure defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct {

Time time;

short x, y;

} XTimeCoord; │__

The time member is set to the time, in milliseconds. The x and y members are set to the coordinates of the pointer and are reported relative to the origin of the specified window. To free the data returned from this call, use XFree.

XGetMotionEvents can generate a BadWindow error.

11.8. Handling Protocol Errors

Xlib provides functions that you can use to enable or disable synchronization and to use the default error handlers.

11.8.1. Enabling or Disabling Synchronization

When debugging X applications, it often is very convenient to require Xlib to behave synchronously so that errors are reported as they occur. The following function lets you disable or enable synchronous behavior. Note that graphics may occur 30 or more times more slowly when synchronization is enabled. On POSIX-conformant systems, there is also a global variable _Xdebug that, if set to nonzero before starting a program under a debugger, will force synchronous library behavior.

After completing their work, all Xlib functions that generate protocol requests call what is known as an after function. XSetAfterFunction sets which function is to be called. __ │

int (*XSetAfterFunction(display, procedure))()
Display *display;
int (*procedure)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

procedure

Specifies the procedure to be called. │__

The specified procedure is called with only a display pointer. XSetAfterFunction returns the previous after function.

To enable or disable synchronization, use XSynchronize. __ │

int (*XSynchronize(display, onoff))()
Display *display;
Bool onoff;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

onoff

Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether

to enable or disable synchronization. │__

The XSynchronize function returns the previous after function. If onoff is True, XSynchronize turns on synchronous behavior. If onoff is False, XSynchronize turns off synchronous behavior.

11.8.2. Using the Default Error Handlers

There are two default error handlers in Xlib: one to handle typically fatal conditions (for example, the connection to a display server dying because a machine crashed) and one to handle protocol errors from the X server. These error handlers can be changed to user-supplied routines if you prefer your own error handling and can be changed as often as you like. If either function is passed a NULL pointer, it will reinvoke the default handler. The action of the default handlers is to print an explanatory message and exit.

To set the error handler, use XSetErrorHandler. __ │

int (*XSetErrorHandler(handler))()
int (*handler)(Display *, XErrorEvent *)

handler

Specifies the program’s supplied error handler. │__

Xlib generally calls the program’s supplied error handler whenever an error is received. It is not called on BadName errors from OpenFont, LookupColor, or AllocNamedColor protocol requests or on BadFont errors from a QueryFont protocol request. These errors generally are reflected back to the program through the procedural interface. Because this condition is not assumed to be fatal, it is acceptable for your error handler to return; the returned value is ignored. However, the error handler should not call any functions (directly or indirectly) on the display that will generate protocol requests or that will look for input events. The previous error handler is returned.

The XErrorEvent structure contains:

typedef struct {

int type;

Display *display;

/* Display the event was read from */

unsigned long serial;/* serial number of failed request */

unsigned char error_code;/* error code of failed request */

unsigned char request_code;/* Major op-code of failed request */

unsigned char minor_code;/* Minor op-code of failed request */

XID resourceid;

/* resource id */

} XErrorEvent;

The serial member is the number of requests, starting from one, sent over the network connection since it was opened. It is the number that was the value of NextRequest immediately before the failing call was made. The request_code member is a protocol request of the procedure that failed, as defined in <X11/Xproto.h>. The following error codes can be returned by the functions described in this chapter:
Error Code Description
BadAccess

A client attempts to grab a key/button
combination already grabbed by another
client.
A client attempts to free a colormap
entry that it had not already allocated
or to free an entry in a colormap that
was created with all entries writable.
A client attempts to store into a
read-only or unallocated colormap entry.
A client attempts to modify the access
control list from other than the local
(or otherwise authorized) host.
A client attempts to select an event
type that another client has already
selected.
BadAlloc

The server fails to allocate the
requested resource. Note that the
explicit listing of BadAlloc errors in
requests only covers allocation errors
at a very coarse level and is not
intended to (nor can it in practice hope
to) cover all cases of a server running
out of allocation space in the middle of
service. The semantics when a server
runs out of allocation space are left
unspecified, but a server may generate a
BadAlloc
error on any request for this
reason, and clients should be prepared
to receive such errors and handle or
discard them.
BadAtom

A value for an atom argument does not
name a defined atom.
BadColor

A value for a colormap argument does not
name a defined colormap.
BadCursor

A value for a cursor argument does not
name a defined cursor.
BadDrawable

A value for a drawable argument does not
name a defined window or pixmap.
BadFont

A value for a font argument does not
name a defined font (or, in some cases,
GContext
).
BadGC

A value for a GContext argument does not
name a defined GContext.
BadIDChoice

The value chosen for a resource
identifier either is not included in the
range assigned to the client or is
already in use. Under normal
circumstances, this cannot occur and
should be considered a server or Xlib
error.
BadImplementation

The server does not implement some
aspect of the request. A server that
generates this error for a core request
is deficient. As such, this error is
not listed for any of the requests, but
clients should be prepared to receive
such errors and handle or discard them.
BadLength

The length of a request is shorter or
longer than that required to contain the
arguments. This is an internal Xlib or
server error.
The length of a request exceeds the
maximum length accepted by the server.
BadMatch

In a graphics request, the root and
depth of the graphics context do not
match those of the drawable.
An InputOnly window is used as a
drawable.
Some argument or pair of arguments has
the correct type and range, but it fails
to match in some other way required by
the request.
An InputOnly window lacks this
attribute.
BadName

A font or color of the specified name
does not exist.
BadPixmap

A value for a pixmap argument does not
name a defined pixmap.
BadRequest

The major or minor opcode does not
specify a valid request. This usually
is an Xlib or server error.
BadValue

Some numeric value falls outside of the
range of values accepted by the request.
Unless a specific range is specified for
an argument, the full range defined by
the argument’s type is accepted. Any
argument defined as a set of
alternatives typically can generate this
error (due to the encoding).
BadWindow

A value for a window argument does not
name a defined window.

Note

The BadAtom, BadColor, BadCursor, BadDrawable, BadFont, BadGC, BadPixmap, and BadWindow errors are also used when the argument type is extended by a set of fixed alternatives.

To obtain textual descriptions of the specified error code, use XGetErrorText. __ │

XGetErrorText(display, code, buffer_return, length)
Display *display;
int code;
char *buffer_return;
int length;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

code

Specifies the error code for which you want to ob-

tain a description.

buffer_return
Returns the error description.

length

Specifies the size of the buffer. │__

The XGetErrorText function copies a null-terminated string describing the specified error code into the specified buffer. The returned text is in the encoding of the current locale. It is recommended that you use this function to obtain an error description because extensions to Xlib may define their own error codes and error strings.

To obtain error messages from the error database, use XGetErrorDatabaseText. __ │

XGetErrorDatabaseText(display, name, message, default_string, buffer_return, length)
Display *display;
char *name, *message;
char *default_string;
char *buffer_return;
int length;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

name

Specifies the name of the application.

message

Specifies the type of the error message.

default_string
Specifies the default error message if none is
found in the database.

buffer_return
Returns the error description.

length

Specifies the size of the buffer. │__

The XGetErrorDatabaseText function returns a null-terminated message (or the default message) from the error message database. Xlib uses this function internally to look up its error messages. The text in the default_string argument is assumed to be in the encoding of the current locale, and the text stored in the buffer_return argument is in the encoding of the current locale.

The name argument should generally be the name of your application. The message argument should indicate which type of error message you want. If the name and message are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Xlib uses three predefined ‘‘application names’’ to report errors. In these names, uppercase and lowercase matter.

XProtoErrorThe protocol error number is used as a string for the message argument.

XlibMessageThese are the message strings that are used internally by the library.

XRequest

For a core protocol request, the major request protocol number is used for the message argument. For an extension request, the extension name (as given by InitExtension) followed by a period (.) and the minor request protocol number is used for the message argument. If no string is found in the error database, the default_string is returned to the buffer argument.

To report an error to the user when the requested display does not exist, use XDisplayName. __ │

char *XDisplayName(string)
char *string;

string

Specifies the character string. │__

The XDisplayName function returns the name of the display that XOpenDisplay would attempt to use. If a NULL string is specified, XDisplayName looks in the environment for the display and returns the display name that XOpenDisplay would attempt to use. This makes it easier to report to the user precisely which display the program attempted to open when the initial connection attempt failed.

To handle fatal I/O errors, use XSetIOErrorHandler. __ │

int (*XSetIOErrorHandler(handler))()
int (*handler)(Display *);

handler

Specifies the program’s supplied error handler. │__

The XSetIOErrorHandler sets the fatal I/O error handler. Xlib calls the program’s supplied error handler if any sort of system call error occurs (for example, the connection to the server was lost). This is assumed to be a fatal condition, and the called routine should not return. If the I/O error handler does return, the client process exits.

Note that the previous error handler is returned.

11

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 12

Input Device Functions

You can use the Xlib input device functions to:

Grab the pointer and individual buttons on the pointer

Grab the keyboard and individual keys on the keyboard

Resume event processing

Move the pointer

Set the input focus

Manipulate the keyboard and pointer settings

Manipulate the keyboard encoding

12.1. Pointer Grabbing

Xlib provides functions that you can use to control input from the pointer, which usually is a mouse. Usually, as soon as keyboard and mouse events occur, the X server delivers them to the appropriate client, which is determined by the window and input focus. The X server provides sufficient control over event delivery to allow window managers to support mouse ahead and various other styles of user interface. Many of these user interfaces depend on synchronous delivery of events. The delivery of pointer and keyboard events can be controlled independently.

When mouse buttons or keyboard keys are grabbed, events will be sent to the grabbing client rather than the normal client who would have received the event. If the keyboard or pointer is in asynchronous mode, further mouse and keyboard events will continue to be processed. If the keyboard or pointer is in synchronous mode, no further events are processed until the grabbing client allows them (see XAllowEvents). The keyboard or pointer is considered frozen during this interval. The event that triggered the grab can also be replayed.

Note that the logical state of a device (as seen by client applications) may lag the physical state if device event processing is frozen.

There are two kinds of grabs: active and passive. An active grab occurs when a single client grabs the keyboard and/or pointer explicitly (see XGrabPointer and XGrabKeyboard). A passive grab occurs when clients grab a particular keyboard key or pointer button in a window, and the grab will activate when the key or button is actually pressed. Passive grabs are convenient for implementing reliable pop-up menus. For example, you can guarantee that the pop-up is mapped before the up pointer button event occurs by grabbing a button requesting synchronous behavior. The down event will trigger the grab and freeze further processing of pointer events until you have the chance to map the pop-up window. You can then allow further event processing. The up event will then be correctly processed relative to the pop-up window.

For many operations, there are functions that take a time argument. The X server includes a timestamp in various events. One special time, called CurrentTime, represents the current server time. The X server maintains the time when the input focus was last changed, when the keyboard was last grabbed, when the pointer was last grabbed, or when a selection was last changed. Your application may be slow reacting to an event. You often need some way to specify that your request should not occur if another application has in the meanwhile taken control of the keyboard, pointer, or selection. By providing the timestamp from the event in the request, you can arrange that the operation not take effect if someone else has performed an operation in the meanwhile.

A timestamp is a time value, expressed in milliseconds. It typically is the time since the last server reset. Timestamp values wrap around (after about 49.7 days). The server, given its current time is represented by timestamp T, always interprets timestamps from clients by treating half of the timestamp space as being later in time than T. One timestamp value, named CurrentTime, is never generated by the server. This value is reserved for use in requests to represent the current server time.

For many functions in this section, you pass pointer event mask bits. The valid pointer event mask bits are: ButtonPressMask, ButtonReleaseMask, EnterWindowMask, LeaveWindowMask, PointerMotionMask, PointerMotionHintMask, Button1MotionMask, Button2MotionMask, Button3MotionMask, Button4MotionMask, Button5MotionMask, ButtonMotionMask, and KeyMapStateMask. For other functions in this section, you pass keymask bits. The valid keymask bits are: ShiftMask, LockMask, ControlMask, Mod1Mask, Mod2Mask, Mod3Mask, Mod4Mask, and Mod5Mask.

To grab the pointer, use XGrabPointer. __ │

int XGrabPointer(display, grab_window, owner_events, event_mask, pointer_mode,
keyboard_mode
, confine_to, cursor, time)
Display *display;
Window grab_window;
Bool owner_events;
unsigned int event_mask;
int pointer_mode, keyboard_mode;
Window confine_to;
Cursor cursor;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

grab_windowSpecifies the grab window.

owner_events
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
the pointer events are to be reported as usual or
reported with respect to the grab window if se-
lected by the event mask.

event_maskSpecifies which pointer events are reported to the
client. The mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of
the valid pointer event mask bits.

pointer_mode
Specifies further processing of pointer events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

keyboard_mode
Specifies further processing of keyboard events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

confine_toSpecifies the window to confine the pointer in or
None
.

cursor

Specifies the cursor that is to be displayed dur-

ing the grab or None.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XGrabPointer function actively grabs control of the pointer and returns GrabSuccess if the grab was successful. Further pointer events are reported only to the grabbing client. XGrabPointer overrides any active pointer grab by this client. If owner_events is False, all generated pointer events are reported with respect to grab_window and are reported only if selected by event_mask. If owner_events is True and if a generated pointer event would normally be reported to this client, it is reported as usual. Otherwise, the event is reported with respect to the grab_window and is reported only if selected by event_mask. For either value of owner_events, unreported events are discarded.

If the pointer_mode is GrabModeAsync, pointer event processing continues as usual. If the pointer is currently frozen by this client, the processing of events for the pointer is resumed. If the pointer_mode is GrabModeSync, the state of the pointer, as seen by client applications, appears to freeze, and the X server generates no further pointer events until the grabbing client calls XAllowEvents or until the pointer grab is released. Actual pointer changes are not lost while the pointer is frozen; they are simply queued in the server for later processing.

If the keyboard_mode is GrabModeAsync, keyboard event processing is unaffected by activation of the grab. If the keyboard_mode is GrabModeSync, the state of the keyboard, as seen by client applications, appears to freeze, and the X server generates no further keyboard events until the grabbing client calls XAllowEvents or until the pointer grab is released. Actual keyboard changes are not lost while the pointer is frozen; they are simply queued in the server for later processing.

If a cursor is specified, it is displayed regardless of what window the pointer is in. If None is specified, the normal cursor for that window is displayed when the pointer is in grab_window or one of its subwindows; otherwise, the cursor for grab_window is displayed.

If a confine_to window is specified, the pointer is restricted to stay contained in that window. The confine_to window need have no relationship to the grab_window. If the pointer is not initially in the confine_to window, it is warped automatically to the closest edge just before the grab activates and enter/leave events are generated as usual. If the confine_to window is subsequently reconfigured, the pointer is warped automatically, as necessary, to keep it contained in the window.

The time argument allows you to avoid certain circumstances that come up if applications take a long time to respond or if there are long network delays. Consider a situation where you have two applications, both of which normally grab the pointer when clicked on. If both applications specify the timestamp from the event, the second application may wake up faster and successfully grab the pointer before the first application. The first application then will get an indication that the other application grabbed the pointer before its request was processed.

XGrabPointer generates EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events.

Either if grab_window or confine_to window is not viewable or if the confine_to window lies completely outside the boundaries of the root window, XGrabPointer fails and returns GrabNotViewable. If the pointer is actively grabbed by some other client, it fails and returns AlreadyGrabbed. If the pointer is frozen by an active grab of another client, it fails and returns GrabFrozen. If the specified time is earlier than the last-pointer-grab time or later than the current X server time, it fails and returns GrabInvalidTime. Otherwise, the last-pointer-grab time is set to the specified time (CurrentTime is replaced by the current X server time).

XGrabPointer can generate BadCursor, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To ungrab the pointer, use XUngrabPointer. __ │

XUngrabPointer(display, time)
Display *display;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XUngrabPointer function releases the pointer and any queued events if this client has actively grabbed the pointer from XGrabPointer, XGrabButton, or from a normal button press. XUngrabPointer does not release the pointer if the specified time is earlier than the last-pointer-grab time or is later than the current X server time. It also generates EnterNotify and LeaveNotify events. The X server performs an UngrabPointer request automatically if the event window or confine_to window for an active pointer grab becomes not viewable or if window reconfiguration causes the confine_to window to lie completely outside the boundaries of the root window.

To change an active pointer grab, use XChangeActivePointerGrab. __ │

XChangeActivePointerGrab(display, event_mask, cursor, time)
Display *display;
unsigned int event_mask;
Cursor cursor;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_maskSpecifies which pointer events are reported to the
client. The mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of
the valid pointer event mask bits.

cursor

Specifies the cursor that is to be displayed or

None.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XChangeActivePointerGrab function changes the specified dynamic parameters if the pointer is actively grabbed by the client and if the specified time is no earlier than the last-pointer-grab time and no later than the current X server time. This function has no effect on the passive parameters of an XGrabButton. The interpretation of event_mask and cursor is the same as described in XGrabPointer.

XChangeActivePointerGrab can generate BadCursor and BadValue errors.

To grab a pointer button, use XGrabButton. __ │

XGrabButton(display, button, modifiers, grab_window, owner_events, event_mask,
pointer_mode
, keyboard_mode, confine_to, cursor)
Display *display;
unsigned int button;
unsigned int modifiers;
Window grab_window;
Bool owner_events;
unsigned int event_mask;
int pointer_mode, keyboard_mode;
Window confine_to;
Cursor cursor;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

button

Specifies the pointer button that is to be grabbed

or AnyButton.

modifiers

Specifies the set of keymasks or AnyModifier. The

mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid key-
mask bits.

grab_windowSpecifies the grab window.

owner_events
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
the pointer events are to be reported as usual or
reported with respect to the grab window if se-
lected by the event mask.

event_maskSpecifies which pointer events are reported to the
client. The mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of
the valid pointer event mask bits.

pointer_mode
Specifies further processing of pointer events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

keyboard_mode
Specifies further processing of keyboard events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

confine_toSpecifies the window to confine the pointer in or
None
.

cursor

Specifies the cursor that is to be displayed or

None. │__

The XGrabButton function establishes a passive grab. In the future, the pointer is actively grabbed (as for XGrabPointer), the last-pointer-grab time is set to the time at which the button was pressed (as transmitted in the ButtonPress event), and the ButtonPress event is reported if all of the following conditions are true:

The pointer is not grabbed, and the specified button is logically pressed when the specified modifier keys are logically down, and no other buttons or modifier keys are logically down.

The grab_window contains the pointer.

The confine_to window (if any) is viewable.

A passive grab on the same button/key combination does not exist on any ancestor of grab_window.

The interpretation of the remaining arguments is as for XGrabPointer. The active grab is terminated automatically when the logical state of the pointer has all buttons released (independent of the state of the logical modifier keys).

Note that the logical state of a device (as seen by client applications) may lag the physical state if device event processing is frozen.

This request overrides all previous grabs by the same client on the same button/key combinations on the same window. A modifiers of AnyModifier is equivalent to issuing the grab request for all possible modifier combinations (including the combination of no modifiers). It is not required that all modifiers specified have currently assigned KeyCodes. A button of AnyButton is equivalent to issuing the request for all possible buttons. Otherwise, it is not required that the specified button currently be assigned to a physical button.

If some other client has already issued an XGrabButton with the same button/key combination on the same window, a BadAccess error results. When using AnyModifier or AnyButton, the request fails completely, and a BadAccess error results (no grabs are established) if there is a conflicting grab for any combination. XGrabButton has no effect on an active grab.

XGrabButton can generate BadCursor, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To ungrab a pointer button, use XUngrabButton. __ │

XUngrabButton(display, button, modifiers, grab_window)
Display *display;
unsigned int button;
unsigned int modifiers;
Window grab_window;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

button

Specifies the pointer button that is to be re-

leased or AnyButton.

modifiers

Specifies the set of keymasks or AnyModifier. The

mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid key-
mask bits.

grab_windowSpecifies the grab window. │__

The XUngrabButton function releases the passive button/key combination on the specified window if it was grabbed by this client. A modifiers of AnyModifier is equivalent to issuing the ungrab request for all possible modifier combinations, including the combination of no modifiers. A button of AnyButton is equivalent to issuing the request for all possible buttons. XUngrabButton has no effect on an active grab.

XUngrabButton can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

12.2. Keyboard Grabbing

Xlib provides functions that you can use to grab or ungrab the keyboard as well as allow events.

For many functions in this section, you pass keymask bits. The valid keymask bits are: ShiftMask, LockMask, ControlMask, Mod1Mask, Mod2Mask, Mod3Mask, Mod4Mask, and Mod5Mask.

To grab the keyboard, use XGrabKeyboard. __ │

int XGrabKeyboard(display, grab_window, owner_events, pointer_mode, keyboard_mode, time)
Display *display;
Window grab_window;
Bool owner_events;
int pointer_mode, keyboard_mode;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

grab_windowSpecifies the grab window.

owner_events
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
the keyboard events are to be reported as usual.

pointer_mode
Specifies further processing of pointer events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

keyboard_mode
Specifies further processing of keyboard events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XGrabKeyboard function actively grabs control of the keyboard and generates FocusIn and FocusOut events. Further key events are reported only to the grabbing client. XGrabKeyboard overrides any active keyboard grab by this client. If owner_events is False, all generated key events are reported with respect to grab_window. If owner_events is True and if a generated key event would normally be reported to this client, it is reported normally; otherwise, the event is reported with respect to the grab_window. Both KeyPress and KeyRelease events are always reported, independent of any event selection made by the client.

If the keyboard_mode argument is GrabModeAsync, keyboard event processing continues as usual. If the keyboard is currently frozen by this client, then processing of keyboard events is resumed. If the keyboard_mode argument is GrabModeSync, the state of the keyboard (as seen by client applications) appears to freeze, and the X server generates no further keyboard events until the grabbing client issues a releasing XAllowEvents call or until the keyboard grab is released. Actual keyboard changes are not lost while the keyboard is frozen; they are simply queued in the server for later processing.

If pointer_mode is GrabModeAsync, pointer event processing is unaffected by activation of the grab. If pointer_mode is GrabModeSync, the state of the pointer (as seen by client applications) appears to freeze, and the X server generates no further pointer events until the grabbing client issues a releasing XAllowEvents call or until the keyboard grab is released. Actual pointer changes are not lost while the pointer is frozen; they are simply queued in the server for later processing.

If the keyboard is actively grabbed by some other client, XGrabKeyboard fails and returns AlreadyGrabbed. If grab_window is not viewable, it fails and returns GrabNotViewable. If the keyboard is frozen by an active grab of another client, it fails and returns GrabFrozen. If the specified time is earlier than the last-keyboard-grab time or later than the current X server time, it fails and returns GrabInvalidTime. Otherwise, the last-keyboard-grab time is set to the specified time (CurrentTime is replaced by the current X server time).

XGrabKeyboard can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

To ungrab the keyboard, use XUngrabKeyboard. __ │

XUngrabKeyboard(display, time)
Display *display;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XUngrabKeyboard function releases the keyboard and any queued events if this client has it actively grabbed from either XGrabKeyboard or XGrabKey. XUngrabKeyboard does not release the keyboard and any queued events if the specified time is earlier than the last-keyboard-grab time or is later than the current X server time. It also generates FocusIn and FocusOut events. The X server automatically performs an UngrabKeyboard request if the event window for an active keyboard grab becomes not viewable.

To passively grab a single key of the keyboard, use XGrabKey. __ │

XGrabKey(display, keycode, modifiers, grab_window, owner_events, pointer_mode,
keyboard_mode
)
Display *display;
int keycode;
unsigned int modifiers;
Window grab_window;
Bool owner_events;
int pointer_mode, keyboard_mode;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

keycode

Specifies the KeyCode or AnyKey.

modifiers

Specifies the set of keymasks or AnyModifier. The

mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid key-
mask bits.

grab_windowSpecifies the grab window.

owner_events
Specifies a Boolean value that indicates whether
the keyboard events are to be reported as usual.

pointer_mode
Specifies further processing of pointer events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync.

keyboard_mode
Specifies further processing of keyboard events.
You can pass GrabModeSync or GrabModeAsync. │__

The XGrabKey function establishes a passive grab on the keyboard. In the future, the keyboard is actively grabbed (as for XGrabKeyboard), the last-keyboard-grab time is set to the time at which the key was pressed (as transmitted in the KeyPress event), and the KeyPress event is reported if all of the following conditions are true:

The keyboard is not grabbed and the specified key (which can itself be a modifier key) is logically pressed when the specified modifier keys are logically down, and no other modifier keys are logically down.

Either the grab_window is an ancestor of (or is) the focus window, or the grab_window is a descendant of the focus window and contains the pointer.

A passive grab on the same key combination does not exist on any ancestor of grab_window.

The interpretation of the remaining arguments is as for XGrabKeyboard. The active grab is terminated automatically when the logical state of the keyboard has the specified key released (independent of the logical state of the modifier keys).

Note that the logical state of a device (as seen by client applications) may lag the physical state if device event processing is frozen.

A modifiers argument of AnyModifier is equivalent to issuing the request for all possible modifier combinations (including the combination of no modifiers). It is not required that all modifiers specified have currently assigned KeyCodes. A keycode argument of AnyKey is equivalent to issuing the request for all possible KeyCodes. Otherwise, the specified keycode must be in the range specified by min_keycode and max_keycode in the connection setup, or a BadValue error results.

If some other client has issued a XGrabKey with the same key combination on the same window, a BadAccess error results. When using AnyModifier or AnyKey, the request fails completely, and a BadAccess error results (no grabs are established) if there is a conflicting grab for any combination.

XGrabKey can generate BadAccess, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To ungrab a key, use XUngrabKey. __ │

XUngrabKey(display, keycode, modifiers, grab_window)
Display *display;
int keycode;
unsigned int modifiers;
Window grab_window;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

keycode

Specifies the KeyCode or AnyKey.

modifiers

Specifies the set of keymasks or AnyModifier. The

mask is the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid key-
mask bits.

grab_windowSpecifies the grab window. │__

The XUngrabKey function releases the key combination on the specified window if it was grabbed by this client. It has no effect on an active grab. A modifiers of AnyModifier is equivalent to issuing the request for all possible modifier combinations (including the combination of no modifiers). A keycode argument of AnyKey is equivalent to issuing the request for all possible key codes.

XUngrabKey can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

12.3. Resuming Event Processing

The previous sections discussed grab mechanisms with which processing of events by the server can be temporarily suspended. This section describes the mechanism for resuming event processing.

To allow further events to be processed when the device has been frozen, use XAllowEvents. __ │

XAllowEvents(display, event_mode, time)
Display *display;
int event_mode;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_modeSpecifies the event mode. You can pass Async-
Pointer
, SyncPointer, AsyncKeyboard, SyncKeyboard,
ReplayPointer
, ReplayKeyboard, AsyncBoth, or
SyncBoth
.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XAllowEvents function releases some queued events if the client has caused a device to freeze. It has no effect if the specified time is earlier than the last-grab time of the most recent active grab for the client or if the specified time is later than the current X server time. Depending on the event_mode argument, the following occurs:
AsyncPointer

If the pointer is frozen by the client,
pointer event processing continues as usual.
If the pointer is frozen twice by the client
on behalf of two separate grabs, AsyncPointer
thaws for both. AsyncPointer has no effect
if the pointer is not frozen by the client,
but the pointer need not be grabbed by the
client.
SyncPointer

If the pointer is frozen and actively grabbed
by the client, pointer event processing
continues as usual until the next ButtonPress
or ButtonRelease event is reported to the
client. At this time, the pointer again
appears to freeze. However, if the reported
event causes the pointer grab to be released,
the pointer does not freeze. SyncPointer has
no effect if the pointer is not frozen by the
client or if the pointer is not grabbed by
the client.
ReplayPointer

If the pointer is actively grabbed by the
client and is frozen as the result of an
event having been sent to the client (either
from the activation of an XGrabButton or from
a previous XAllowEvents with mode SyncPointer
but not from an XGrabPointer), the pointer
grab is released and that event is completely
reprocessed. This time, however, the
function ignores any passive grabs at or
above (toward the root of) the grab_window of
the grab just released. The request has no
effect if the pointer is not grabbed by the
client or if the pointer is not frozen as the
result of an event.
AsyncKeyboard

If the keyboard is frozen by the client,
keyboard event processing continues as usual.
If the keyboard is frozen twice by the client
on behalf of two separate grabs,
AsyncKeyboard
thaws for both. AsyncKeyboard
has no effect if the keyboard is not frozen
by the client, but the keyboard need not be
grabbed by the client.
SyncKeyboard

If the keyboard is frozen and actively
grabbed by the client, keyboard event
processing continues as usual until the next
KeyPress
or KeyRelease event is reported to
the client. At this time, the keyboard again
appears to freeze. However, if the reported
event causes the keyboard grab to be
released, the keyboard does not freeze.
SyncKeyboard
has no effect if the keyboard is
not frozen by the client or if the keyboard
is not grabbed by the client.
ReplayKeyboard

If the keyboard is actively grabbed by the
client and is frozen as the result of an
event having been sent to the client (either
from the activation of an XGrabKey or from a
previous XAllowEvents with mode SyncKeyboard
but not from an XGrabKeyboard), the keyboard
grab is released and that event is completely
reprocessed. This time, however, the
function ignores any passive grabs at or
above (toward the root of) the grab_window of
the grab just released. The request has no
effect if the keyboard is not grabbed by the
client or if the keyboard is not frozen as
the result of an event.
SyncBoth

If both pointer and keyboard are frozen by
the client, event processing for both devices
continues as usual until the next
ButtonPress
, ButtonRelease, KeyPress, or
KeyRelease
event is reported to the client
for a grabbed device (button event for the
pointer, key event for the keyboard), at
which time the devices again appear to
freeze. However, if the reported event
causes the grab to be released, then the
devices do not freeze (but if the other
device is still grabbed, then a subsequent
event for it will still cause both devices to
freeze). SyncBoth has no effect unless both
pointer and keyboard are frozen by the
client. If the pointer or keyboard is frozen
twice by the client on behalf of two separate
grabs, SyncBoth thaws for both (but a
subsequent freeze for SyncBoth will only
freeze each device once).
AsyncBoth

If the pointer and the keyboard are frozen by
the client, event processing for both devices
continues as usual. If a device is frozen
twice by the client on behalf of two separate
grabs, AsyncBoth thaws for both. AsyncBoth
has no effect unless both pointer and
keyboard are frozen by the client.

AsyncPointer, SyncPointer, and ReplayPointer have no effect on the processing of keyboard events. AsyncKeyboard, SyncKeyboard, and ReplayKeyboard have no effect on the processing of pointer events. It is possible for both a pointer grab and a keyboard grab (by the same or different clients) to be active simultaneously. If a device is frozen on behalf of either grab, no event processing is performed for the device. It is possible for a single device to be frozen because of both grabs. In this case, the freeze must be released on behalf of both grabs before events can again be processed. If a device is frozen twice by a single client, then a single AllowEvents releases both.

XAllowEvents can generate a BadValue error.

12.4. Moving the Pointer

Although movement of the pointer normally should be left to the control of the end user, sometimes it is necessary to move the pointer to a new position under program control.

To move the pointer to an arbitrary point in a window, use XWarpPointer. __ │

XWarpPointer(display, src_w, dest_w, src_x, src_y, src_width, src_height, dest_x,
dest_y
)
Display *display;
Window src_w, dest_w;
int src_x, src_y;
unsigned int src_width, src_height;
int dest_x, dest_y;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

src_w

Specifies the source window or None.

dest_w

Specifies the destination window or None.

src_x

src_y

src_width

src_heightSpecify a rectangle in the source window.

dest_x

dest_y

Specify the x and y coordinates within the desti-

nation window. │__

If dest_w is None, XWarpPointer moves the pointer by the offsets (dest_x, dest_y) relative to the current position of the pointer. If dest_w is a window, XWarpPointer moves the pointer to the offsets (dest_x, dest_y) relative to the origin of dest_w. However, if src_w is a window, the move only takes place if the window src_w contains the pointer and if the specified rectangle of src_w contains the pointer.

The src_x and src_y coordinates are relative to the origin of src_w. If src_height is zero, it is replaced with the current height of src_w minus src_y. If src_width is zero, it is replaced with the current width of src_w minus src_x.

There is seldom any reason for calling this function. The pointer should normally be left to the user. If you do use this function, however, it generates events just as if the user had instantaneously moved the pointer from one position to another. Note that you cannot use XWarpPointer to move the pointer outside the confine_to window of an active pointer grab. An attempt to do so will only move the pointer as far as the closest edge of the confine_to window.

XWarpPointer can generate a BadWindow error.

12.5. Controlling Input Focus

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and get the input focus. The input focus is a shared resource, and cooperation among clients is required for correct interaction. See the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual for input focus policy.

To set the input focus, use XSetInputFocus. __ │

XSetInputFocus(display, focus, revert_to, time)
Display *display;
Window focus;
int revert_to;
Time time;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

focus

Specifies the window, PointerRoot, or None.

revert_to

Specifies where the input focus reverts to if the

window becomes not viewable. You can pass Revert-
ToParent
, RevertToPointerRoot, or RevertToNone.

time

Specifies the time. You can pass either a time-

stamp or CurrentTime. │__

The XSetInputFocus function changes the input focus and the last-focus-change time. It has no effect if the specified time is earlier than the current last-focus-change time or is later than the current X server time. Otherwise, the last-focus-change time is set to the specified time (CurrentTime is replaced by the current X server time). XSetInputFocus causes the X server to generate FocusIn and FocusOut events.

Depending on the focus argument, the following occurs:

If focus is None, all keyboard events are discarded until a new focus window is set, and the revert_to argument is ignored.

If focus is a window, it becomes the keyboard’s focus window. If a generated keyboard event would normally be reported to this window or one of its inferiors, the event is reported as usual. Otherwise, the event is reported relative to the focus window.

If focus is PointerRoot, the focus window is dynamically taken to be the root window of whatever screen the pointer is on at each keyboard event. In this case, the revert_to argument is ignored.

The specified focus window must be viewable at the time XSetInputFocus is called, or a BadMatch error results. If the focus window later becomes not viewable, the X server evaluates the revert_to argument to determine the new focus window as follows:

If revert_to is RevertToParent, the focus reverts to the parent (or the closest viewable ancestor), and the new revert_to value is taken to be RevertToNone.

If revert_to is RevertToPointerRoot or RevertToNone, the focus reverts to PointerRoot or None, respectively. When the focus reverts, the X server generates FocusIn and FocusOut events, but the last-focus-change time is not affected.

XSetInputFocus can generate BadMatch, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To obtain the current input focus, use XGetInputFocus. __ │

XGetInputFocus(display, focus_return, revert_to_return)
Display *display;
Window *focus_return;
int *revert_to_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

focus_return
Returns the focus window, PointerRoot, or None.

revert_to_return
Returns the current focus state (RevertToParent,
RevertToPointerRoot
, or RevertToNone). │__

The XGetInputFocus function returns the focus window and the current focus state.

12.6. Manipulating the Keyboard and Pointer Settings

Xlib provides functions that you can use to change the keyboard control, obtain a list of the auto-repeat keys, turn keyboard auto-repeat on or off, ring the bell, set or obtain the pointer button or keyboard mapping, and obtain a bit vector for the keyboard.

This section discusses the user-preference options of bell, key click, pointer behavior, and so on. The default values for many of these options are server dependent. Not all implementations will actually be able to control all of these parameters.

The XChangeKeyboardControl function changes control of a keyboard and operates on a XKeyboardControl structure: __ │

/* Mask bits for ChangeKeyboardControl */

#de-
fine
KBKeyClickPercent

(1L<<0)

#de-
fine
KBBellPercent

(1L<<1)

#de-
fine
KBBellPitch

(1L<<2)

#de-
fine
KBBellDuration

(1L<<3)

#de-
fine
KBLed

(1L<<4)

#de-
fine
KBLedMode

(1L<<5)

#de-
fine
KBKey

(1L<<6)

#de-
fine
KBAutoRepeatMode

(1L<<7)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

int key_click_percent;

int bell_percent;

int bell_pitch;

int bell_duration;

int led;

int led_mode;

/* LedModeOn, LedModeOff */

int key;

int auto_repeat_mode;/* AutoRepeatModeOff, AutoRepeatModeOn,

AutoRepeatModeDefault */
} XKeyboardControl; │__

The key_click_percent member sets the volume for key clicks between 0 (off) and 100 (loud) inclusive, if possible. A setting of −1 restores the default. Other negative values generate a BadValue error.

The bell_percent sets the base volume for the bell between 0 (off) and 100 (loud) inclusive, if possible. A setting of −1 restores the default. Other negative values generate a BadValue error. The bell_pitch member sets the pitch (specified in Hz) of the bell, if possible. A setting of −1 restores the default. Other negative values generate a BadValue error. The bell_duration member sets the duration of the bell specified in milliseconds, if possible. A setting of −1 restores the default. Other negative values generate a BadValue error.

If both the led_mode and led members are specified, the state of that LED is changed, if possible. The led_mode member can be set to LedModeOn or LedModeOff. If only led_mode is specified, the state of all LEDs are changed, if possible. At most 32 LEDs numbered from one are supported. No standard interpretation of LEDs is defined. If led is specified without led_mode, a BadMatch error results.

If both the auto_repeat_mode and key members are specified, the auto_repeat_mode of that key is changed (according to AutoRepeatModeOn, AutoRepeatModeOff, or AutoRepeatModeDefault), if possible. If only auto_repeat_mode is specified, the global auto_repeat_mode for the entire keyboard is changed, if possible, and does not affect the per-key settings. If a key is specified without an auto_repeat_mode, a BadMatch error results. Each key has an individual mode of whether or not it should auto-repeat and a default setting for the mode. In addition, there is a global mode of whether auto-repeat should be enabled or not and a default setting for that mode. When global mode is AutoRepeatModeOn, keys should obey their individual auto-repeat modes. When global mode is AutoRepeatModeOff, no keys should auto-repeat. An auto-repeating key generates alternating KeyPress and KeyRelease events. When a key is used as a modifier, it is desirable for the key not to auto-repeat, regardless of its auto-repeat setting.

A bell generator connected with the console but not directly on a keyboard is treated as if it were part of the keyboard. The order in which controls are verified and altered is server-dependent. If an error is generated, a subset of the controls may have been altered. __ │

XChangeKeyboardControl(display, value_mask, values)
Display *display;
unsigned long value_mask;
XKeyboardControl *values;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

value_maskSpecifies which controls to change. This mask is
the bitwise inclusive OR of the valid control mask
bits.

values

Specifies one value for each bit set to 1 in the

mask. │__

The XChangeKeyboardControl function controls the keyboard characteristics defined by the XKeyboardControl structure. The value_mask argument specifies which values are to be changed.

XChangeKeyboardControl can generate BadMatch and BadValue errors.

To obtain the current control values for the keyboard, use XGetKeyboardControl. __ │

XGetKeyboardControl(display, values_return)
Display *display;
XKeyboardState *values_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

values_return
Returns the current keyboard controls in the spec-
ified XKeyboardState structure. │__

The XGetKeyboardControl function returns the current control values for the keyboard to the XKeyboardState structure. __ │

typedef struct {

int key_click_percent;

int bell_percent;

unsigned int bell_pitch, bell_duration;

unsigned long led_mask;

int global_auto_repeat;

char auto_repeats[32];

} XKeyboardState; │__

For the LEDs, the least significant bit of led_mask corresponds to LED one, and each bit set to 1 in led_mask indicates an LED that is lit. The global_auto_repeat member can be set to AutoRepeatModeOn or AutoRepeatModeOff. The auto_repeats member is a bit vector. Each bit set to 1 indicates that auto-repeat is enabled for the corresponding key. The vector is represented as 32 bytes. Byte N (from 0) contains the bits for keys 8N to 8N + 7 with the least significant bit in the byte representing key 8N.

To turn on keyboard auto-repeat, use XAutoRepeatOn. __ │

XAutoRepeatOn(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XAutoRepeatOn function turns on auto-repeat for the keyboard on the specified display.

To turn off keyboard auto-repeat, use XAutoRepeatOff. __ │

XAutoRepeatOff(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XAutoRepeatOff function turns off auto-repeat for the keyboard on the specified display.

To ring the bell, use XBell. __ │

XBell(display, percent)
Display *display;
int percent;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

percent

Specifies the volume for the bell, which can range

from −100 to 100 inclusive. │__

The XBell function rings the bell on the keyboard on the specified display, if possible. The specified volume is relative to the base volume for the keyboard. If the value for the percent argument is not in the range −100 to 100 inclusive, a BadValue error results. The volume at which the bell rings when the percent argument is nonnegative is:

base − [(base * percent) / 100] + percent

The volume at which the bell rings when the percent argument is negative is:

base + [(base * percent) / 100]

To change the base volume of the bell, use XChangeKeyboardControl.

XBell can generate a BadValue error.

To obtain a bit vector that describes the state of the keyboard, use XQueryKeymap. __ │

XQueryKeymap(display, keys_return)
Display *display;
char keys_return[32];

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

keys_returnReturns an array of bytes that identifies which
keys are pressed down. Each bit represents one
key of the keyboard. │__

The XQueryKeymap function returns a bit vector for the logical state of the keyboard, where each bit set to 1 indicates that the corresponding key is currently pressed down. The vector is represented as 32 bytes. Byte N (from 0) contains the bits for keys 8N to 8N + 7 with the least significant bit in the byte representing key 8N.

Note that the logical state of a device (as seen by client applications) may lag the physical state if device event processing is frozen.

To set the mapping of the pointer buttons, use XSetPointerMapping. __ │

int XSetPointerMapping(display, map, nmap)
Display *display;
unsigned char map[];
int nmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

map

Specifies the mapping list.

nmap

Specifies the number of items in the mapping list. │__

The XSetPointerMapping function sets the mapping of the pointer. If it succeeds, the X server generates a MappingNotify event, and XSetPointerMapping returns MappingSuccess. Element map[i] defines the logical button number for the physical button i+1. The length of the list must be the same as XGetPointerMapping would return, or a BadValue error results. A zero element disables a button, and elements are not restricted in value by the number of physical buttons. However, no two elements can have the same nonzero value, or a BadValue error results. If any of the buttons to be altered are logically in the down state, XSetPointerMapping returns MappingBusy, and the mapping is not changed.

XSetPointerMapping can generate a BadValue error.

To get the pointer mapping, use XGetPointerMapping. __ │

int XGetPointerMapping(display, map_return, nmap)
Display *display;
unsigned char map_return[];
int nmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

map_returnReturns the mapping list.

nmap

Specifies the number of items in the mapping list. │__

The XGetPointerMapping function returns the current mapping of the pointer. Pointer buttons are numbered starting from one. XGetPointerMapping returns the number of physical buttons actually on the pointer. The nominal mapping for a pointer is map[i]=i+1. The nmap argument specifies the length of the array where the pointer mapping is returned, and only the first nmap elements are returned in map_return.

To control the pointer’s interactive feel, use XChangePointerControl. __ │

XChangePointerControl(display, do_accel, do_threshold, accel_numerator,
accel_denominator
, threshold)
Display *display;
Bool do_accel, do_threshold;
int accel_numerator, accel_denominator;
int threshold;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

do_accel

Specifies a Boolean value that controls whether

the values for the accel_numerator or accel_denom-
inator are used.

do_threshold
Specifies a Boolean value that controls whether
the value for the threshold is used.

accel_numerator
Specifies the numerator for the acceleration mul-
tiplier.

accel_denominator
Specifies the denominator for the acceleration
multiplier.

threshold

Specifies the acceleration threshold. │__

The XChangePointerControl function defines how the pointing device moves. The acceleration, expressed as a fraction, is a multiplier for movement. For example, specifying 3/1 means the pointer moves three times as fast as normal. The fraction may be rounded arbitrarily by the X server. Acceleration only takes effect if the pointer moves more than threshold pixels at once and only applies to the amount beyond the value in the threshold argument. Setting a value to −1 restores the default. The values of the do_accel and do_threshold arguments must be True for the pointer values to be set, or the parameters are unchanged. Negative values (other than −1) generate a BadValue error, as does a zero value for the accel_denominator argument.

XChangePointerControl can generate a BadValue error.

To get the current pointer parameters, use XGetPointerControl. __ │

XGetPointerControl(display, accel_numerator_return, accel_denominator_return,
threshold_return
)
Display *display;
int *accel_numerator_return, *accel_denominator_return;
int *threshold_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

accel_numerator_return
Returns the numerator for the acceleration multi-
plier.

accel_denominator_return
Returns the denominator for the acceleration mul-
tiplier.

threshold_return
Returns the acceleration threshold. │__

The XGetPointerControl function returns the pointer’s current acceleration multiplier and acceleration threshold.

12.7. Manipulating the Keyboard Encoding

A KeyCode represents a physical (or logical) key. KeyCodes lie in the inclusive range [8,255]. A KeyCode value carries no intrinsic information, although server implementors may attempt to encode geometry (for example, matrix) information in some fashion so that it can be interpreted in a server-dependent fashion. The mapping between keys and KeyCodes cannot be changed.

A KeySym is an encoding of a symbol on the cap of a key. The set of defined KeySyms includes the ISO Latin character sets (1−4), Katakana, Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek, Technical, Special, Publishing, APL, Hebrew, Thai, Korean and a miscellany of keys found on keyboards (Return, Help, Tab, and so on). To the extent possible, these sets are derived from international standards. In areas where no standards exist, some of these sets are derived from Digital Equipment Corporation standards. The list of defined symbols can be found in <X11/keysymdef.h>. Unfortunately, some C preprocessors have limits on the number of defined symbols. If you must use KeySyms not in the Latin 1−4, Greek, and miscellaneous classes, you may have to define a symbol for those sets. Most applications usually only include <X11/keysym.h>, which defines symbols for ISO Latin 1−4, Greek, and miscellaneous.

A list of KeySyms is associated with each KeyCode. The list is intended to convey the set of symbols on the corresponding key. If the list (ignoring trailing NoSymbol entries) is a single KeySym ‘‘K’’, then the list is treated as if it were the list ‘‘K NoSymbol K NoSymbol’’. If the list (ignoring trailing NoSymbol entries) is a pair of KeySyms ‘‘K1 K2’’, then the list is treated as if it were the list ‘‘K1 K2 K1 K2’’. If the list (ignoring trailing NoSymbol entries) is a triple of KeySyms ‘‘K1 K2 K3’’, then the list is treated as if it were the list ‘‘K1 K2 K3 NoSymbol’’. When an explicit ‘‘void’’ element is desired in the list, the value VoidSymbol can be used.

The first four elements of the list are split into two groups of KeySyms. Group 1 contains the first and second KeySyms; Group 2 contains the third and fourth KeySyms. Within each group, if the second element of the group is NoSymbol, then the group should be treated as if the second element were the same as the first element, except when the first element is an alphabetic KeySym ‘‘K’’ for which both lowercase and uppercase forms are defined. In that case, the group should be treated as if the first element were the lowercase form of ‘‘K’’ and the second element were the uppercase form of ‘‘K’’.

The standard rules for obtaining a KeySym from a KeyPress event make use of only the Group 1 and Group 2 KeySyms; no interpretation of other KeySyms in the list is given. Which group to use is determined by the modifier state. Switching between groups is controlled by the KeySym named MODE SWITCH, by attaching that KeySym to some KeyCode and attaching that KeyCode to any one of the modifiers Mod1 through Mod5. This modifier is called the group modifier. For any KeyCode, Group 1 is used when the group modifier is off, and Group 2 is used when the group modifier is on.

The Lock modifier is interpreted as CapsLock when the KeySym named XK_Caps_Lock is attached to some KeyCode and that KeyCode is attached to the Lock modifier. The Lock modifier is interpreted as ShiftLock when the KeySym named XK_Shift_Lock is attached to some KeyCode and that KeyCode is attached to the Lock modifier. If the Lock modifier could be interpreted as both CapsLock and ShiftLock, the CapsLock interpretation is used.

The operation of keypad keys is controlled by the KeySym named XK_Num_Lock, by attaching that KeySym to some KeyCode and attaching that KeyCode to any one of the modifiers Mod1 through Mod5. This modifier is called the numlock modifier. The standard KeySyms with the prefix ‘‘XK_KP_’’ in their name are called keypad KeySyms; these are KeySyms with numeric value in the hexadecimal range 0xFF80 to 0xFFBD inclusive. In addition, vendor-specific KeySyms in the hexadecimal range 0x11000000 to 0x1100FFFF are also keypad KeySyms.

Within a group, the choice of KeySym is determined by applying the first rule that is satisfied from the following list:

The numlock modifier is on and the second KeySym is a keypad KeySym. In this case, if the Shift modifier is on, or if the Lock modifier is on and is interpreted as ShiftLock, then the first KeySym is used, otherwise the second KeySym is used.

The Shift and Lock modifiers are both off. In this case, the first KeySym is used.

The Shift modifier is off, and the Lock modifier is on and is interpreted as CapsLock. In this case, the first KeySym is used, but if that KeySym is lowercase alphabetic, then the corresponding uppercase KeySym is used instead.

The Shift modifier is on, and the Lock modifier is on and is interpreted as CapsLock. In this case, the second KeySym is used, but if that KeySym is lowercase alphabetic, then the corresponding uppercase KeySym is used instead.

The Shift modifier is on, or the Lock modifier is on and is interpreted as ShiftLock, or both. In this case, the second KeySym is used.

No spatial geometry of the symbols on the key is defined by their order in the KeySym list, although a geometry might be defined on a server-specific basis. The X server does not use the mapping between KeyCodes and KeySyms. Rather, it merely stores it for reading and writing by clients.

To obtain the legal KeyCodes for a display, use XDisplayKeycodes. __ │

XDisplayKeycodes(display, min_keycodes_return, max_keycodes_return)
Display *display;
int *min_keycodes_return, *max_keycodes_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

min_keycodes_return
Returns the minimum number of KeyCodes.

max_keycodes_return
Returns the maximum number of KeyCodes. │__

The XDisplayKeycodes function returns the min-keycodes and max-keycodes supported by the specified display. The minimum number of KeyCodes returned is never less than 8, and the maximum number of KeyCodes returned is never greater than 255. Not all KeyCodes in this range are required to have corresponding keys.

To obtain the symbols for the specified KeyCodes, use XGetKeyboardMapping. __ │

KeySym *XGetKeyboardMapping(display, first_keycode, keycode_count,
keysyms_per_keycode_return
)
Display *display;
KeyCode first_keycode;
int keycode_count;
int *keysyms_per_keycode_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

first_keycode
Specifies the first KeyCode that is to be re-
turned.

keycode_count
Specifies the number of KeyCodes that are to be
returned.

keysyms_per_keycode_return
Returns the number of KeySyms per KeyCode. │__

The XGetKeyboardMapping function returns the symbols for the specified number of KeyCodes starting with first_keycode. The value specified in first_keycode must be greater than or equal to min_keycode as returned by XDisplayKeycodes, or a BadValue error results. In addition, the following expression must be less than or equal to max_keycode as returned by XDisplayKeycodes:

first_keycode + keycode_count − 1

If this is not the case, a BadValue error results. The number of elements in the KeySyms list is:

keycode_count * keysyms_per_keycode_return

KeySym number N, counting from zero, for KeyCode K has the following index in the list, counting from zero:

(K − first_code) * keysyms_per_code_return + N

The X server arbitrarily chooses the keysyms_per_keycode_return value to be large enough to report all requested symbols. A special KeySym value of NoSymbol is used to fill in unused elements for individual KeyCodes. To free the storage returned by XGetKeyboardMapping, use XFree.

XGetKeyboardMapping can generate a BadValue error.

To change the keyboard mapping, use XChangeKeyboardMapping. __ │

XChangeKeyboardMapping(display, first_keycode, keysyms_per_keycode, keysyms, num_codes)
Display *display;
int first_keycode;
int keysyms_per_keycode;
KeySym *keysyms;
int num_codes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

first_keycode
Specifies the first KeyCode that is to be changed.

keysyms_per_keycode
Specifies the number of KeySyms per KeyCode.

keysyms

Specifies an array of KeySyms.

num_codes

Specifies the number of KeyCodes that are to be

changed. │__

The XChangeKeyboardMapping function defines the symbols for the specified number of KeyCodes starting with first_keycode. The symbols for KeyCodes outside this range remain unchanged. The number of elements in keysyms must be:

num_codes * keysyms_per_keycode

The specified first_keycode must be greater than or equal to min_keycode returned by XDisplayKeycodes, or a BadValue error results. In addition, the following expression must be less than or equal to max_keycode as returned by XDisplayKeycodes, or a BadValue error results:

first_keycode + num_codes − 1

KeySym number N, counting from zero, for KeyCode K has the following index in keysyms, counting from zero:

(K − first_keycode) * keysyms_per_keycode + N

The specified keysyms_per_keycode can be chosen arbitrarily by the client to be large enough to hold all desired symbols. A special KeySym value of NoSymbol should be used to fill in unused elements for individual KeyCodes. It is legal for NoSymbol to appear in nontrailing positions of the effective list for a KeyCode. XChangeKeyboardMapping generates a MappingNotify event.

There is no requirement that the X server interpret this mapping. It is merely stored for reading and writing by clients.

XChangeKeyboardMapping can generate BadAlloc and BadValue errors.

The next six functions make use of the XModifierKeymap data structure, which contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int max_keypermod;

/* This server’s max number of keys per modifier */

KeyCode *modifiermap;/* An 8 by max_keypermod array of the modifiers */

} XModifierKeymap; │__

To create an XModifierKeymap structure, use XNewModifiermap. __ │

XModifierKeymap *XNewModifiermap(max_keys_per_mod)
int max_keys_per_mod;

max_keys_per_mod
Specifies the number of KeyCode entries preallo-
cated to the modifiers in the map. │__

The XNewModifiermap function returns a pointer to XModifierKeymap structure for later use.

To add a new entry to an XModifierKeymap structure, use XInsertModifiermapEntry. __ │

XModifierKeymap *XInsertModifiermapEntry(modmap, keycode_entry, modifier)
XModifierKeymap *modmap;
KeyCode keycode_entry;
int modifier;

modmap

Specifies the XModifierKeymap structure.

keycode_entry
Specifies the KeyCode.

modifier

Specifies the modifier. │__

The XInsertModifiermapEntry function adds the specified KeyCode to the set that controls the specified modifier and returns the resulting XModifierKeymap structure (expanded as needed).

To delete an entry from an XModifierKeymap structure, use XDeleteModifiermapEntry. __ │

XModifierKeymap *XDeleteModifiermapEntry(modmap, keycode_entry, modifier)
XModifierKeymap *modmap;
KeyCode keycode_entry;
int modifier;

modmap

Specifies the XModifierKeymap structure.

keycode_entry
Specifies the KeyCode.

modifier

Specifies the modifier. │__

The XDeleteModifiermapEntry function deletes the specified KeyCode from the set that controls the specified modifier and returns a pointer to the resulting XModifierKeymap structure.

To destroy an XModifierKeymap structure, use XFreeModifiermap. __ │

XFreeModifiermap(modmap)
XModifierKeymap *modmap;

modmap

Specifies the XModifierKeymap structure. │__

The XFreeModifiermap function frees the specified XModifierKeymap structure.

To set the KeyCodes to be used as modifiers, use XSetModifierMapping. __ │

int XSetModifierMapping(display, modmap)
Display *display;
XModifierKeymap *modmap;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

modmap

Specifies the XModifierKeymap structure. │__

The XSetModifierMapping function specifies the KeyCodes of the keys (if any) that are to be used as modifiers. If it succeeds, the X server generates a MappingNotify event, and XSetModifierMapping returns MappingSuccess. X permits at most 8 modifier keys. If more than 8 are specified in the XModifierKeymap structure, a BadLength error results.

The modifiermap member of the XModifierKeymap structure contains 8 sets of max_keypermod KeyCodes, one for each modifier in the order Shift, Lock, Control, Mod1, Mod2, Mod3, Mod4, and Mod5. Only nonzero KeyCodes have meaning in each set, and zero KeyCodes are ignored. In addition, all of the nonzero KeyCodes must be in the range specified by min_keycode and max_keycode in the Display structure, or a BadValue error results.

An X server can impose restrictions on how modifiers can be changed, for example, if certain keys do not generate up transitions in hardware, if auto-repeat cannot be disabled on certain keys, or if multiple modifier keys are not supported. If some such restriction is violated, the status reply is MappingFailed, and none of the modifiers are changed. If the new KeyCodes specified for a modifier differ from those currently defined and any (current or new) keys for that modifier are in the logically down state, XSetModifierMapping returns MappingBusy, and none of the modifiers is changed.

XSetModifierMapping can generate BadAlloc and BadValue errors.

To obtain the KeyCodes used as modifiers, use XGetModifierMapping. __ │

XModifierKeymap *XGetModifierMapping(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XGetModifierMapping function returns a pointer to a newly created XModifierKeymap structure that contains the keys being used as modifiers. The structure should be freed after use by calling XFreeModifiermap. If only zero values appear in the set for any modifier, that modifier is disabled.

12

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 13

Locales and Internationalized Text Functions

An internationalized application is one that is adaptable to the requirements of different native languages, local customs, and character string encodings. The process of adapting the operation to a particular native language, local custom, or string encoding is called localization. A goal of internationalization is to permit localization without program source modifications or recompilation.

As one of the localization mechanisms, Xlib provides an X Input Method (XIM) functional interface for internationalized text input and an X Output Method (XOM) functional interface for internationalized text output.

Internationalization in X is based on the concept of a locale. A locale defines the localized behavior of a program at run time. Locales affect Xlib in its:

Encoding and processing of input method text

Encoding of resource files and values

Encoding and imaging of text strings

Encoding and decoding for inter-client text communication

Characters from various languages are represented in a computer using an encoding. Different languages have different encodings, and there are even different encodings for the same characters in the same language.

This chapter defines support for localized text imaging and text input and describes the locale mechanism that controls all locale-dependent Xlib functions. Sets of functions are provided for multibyte (char *) text as well as wide character (wchar_t) text in the form supported by the host C language environment. The multibyte and wide character functions are equivalent except for the form of the text argument.

The Xlib internationalization functions are not meant to provide support for multilingual applications (mixing multiple languages within a single piece of text), but they make it possible to implement applications that work in limited fashion with more than one language in independent contexts.

The remainder of this chapter discusses:

X locale management

Locale and modifier dependencies

Variable argument lists

Output methods

Input methods

String constants

13.1. X Locale Management

X supports one or more of the locales defined by the host environment. On implementations that conform to the ANSI C library, the locale announcement method is setlocale. This function configures the locale operation of both the host C library and Xlib. The operation of Xlib is governed by the LC_CTYPE category; this is called the current locale. An implementation is permitted to provide implementation-dependent mechanisms for announcing the locale in addition to setlocale.

On implementations that do not conform to the ANSI C library, the locale announcement method is Xlib implementation-dependent.

The mechanism by which the semantic operation of Xlib is defined for a specific locale is implementation-dependent.

X is not required to support all the locales supported by the host. To determine if the current locale is supported by X, use XSupportsLocale. __ │

Bool XSupportsLocale() │__

The XSupportsLocale function returns True if Xlib functions are capable of operating under the current locale. If it returns False, Xlib locale-dependent functions for which the XLocaleNotSupported return status is defined will return XLocaleNotSupported. Other Xlib locale-dependent routines will operate in the ‘‘C’’ locale.

The client is responsible for selecting its locale and X modifiers. Clients should provide a means for the user to override the clients’ locale selection at client invocation. Most single-display X clients operate in a single locale for both X and the host processing environment. They will configure the locale by calling three functions: the host locale configuration function, XSupportsLocale, and XSetLocaleModifiers.

The semantics of certain categories of X internationalization capabilities can be configured by setting modifiers. Modifiers are named by implementation-dependent and locale-specific strings. The only standard use for this capability at present is selecting one of several styles of keyboard input method.

To configure Xlib locale modifiers for the current locale, use XSetLocaleModifiers. __ │

char *XSetLocaleModifiers(modifier_list)
char *modifier_list;

modifier_list
Specifies the modifiers. │__

The XSetLocaleModifiers function sets the X modifiers for the current locale setting. The modifier_list argument is a null-terminated string of the form ‘‘{@category=value}’’, that is, having zero or more concatenated ‘‘@category=value’’ entries, where category is a category name and value is the (possibly empty) setting for that category. The values are encoded in the current locale. Category names are restricted to the POSIX Portable Filename Character Set.

The local host X locale modifiers announcer (on POSIX-compliant systems, the XMODIFIERS environment variable) is appended to the modifier_list to provide default values on the local host. If a given category appears more than once in the list, the first setting in the list is used. If a given category is not included in the full modifier list, the category is set to an implementation-dependent default for the current locale. An empty value for a category explicitly specifies the implementation-dependent default.

If the function is successful, it returns a pointer to a string. The contents of the string are such that a subsequent call with that string (in the same locale) will restore the modifiers to the same settings. If modifier_list is a NULL pointer, XSetLocaleModifiers also returns a pointer to such a string, and the current locale modifiers are not changed.

If invalid values are given for one or more modifier categories supported by the locale, a NULL pointer is returned, and none of the current modifiers are changed.

At program startup, the modifiers that are in effect are unspecified until the first successful call to set them. Whenever the locale is changed, the modifiers that are in effect become unspecified until the next successful call to set them. Clients should always call XSetLocaleModifiers with a non-NULL modifier_list after setting the locale before they call any locale-dependent Xlib routine.

The only standard modifier category currently defined is ‘‘im’’, which identifies the desired input method. The values for input method are not standardized. A single locale may use multiple input methods, switching input method under user control. The modifier may specify the initial input method in effect or an ordered list of input methods. Multiple input methods may be specified in a single im value string in an implementation-dependent manner.

The returned modifiers string is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It may be freed by Xlib after the current locale or modifiers are changed. Until freed, it will not be modified by Xlib.

The recommended procedure for clients initializing their locale and modifiers is to obtain locale and modifier announcers separately from one of the following prioritized sources:

A command line option

A resource

The empty string ("")

The first of these that is defined should be used. Note that when a locale command line option or locale resource is defined, the effect should be to set all categories to the specified locale, overriding any category-specific settings in the local host environment.

13.2. Locale and Modifier Dependencies

The internationalized Xlib functions operate in the current locale configured by the host environment and X locale modifiers set by XSetLocaleModifiers or in the locale and modifiers configured at the time some object supplied to the function was created. For each locale-dependent function, the following table describes the locale (and modifiers) dependency:
Locale from Affects the Function In

Locale Query/Configuration:
setlocale
XSupportsLocale

Locale queried
XSetLocaleModifiers

Locale modified

Resources:
setlocale
XrmGetFileDatabase

Locale of XrmDatabase
XrmGetStringDatabase
XrmDatabase
XrmPutFileDatabase

Locale of XrmDatabase
XrmLocaleOfDatabase

Setting Standard Properties:
setlocale
XmbSetWMProperties

Encoding of
supplied/returned
text (some WM_ property
text in environment locale)
setlocale
XmbTextPropertyToTextList

Encoding of
supplied/returned text
XwcTextPropertyToTextList
XmbTextListToTextProperty
XwcTextListToTextProperty

Text Input:
setlocale
XOpenIM

XIM input method selection
XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback

XIM selection
XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback

XIM selection
XIM
XCreateIC

XIC input method
configuration
XLocaleOfIM
, and so on
Queried locale
XIC
XmbLookupString

Keyboard layout
XwcLookupString

Encoding of returned text

Text Drawing:
setlocale
XOpenOM

XOM output method selection
XCreateFontSet

Charsets of fonts in
XFontSet
XOM
XCreateOC

XOC output method
configuration
XLocaleOfOM
, and so on
Queried locale
XFontSet
XmbDrawText
,
Locale of supplied text
XwcDrawText
, and so on
Locale of supplied text
XExtentsOfFontSet
, and so on
Locale-dependent metrics
XmbTextExtents
,
XwcTextExtents
, and so on

Xlib Errors:
setlocale
XGetErrorDatabaseText

Locale of error message
XGetErrorText

Clients may assume that a locale-encoded text string returned by an X function can be passed to a C library routine, or vice versa, if the locale is the same at the two calls.

All text strings processed by internationalized Xlib functions are assumed to begin in the initial state of the encoding of the locale, if the encoding is state-dependent.

All Xlib functions behave as if they do not change the current locale or X modifier setting. (This means that if they do change locale or call XSetLocaleModifiers with a non-NULL argument, they must save and restore the current state on entry and exit.) Also, Xlib functions on implementations that conform to the ANSI C library do not alter the global state associated with the ANSI C functions mblen, mbtowc, wctomb, and strtok.

13.3. Variable Argument Lists

Various functions in this chapter have arguments that conform to the ANSI C variable argument list calling convention. Each function denoted with an argument of the form ‘‘...’’ takes a variable-length list of name and value pairs, where each name is a string and each value is of type XPointer. A name argument that is NULL identifies the end of the list.

A variable-length argument list may contain a nested list. If the name XNVaNestedList is specified in place of an argument name, then the following value is interpreted as an XVaNestedList value that specifies a list of values logically inserted into the original list at the point of declaration. A NULL identifies the end of a nested list.

To allocate a nested variable argument list dynamically, use XVaCreateNestedList. __ │

typedef void * XVaNestedList;

XVaNestedList XVaCreateNestedList(dummy, ...)
int dummy;

dummy

Specifies an unused argument (required by ANSI C).

...

Specifies the variable length argument list. │__

The XVaCreateNestedList function allocates memory and copies its arguments into a single list pointer, which may be used as a value for arguments requiring a list value. Any entries are copied as specified. Data passed by reference is not copied; the caller must ensure data remains valid for the lifetime of the nested list. The list should be freed using XFree when it is no longer needed.

13.4. Output Methods

This section provides discussions of the following X Output Method (XOM) topics:

Output method overview

Output method functions

Output method values

Output context functions

Output context values

Creating and freeing a font set

Obtaining font set metrics

Drawing text using font sets

13.4.1. Output Method Overview

Locale-dependent text may include one or more text components, each of which may require different fonts and character set encodings. In some languages, each component might have a different drawing direction, and some components might contain context-dependent characters that change shape based on relationships with neighboring characters.

When drawing such locale-dependent text, some locale-specific knowledge is required; for example, what fonts are required to draw the text, how the text can be separated into components, and which fonts are selected to draw each component. Further, when bidirectional text must be drawn, the internal representation order of the text must be changed into the visual representation order to be drawn.

An X Output Method provides a functional interface so that clients do not have to deal directly with such locale-dependent details. Output methods provide the following capabilities:

Creating a set of fonts required to draw locale-dependent text.

Drawing locale-dependent text with a font set without the caller needing to be aware of locale dependencies.

Obtaining the escapement and extents in pixels of locale-dependent text.

Determining if bidirectional or context-dependent drawing is required in a specific locale with a specific font set.

Two different abstractions are used in the representation of the output method for clients.

The abstraction used to communicate with an output method is an opaque data structure represented by the XOM data type. The abstraction for representing the state of a particular output thread is called an output context. The Xlib representation of an output context is an XOC, which is compatible with XFontSet in terms of its functional interface, but is a broader, more generalized abstraction.

13.4.2. Output Method Functions

To open an output method, use XOpenOM. __ │

XOM XOpenOM(display, db, res_name, res_class)
Display *display;
XrmDatabase db;
char *res_name;
char *res_class;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

db

Specifies a pointer to the resource database.

res_name

Specifies the full resource name of the applica-

tion.

res_class

Specifies the full class name of the application. │__

The XOpenOM function opens an output method matching the current locale and modifiers specification. The current locale and modifiers are bound to the output method when XOpenOM is called. The locale associated with an output method cannot be changed.

The specific output method to which this call will be routed is identified on the basis of the current locale and modifiers. XOpenOM will identify a default output method corresponding to the current locale. That default can be modified using XSetLocaleModifiers to set the output method modifier.

The db argument is the resource database to be used by the output method for looking up resources that are private to the output method. It is not intended that this database be used to look up values that can be set as OC values in an output context. If db is NULL, no database is passed to the output method.

The res_name and res_class arguments specify the resource name and class of the application. They are intended to be used as prefixes by the output method when looking up resources that are common to all output contexts that may be created for this output method. The characters used for resource names and classes must be in the X Portable Character Set. The resources looked up are not fully specified if res_name or res_class is NULL.

The res_name and res_class arguments are not assumed to exist beyond the call to XOpenOM. The specified resource database is assumed to exist for the lifetime of the output method.

XOpenOM returns NULL if no output method could be opened.

To close an output method, use XCloseOM. __ │

Status XCloseOM(om)
XOM om;

om

Specifies the output method. │__

The XCloseOM function closes the specified output method.

To set output method attributes, use XSetOMValues. __ │

char * XSetOMValues(om, ...)
XOM om;

om

Specifies the output method.

...

Specifies the variable-length argument list to set

XOM values. │__

The XSetOMValues function presents a variable argument list programming interface for setting properties or features of the specified output method. This function returns NULL if it succeeds; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be obtained.

No standard arguments are currently defined by Xlib.

To query an output method, use XGetOMValues. __ │

char * XGetOMValues(om, ...)
XOM om;

om

Specifies the output method.

...

Specifies the variable-length argument list to get

XOM values. │__

The XGetOMValues function presents a variable argument list programming interface for querying properties or features of the specified output method. This function returns NULL if it succeeds; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be obtained.

To obtain the display associated with an output method, use XDisplayOfOM. __ │

Display * XDisplayOfOM(om)

XOM om;

om

Specifies the output method. │__

The XDisplayOfOM function returns the display associated with the specified output method.

To get the locale associated with an output method, use XLocaleOfOM. __ │

char * XLocaleOfOM(om)
XOM om;

om

Specifies the output method. │__

The XLocaleOfOM returns the locale associated with the specified output method.

13.4.3. X Output Method Values

The following table describes how XOM values are interpreted by an output method. The first column lists the XOM values. The second column indicates how each of the XOM values are treated by a particular output style.

The following key applies to this table.
Key Explanation

G
This value may be read using XGetOMValues.
XOM Value Key
XNRequiredCharSet

G
XNQueryOrientation

G
XNDirectionalDependentDrawing

G
XNContextualDrawing

G

13.4.3.1. Required Char Set

The XNRequiredCharSet argument returns the list of charsets that are required for loading the fonts needed for the locale. The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XOMCharSetList.

The XOMCharSetList structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct {

int charset_count;

char **charset_list;

} XOMCharSetList; │__

The charset_list member is a list of one or more null-terminated charset names, and the charset_count member is the number of charset names.

The required charset list is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It will be freed by a call to XCloseOM with the associated XOM. Until freed, its contents will not be modified by Xlib.

13.4.3.2. Query Orientation

The XNQueryOrientation argument returns the global orientation of text when drawn. Other than XOMOrientation_LTR_TTB, the set of orientations supported is locale-dependent. The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XOMOrientation. Clients are responsible for freeing the XOMOrientation structure by using XFree; this also frees the contents of the structure. __ │

typedef struct {

int num_orientation;

XOrientation *orientation;/* Input Text description */

} XOMOrientation;

typedef enum {

XOMOrientation_LTR_TTB,

XOMOrientation_RTL_TTB,

XOMOrientation_TTB_LTR,

XOMOrientation_TTB_RTL,

XOMOrientation_Context

} XOrientation; │__

The possible value for XOrientation may be:

XOMOrientation_LTR_TTB left-to-right, top-to-bottom global orientation

XOMOrientation_RTL_TTB right-to-left, top-to-bottom global orientation

XOMOrientation_TTB_LTR top-to-bottom, left-to-right global orientation

XOMOrientation_TTB_RTL top-to-bottom, right-to-left global orientation

XOMOrientation_Context contextual global orientation

13.4.3.3. Directional Dependent Drawing

The XNDirectionalDependentDrawing argument indicates whether the text rendering functions implement implicit handling of directional text. If this value is True, the output method has knowledge of directional dependencies and reorders text as necessary when rendering text. If this value is False, the output method does not implement any directional text handling, and all character directions are assumed to be left-to-right.

Regardless of the rendering order of characters, the origins of all characters are on the primary draw direction side of the drawing origin.

This OM value presents functionality identical to the XDirectionalDependentDrawing function.

13.4.3.4. Context Dependent Drawing

The XNContextualDrawing argument indicates whether the text rendering functions implement implicit context-dependent drawing. If this value is True, the output method has knowledge of context dependencies and performs character shape editing, combining glyphs to present a single character as necessary. The actual shape editing is dependent on the locale implementation and the font set used.

This OM value presents functionality identical to the XContextualDrawing function.

13.4.4. Output Context Functions

An output context is an abstraction that contains both the data required by an output method and the information required to display that data. There can be multiple output contexts for one output method. The programming interfaces for creating, reading, or modifying an output context use a variable argument list. The name elements of the argument lists are referred to as XOC values. It is intended that output methods be controlled by these XOC values. As new XOC values are created, they should be registered with the X Consortium. An XOC can be used anywhere an XFontSet can be used, and vice versa; XFontSet is retained for compatibility with previous releases. The concepts of output methods and output contexts include broader, more generalized abstraction than font set, supporting complex and more intelligent text display, and dealing not only with multiple fonts but also with context dependencies. However, XFontSet is widely used in several interfaces, so XOC is defined as an upward compatible type of XFontSet.

To create an output context, use XCreateOC. __ │

XOC XCreateOC(om, ...)
XOM om;

om

Specifies the output method.

...

Specifies the variable-length argument list to set

XOC values. │__

The XCreateOC function creates an output context within the specified output method.

The base font names argument is mandatory at creation time, and the output context will not be created unless it is provided. All other output context values can be set later.

XCreateOC returns NULL if no output context could be created. NULL can be returned for any of the following reasons:

A required argument was not set.

A read-only argument was set.

An argument name is not recognized.

The output method encountered an output method implementation-dependent error.

XCreateOC can generate a BadAtom error.

To destroy an output context, use XDestroyOC. __ │

void XDestroyOC(oc)
XOC oc;

oc

Specifies the output context. │__

The XDestroyOC function destroys the specified output context.

To get the output method associated with an output context, use XOMOfOC. __ │

XOM XOMOfOC(oc)
XOC oc;

oc

Specifies the output context. │__

The XOMOfOC function returns the output method associated with the specified output context.

Xlib provides two functions for setting and reading output context values, respectively, XSetOCValues and XGetOCValues. Both functions have a variable-length argument list. In that argument list, any XOC value’s name must be denoted with a character string using the X Portable Character Set.

To set XOC values, use XSetOCValues. __ │

char * XSetOCValues(oc, ...)
XOC oc;

oc

Specifies the output context.

...

Specifies the variable-length argument list to set

XOC values. │__

The XSetOCValues function returns NULL if no error occurred; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be set. An argument might not be set for any of the following reasons:

The argument is read-only.

The argument name is not recognized.

An implementation-dependent error occurs.

Each value to be set must be an appropriate datum, matching the data type imposed by the semantics of the argument.

XSetOCValues can generate a BadAtom error.

To obtain XOC values, use XGetOCValues. __ │

char * XGetOCValues(oc, ...)
XOC oc;

oc

Specifies the output context.

...

Specifies the variable-length argument list to get

XOC values. │__

The XGetOCValues function returns NULL if no error occurred; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be obtained. An argument might not be obtained for any of the following reasons:

The argument name is not recognized.

An implementation-dependent error occurs.

Each argument value following a name must point to a location where the value is to be stored.

13.4.5. Output Context Values

The following table describes how XOC values are interpreted by an output method. The first column lists the XOC values. The second column indicates the alternative interfaces that function identically and are provided for compatibility with previous releases. The third column indicates how each of the XOC values is treated.

The following keys apply to this table.
Key Explanation

C
This value must be set with XCreateOC.
D
This value may be set using XCreateOC. If it
is not set,
a default is provided.
G
This value may be read using XGetOCValues.
S
This value must be set using XSetOCValues.
XOC Value Alternative Interface Key

BaseFontName
XCreateFontSet

C-G
MissingCharSet
XCreateFontSet

G
DefaultString
XCreateFontSet

G
Orientation

D-S-G
ResourceName

S-G
ResourceClass

S-G
FontInfo
XFontsOfFontSet

G
OMAutomatic

G

13.4.5.1. Base Font Name

The XNBaseFontName argument is a list of base font names that Xlib uses to load the fonts needed for the locale. The base font names are a comma-separated list. The string is null-terminated and is assumed to be in the Host Portable Character Encoding; otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. White space immediately on either side of a separating comma is ignored.

Use of XLFD font names permits Xlib to obtain the fonts needed for a variety of locales from a single locale-independent base font name. The single base font name should name a family of fonts whose members are encoded in the various charsets needed by the locales of interest.

An XLFD base font name can explicitly name a charset needed for the locale. This allows the user to specify an exact font for use with a charset required by a locale, fully controlling the font selection.

If a base font name is not an XLFD name, Xlib will attempt to obtain an XLFD name from the font properties for the font. If Xlib is successful, the XGetOCValues function will return this XLFD name instead of the client-supplied name.

This argument must be set at creation time and cannot be changed. If no fonts exist for any of the required charsets, or if the locale definition in Xlib requires that a font exist for a particular charset and a font is not found for that charset, XCreateOC returns NULL.

When querying for the XNBaseFontName XOC value, XGetOCValues returns a null-terminated string identifying the base font names that Xlib used to load the fonts needed for the locale. This string is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. The string will be freed by a call to XDestroyOC with the associated XOC. Until freed, the string contents will not be modified by Xlib.

13.4.5.2. Missing CharSet

The XNMissingCharSet argument returns the list of required charsets that are missing from the font set. The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XOMCharSetList.

If fonts exist for all of the charsets required by the current locale, charset_list is set to NULL and charset_count is set to zero. If no fonts exist for one or more of the required charsets, charset_list is set to a list of one or more null-terminated charset names for which no fonts exist, and charset_count is set to the number of missing charsets. The charsets are from the list of the required charsets for the encoding of the locale and do not include any charsets to which Xlib may be able to remap a required charset.

The missing charset list is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It will be freed by a call to XDestroyOC with the associated XOC. Until freed, its contents will not be modified by Xlib.

13.4.5.3. Default String

When a drawing or measuring function is called with an XOC that has missing charsets, some characters in the locale will not be drawable. The XNDefaultString argument returns a pointer to a string that represents the glyphs that are drawn with this XOC when the charsets of the available fonts do not include all glyphs required to draw a character. The string does not necessarily consist of valid characters in the current locale and is not necessarily drawn with the fonts loaded for the font set, but the client can draw or measure the default glyphs by including this string in a string being drawn or measured with the XOC.

If the XNDefaultString argument returned the empty string (""), no glyphs are drawn and the escapement is zero. The returned string is null-terminated. It is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It will be freed by a call to XDestroyOC with the associated XOC. Until freed, its contents will not be modified by Xlib.

13.4.5.4. Orientation

The XNOrientation argument specifies the current orientation of text when drawn. The value of this argument is one of the values returned by the XGetOMValues function with the XNQueryOrientation argument specified in the XOrientation list. The value of the argument is of type XOrientation. When XNOrientation is queried, the value specifies the current orientation. When XNOrientation is set, a value is used to set the current orientation.

When XOMOrientation_Context is set, the text orientation of the text is determined according to an implementation-defined method (for example, ISO 6429 control sequences), and the initial text orientation for locale-dependent Xlib functions is assumed to be XOMOrientation_LTR_TTB.

The XNOrientation value does not change the prime drawing direction for Xlib drawing functions.

13.4.5.5. Resource Name and Class

The XNResourceName and XNResourceClass arguments are strings that specify the full name and class used by the client to obtain resources for the display of the output context. These values should be used as prefixes for name and class when looking up resources that may vary according to the output context. If these values are not set, the resources will not be fully specified.

It is not intended that values that can be set as XOM values be set as resources.

When querying for the XNResourceName or XNResourceClass XOC value, XGetOCValues returns a null-terminated string. This string is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. The string will be freed by a call to XDestroyOC with the associated XOC or when the associated value is changed via XSetOCValues. Until freed, the string contents will not be modified by Xlib.

13.4.5.6. Font Info

The XNFontInfo argument specifies a list of one or more XFontStruct structures and font names for the fonts used for drawing by the given output context. The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XOMFontInfo. __ │

typedef struct {

int num_font;

XFontStruct **font_struct_list;

char **font_name_list;

} XOMFontInfo; │__

A list of pointers to the XFontStruct structures is returned to font_struct_list. A list of pointers to null-terminated, fully-specified font name strings in the locale of the output context is returned to font_name_list. The font_name_list order corresponds to the font_struct_list order. The number of XFontStruct structures and font names is returned to num_font.

Because it is not guaranteed that a given character will be imaged using a single font glyph, there is no provision for mapping a character or default string to the font properties, font ID, or direction hint for the font for the character. The client may access the XFontStruct list to obtain these values for all the fonts currently in use.

Xlib does not guarantee that fonts are loaded from the server at the creation of an XOC. Xlib may choose to cache font data, loading it only as needed to draw text or compute text dimensions. Therefore, existence of the per_char metrics in the XFontStruct structures in the XFontStructSet is undefined. Also, note that all properties in the XFontStruct structures are in the STRING encoding.

The client must not free the XOMFontInfo struct itself; it will be freed when the XOC is closed.

13.4.5.7. OM Automatic

The XNOMAutomatic argument returns whether the associated output context was created by XCreateFontSet or not. Because the XFreeFontSet function not only destroys the output context but also closes the implicit output method associated with it, XFreeFontSet should be used with any output context created by XCreateFontSet. However, it is possible that a client does not know how the output context was created. Before a client destroys the output context, it can query whether XNOMAutomatic is set to determine whether XFreeFontSet or XDestroyOC should be used to destroy the output context.

13.4.6. Creating and Freeing a Font Set

Xlib international text drawing is done using a set of one or more fonts, as needed for the locale of the text. Fonts are loaded according to a list of base font names supplied by the client and the charsets required by the locale. The XFontSet is an opaque type representing the state of a particular output thread and is equivalent to the type XOC.

The XCreateFontSet function is a convenience function for creating an output context using only default values. The returned XFontSet has an implicitly created XOM. This XOM has an OM value XNOMAutomatic automatically set to True so that the output context self indicates whether it was created by XCreateOC or XCreateFontSet. __ │

XFontSet XCreateFontSet(display, base_font_name_list, missing_charset_list_return,
missing_charset_count_return
, def_string_return)
Display *display;
char *base_font_name_list;
char ***missing_charset_list_return;
int *missing_charset_count_return;
char **def_string_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

base_font_name_list
Specifies the base font names.

missing_charset_list_return
Returns the missing charsets.

missing_charset_count_return
Returns the number of missing charsets.

def_string_return
Returns the string drawn for missing charsets. │__

The XCreateFontSet function creates a font set for the specified display. The font set is bound to the current locale when XCreateFontSet is called. The font set may be used in subsequent calls to obtain font and character information and to image text in the locale of the font set.

The base_font_name_list argument is a list of base font names that Xlib uses to load the fonts needed for the locale. The base font names are a comma-separated list. The string is null-terminated and is assumed to be in the Host Portable Character Encoding; otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. White space immediately on either side of a separating comma is ignored.

Use of XLFD font names permits Xlib to obtain the fonts needed for a variety of locales from a single locale-independent base font name. The single base font name should name a family of fonts whose members are encoded in the various charsets needed by the locales of interest.

An XLFD base font name can explicitly name a charset needed for the locale. This allows the user to specify an exact font for use with a charset required by a locale, fully controlling the font selection.

If a base font name is not an XLFD name, Xlib will attempt to obtain an XLFD name from the font properties for the font. If this action is successful in obtaining an XLFD name, the XBaseFontNameListOfFontSet function will return this XLFD name instead of the client-supplied name.

Xlib uses the following algorithm to select the fonts that will be used to display text with the XFontSet.

For each font charset required by the locale, the base font name list is searched for the first appearance of one of the following cases that names a set of fonts that exist at the server:

The first XLFD-conforming base font name that specifies the required charset or a superset of the required charset in its CharSetRegistry and CharSetEncoding fields. The implementation may use a base font name whose specified charset is a superset of the required charset, for example, an ISO8859-1 font for an ASCII charset.

The first set of one or more XLFD-conforming base font names that specify one or more charsets that can be remapped to support the required charset. The Xlib implementation may recognize various mappings from a required charset to one or more other charsets and use the fonts for those charsets. For example, JIS Roman is ASCII with tilde and backslash replaced by yen and overbar; Xlib may load an ISO8859-1 font to support this character set if a JIS Roman font is not available.

The first XLFD-conforming font name or the first non-XLFD font name for which an XLFD font name can be obtained, combined with the required charset (replacing the CharSetRegistry and CharSetEncoding fields in the XLFD font name). As in case 1, the implementation may use a charset that is a superset of the required charset.

The first font name that can be mapped in some implementation-dependent manner to one or more fonts that support imaging text in the charset.

For example, assume that a locale required the charsets:

ISO8859-1
JISX0208.1983
JISX0201.1976
GB2312-1980.0

The user could supply a base_font_name_list that explicitly specifies the charsets, ensuring that specific fonts are used if they exist. For example:

"-JIS-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--26-180-100-100-C-240-JISX0208.1983-0,\
-JIS-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--26-180-100-100-C-120-JISX0201.1976-0,\
-GB-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--26-180-100-100-C-240-GB2312-1980.0,\
-Adobe-Courier-Bold-R-Normal--25-180-75-75-M-150-ISO8859-1"

Alternatively, the user could supply a base_font_name_list that omits the charsets, letting Xlib select font charsets required for the locale. For example:

"-JIS-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--26-180-100-100-C-240,\
-JIS-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--26-180-100-100-C-120,\
-GB-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--26-180-100-100-C-240,\
-Adobe-Courier-Bold-R-Normal--25-180-100-100-M-150"

Alternatively, the user could simply supply a single base font name that allows Xlib to select from all available fonts that meet certain minimum XLFD property requirements. For example:

"-*-*-*-R-Normal--*-180-100-100-*-*"

If XCreateFontSet is unable to create the font set, either because there is insufficient memory or because the current locale is not supported, XCreateFontSet returns NULL, missing_charset_list_return is set to NULL, and missing_charset_count_return is set to zero. If fonts exist for all of the charsets required by the current locale, XCreateFontSet returns a valid XFontSet, missing_charset_list_return is set to NULL, and missing_charset_count_return is set to zero.

If no font exists for one or more of the required charsets, XCreateFontSet sets missing_charset_list_return to a list of one or more null-terminated charset names for which no font exists and sets missing_charset_count_return to the number of missing fonts. The charsets are from the list of the required charsets for the encoding of the locale and do not include any charsets to which Xlib may be able to remap a required charset.

If no font exists for any of the required charsets or if the locale definition in Xlib requires that a font exist for a particular charset and a font is not found for that charset, XCreateFontSet returns NULL. Otherwise, XCreateFontSet returns a valid XFontSet to font_set.

When an Xmb/wc drawing or measuring function is called with an XFontSet that has missing charsets, some characters in the locale will not be drawable. If def_string_return is non-NULL, XCreateFontSet returns a pointer to a string that represents the glyphs that are drawn with this XFontSet when the charsets of the available fonts do not include all font glyphs required to draw a codepoint. The string does not necessarily consist of valid characters in the current locale and is not necessarily drawn with the fonts loaded for the font set, but the client can draw and measure the default glyphs by including this string in a string being drawn or measured with the XFontSet.

If the string returned to def_string_return is the empty string (""), no glyphs are drawn, and the escapement is zero. The returned string is null-terminated. It is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It will be freed by a call to XFreeFontSet with the associated XFontSet. Until freed, its contents will not be modified by Xlib.

The client is responsible for constructing an error message from the missing charset and default string information and may choose to continue operation in the case that some fonts did not exist.

The returned XFontSet and missing charset list should be freed with XFreeFontSet and XFreeStringList, respectively. The client-supplied base_font_name_list may be freed by the client after calling XCreateFontSet.

To obtain a list of XFontStruct structures and full font names given an XFontSet, use XFontsOfFontSet. __ │

int XFontsOfFontSet(font_set, font_struct_list_return, font_name_list_return)
XFontSet font_set;
XFontStruct ***font_struct_list_return;
char ***font_name_list_return;

font_set

Specifies the font set.

font_struct_list_return
Returns the list of font structs.

font_name_list_return
Returns the list of font names. │__

The XFontsOfFontSet function returns a list of one or more XFontStructs and font names for the fonts used by the Xmb and Xwc layers for the given font set. A list of pointers to the XFontStruct structures is returned to font_struct_list_return. A list of pointers to null-terminated, fully specified font name strings in the locale of the font set is returned to font_name_list_return. The font_name_list order corresponds to the font_struct_list order. The number of XFontStruct structures and font names is returned as the value of the function.

Because it is not guaranteed that a given character will be imaged using a single font glyph, there is no provision for mapping a character or default string to the font properties, font ID, or direction hint for the font for the character. The client may access the XFontStruct list to obtain these values for all the fonts currently in use.

Xlib does not guarantee that fonts are loaded from the server at the creation of an XFontSet. Xlib may choose to cache font data, loading it only as needed to draw text or compute text dimensions. Therefore, existence of the per_char metrics in the XFontStruct structures in the XFontStructSet is undefined. Also, note that all properties in the XFontStruct structures are in the STRING encoding.

The XFontStruct and font name lists are owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. They will be freed by a call to XFreeFontSet with the associated XFontSet. Until freed, their contents will not be modified by Xlib.

To obtain the base font name list and the selected font name list given an XFontSet, use XBaseFontNameListOfFontSet. __ │

char *XBaseFontNameListOfFontSet(font_set)
XFontSet font_set;

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XBaseFontNameListOfFontSet function returns the original base font name list supplied by the client when the XFontSet was created. A null-terminated string containing a list of comma-separated font names is returned as the value of the function. White space may appear immediately on either side of separating commas.

If XCreateFontSet obtained an XLFD name from the font properties for the font specified by a non-XLFD base name, the XBaseFontNameListOfFontSet function will return the XLFD name instead of the non-XLFD base name.

The base font name list is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It will be freed by a call to XFreeFontSet with the associated XFontSet. Until freed, its contents will not be modified by Xlib.

To obtain the locale name given an XFontSet, use XLocaleOfFontSet. __ │

char *XLocaleOfFontSet(font_set)
XFontSet font_set;

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XLocaleOfFontSet function returns the name of the locale bound to the specified XFontSet, as a null-terminated string.

The returned locale name string is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It may be freed by a call to XFreeFontSet with the associated XFontSet. Until freed, it will not be modified by Xlib.

The XFreeFontSet function is a convenience function for freeing an output context. XFreeFontSet also frees its associated XOM if the output context was created by XCreateFontSet. __ │

void XFreeFontSet(display, font_set)
Display *display;
XFontSet font_set;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XFreeFontSet function frees the specified font set. The associated base font name list, font name list, XFontStruct list, and XFontSetExtents, if any, are freed.

13.4.7. Obtaining Font Set Metrics

Metrics for the internationalized text drawing functions are defined in terms of a primary draw direction, which is the default direction in which the character origin advances for each succeeding character in the string. The Xlib interface is currently defined to support only a left-to-right primary draw direction. The drawing origin is the position passed to the drawing function when the text is drawn. The baseline is a line drawn through the drawing origin parallel to the primary draw direction. Character ink is the pixels painted in the foreground color and does not include interline or intercharacter spacing or image text background pixels.

The drawing functions are allowed to implement implicit text directionality control, reversing the order in which characters are rendered along the primary draw direction in response to locale-specific lexical analysis of the string.

Regardless of the character rendering order, the origins of all characters are on the primary draw direction side of the drawing origin. The screen location of a particular character image may be determined with XmbTextPerCharExtents or XwcTextPerCharExtents.

The drawing functions are allowed to implement context-dependent rendering, where the glyphs drawn for a string are not simply a concatenation of the glyphs that represent each individual character. A string of two characters drawn with XmbDrawString may render differently than if the two characters were drawn with separate calls to XmbDrawString. If the client appends or inserts a character in a previously drawn string, the client may need to redraw some adjacent characters to obtain proper rendering.

To find out about direction-dependent rendering, use XDirectionalDependentDrawing. __ │

Bool XDirectionalDependentDrawing(font_set)
XFontSet font_set;

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XDirectionalDependentDrawing function returns True if the drawing functions implement implicit text directionality; otherwise, it returns False.

To find out about context-dependent rendering, use XContextualDrawing. __ │

Bool XContextualDrawing(font_set)
XFontSet font_set;

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XContextualDrawing function returns True if text drawn with the font set might include context-dependent drawing; otherwise, it returns False.

To find out about context-dependent or direction-dependent rendering, use XContextDependentDrawing. __ │

Bool XContextDependentDrawing(font_set)
XFontSet font_set;

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XContextDependentDrawing function returns True if the drawing functions implement implicit text directionality or if text drawn with the font_set might include context-dependent drawing; otherwise, it returns False.

The drawing functions do not interpret newline, tab, or other control characters. The behavior when nonprinting characters other than space are drawn is implementation-dependent. It is the client’s responsibility to interpret control characters in a text stream.

The maximum character extents for the fonts that are used by the text drawing layers can be accessed by the XFontSetExtents structure:

typedef struct {

XRectangle max_ink_extent;/* over all drawable characters */

XRectangle max_logical_extent;/* over all drawable characters */

} XFontSetExtents;

The XRectangle structures used to return font set metrics are the usual Xlib screen-oriented rectangles with x, y giving the upper left corner, and width and height always positive.

The max_ink_extent member gives the maximum extent, over all drawable characters, of the rectangles that bound the character glyph image drawn in the foreground color, relative to a constant origin. See XmbTextExtents and XwcTextExtents for detailed semantics.

The max_logical_extent member gives the maximum extent, over all drawable characters, of the rectangles that specify minimum spacing to other graphical features, relative to a constant origin. Other graphical features drawn by the client, for example, a border surrounding the text, should not intersect this rectangle. The max_logical_extent member should be used to compute minimum interline spacing and the minimum area that must be allowed in a text field to draw a given number of arbitrary characters.

Due to context-dependent rendering, appending a given character to a string may change the string’s extent by an amount other than that character’s individual extent.

The rectangles for a given character in a string can be obtained from XmbPerCharExtents or XwcPerCharExtents.

To obtain the maximum extents structure given an XFontSet, use XExtentsOfFontSet. __ │

XFontSetExtents *XExtentsOfFontSet(font_set)
XFontSet font_set;

font_set

Specifies the font set. │__

The XExtentsOfFontSet function returns an XFontSetExtents structure for the fonts used by the Xmb and Xwc layers for the given font set.

The XFontSetExtents structure is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It will be freed by a call to XFreeFontSet with the associated XFontSet. Until freed, its contents will not be modified by Xlib.

To obtain the escapement in pixels of the specified text as a value, use XmbTextEscapement or XwcTextEscapement. __ │

int XmbTextEscapement(font_set, string, num_bytes)
XFontSet font_set;
char *string;
int num_bytes;

int XwcTextEscapement(font_set, string, num_wchars)
XFontSet font_set;
wchar_t *string;
int num_wchars;

font_set

Specifies the font set.

string

Specifies the character string.

num_bytes

Specifies the number of bytes in the string argu-

ment.

num_wcharsSpecifies the number of characters in the string
argument. │__

The XmbTextEscapement and XwcTextEscapement functions return the escapement in pixels of the specified string as a value, using the fonts loaded for the specified font set. The escapement is the distance in pixels in the primary draw direction from the drawing origin to the origin of the next character to be drawn, assuming that the rendering of the next character is not dependent on the supplied string.

Regardless of the character rendering order, the escapement is always positive.

To obtain the overall_ink_return and overall_logical_return arguments, the overall bounding box of the string’s image, and a logical bounding box, use XmbTextExtents
or XwcTextExtents. __ │

int XmbTextExtents(font_set, string, num_bytes, overall_ink_return, overall_logical_return)
XFontSet font_set;
char *string;
int num_bytes;
XRectangle *overall_ink_return;
XRectangle *overall_logical_return;

int XwcTextExtents(font_set, string, num_wchars,
overall_ink_return
, overall_logical_return)
XFontSet font_set;
wchar_t *string;
int num_wchars;
XRectangle *overall_ink_return;
XRectangle *overall_logical_return;

font_set

Specifies the font set.

string

Specifies the character string.

num_bytes

Specifies the number of bytes in the string argu-

ment.

num_wcharsSpecifies the number of characters in the string
argument.

overall_ink_return
Returns the overall ink dimensions.

overall_logical_return
Returns the overall logical dimensions. │__

The XmbTextExtents and XwcTextExtents functions set the components of the specified overall_ink_return and overall_logical_return arguments to the overall bounding box of the string’s image and a logical bounding box for spacing purposes, respectively. They return the value returned by XmbTextEscapement or XwcTextEscapement. These metrics are relative to the drawing origin of the string, using the fonts loaded for the specified font set.

If the overall_ink_return argument is non-NULL, it is set to the bounding box of the string’s character ink. The overall_ink_return for a nondescending, horizontally drawn Latin character is conventionally entirely above the baseline; that is, overall_ink_return.height <= −overall_ink_return.y. The overall_ink_return for a nonkerned character is entirely at, and to the right of, the origin; that is, overall_ink_return.x >= 0. A character consisting of a single pixel at the origin would set overall_ink_return fields y = 0, x = 0, width = 1, and height = 1.

If the overall_logical_return argument is non-NULL, it is set to the bounding box that provides minimum spacing to other graphical features for the string. Other graphical features, for example, a border surrounding the text, should not intersect this rectangle.

When the XFontSet has missing charsets, metrics for each unavailable character are taken from the default string returned by XCreateFontSet so that the metrics represent the text as it will actually be drawn. The behavior for an invalid codepoint is undefined.

To determine the effective drawing origin for a character in a drawn string, the client should call XmbTextPerCharExtents on the entire string, then on the character, and subtract the x values of the returned rectangles for the character. This is useful to redraw portions of a line of text or to justify words, but for context-dependent rendering, the client should not assume that it can redraw the character by itself and get the same rendering.

To obtain per-character information for a text string, use XmbTextPerCharExtents or XwcTextPerCharExtents. __ │

Status XmbTextPerCharExtents(font_set, string, num_bytes, ink_array_return,
logical_array_return
, array_size, num_chars_return, overall_ink_return, overall_logical_return)
XFontSet font_set;
char *string;
int num_bytes;
XRectangle *ink_array_return;
XRectangle *logical_array_return;
int array_size;
int *num_chars_return;
XRectangle *overall_ink_return;
XRectangle *overall_logical_return;

Status XwcTextPerCharExtents(font_set, string, num_wchars, ink_array_return,
logical_array_return
, array_size, num_chars_return, overall_ink_return, overall_ink_return)
XFontSet font_set;
wchar_t *string;
int num_wchars;
XRectangle *ink_array_return;
XRectangle *logical_array_return;
int array_size;
int *num_chars_return;
XRectangle *overall_ink_return;
XRectangle *overall_logical_return;

font_set

Specifies the font set.

string

Specifies the character string.

num_bytes

Specifies the number of bytes in the string argu-

ment.

num_wcharsSpecifies the number of characters in the string
argument.

ink_array_return
Returns the ink dimensions for each character.

logical_array_return
Returns the logical dimensions for each character.

array_sizeSpecifies the size of ink_array_return and logi-
cal_array_return. The caller must pass in arrays
of this size.

num_chars_return
Returns the number of characters in the string ar-
gument.

overall_ink_return
Returns the overall ink extents of the entire
string.

overall_logical_return
Returns the overall logical extents of the entire
string. │__

The XmbTextPerCharExtents and XwcTextPerCharExtents functions return the text dimensions of each character of the specified text, using the fonts loaded for the specified font set. Each successive element of ink_array_return and logical_array_return is set to the successive character’s drawn metrics, relative to the drawing origin of the string and one rectangle for each character in the supplied text string. The number of elements of ink_array_return and logical_array_return that have been set is returned to num_chars_return.

Each element of ink_array_return is set to the bounding box of the corresponding character’s drawn foreground color. Each element of logical_array_return is set to the bounding box that provides minimum spacing to other graphical features for the corresponding character. Other graphical features should not intersect any of the logical_array_return rectangles.

Note that an XRectangle represents the effective drawing dimensions of the character, regardless of the number of font glyphs that are used to draw the character or the direction in which the character is drawn. If multiple characters map to a single character glyph, the dimensions of all the XRectangles of those characters are the same.

When the XFontSet has missing charsets, metrics for each unavailable character are taken from the default string returned by XCreateFontSet so that the metrics represent the text as it will actually be drawn. The behavior for an invalid codepoint is undefined.

If the array_size is too small for the number of characters in the supplied text, the functions return zero and num_chars_return is set to the number of rectangles required. Otherwise, the functions return a nonzero value.

If the overall_ink_return or overall_logical_return argument is non-NULL, XmbTextPerCharExtents and XwcTextPerCharExtents return the maximum extent of the string’s metrics to overall_ink_return or overall_logical_return, as returned by XmbTextExtents or XwcTextExtents.

13.4.8. Drawing Text Using Font Sets

The functions defined in this section draw text at a specified location in a drawable. They are similar to the functions XDrawText, XDrawString, and XDrawImageString except that they work with font sets instead of single fonts and interpret the text based on the locale of the font set instead of treating the bytes of the string as direct font indexes. See section 8.6 for details of the use of Graphics Contexts (GCs) and possible protocol errors. If a BadFont error is generated, characters prior to the offending character may have been drawn.

The text is drawn using the fonts loaded for the specified font set; the font in the GC is ignored and may be modified by the functions. No validation that all fonts conform to some width rule is performed.

The text functions XmbDrawText and XwcDrawText use the following structures: __ │

typedef struct {

char *chars;

/* pointer to string */

int nchars;

/* number of bytes */

int delta;

/* pixel delta between strings */

XFontSet font_set;

/* fonts, None means don’t change */

} XmbTextItem;

typedef struct {

wchar_t *chars;

/* pointer to wide char string */

int nchars;

/* number of wide characters */

int delta;

/* pixel delta between strings */

XFontSet font_set;

/* fonts, None means don’t change */

} XwcTextItem; │__

To draw text using multiple font sets in a given drawable, use XmbDrawText or XwcDrawText. __ │

void XmbDrawText(display, d, gc, x, y, items, nitems)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
XmbTextItem *items;
int nitems;

void XwcDrawText(display, d, gc, x, y, items, nitems)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y;
XwcTextItem *items;
int nitems;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates.

items

Specifies an array of text items.

nitems

Specifies the number of text items in the array. │__

The XmbDrawText and XwcDrawText functions allow complex spacing and font set shifts between text strings. Each text item is processed in turn, with the origin of a text element advanced in the primary draw direction by the escapement of the previous text item. A text item delta specifies an additional escapement of the text item drawing origin in the primary draw direction. A font_set member other than None in an item causes the font set to be used for this and subsequent text items in the text_items list. Leading text items with a font_set member set to None will not be drawn.

XmbDrawText and XwcDrawText do not perform any context-dependent rendering between text segments. Clients may compute the drawing metrics by passing each text segment to XmbTextExtents and XwcTextExtents or XmbTextPerCharExtents and XwcTextPerCharExtents. When the XFontSet has missing charsets, each unavailable character is drawn with the default string returned by XCreateFontSet. The behavior for an invalid codepoint is undefined.

To draw text using a single font set in a given drawable, use XmbDrawString or XwcDrawString. __ │

void XmbDrawString(display, d, font_set, gc, x, y, string, num_bytes)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
XFontSet font_set;
GC gc;
int x, y;
char *string;
int num_bytes;

void XwcDrawString(display, d, font_set, gc, x, y, string, num_wchars)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
XFontSet font_set;
GC gc;
int x, y;
wchar_t *string;
int num_wchars;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

font_set

Specifies the font set.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates.

string

Specifies the character string.

num_bytes

Specifies the number of bytes in the string argu-

ment.

num_wcharsSpecifies the number of characters in the string
argument. │__

The XmbDrawString and XwcDrawString functions draw the specified text with the foreground pixel. When the XFontSet has missing charsets, each unavailable character is drawn with the default string returned by XCreateFontSet. The behavior for an invalid codepoint is undefined.

To draw image text using a single font set in a given drawable, use XmbDrawImageString or XwcDrawImageString. __ │

void XmbDrawImageString(display, d, font_set, gc, x, y, string, num_bytes)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
XFontSet font_set;
GC gc;
int x, y;
char *string;
int num_bytes;

void XwcDrawImageString(display, d, font_set, gc, x, y, string, num_wchars)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
XFontSet font_set;
GC gc;
int x, y;
wchar_t *string;
int num_wchars;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

font_set

Specifies the font set.

gc

Specifies the GC.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates.

string

Specifies the character string.

num_bytes

Specifies the number of bytes in the string argu-

ment.

num_wcharsSpecifies the number of characters in the string
argument. │__

The XmbDrawImageString and XwcDrawImageString functions fill a destination rectangle with the background pixel defined in the GC and then paint the text with the foreground pixel. The filled rectangle is the rectangle returned to overall_logical_return by XmbTextExtents or XwcTextExtents for the same text and XFontSet.

When the XFontSet has missing charsets, each unavailable character is drawn with the default string returned by XCreateFontSet. The behavior for an invalid codepoint is undefined.

13.5. Input Methods

This section provides discussions of the following X Input Method (XIM) topics:

Input method overview

Input method management

Input method functions

Input method values

Input context functions

Input context values

Input method callback semantics

Event filtering

Getting keyboard input

Input method conventions

13.5.1. Input Method Overview

This section provides definitions for terms and concepts used for internationalized text input and a brief overview of the intended use of the mechanisms provided by Xlib.

A large number of languages in the world use alphabets consisting of a small set of symbols (letters) to form words. To enter text into a computer in an alphabetic language, a user usually has a keyboard on which there exist key symbols corresponding to the alphabet. Sometimes, a few characters of an alphabetic language are missing on the keyboard. Many computer users who speak a Latin-alphabet-based language only have an English-based keyboard. They need to hit a combination of keystrokes to enter a character that does not exist directly on the keyboard. A number of algorithms have been developed for entering such characters. These are known as European input methods, compose input methods, or dead-key input methods.

Japanese is an example of a language with a phonetic symbol set, where each symbol represents a specific sound. There are two phonetic symbol sets in Japanese: Katakana and Hiragana. In general, Katakana is used for words that are of foreign origin, and Hiragana is used for writing native Japanese words. Collectively, the two systems are called Kana. Each set consists of 48 characters.

Korean also has a phonetic symbol set, called Hangul. Each of the 24 basic phonetic symbols (14 consonants and 10 vowels) represents a specific sound. A syllable is composed of two or three parts: the initial consonants, the vowels, and the optional last consonants. With Hangul, syllables can be treated as the basic units on which text processing is done. For example, a delete operation may work on a phonetic symbol or a syllable. Korean code sets include several thousands of these syllables. A user types the phonetic symbols that make up the syllables of the words to be entered. The display may change as each phonetic symbol is entered. For example, when the second phonetic symbol of a syllable is entered, the first phonetic symbol may change its shape and size. Likewise, when the third phonetic symbol is entered, the first two phonetic symbols may change their shape and size.

Not all languages rely solely on alphabetic or phonetic systems. Some languages, including Japanese and Korean, employ an ideographic writing system. In an ideographic system, rather than taking a small set of symbols and combining them in different ways to create words, each word consists of one unique symbol (or, occasionally, several symbols). The number of symbols can be very large: approximately 50,000 have been identified in Hanzi, the Chinese ideographic system.

Two major aspects of ideographic systems impact their use with computers. First, the standard computer character sets in Japan, China, and Korea include roughly 8,000 characters, while sets in Taiwan have between 15,000 and 30,000 characters. This makes it necessary to use more than one byte to represent a character. Second, it obviously is impractical to have a keyboard that includes all of a given language’s ideographic symbols. Therefore, a mechanism is required for entering characters so that a keyboard with a reasonable number of keys can be used. Those input methods are usually based on phonetics, but there also exist methods based on the graphical properties of characters.

In Japan, both Kana and the ideographic system Kanji are used. In Korea, Hangul and sometimes the ideographic system Hanja are used. Now consider entering ideographs in Japan, Korea, China, and Taiwan.

In Japan, either Kana or English characters are typed and then a region is selected (sometimes automatically) for conversion to Kanji. Several Kanji characters may have the same phonetic representation. If that is the case with the string entered, a menu of characters is presented and the user must choose the appropriate one. If no choice is necessary or a preference has been established, the input method does the substitution directly. When Latin characters are converted to Kana or Kanji, it is called a romaji conversion.

In Korea, it is usually acceptable to keep Korean text in Hangul form, but some people may choose to write Hanja-originated words in Hanja rather than in Hangul. To change Hangul to Hanja, the user selects a region for conversion and then follows the same basic method as that described for Japanese.

Probably because there are well-accepted phonetic writing systems for Japanese and Korean, computer input methods in these countries for entering ideographs are fairly standard. Keyboard keys have both English characters and phonetic symbols engraved on them, and the user can switch between the two sets.

The situation is different for Chinese. While there is a phonetic system called Pinyin promoted by authorities, there is no consensus for entering Chinese text. Some vendors use a phonetic decomposition (Pinyin or another), others use ideographic decomposition of Chinese words, with various implementations and keyboard layouts. There are about 16 known methods, none of which is a clear standard.

Also, there are actually two ideographic sets used: Traditional Chinese (the original written Chinese) and Simplified Chinese. Several years ago, the People’s Republic of China launched a campaign to simplify some ideographic characters and eliminate redundancies altogether. Under the plan, characters would be streamlined every five years. Characters have been revised several times now, resulting in the smaller, simpler set that makes up Simplified Chinese.

13.5.1.1. Input Method Architecture

As shown in the previous section, there are many different input methods in use today, each varying with language, culture, and history. A common feature of many input methods is that the user may type multiple keystrokes to compose a single character (or set of characters). The process of composing characters from keystrokes is called preediting. It may require complex algorithms and large dictionaries involving substantial computer resources.

Input methods may require one or more areas in which to show the feedback of the actual keystrokes, to propose disambiguation to the user, to list dictionaries, and so on. The input method areas of concern are as follows:

The status area is a logical extension of the LEDs that exist on the physical keyboard. It is a window that is intended to present the internal state of the input method that is critical to the user. The status area may consist of text data and bitmaps or some combination.

The preedit area displays the intermediate text for those languages that are composing prior to the client handling the data.

The auxiliary area is used for pop-up menus and customizing dialogs that may be required for an input method. There may be multiple auxiliary areas for an input method. Auxiliary areas are managed by the input method independent of the client. Auxiliary areas are assumed to be separate dialogs, which are maintained by the input method.

There are various user interaction styles used for preediting. The ones supported by Xlib are as follows:

For on-the-spot input methods, preediting data will be displayed directly in the application window. Application data is moved to allow preedit data to appear at the point of insertion.

Over-the-spot preediting means that the data is displayed in a preedit window that is placed over the point of insertion.

Off-the-spot preediting means that the preedit window is inside the application window but not at the point of insertion. Often, this type of window is placed at the bottom of the application window.

Root-window preediting refers to input methods that use a preedit window that is the child of RootWindow.

It would require a lot of computing resources if portable applications had to include input methods for all the languages in the world. To avoid this, a goal of the Xlib design is to allow an application to communicate with an input method placed in a separate process. Such a process is called an input server. The server to which the application should connect is dependent on the environment when the application is started up, that is, the user language and the actual encoding to be used for it. The input method connection is said to be locale-dependent. It is also user-dependent. For a given language, the user can choose, to some extent, the user interface style of input method (if choice is possible among several).

Using an input server implies communication overhead, but applications can be migrated without relinking. Input methods can be implemented either as a stub communicating to an input server or as a local library.

An input method may be based on a front-end or a back-end architecture. In a front-end architecture, there are two separate connections to the X server: keystrokes go directly from the X server to the input method on one connection and other events to the regular client connection. The input method is then acting as a filter and sends composed strings to the client. A front-end architecture requires synchronization between the two connections to avoid lost key events or locking issues.

In a back-end architecture, a single X server connection is used. A dispatching mechanism must decide on this channel to delegate appropriate keystrokes to the input method. For instance, it may retain a Help keystroke for its own purpose. In the case where the input method is a separate process (that is, a server), there must be a special communication protocol between the back-end client and the input server.

A front-end architecture introduces synchronization issues and a filtering mechanism for noncharacter keystrokes (Function keys, Help, and so on). A back-end architecture sometimes implies more communication overhead and more process switching. If all three processes (X server, input server, client) are running on a single workstation, there are two process switches for each keystroke in a back-end architecture, but there is only one in a front-end architecture.

The abstraction used by a client to communicate with an input method is an opaque data structure represented by the XIM data type. This data structure is returned by the XOpenIM function, which opens an input method on a given display. Subsequent operations on this data structure encapsulate all communication between client and input method. There is no need for an X client to use any networking library or natural language package to use an input method.

A single input server may be used for one or more languages, supporting one or more encoding schemes. But the strings returned from an input method will always be encoded in the (single) locale associated with the XIM object.

13.5.1.2. Input Contexts

Xlib provides the ability to manage a multi-threaded state for text input. A client may be using multiple windows, each window with multiple text entry areas, and the user possibly switching among them at any time. The abstraction for representing the state of a particular input thread is called an input context. The Xlib representation of an input context is an XIC.

An input context is the abstraction retaining the state, properties, and semantics of communication between a client and an input method. An input context is a combination of an input method, a locale specifying the encoding of the character strings to be returned, a client window, internal state information, and various layout or appearance characteristics. The input context concept somewhat matches for input the graphics context abstraction defined for graphics output.

One input context belongs to exactly one input method. Different input contexts may be associated with the same input method, possibly with the same client window. An XIC is created with the XCreateIC function, providing an XIM argument and affiliating the input context to the input method for its lifetime. When an input method is closed with XCloseIM, all of its affiliated input contexts should not be used any more (and should preferably be destroyed before closing the input method).

Considering the example of a client window with multiple text entry areas, the application programmer could, for example, choose to implement as follows:

As many input contexts are created as text entry areas, and the client will get the input accumulated on each context each time it looks up in that context.

A single context is created for a top-level window in the application. If such a window contains several text entry areas, each time the user moves to another text entry area, the client has to indicate changes in the context.

A range of choices can be made by application designers to use either a single or multiple input contexts, according to the needs of their application.

13.5.1.3. Getting Keyboard Input

To obtain characters from an input method, a client must call the function XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString with an input context created from that input method. Both a locale and display are bound to an input method when it is opened, and an input context inherits this locale and display. Any strings returned by XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString will be encoded in that locale.

13.5.1.4. Focus Management

For each text entry area in which the XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString functions are used, there will be an associated input context.

When the application focus moves to a text entry area, the application must set the input context focus to the input context associated with that area. The input context focus is set by calling XSetICFocus with the appropriate input context.

Also, when the application focus moves out of a text entry area, the application should unset the focus for the associated input context by calling XUnsetICFocus. As an optimization, if XSetICFocus is called successively on two different input contexts, setting the focus on the second will automatically unset the focus on the first.

To set and unset the input context focus correctly, it is necessary to track application-level focus changes. Such focus changes do not necessarily correspond to X server focus changes.

If a single input context is being used to do input for multiple text entry areas, it will also be necessary to set the focus window of the input context whenever the focus window changes (see section 13.5.6.3).

13.5.1.5. Geometry Management

In most input method architectures (on-the-spot being the notable exception), the input method will perform the display of its own data. To provide better visual locality, it is often desirable to have the input method areas embedded within a client. To do this, the client may need to allocate space for an input method. Xlib provides support that allows the size and position of input method areas to be provided by a client. The input method areas that are supported for geometry management are the status area and the preedit area.

The fundamental concept on which geometry management for input method windows is based is the proper division of responsibilities between the client (or toolkit) and the input method. The division of responsibilities is as follows:

The client is responsible for the geometry of the input method window.

The input method is responsible for the contents of the input method window.

An input method is able to suggest a size to the client, but it cannot suggest a placement. Also the input method can only suggest a size. It does not determine the size, and it must accept the size it is given.

Before a client provides geometry management for an input method, it must determine if geometry management is needed. The input method indicates the need for geometry management by setting XIMPreeditArea or XIMStatusArea in its XIMStyles value returned by XGetIMValues. When a client has decided that it will provide geometry management for an input method, it indicates that decision by setting the XNInputStyle value in the XIC.

After a client has established with the input method that it will do geometry management, the client must negotiate the geometry with the input method. The geometry is negotiated by the following steps:

The client suggests an area to the input method by setting the XNAreaNeeded value for that area. If the client has no constraints for the input method, it either will not suggest an area or will set the width and height to zero. Otherwise, it will set one of the values.

The client will get the XIC value XNAreaNeeded. The input method will return its suggested size in this value. The input method should pay attention to any constraints suggested by the client.

The client sets the XIC value XNArea to inform the input method of the geometry of its window. The client should try to honor the geometry requested by the input method. The input method must accept this geometry.

Clients doing geometry management must be aware that setting other XIC values may affect the geometry desired by an input method. For example, XNFontSet and XNLineSpacing may change the geometry desired by the input method.

The table of XIC values (see section 13.5.6) indicates the values that can cause the desired geometry to change when they are set. It is the responsibility of the client to renegotiate the geometry of the input method window when it is needed.

In addition, a geometry management callback is provided by which an input method can initiate a geometry change.

13.5.1.6. Event Filtering

A filtering mechanism is provided to allow input methods to capture X events transparently to clients. It is expected that toolkits (or clients) using XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString will call this filter at some point in the event processing mechanism to make sure that events needed by an input method can be filtered by that input method.

If there were no filter, a client could receive and discard events that are necessary for the proper functioning of an input method. The following provides a few examples of such events:

Expose events on preedit window in local mode.

Events may be used by an input method to communicate with an input server. Such input server protocol-related events have to be intercepted if one does not want to disturb client code.

Key events can be sent to a filter before they are bound to translations such as those the X Toolkit Intrinsics library provides.

Clients are expected to get the XIC value XNFilterEvents and augment the event mask for the client window with that event mask. This mask may be zero.

13.5.1.7. Callbacks

When an on-the-spot input method is implemented, only the client can insert or delete preedit data in place and possibly scroll existing text. This means that the echo of the keystrokes has to be achieved by the client itself, tightly coupled with the input method logic.

When the user enters a keystroke, the client calls XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString. At this point, in the on-the-spot case, the echo of the keystroke in the preedit has not yet been done. Before returning to the client logic that handles the input characters, the look-up function must call the echoing logic to insert the new keystroke. If the keystrokes entered so far make up a character, the keystrokes entered need to be deleted, and the composed character will be returned. Hence, what happens is that, while being called by client code, the input method logic has to call back to the client before it returns. The client code, that is, a callback procedure, is called from the input method logic.

There are a number of cases where the input method logic has to call back the client. Each of those cases is associated with a well-defined callback action. It is possible for the client to specify, for each input context, what callback is to be called for each action.

There are also callbacks provided for feedback of status information and a callback to initiate a geometry request for an input method.

13.5.1.8. Visible Position Feedback Masks

In the on-the-spot input style, there is a problem when attempting to draw preedit strings that are longer than the available space. Once the display area is exceeded, it is not clear how best to display the preedit string. The visible position feedback masks of XIMText help resolve this problem by allowing the input method to specify hints that indicate the essential portions of the preedit string. For example, such hints can help developers implement scrolling of a long preedit string within a short preedit display area.

13.5.1.9. Preedit String Management

As highlighted before, the input method architecture provides preediting, which supports a type of preprocessor input composition. In this case, composition consists of interpreting a sequence of key events and returning a committed string via XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString. This provides the basics for input methods.

In addition to preediting based on key events, a general framework is provided to give a client that desires it more advanced preediting based on the text within the client. This framework is called string conversion and is provided using XIC values. The fundamental concept of string conversion is to allow the input method to manipulate the client’s text independent of any user preediting operation.

The need for string conversion is based on language needs and input method capabilities. The following are some examples of string conversion:

Transliteration conversion provides language-specific conversions within the input method. In the case of Korean input, users wish to convert a Hangul string into a Hanja string while in preediting, after preediting, or in other situations (for example, on a selected string). The conversion is triggered when the user presses a Hangul-to-Hanja key sequence (which may be input method specific). Sometimes the user may want to invoke the conversion after finishing preediting or on a user-selected string. Thus, the string to be converted is in an application buffer, not in the preedit area of the input method. The string conversion services allow the client to request this transliteration conversion from the input method. There are many other transliteration conversions defined for various languages, for example, Kana-to-Kanji conversion in Japanese.

The key to remember is that transliteration conversions are triggered at the request of the user and returned to the client immediately without affecting the preedit area of the input method.

Reconversion of a previously committed string or a selected string is supported by many input methods as a convenience to the user. For example, a user tends to mistype the commit key while preediting. In that case, some input methods provide a special key sequence to request a ‘‘reconvert’’ operation on the committed string, similiar to the undo facility provided by most text editors. Another example is where the user is proofreading a document that has some misconversions from preediting and wants to correct the misconverted text. Such reconversion is again triggered by the user invoking some special action, but reconversions should not affect the state of the preedit area.

Context-sensitive conversion is required for some languages and input methods that need to retrieve text that surrounds the current spot location (cursor position) of the client’s buffer. Such text is needed when the preediting operation depends on some surrounding characters (usually preceding the spot location). For example, in Thai language input, certain character sequences may be invalid and the input method may want to check whether characters constitute a valid word. Input methods that do such context-dependent checking need to retrieve the characters surrounding the current cursor position to obtain complete words.

Unlike other conversions, this conversion is not explicitly requested by the user. Input methods that provide such context-sensitive conversion continuously need to request context from the client, and any change in the context of the spot location may affect such conversions. The client’s context would be needed if the user moves the cursor and starts editing again.

For this reason, an input method supporting this type of conversion should take notice of when the client calls XmbResetIC or XwcResetIC, which is usually an indication of a context change.

Context-sensitive conversions just need a copy of the client’s text, while other conversions replace the client’s text with new text to achieve the reconversion or transliteration. Yet in all cases the result of a conversion, either immediately or via preediting, is returned by the XmbLookupString and XwcLookupString functions.

String conversion support is dependent on the availability of the XNStringConversion or XNStringConversionCallback XIC values. Because the input method may not support string conversions, clients have to query the availability of string conversion operations by checking the supported XIC values list by calling XGetIMValues with the XNQueryICValuesList IM value.

The difference between these two values is whether the conversion is invoked by the client or the input method. The XNStringConversion XIC value is used by clients to request a string conversion from the input method. The client is responsible for determining which events are used to trigger the string conversion and whether the string to be converted should be copied or deleted. The type of conversion is determined by the input method; the client can only pass the string to be converted. The client is guaranteed that no XNStringConversionCallback will be issued when this value is set; thus, the client need only set one of these values.

The XNStringConversionCallback XIC value is used by the client to notify the input method that it will accept requests from the input method for string conversion. If this value is set, it is the input method’s responsibility to determine which events are used to trigger the string conversion. When such events occur, the input method issues a call to the client-supplied procedure to retrieve the string to be converted. The client’s callback procedure is notified whether to copy or delete the string and is provided with hints as to the amount of text needed. The XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct specifies which text should be passed back to the input method.

Finally, the input method may call the client’s XNStringConversionCallback procedure multiple times if the string returned from the callback is not sufficient to perform a successful conversion. The arguments to the client’s procedure allow the input method to define a position (in character units) relative to the client’s cursor position and the size of the text needed. By varying the position and size of the desired text in subsequent callbacks, the input method can retrieve additional text.

13.5.2. Input Method Management

The interface to input methods might appear to be simply creating an input method (XOpenIM) and freeing an input method (XCloseIM). However, input methods may require complex communication with input method servers (IM servers), for example:

If the X server, IM server, and X clients are started asynchronously, some clients may attempt to connect to the IM server before it is fully operational, and fail. Therefore, some mechanism is needed to allow clients to detect when an IM server has started.

It is up to clients to decide what should be done when an IM server is not available (for example, wait, or use some other IM server).

Some input methods may allow the underlying IM server to be switched. Such customization may be desired without restarting the entire client.

To support management of input methods in these cases, the following functions are provided:
XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback

This function allows clients to
register a callback procedure to
be called when Xlib detects that
an IM server is up and available.
XOpenIM

A client calls this function as a
result of the callback procedure
being called.
XSetIMValue
, XSetICValue
These functions use the XIM and
XIC values, XNDestroyCallback, to
allow a client to register a
callback procedure to be called
when Xlib detects that an IM
server that was associated with
an opened input method is no
longer available.
In addition, this function can be
used to switch IM servers for
those input methods that support
such functionality. The IM value
for switching IM servers is
implementation-dependent; see the
description below about switching
IM servers.
XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback

This function removes a callback
procedure registered by the
client.

Input methods that support switching of IM servers may exhibit some side-effects:

The input method will ensure that any new IM server supports any of the input styles being used by input contexts already associated with the input method. However, the list of supported input styles may be different.

Geometry management requests on previously created input contexts may be initiated by the new IM server.

13.5.2.1. Hot Keys

Some clients need to guarantee which keys can be used to escape from the input method, regardless of the input method state; for example, the client-specific Help key or the keys to move the input focus. The HotKey mechanism allows clients to specify a set of keys for this purpose. However, the input method might not allow clients to specify hot keys. Therefore, clients have to query support of hot keys by checking the supported XIC values list by calling XGetIMValues with the XNQueryICValuesList IM value. When the hot keys specified conflict with the key bindings of the input method, hot keys take precedence over the key bindings of the input method.

13.5.2.2. Preedit State Operation

An input method may have several internal states, depending on its implementation and the locale. However, one state that is independent of locale and implementation is whether the input method is currently performing a preediting operation. Xlib provides the ability for an application to manage the preedit state programmatically. Two methods are provided for retrieving the preedit state of an input context. One method is to query the state by calling XGetICValues with the XNPreeditState XIC value. Another method is to receive notification whenever the preedit state is changed. To receive such notification, an application needs to register a callback by calling XSetICValues with the XNPreeditStateNotifyCallback XIC value. In order to change the preedit state programmatically, an application needs to call XSetICValues with XNPreeditState.

Availability of the preedit state is input method dependent. The input method may not provide the ability to set the state or to retrieve the state programmatically. Therefore, clients have to query availability of preedit state operations by checking the supported XIC values list by calling XGetIMValues with the XNQueryICValuesList IM value.

13.5.3. Input Method Functions

To open a connection, use XOpenIM. __ │

XIM XOpenIM(display, db, res_name, res_class)
Display *display;
XrmDatabase db;
char *res_name;
char *res_class;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

db

Specifies a pointer to the resource database.

res_name

Specifies the full resource name of the applica-

tion.

res_class

Specifies the full class name of the application. │__

The XOpenIM function opens an input method, matching the current locale and modifiers specification. Current locale and modifiers are bound to the input method at opening time. The locale associated with an input method cannot be changed dynamically. This implies that the strings returned by XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString, for any input context affiliated with a given input method, will be encoded in the locale current at the time the input method is opened.

The specific input method to which this call will be routed is identified on the basis of the current locale. XOpenIM will identify a default input method corresponding to the current locale. That default can be modified using XSetLocaleModifiers for the input method modifier.

The db argument is the resource database to be used by the input method for looking up resources that are private to the input method. It is not intended that this database be used to look up values that can be set as IC values in an input context. If db is NULL, no database is passed to the input method.

The res_name and res_class arguments specify the resource name and class of the application. They are intended to be used as prefixes by the input method when looking up resources that are common to all input contexts that may be created for this input method. The characters used for resource names and classes must be in the X Portable Character Set. The resources looked up are not fully specified if res_name or res_class is NULL.

The res_name and res_class arguments are not assumed to exist beyond the call to XOpenIM. The specified resource database is assumed to exist for the lifetime of the input method.

XOpenIM returns NULL if no input method could be opened.

To close a connection, use XCloseIM. __ │

Status XCloseIM(im)
XIM im;

im

Specifies the input method. │__

The XCloseIM function closes the specified input method.

To set input method attributes, use XSetIMValues. __ │

char * XSetIMValues(im, ...)
XIM im;

im

Specifies the input method.

...

Specifies the variable-length argument list to set

XIM values. │__

The XSetIMValues function presents a variable argument list programming interface for setting attributes of the specified input method. It returns NULL if it succeeds; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be set. Xlib does not attempt to set arguments from the supplied list that follow the failed argument; all arguments in the list preceding the failed argument have been set correctly.

To query an input method, use XGetIMValues. __ │

char * XGetIMValues(im, ...)
XIM im;

im

Specifies the input method.

...

Specifies the variable length argument list to get

XIM values. │__

The XGetIMValues function presents a variable argument list programming interface for querying properties or features of the specified input method. This function returns NULL if it succeeds; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be obtained.

Each XIM value argument (following a name) must point to a location where the XIM value is to be stored. That is, if the XIM value is of type T, the argument must be of type T*. If T itself is a pointer type, then XGetIMValues allocates memory to store the actual data, and the client is responsible for freeing this data by calling XFree with the returned pointer.

To obtain the display associated with an input method, use XDisplayOfIM. __ │

Display * XDisplayOfIM(im)

XIM im;

im

Specifies the input method. │__

The XDisplayOfIM function returns the display associated with the specified input method.

To get the locale associated with an input method, use XLocaleOfIM. __ │

char * XLocaleOfIM(im)
XIM im;

im

Specifies the input method. │__

The XLocaleOfIM function returns the locale associated with the specified input method.

To register an input method instantiate callback, use XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback. __ │

Bool XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback(display, db, res_name, res_class, callback, client_data)
Display *display;
XrmDatabase db;
char *res_name;
char *res_class;
XIMProc callback;
XPointer *client_data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

db

Specifies a pointer to the resource database.

res_name

Specifies the full resource name of the applica-

tion.

res_class

Specifies the full class name of the application.

callback

Specifies a pointer to the input method instanti-

ate callback.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data. │__

The XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback function registers a callback to be invoked whenever a new input method becomes available for the specified display that matches the current locale and modifiers.

The function returns True
if it succeeds; otherwise, it returns False.

The generic prototype is as follows: __ │

void IMInstantiateCallback(display, client_data, call_data)
Display *display;

XPointer client_data;

XPointer call_data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

To unregister an input method instantiation callback, use XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback. __ │

Bool XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback(display, db, res_name, res_class, callback, client_data)
Display *display;
XrmDatabase db;
char *res_name;
char *res_class;
XIMProc callback;
XPointer *client_data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

db

Specifies a pointer to the resource database.

res_name

Specifies the full resource name of the applica-

tion.

res_class

Specifies the full class name of the application.

callback

Specifies a pointer to the input method instanti-

ate callback.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data. │__

The XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback function removes an input method instantiation callback previously registered. The function returns True if it succeeds; otherwise, it returns False.

13.5.4. Input Method Values

The following table describes how XIM values are interpreted by an input method. The first column lists the XIM values. The second column indicates how each of the XIM values are treated by that input style.

The following keys apply to this table.
Key Explanation

D
This value may be set using XSetIMValues. If
it is not set,
a default is provided.
S
This value may be set using XSetIMValues.
G
This value may be read using XGetIMValues.
XIM Value Key
XNQueryInputStyle

G
XNResourceName

D-S-G
XNResourceClass

D-S-G
XNDestroyCallback

D-S-G
XNQueryIMValuesList

G
XNQueryICValuesList

G
XNVisiblePosition

G
XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior

D-S-G

XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior is obsolete and its use is not recommended (see section 13.5.4.6).

13.5.4.1. Query Input Style

A client should always query the input method to determine which input styles are supported. The client should then find an input style it is capable of supporting.

If the client cannot find an input style that it can support, it should negotiate with the user the continuation of the program (exit, choose another input method, and so on).

The argument value must be a pointer to a location where the returned value will be stored. The returned value is a pointer to a structure of type XIMStyles. Clients are responsible for freeing the XIMStyles structure. To do so, use XFree.

The XIMStyles structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef unsigned long XIMStyle;
#define
XIMPreeditArea

0x0001L
#define
XIMPreeditCallbacks

0x0002L
#define
XIMPreeditPosition

0x0004L
#define
XIMPreeditNothing

0x0008L
#define
XIMPreeditNone

0x0010L

#define
XIMStatusArea

0x0100L
#define
XIMStatusCallbacks

0x0200L
#define
XIMStatusNothing

0x0400L
#define
XIMStatusNone

0x0800L

typedef struct {

unsigned short count_styles;

XIMStyle * supported_styles;

} XIMStyles; │__

An XIMStyles structure contains the number of input styles supported in its count_styles field. This is also the size of the supported_styles array.

The supported styles is a list of bitmask combinations, which indicate the combination of styles for each of the areas supported. These areas are described later. Each element in the list should select one of the bitmask values for each area. The list describes the complete set of combinations supported. Only these combinations are supported by the input method.

The preedit category defines what type of support is provided by the input method for preedit information.
XIMPreeditArea

If chosen, the input method would require
the client to provide some area values for
it to do its preediting. Refer to XIC
values XNArea and XNAreaNeeded.
XIMPreeditPosition

If chosen, the input method would require
the client to provide positional values.
Refer to XIC values XNSpotLocation and
XNFocusWindow
.
XIMPreeditCallbacks

If chosen, the input method would require
the client to define the set of preedit
callbacks. Refer to XIC values
XNPreeditStartCallback
,
XNPreeditDoneCallback
,
XNPreeditDrawCallback
, and
XNPreeditCaretCallback
.
XIMPreeditNothing

If chosen, the input method can function
without any preedit values.
XIMPreeditNone

The input method does not provide any
preedit feedback. Any preedit value is
ignored. This style is mutually exclusive
with the other preedit styles.

The status category defines what type of support is provided by the input method for status information.
XIMStatusArea

The input method requires the client to
provide some area values for it to do its
status feedback. See XNArea and
XNAreaNeeded
.
XIMStatusCallbacks

The input method requires the client to
define the set of status callbacks,
XNStatusStartCallback
,
XNStatusDoneCallback
, and
XNStatusDrawCallback
.
XIMStatusNothing

The input method can function without any
status values.
XIMStatusNone

The input method does not provide any
status feedback. If chosen, any status
value is ignored. This style is mutually
exclusive with the other status styles.

13.5.4.2. Resource Name and Class

The XNResourceName and XNResourceClass arguments are strings that specify the full name and class used by the input method. These values should be used as prefixes for the name and class when looking up resources that may vary according to the input method. If these values are not set, the resources will not be fully specified.

It is not intended that values that can be set as XIM values be set as resources.

13.5.4.3. Destroy Callback

The XNDestroyCallback argument is a pointer to a structure of type XIMCallback. XNDestroyCallback is triggered when an input method stops its service for any reason. After the callback is invoked, the input method is closed and the associated input context(s) are destroyed by Xlib. Therefore, the client should not call XCloseIM or XDestroyIC.

The generic prototype of this callback function is as follows: __ │

void DestroyCallback(im, client_data, call_data)
XIM im;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

im

Specifies the input method.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

A DestroyCallback is always called with a NULL call_data argument.

13.5.4.4. Query IM/IC Values List

XNQueryIMValuesList and XNQueryICValuesList are used to query about XIM and XIC values supported by the input method.

The argument value must be a pointer to a location where the returned value will be stored. The returned value is a pointer to a structure of type XIMValuesList. Clients are responsible for freeing the XIMValuesList structure. To do so, use XFree.

The XIMValuesList structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct {

unsigned short count_values;

char **supported_values;

} XIMValuesList; │__

13.5.4.5. Visible Position

The XNVisiblePosition argument indicates whether the visible position masks of XIMFeedback in XIMText are available.

The argument value must be a pointer to a location where the returned value will be stored. The returned value is of type Bool. If the returned value is True, the input method uses the visible position masks of XIMFeedback in XIMText; otherwise, the input method does not use the masks.

Because this XIM value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryIMValues before using this argument. If the XNVisiblePosition does not exist in the IM values list returned from XNQueryIMValues, the visible position masks of XIMFeedback in XIMText are not used to indicate the visible position.

13.5.4.6. Preedit Callback Behavior

The XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior argument originally included in the X11R6 specification has been deprecated.†

The XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior argument indicates whether the behavior of preedit callbacks regarding XIMPreeditDrawCallbackStruct values follows Release 5 or Release 6 semantics.

The value is of type Bool. When querying for XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior, if the returned value is True, the input method uses the Release 6 behavior; otherwise, it uses the Release 5 behavior. The default value is False. In order to use Release 6 semantics, the value of XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior must be set to True.

Because this XIM value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryIMValues before using this argument. If the XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior does not exist in the IM values list returned from XNQueryIMValues, the PreeditCallback behavior is Release 5 semantics.

13.5.5. Input Context Functions

An input context is an abstraction that is used to contain both the data required (if any) by an input method and the information required to display that data. There may be multiple input contexts for one input method. The programming interfaces for creating, reading, or modifying an input context use a variable argument list. The name elements of the argument lists are referred to as XIC values. It is intended that input methods be controlled by these XIC values. As new XIC values are created, they should be registered with the X Consortium.

To create an input context, use XCreateIC. __ │

XIC XCreateIC(im, ...)
XIM im;

im

Specifies the input method.

...

Specifies the variable length argument list to set

XIC values. │__

The XCreateIC function creates a context within the specified input method.

Some of the arguments are mandatory at creation time, and the input context will not be created if those arguments are not provided. The mandatory arguments are the input style and the set of text callbacks (if the input style selected requires callbacks). All other input context values can be set later.

XCreateIC returns a NULL value if no input context could be created. A NULL value could be returned for any of the following reasons:

A required argument was not set.

A read-only argument was set (for example, XNFilterEvents).

The argument name is not recognized.

The input method encountered an input method implementation-dependent error.

XCreateIC can generate BadAtom, BadColor, BadPixmap, and BadWindow errors.

To destroy an input context, use XDestroyIC. __ │

void XDestroyIC(ic)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context. │__

XDestroyIC destroys the specified input context.

To communicate to and synchronize with input method for any changes in keyboard focus from the client side, use XSetICFocus and XUnsetICFocus. __ │

void XSetICFocus(ic)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context. │__

The XSetICFocus function allows a client to notify an input method that the focus window attached to the specified input context has received keyboard focus. The input method should take action to provide appropriate feedback. Complete feedback specification is a matter of user interface policy.

Calling XSetICFocus does not affect the focus window value. __ │

void XUnsetICFocus(ic)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context. │__

The XUnsetICFocus function allows a client to notify an input method that the specified input context has lost the keyboard focus and that no more input is expected on the focus window attached to that input context. The input method should take action to provide appropriate feedback. Complete feedback specification is a matter of user interface policy.

Calling XUnsetICFocus does not affect the focus window value; the client may still receive events from the input method that are directed to the focus window.

To reset the state of an input context to its initial state, use XmbResetIC or XwcResetIC. __ │

char * XmbResetIC(ic)
XIC ic;

wchar_t * XwcResetIC(ic)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context. │__

When XNResetState is set to XIMInitialState, XmbResetIC and XwcResetIC reset an input context to its initial state; when XNResetState is set to XIMPreserveState, the current input context state is preserved. In both cases, any input pending on that context is deleted. The input method is required to clear the preedit area, if any, and update the status accordingly. Calling XmbResetIC or XwcResetIC does not change the focus.

The return value of XmbResetIC is its current preedit string as a multibyte string. If there is any preedit text drawn or visible to the user, then these procedures must return a non-NULL string. If there is no visible preedit text, then it is input method implementation-dependent whether these procedures return a non-NULL string or NULL.

The client should free the returned string by calling XFree.

To get the input method associated with an input context, use XIMOfIC. __ │

XIM XIMOfIC(ic)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context. │__

The XIMOfIC function returns the input method associated with the specified input context.

Xlib provides two functions for setting and reading XIC values, respectively, XSetICValues and XGetICValues. Both functions have a variable-length argument list. In that argument list, any XIC value’s name must be denoted with a character string using the X Portable Character Set.

To set XIC values, use XSetICValues. __ │

char * XSetICValues(ic, ...)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context.

...

Specifies the variable length argument list to set

XIC values. │__

The XSetICValues function returns NULL if no error occurred; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be set. An argument might not be set for any of the following reasons:

The argument is read-only (for example, XNFilterEvents).

The argument name is not recognized.

An implementation-dependent error occurs.

Each value to be set must be an appropriate datum, matching the data type imposed by the semantics of the argument.

XSetICValues can generate BadAtom, BadColor, BadCursor, BadPixmap, and BadWindow errors.

To obtain XIC values, use XGetICValues. __ │

char * XGetICValues(ic, ...)
XIC ic;

ic

Specifies the input context.

...

Specifies the variable length argument list to get

XIC values. │__

The XGetICValues function returns NULL if no error occurred; otherwise, it returns the name of the first argument that could not be obtained. An argument could not be obtained for any of the following reasons:

The argument name is not recognized.

The input method encountered an implementation-dependent error.

Each IC attribute value argument (following a name) must point to a location where the IC value is to be stored. That is, if the IC value is of type T, the argument must be of type T*. If T itself is a pointer type, then XGetICValues allocates memory to store the actual data, and the client is responsible for freeing this data by calling XFree with the returned pointer. The exception to this rule is for an IC value of type XVaNestedList (for preedit and status attributes). In this case, the argument must also be of type XVaNestedList. Then, the rule of changing type T to T* and freeing the allocated data applies to each element of the nested list.

13.5.6. Input Context Values

The following tables describe how XIC values are interpreted by an input method depending on the input style chosen by the user.

The first column lists the XIC values. The second column indicates which values are involved in affecting, negotiating, and setting the geometry of the input method windows. The subentries under the third column indicate the different input styles that are supported. Each of these columns indicates how each of the XIC values are treated by that input style.

The following keys apply to these tables.
Key Explanation

C
This value must be set with XCreateIC.
D
This value may be set using XCreateIC. If it
is not set, a default is provided.
G
This value may be read using XGetICValues.
GN
This value may cause geometry negotiation when
its value is set by means of XCreateIC or
XSetICValues
.
GR
This value will be the response of the input
method when any GN value is changed.
GS
This value will cause the geometry of the input
method window to be set.
O
This value must be set once and only once. It
need not be set at create time.
S
This value may be set with XSetICValues.
Ignored
This value is ignored by the input method for
the given input style.
Input Style
XIC Value Geometry Preedit Preedit Preedit Preedit Preedit
Management Callback Position Area Nothing None

Input Style C-G C-G C-G C-G C-G
Client Window O-G O-G O-G O-G Ignored
Focus Window GN D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Resource Name Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Resource Class Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Geometry Callback Ignored Ignored D-S-G Ignored Ignored
Filter Events G G G G Ignored
Destroy Callback D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G
String Conversion Callback S-G S-G S-G S-G S-G
String Conversion D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G
Reset State D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
HotKey S-G S-G S-G S-G Ignored
HotKeyState D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Preedit

Area GS Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored Ignored
Area Needed GN-GR Ignored Ignored S-G Ignored Ignored
Spot Location Ignored D-S-G Ignored Ignored Ignored
Colormap Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Foreground Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Background Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Background Pixmap Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Font Set GN Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Line Spacing GN Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Cursor Ignored D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Preedit State D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Preedit State Notify Callback S-G S-G S-G S-G Ignored
Preedit Callbacks C-S-G Ignored Ignored Ignored Ignored
Input Style
XIC Value Geometry Status Status Status Status
Management Callback Area Nothing None

Input Style C-G C-G C-G C-G
Client Window O-G O-G O-G Ignored
Focus Window GN D-S-G D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Resource Name Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Resource Class Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Geometry Callback Ignored D-S-G Ignored Ignored
Filter Events G G G G
Status

Area GS Ignored D-S-G Ignored Ignored
Area Needed GN-GR Ignored S-G Ignored Ignored
Colormap Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Foreground Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Background Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Background Pixmap Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Font Set GN Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Line Spacing GN Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Cursor Ignored D-S-G D-S-G Ignored
Status Callbacks C-S-G Ignored Ignored Ignored

13.5.6.1. Input Style

The XNInputStyle argument specifies the input style to be used. The value of this argument must be one of the values returned by the XGetIMValues function with the XNQueryInputStyle argument specified in the supported_styles list.

Note that this argument must be set at creation time and cannot be changed.

13.5.6.2. Client Window

The XNClientWindow argument specifies to the input method the client window in which the input method can display data or create subwindows. Geometry values for input method areas are given with respect to the client window. Dynamic change of client window is not supported. This argument may be set only once and should be set before any input is done using this input context. If it is not set, the input method may not operate correctly.

If an attempt is made to set this value a second time with XSetICValues, the string XNClientWindow will be returned by XSetICValues, and the client window will not be changed.

If the client window is not a valid window ID on the display attached to the input method, a BadWindow error can be generated when this value is used by the input method.

13.5.6.3. Focus Window

The XNFocusWindow argument specifies the focus window. The primary purpose of the XNFocusWindow is to identify the window that will receive the key event when input is composed. In addition, the input method may possibly affect the focus window as follows:

Select events on it

Send events to it

Modify its properties

Grab the keyboard within that window

The associated value must be of type Window. If the focus window is not a valid window ID on the display attached to the input method, a BadWindow error can be generated when this value is used by the input method.

When this XIC value is left unspecified, the input method will use the client window as the default focus window.

13.5.6.4. Resource Name and Class

The XNResourceName and XNResourceClass arguments are strings that specify the full name and class used by the client to obtain resources for the client window. These values should be used as prefixes for name and class when looking up resources that may vary according to the input context. If these values are not set, the resources will not be fully specified.

It is not intended that values that can be set as XIC values be set as resources.

13.5.6.5. Geometry Callback

The XNGeometryCallback argument is a structure of type XIMCallback (see section 13.5.6.13.12).

The XNGeometryCallback argument specifies the geometry callback that a client can set. This callback is not required for correct operation of either an input method or a client. It can be set for a client whose user interface policy permits an input method to request the dynamic change of that input method’s window. An input method that does dynamic change will need to filter any events that it uses to initiate the change.

13.5.6.6. Filter Events

The XNFilterEvents argument returns the event mask that an input method needs to have selected for. The client is expected to augment its own event mask for the client window with this one.

This argument is read-only, is set by the input method at create time, and is never changed.

The type of this argument is unsigned long. Setting this value will cause an error.

13.5.6.7. Destroy Callback

The XNDestroyCallback argument is a pointer to a structure of type XIMCallback (see section 13.5.6.13.12). This callback is triggered when the input method stops its service for any reason; for example, when a connection to an IM server is broken. After the destroy callback is called, the input context is destroyed and the input method is closed. Therefore, the client should not call XDestroyIC and XCloseIM.

13.5.6.8. String Conversion Callback

The XNStringConversionCallback argument is a structure of type XIMCallback (see section 13.5.6.13.12).

The XNStringConversionCallback argument specifies a string conversion callback. This callback is not required for correct operation of either the input method or the client. It can be set by a client to support string conversions that may be requested by the input method. An input method that does string conversions will filter any events that it uses to initiate the conversion.

Because this XIC value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryICValuesList before using this argument.

13.5.6.9. String Conversion

The XNStringConversion argument is a structure of type XIMStringConversionText.

The XNStringConversion argument specifies the string to be converted by an input method. This argument is not required for correct operation of either the input method or the client.

String conversion facilitates the manipulation of text independent of preediting. It is essential for some input methods and clients to manipulate text by performing context-sensitive conversion, reconversion, or transliteration conversion on it.

Because this XIC value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryICValuesList before using this argument.

The XIMStringConversionText structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct _XIMStringConversionText {

unsigned short length;

XIMStringConversionFeedback *feedback;

Bool encoding_is_wchar;

union {

char

*mbs;

wchar_t *wcs;

} string;

} XIMStringConversionText;

typedef unsigned long XIMStringConversionFeedback; │__

The feedback member is reserved for future use. The text to be converted is defined by the string and length members. The length is indicated in characters. To prevent the library from freeing memory pointed to by an uninitialized pointer, the client should set the feedback element to NULL.

13.5.6.10. Reset State

The XNResetState argument specifies the state the input context will return to after calling XmbResetIC or XwcResetIC.

The XIC state may be set to its initial state, as specified by the XNPreeditState value when XCreateIC was called, or it may be set to preserve the current state.

The valid masks for XIMResetState are as follows: __ │

typedef unsigned long XIMResetState;
#define
XIMInitialState

(1L)
#define
XIMPreserveState

(1L<<1) │__

If XIMInitialState is set, then XmbResetIC and XwcResetIC will return to the initial XNPreeditState state of the XIC.

If XIMPreserveState is set, then XmbResetIC and XwcResetIC will preserve the current state of the XIC.

If XNResetState is left unspecified, the default is XIMInitialState.

XIMResetState values other than those specified above will default to XIMInitialState.

Because this XIC value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryICValuesList before using this argument.

13.5.6.11. Hot Keys

The XNHotKey argument specifies the hot key list to the XIC. The hot key list is a pointer to the structure of type XIMHotKeyTriggers, which specifies the key events that must be received without any interruption of the input method. For the hot key list set with this argument to be utilized, the client must also set XNHotKeyState to XIMHotKeyStateON.

Because this XIC value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryICValuesList before using this functionality.

The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XIMHotKeyTriggers.

If an event for a key in the hot key list is found, then the process will receive the event and it will be processed inside the client. __ │

typedef struct {

KeySym keysym;

unsigned int modifier;

unsigned int modifier_mask;

} XIMHotKeyTrigger;

typedef struct {

int num_hot_key;

XIMHotKeyTrigger *key;

} XIMHotKeyTriggers; │__

The combination of modifier and modifier_mask are used to represent one of three states for each modifier: either the modifier must be on, or the modifier must be off, or the modifier is a ‘‘don’t care’’ − it may be on or off. When a modifier_mask bit is set to 0, the state of the associated modifier is ignored when evaluating whether the key is hot or not.
Modifier Bit Mask Bit Meaning

0
1
The modifier must be off.
1
1
The modifier must be on.
n/a
0
Do not care if the modifier is
on or off.

13.5.6.12. Hot Key State

The XNHotKeyState argument specifies the hot key state of the input method. This is usually used to switch the input method between hot key operation and normal input processing.

The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XIMHotKeyState . __ │

typedef unsigned long XIMHotKeyState;
#define
XIMHotKeyStateON

(0x0001L)
#define
XIMHotKeyStateOFF

(0x0002L) │__

If not specified, the default is XIMHotKeyStateOFF.

13.5.6.13. Preedit and Status Attributes

The XNPreeditAttributes and XNStatusAttributes arguments specify to an input method the attributes to be used for the preedit and status areas, if any. Those attributes are passed to XSetICValues or XGetICValues as a nested variable-length list. The names to be used in these lists are described in the following sections.

13.5.6.13.1. Area

The value of the XNArea argument must be a pointer to a structure of type XRectangle. The interpretation of the XNArea argument is dependent on the input method style that has been set.

If the input method style is XIMPreeditPosition, XNArea specifies the clipping region within which preediting will take place. If the focus window has been set, the coordinates are assumed to be relative to the focus window. Otherwise, the coordinates are assumed to be relative to the client window. If neither has been set, the results are undefined.

If XNArea is not specified, is set to NULL, or is invalid, the input method will default the clipping region to the geometry of the XNFocusWindow. If the area specified is NULL or invalid, the results are undefined.

If the input style is XIMPreeditArea or XIMStatusArea, XNArea specifies the geometry provided by the client to the input method. The input method may use this area to display its data, either preedit or status depending on the area designated. The input method may create a window as a child of the client window with dimensions that fit the XNArea. The coordinates are relative to the client window. If the client window has not been set yet, the input method should save these values and apply them when the client window is set. If XNArea is not specified, is set to NULL, or is invalid, the results are undefined.

13.5.6.13.2. Area Needed

When set, the XNAreaNeeded argument specifies the geometry suggested by the client for this area (preedit or status). The value associated with the argument must be a pointer to a structure of type XRectangle. Note that the x, y values are not used and that nonzero values for width or height are the constraints that the client wishes the input method to respect.

When read, the XNAreaNeeded argument specifies the preferred geometry desired by the input method for the area.

This argument is only valid if the input style is XIMPreeditArea or XIMStatusArea. It is used for geometry negotiation between the client and the input method and has no other effect on the input method (see section 13.5.1.5).

13.5.6.13.3. Spot Location

The XNSpotLocation argument specifies to the input method the coordinates of the spot to be used by an input method executing with XNInputStyle set to XIMPreeditPosition. When specified to any input method other than XIMPreeditPosition, this XIC value is ignored.

The x coordinate specifies the position where the next character would be inserted. The y coordinate is the position of the baseline used by the current text line in the focus window. The x and y coordinates are relative to the focus window, if it has been set; otherwise, they are relative to the client window. If neither the focus window nor the client window has been set, the results are undefined.

The value of the argument is a pointer to a structure of type XPoint.

13.5.6.13.4. Colormap

Two different arguments can be used to indicate what colormap the input method should use to allocate colors, a colormap ID, or a standard colormap name.

The XNColormap argument is used to specify a colormap ID. The argument value is of type Colormap. An invalid argument may generate a BadColor error when it is used by the input method.

The XNStdColormap argument is used to indicate the name of the standard colormap in which the input method should allocate colors. The argument value is an Atom that should be a valid atom for calling XGetRGBColormaps. An invalid argument may generate a BadAtom error when it is used by the input method.

If the colormap is left unspecified, the client window colormap becomes the default.

13.5.6.13.5. Foreground and Background

The XNForeground and XNBackground arguments specify the foreground and background pixel, respectively. The argument value is of type unsigned long. It must be a valid pixel in the input method colormap.

If these values are left unspecified, the default is determined by the input method.

13.5.6.13.6. Background Pixmap

The XNBackgroundPixmap argument specifies a background pixmap to be used as the background of the window. The value must be of type Pixmap. An invalid argument may generate a BadPixmap error when it is used by the input method.

If this value is left unspecified, the default is determined by the input method.

13.5.6.13.7. Font Set

The XNFontSet argument specifies to the input method what font set is to be used. The argument value is of type XFontSet.

If this value is left unspecified, the default is determined by the input method.

13.5.6.13.8. Line Spacing

The XNLineSpace argument specifies to the input method what line spacing is to be used in the preedit window if more than one line is to be used. This argument is of type int.

If this value is left unspecified, the default is determined by the input method.

13.5.6.13.9. Cursor

The XNCursor argument specifies to the input method what cursor is to be used in the specified window. This argument is of type Cursor.

An invalid argument may generate a BadCursor error when it is used by the input method. If this value is left unspecified, the default is determined by the input method.

13.5.6.13.10. Preedit State

The XNPreeditState argument specifies the state of input preediting for the input method. Input preediting can be on or off.

The valid mask names for XNPreeditState are as follows: __ │

typedef unsigned long XIMPreeditState;
#define
XIMPreeditUnknown

0L
#define
XIMPreeditEnable

1L
#define
XIMPreeditDisable

(1L<<1) │__

If a value of XIMPreeditEnable is set, then input preediting is turned on by the input method.

If a value of XIMPreeditDisable is set, then input preediting is turned off by the input method.

If XNPreeditState is left unspecified, then the state will be implementation-dependent.

When XNResetState is set to XIMInitialState, the XNPreeditState value specified at the creation time will be reflected as the initial state for XmbResetIC and XwcResetIC.

Because this XIC value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryICValuesList before using this argument.

13.5.6.13.11. Preedit State Notify Callback

The preedit state notify callback is triggered by the input method when the preediting state has changed. The value of the XNPreeditStateNotifyCallback argument is a pointer to a structure of type XIMCallback. The generic prototype is as follows: __ │

void PreeditStateNotifyCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XIMPreeditStateNotifyCallbackStruct *call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Specifies the current preedit state. │__

The XIMPreeditStateNotifyCallbackStruct structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct _XIMPreeditStateNotifyCallbackStruct {

XIMPreeditState state;

} XIMPreeditStateNotifyCallbackStruct; │__

Because this XIC value is optional, a client should call XGetIMValues with argument XNQueryICValuesList before using this argument.

13.5.6.13.12. Preedit and Status Callbacks

A client that wants to support the input style XIMPreeditCallbacks must provide a set of preedit callbacks to the input method. The set of preedit callbacks is as follows:
XNPreeditStartCallback

This is called when the input method
starts preedit.
XNPreeditDoneCallback

This is called when the input method
stops preedit.
XNPreeditDrawCallback

This is called when a number of preedit
keystrokes should be echoed.
XNPreeditCaretCallback

This is called to move the text
insertion point within the preedit
string.

A client that wants to support the input style XIMStatusCallbacks must provide a set of status callbacks to the input method. The set of status callbacks is as follows:
XNStatusStartCallback

This is called when the input method
initializes the status area.
XNStatusDoneCallback

This is called when the input method no
longer needs the status area.
XNStatusDrawCallback

This is called when updating of the
status area is required.

The value of any status or preedit argument is a pointer to a structure of type XIMCallback. __ │

typedef void (*XIMProc)();

typedef struct {

XPointer client_data;

XIMProc callback;

} XIMCallback; │__

Each callback has some particular semantics and will carry the data that expresses the environment necessary to the client into a specific data structure. This paragraph only describes the arguments to be used to set the callback.

Setting any of these values while doing preedit may cause unexpected results.

13.5.7. Input Method Callback Semantics

XIM callbacks are procedures defined by clients or text drawing packages that are to be called from the input method when selected events occur. Most clients will use a text editing package or a toolkit and, hence, will not need to define such callbacks. This section defines the callback semantics, when they are triggered, and what their arguments are. This information is mostly useful for X toolkit implementors.

Callbacks are mostly provided so that clients (or text editing packages) can implement on-the-spot preediting in their own window. In that case, the input method needs to communicate and synchronize with the client. The input method needs to communicate changes in the preedit window when it is under control of the client. Those callbacks allow the client to initialize the preedit area, display a new preedit string, move the text insertion point during preedit, terminate preedit, or update the status area.

All callback procedures follow the generic prototype: __ │

void CallbackPrototype(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;

XPointer client_data;

SomeType call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Specifies data specific to the callback. │__

The call_data argument is a structure that expresses the arguments needed to achieve the semantics; that is, it is a specific data structure appropriate to the callback. In cases where no data is needed in the callback, this call_data argument is NULL. The client_data argument is a closure that has been initially specified by the client when specifying the callback and passed back. It may serve, for example, to inherit application context in the callback.

The following paragraphs describe the programming semantics and specific data structure associated with the different reasons.

13.5.7.1. Geometry Callback

The geometry callback is triggered by the input method to indicate that it wants the client to negotiate geometry. The generic prototype is as follows: __ │

void GeometryCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

The callback is called with a NULL call_data argument.

13.5.7.2. Destroy Callback

The destroy callback is triggered by the input method when it stops service for any reason. After the callback is invoked, the input context will be freed by Xlib. The generic prototype is as follows: __ │

void DestroyCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

The callback is called with a NULL call_data argument.

13.5.7.3. String Conversion Callback

The string conversion callback is triggered by the input method to request the client to return the string to be converted. The returned string may be either a multibyte or wide character string, with an encoding matching the locale bound to the input context. The callback prototype is as follows: __ │

void StringConversionCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct *call_data;

ic

Specifies the input method.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Specifies the amount of the string to be convert-

ed. │__

The callback is passed an XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct structure in the call_data argument. The text member is an XIMStringConversionText structure (see section 13.5.6.9) to be filled in by the client and describes the text to be sent to the input method. The data pointed to by the string and feedback elements of the XIMStringConversionText structure will be freed using XFree by the input method after the callback returns. So the client should not point to internal buffers that are critical to the client. Similarly, because the feedback element is currently reserved for future use, the client should set feedback to NULL to prevent the library from freeing memory at some random location due to an uninitialized pointer.

The XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct _XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct {

XIMStringConversionPosition position;

XIMCaretDirection direction;

short factor;

XIMStringConversionOperation operation;

XIMStringConversionText *text;

} XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct;

typedef short XIMStringConversionPosition;

typedef unsigned short XIMStringConversionOperation;
#define
XIMStringConversionSubstitution

(0x0001)
#define
XIMStringConversionRetrieval

(0x0002) │__

XIMStringConversionPosition specifies the starting position of the string to be returned in the XIMStringConversionText structure. The value identifies a position, in units of characters, relative to the client’s cursor position in the client’s buffer.

The ending position of the text buffer is determined by the direction and factor members. Specifically, it is the character position relative to the starting point as defined by the XIMCaretDirection. The factor member of XIMStringConversionCallbackStruct specifies the number of XIMCaretDirection positions to be applied. For example, if the direction specifies XIMLineEnd and factor is 1, then all characters from the starting position to the end of the current display line are returned. If the direction specifies XIMForwardChar or XIMBackwardChar, then the factor specifies a relative position, indicated in characters, from the starting position.

XIMStringConversionOperation specifies whether the string to be converted should be deleted (substitution) or copied (retrieval) from the client’s buffer. When the XIMStringConversionOperation is XIMStringConversionSubstitution, the client must delete the string to be converted from its own buffer. When the XIMStringConversionOperation is XIMStringConversionRetrieval, the client must not delete the string to be converted from its buffer. The substitute operation is typically used for reconversion and transliteration conversion, while the retrieval operation is typically used for context-sensitive conversion.

13.5.7.4. Preedit State Callbacks

When the input method turns preediting on or off, a PreeditStartCallback or PreeditDoneCallback callback is triggered to let the toolkit do the setup or the cleanup for the preedit region. __ │

int PreeditStartCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

When preedit starts on the specified input context, the callback is called with a NULL call_data argument. PreeditStartCallback will return the maximum size of the preedit string. A positive number indicates the maximum number of bytes allowed in the preedit string, and a value of −1 indicates there is no limit. __ │

void PreeditDoneCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

When preedit stops on the specified input context, the callback is called with a NULL call_data argument. The client can release the data allocated by PreeditStartCallback.

PreeditStartCallback should initialize appropriate data needed for displaying preedit information and for handling further PreeditDrawCallback calls. Once PreeditStartCallback is called, it will not be called again before PreeditDoneCallback has been called.

13.5.7.5. Preedit Draw Callback

This callback is triggered to draw and insert, delete or replace, preedit text in the preedit region. The preedit text may include unconverted input text such as Japanese Kana, converted text such as Japanese Kanji characters, or characters of both kinds. That string is either a multibyte or wide character string, whose encoding matches the locale bound to the input context. The callback prototype is as follows: __ │

void PreeditDrawCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XIMPreeditDrawCallbackStruct *call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Specifies the preedit drawing information. │__

The callback is passed an XIMPreeditDrawCallbackStruct structure in the call_data argument. The text member of this structure contains the text to be drawn. After the string has been drawn, the caret should be moved to the specified location.

The XIMPreeditDrawCallbackStruct structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct _XIMPreeditDrawCallbackStruct {

int caret;

/* Cursor offset within preedit string */

int chg_first;

/* Starting change position */

int chg_length;

/* Length of the change in character count */

XIMText *text;

} XIMPreeditDrawCallbackStruct; │__

The client must keep updating a buffer of the preedit text and the callback arguments referring to indexes in that buffer. The call_data fields have specific meanings according to the operation, as follows:

To indicate text deletion, the call_data member specifies a NULL text field. The text to be deleted is then the current text in the buffer from position chg_first (starting at zero) on a character length of chg_length.

When text is non-NULL, it indicates insertion or replacement of text in the buffer.

The chg_length member identifies the number of characters in the current preedit buffer that are affected by this call. A positive chg_length indicates that chg_length number of characters, starting at chg_first, must be deleted or must be replaced by text, whose length is specified in the XIMText structure.

A chg_length value of zero indicates that text must be inserted right at the position specified by chg_first. A value of zero for chg_first specifies the first character in the buffer.

chg_length and chg_first combine to identify the modification required to the preedit buffer; beginning at chg_first, replace chg_length number of characters with the text in the supplied XIMText structure. For example, suppose the preedit buffer contains the string "ABCDE".

Text:      A B C D E
          ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^
CharPos:  0 1 2 3 4 5

The CharPos in the diagram shows the location of the character position relative to the character.

If the value of chg_first is 1 and the value of chg_length is 3, this says to replace 3 characters beginning at character position 1 with the string in the XIMText structure. Hence, BCD would be replaced by the value in the structure.

Though chg_length and chg_first are both signed integers they will never have a negative value.

• The caret member identifies the character position before which the cursor should be placed − after modification to the preedit buffer has been completed. For example, if caret is zero, the cursor is at the beginning of the buffer. If the caret is one, the cursor is between the first and second character. __ │

typedef struct _XIMText {

unsigned short length;

XIMFeedback * feedback;

Bool encoding_is_wchar;

union {

char * multi_byte;

wchar_t * wide_char;

} string;

} XIMText; │__

The text string passed is actually a structure specifying as follows:

The length member is the text length in characters.

The encoding_is_wchar member is a value that indicates if the text string is encoded in wide character or multibyte format. The text string may be passed either as multibyte or as wide character; the input method controls in which form data is passed. The client’s callback routine must be able to handle data passed in either form.

The string member is the text string.

The feedback member indicates rendering type for each character in the string member. If string is NULL (indicating that only highlighting of the existing preedit buffer should be updated), feedback points to length highlight elements that should be applied to the existing preedit buffer, beginning at chg_first.

The feedback member expresses the types of rendering feedback the callback should apply when drawing text. Rendering of the text to be drawn is specified either in generic ways (for example, primary, secondary) or in specific ways (reverse, underline). When generic indications are given, the client is free to choose the rendering style. It is necessary, however, that primary and secondary be mapped to two distinct rendering styles.

If an input method wants to control display of the preedit string, an input method can indicate the visibility hints using feedbacks in a specific way. The XIMVisibleToForward, XIMVisibleToBackward, and XIMVisibleCenter masks are exclusively used for these visibility hints. The XIMVisibleToForward mask indicates that the preedit text is preferably displayed in the primary draw direction from the caret position in the preedit area forward. The XIMVisibleToBackward mask indicates that the preedit text is preferably displayed from the caret position in the preedit area backward, relative to the primary draw direction. The XIMVisibleCenter mask indicates that the preedit text is preferably displayed with the caret position in the preedit area centered.

The insertion point of the preedit string could exist outside of the visible area when visibility hints are used. Only one of the masks is valid for the entire preedit string, and only one character can hold one of these feedbacks for a given input context at one time. This feedback may be OR’ed together with another highlight (such as XIMReverse). Only the most recently set feedback is valid, and any previous feedback is automatically canceled. This is a hint to the client, and the client is free to choose how to display the preedit string.

The feedback member also specifies how rendering of the text argument should be performed. If the feedback is NULL, the callback should apply the same feedback as is used for the surrounding characters in the preedit buffer; if chg_first is at a highlight boundary, the client can choose which of the two highlights to use. If feedback is not NULL, feedback specifies an array defining the rendering for each character of the string, and the length of the array is thus length.

If an input method wants to indicate that it is only updating the feedback of the preedit text without changing the content of it, the XIMText structure will contain a NULL value for the string field, the number of characters affected (relative to chg_first) will be in the length field, and the feedback field will point to an array of XIMFeedback.

Each element in the feedback array is a bitmask represented by a value of type XIMFeedback. The valid mask names are as follows: __ │

typedef unsigned long XIMFeedback;
#define
XIMReverse

1L
#define
XIMUnderline

(1L<<1)
#define
XIMHighlight

(1L<<2)
#define
XIMPrimary

(1L<<5)†
#define
XIMSecondary

(1L<<6)†
#define
XIMTertiary

(1L<<7)†
#define
XIMVisibleToForward

(1L<<8)
#define
XIMVisibleToBackward

(1L<<9)
#define
XIMVisibleCenter

(1L<<10) │__

Characters drawn with the XIMReverse highlight should be drawn by swapping the foreground and background colors used to draw normal, unhighlighted characters. Characters drawn with the XIMUnderline highlight should be underlined. Characters drawn with the XIMHighlight, XIMPrimary, XIMSecondary, and XIMTertiary highlights should be drawn in some unique manner that must be different from XIMReverse and XIMUnderline.

13.5.7.6. Preedit Caret Callback

An input method may have its own navigation keys to allow the user to move the text insertion point in the preedit area (for example, to move backward or forward). Consequently, input method needs to indicate to the client that it should move the text insertion point. It then calls the PreeditCaretCallback. __ │

void PreeditCaretCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XIMPreeditCaretCallbackStruct *call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Specifies the preedit caret information. │__

The input method will trigger PreeditCaretCallback to move the text insertion point during preedit. The call_data argument contains a pointer to an XIMPreeditCaretCallbackStruct structure, which indicates where the caret should be moved. The callback must move the insertion point to its new location and return, in field position, the new offset value from the initial position.

The XIMPreeditCaretCallbackStruct structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef struct _XIMPreeditCaretCallbackStruct {

int position;

/* Caret offset within preedit string */

XIMCaretDirection direction;/* Caret moves direction */

XIMCaretStyle style;/* Feedback of the caret */

} XIMPreeditCaretCallbackStruct; │__

The XIMCaretStyle structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef enum {

XIMIsInvisible,

/* Disable caret feedback */

XIMIsPrimary,

/* UI defined caret feedback */

XIMIsSecondary,

/* UI defined caret feedback */

} XIMCaretStyle; │__

The XIMCaretDirection structure is defined as follows: __ │

typedef enum {

XIMForwardChar, XIMBackwardChar,

XIMForwardWord, XIMBackwardWord,

XIMCaretUp, XIMCaretDown,

XIMNextLine, XIMPreviousLine,

XIMLineStart, XIMLineEnd,

XIMAbsolutePosition,

XIMDontChange,

} XIMCaretDirection; │__

These values are defined as follows:
XIMForwardChar

Move the caret forward one character
position.
XIMBackwardChar

Move the caret backward one character
position.
XIMForwardWord

Move the caret forward one word.
XIMBackwardWord

Move the caret backward one word.
XIMCaretUp

Move the caret up one line keeping the
current horizontal offset.
XIMCaretDown

Move the caret down one line keeping the
current horizontal offset.
XIMPreviousLine

Move the caret to the beginning of the
previous line.
XIMNextLine

Move the caret to the beginning of the
next line.
XIMLineStart

Move the caret to the beginning of the
current display line that contains the
caret.
XIMLineEnd

Move the caret to the end of the current
display line that contains the caret.
XIMAbsolutePosition

The callback must move to the location
specified by the position field of the
callback data, indicated in characters,
starting from the beginning of the preedit
text. Hence, a value of zero means move
back to the beginning of the preedit text.
XIMDontChange

The caret position does not change.

13.5.7.7. Status Callbacks

An input method may communicate changes in the status of an input context (for example, created, destroyed, or focus changes) with three status callbacks: StatusStartCallback, StatusDoneCallback, and StatusDrawCallback.

When the input context is created or gains focus, the input method calls the StatusStartCallback callback. __ │

void StatusStartCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

The callback should initialize appropriate data for displaying status and for responding to StatusDrawCallback calls. Once StatusStartCallback is called, it will not be called again before StatusDoneCallback has been called.

When an input context is destroyed or when it loses focus, the input method calls StatusDoneCallback. __ │

void StatusDoneCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XPointer call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Not used for this callback and always passed as

NULL. │__

The callback may release any data allocated on StatusStart.

When an input context status has to be updated, the input method calls StatusDrawCallback. __ │

void StatusDrawCallback(ic, client_data, call_data)
XIC ic;
XPointer client_data;
XIMStatusDrawCallbackStruct *call_data;

ic

Specifies the input context.

client_dataSpecifies the additional client data.

call_data

Specifies the status drawing information. │__

The callback should update the status area by either drawing a string or imaging a bitmap in the status area.

The XIMStatusDataType and XIMStatusDrawCallbackStruct structures are defined as follows: __ │

typedef enum {

XIMTextType,

XIMBitmapType,

} XIMStatusDataType;

typedef struct _XIMStatusDrawCallbackStruct {

XIMStatusDataType type;

union {

XIMText *text;

Pixmap bitmap;

} data;

} XIMStatusDrawCallbackStruct; │__

The feedback styles XIMVisibleToForward, XIMVisibleToBackward, and XIMVisibleToCenter are not relevant and will not appear in the XIMFeedback element of the XIMText structure.

13.5.8. Event Filtering

Xlib provides the ability for an input method to register a filter internal to Xlib. This filter is called by a client (or toolkit) by calling XFilterEvent after calling XNextEvent. Any client that uses the XIM interface should call XFilterEvent to allow input methods to process their events without knowledge of the client’s dispatching mechanism. A client’s user interface policy may determine the priority of event filters with respect to other event-handling mechanisms (for example, modal grabs).

Clients may not know how many filters there are, if any, and what they do. They may only know if an event has been filtered on return of XFilterEvent. Clients should discard filtered events.

To filter an event, use XFilterEvent. __ │

Bool XFilterEvent(event, w)
XEvent *event;
Window w;

event

Specifies the event to filter.

w

Specifies the window for which the filter is to be

applied. │__

If the window argument is None, XFilterEvent applies the filter to the window specified in the XEvent structure. The window argument is provided so that layers above Xlib that do event redirection can indicate to which window an event has been redirected.

If XFilterEvent returns True, then some input method has filtered the event, and the client should discard the event. If XFilterEvent returns False, then the client should continue processing the event.

If a grab has occurred in the client and XFilterEvent returns True, the client should ungrab the keyboard.

13.5.9. Getting Keyboard Input

To get composed input from an input method, use XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString. __ │

int XmbLookupString(ic, event, buffer_return, bytes_buffer, keysym_return, status_return)
XIC ic;
XKeyPressedEvent *event;
char *buffer_return;
int bytes_buffer;
KeySym *keysym_return;
Status *status_return;

int XwcLookupString(ic, event, buffer_return, bytes_buffer, keysym_return, status_return)
XIC ic;
XKeyPressedEvent *event;
wchar_t *buffer_return;
int wchars_buffer;
KeySym *keysym_return;
Status *status_return;

ic

Specifies the input context.

event

Specifies the key event to be used.

buffer_return
Returns a multibyte string or wide character
string (if any) from the input method.

bytes_buffer
wchars_buffer

Specifies space available in the return buffer.

keysym_return
Returns the KeySym computed from the event if this
argument is not NULL.

status_return
Returns a value indicating what kind of data is
returned. │__

The XmbLookupString and XwcLookupString functions return the string from the input method specified in the buffer_return argument. If no string is returned, the buffer_return argument is unchanged.

The KeySym into which the KeyCode from the event was mapped is returned in the keysym_return argument if it is non-NULL and the status_return argument indicates that a KeySym was returned. If both a string and a KeySym are returned, the KeySym value does not necessarily correspond to the string returned.

XmbLookupString returns the length of the string in bytes, and XwcLookupString returns the length of the string in characters. Both XmbLookupString and XwcLookupString return text in the encoding of the locale bound to the input method of the specified input context.

Each string returned by XmbLookupString and XwcLookupString begins in the initial state of the encoding of the locale (if the encoding of the locale is state-dependent).

Note

To insure proper input processing, it is essential that the client pass only KeyPress events to XmbLookupString and XwcLookupString. Their behavior when a client passes a KeyRelease event is undefined.

Clients should check the status_return argument before using the other returned values. These two functions both return a value to status_return that indicates what has been returned in the other arguments. The possible values returned are:
XBufferOverflow

The input string to be returned is too
large for the supplied buffer_return. The
required size (XmbLookupString in bytes;
XwcLookupString
in characters) is returned
as the value of the function, and the
contents of buffer_return and keysym_return
are not modified. The client should recall
the function with the same event and a
buffer of adequate size to obtain the
string.
XLookupNone

No consistent input has been composed so
far. The contents of buffer_return and
keysym_return are not modified, and the
function returns zero.
XLookupChars

Some input characters have been composed.
They are placed in the buffer_return
argument, and the string length is returned
as the value of the function. The string
is encoded in the locale bound to the input
context. The content of the keysym_return
argument is not modified.
XLookupKeySym

A KeySym has been returned instead of a
string and is returned in keysym_return.
The content of the buffer_return argument
is not modified, and the function returns
zero.
XLookupBoth

Both a KeySym and a string are returned;
XLookupChars
and XLookupKeySym occur
simultaneously.

It does not make any difference if the input context passed as an argument to XmbLookupString and XwcLookupString is the one currently in possession of the focus or not. Input may have been composed within an input context before it lost the focus, and that input may be returned on subsequent calls to XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString even though it does not have any more keyboard focus.

13.5.10. Input Method Conventions

The input method architecture is transparent to the client. However, clients should respect a number of conventions in order to work properly. Clients must also be aware of possible effects of synchronization between input method and library in the case of a remote input server.

13.5.10.1. Client Conventions

A well-behaved client (or toolkit) should first query the input method style. If the client cannot satisfy the requirements of the supported styles (in terms of geometry management or callbacks), it should negotiate with the user continuation of the program or raise an exception or error of some sort.

13.5.10.2. Synchronization Conventions

A KeyPress event with a KeyCode of zero is used exclusively as a signal that an input method has composed input that can be returned by XmbLookupString or XwcLookupString. No other use is made of a KeyPress event with KeyCode of zero.

Such an event may be generated by either a front-end or a back-end input method in an implementation-dependent manner. Some possible ways to generate this event include:

A synthetic event sent by an input method server

An artificial event created by a input method filter and pushed onto a client’s event queue

A KeyPress event whose KeyCode value is modified by an input method filter

When callback support is specified by the client, input methods will not take action unless they explicitly called back the client and obtained no response (the callback is not specified or returned invalid data).

13.6. String Constants

The following symbols for string constants are defined in <X11/Xlib.h>. Although they are shown here with particular macro definitions, they may be implemented as macros, as global symbols, or as a mixture of the two. The string pointer value itself is not significant; clients must not assume that inequality of two values implies inequality of the actual string data.
#define
XNVaNestedList

"XNVaNestedList"
#define
XNSeparatorofNestedList

"separatorofNestedList"
#define
XNQueryInputStyle

"queryInputStyle"
#define
XNClientWindow

"clientWindow"
#define
XNInputStyle

"inputStyle"
#define
XNFocusWindow

"focusWindow"
#define
XNResourceName

"resourceName"
#define
XNResourceClass

"resourceClass"
#define
XNGeometryCallback

"geometryCallback"
#define
XNDestroyCallback

"destroyCallback"
#define
XNFilterEvents

"filterEvents"
#define
XNPreeditStartCallback

"preeditStartCallback"
#define
XNPreeditDoneCallback

"preeditDoneCallback"
#define
XNPreeditDrawCallback

"preeditDrawCallback"
#define
XNPreeditCaretCallback

"preeditCaretCallback"
#define
XNPreeditStateNotifyCallback

"preeditStateNotifyCallback"
#define
XNPreeditAttributes

"preeditAttributes"
#define
XNStatusStartCallback

"statusStartCallback"
#define
XNStatusDoneCallback

"statusDoneCallback"
#define
XNStatusDrawCallback

"statusDrawCallback"
#define
XNStatusAttributes

"statusAttributes"
#define
XNArea

"area"
#define
XNAreaNeeded

"areaNeeded"
#define
XNSpotLocation

"spotLocation"
#define
XNColormap

"colorMap"
#define
XNStdColormap

"stdColorMap"
#define
XNForeground

"foreground"
#define
XNBackground

"background"
#define
XNBackgroundPixmap

"backgroundPixmap"
#define
XNFontSet

"fontSet"
#define
XNLineSpace

"lineSpace"
#define
XNCursor

"cursor"
#define
XNQueryIMValuesList

"queryIMValuesList"
#define
XNQueryICValuesList

"queryICValuesList"
#define
XNStringConversionCallback

"stringConversionCallback"
#define
XNStringConversion

"stringConversion"
#define
XNResetState

"resetState"
#define
XNHotKey

"hotkey"
#define
XNHotKeyState

"hotkeyState"
#define
XNPreeditState

"preeditState"
#define
XNVisiblePosition

"visiblePosition"
#define
XNR6PreeditCallbackBehavior

"r6PreeditCallback"
#define
XNRequiredCharSet

"requiredCharSet"
#define
XNQueryOrientation

"queryOrientation"
#define
XNDirectionalDependentDrawing

"directionalDependentDrawing"
#define
XNContextualDrawing

"contextualDrawing"
#define
XNBaseFontName

"baseFontName"
#define
XNMissingCharSet

"missingCharSet"
#define
XNDefaultString

"defaultString"
#define
XNOrientation

"orientation"
#define
XNFontInfo

"fontInfo"
#define
XNOMAutomatic

"omAutomatic"
_________________________
† During formulation of the X11R6 specification, the
behavior of the R6 PreeditDrawCallbacks was going to
differ significantly from that of the R5 callbacks.
Late changes to the specification converged the R5 and
R6 behaviors, eliminating the need for XNR6PreeditCall-
backBehavior
. Unfortunately, this argument was not re-
moved from the R6 specification before it was pub-
lished.
† The values for XIMPrimary, XIMSecondary, and
XIMTertiary
were incorrectly defined in the R5 specifi-
cation. The X Consortium’s X11R5 implementation cor-
rectly implemented the values for these highlights.
The value of these highlights has been corrected in
this specification to agree with the values in the Con-
sortium’s X11R5 and X11R6 implementations.

13

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 14

Inter-Client Communication Functions

The Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual, hereafter referred to as the ICCCM, details the X Consortium approved conventions that govern inter-client communications. These conventions ensure peer-to-peer client cooperation in the use of selections, cut buffers, and shared resources as well as client cooperation with window and session managers. For further information, see the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual.

Xlib provides a number of standard properties and programming interfaces that are ICCCM compliant. The predefined atoms for some of these properties are defined in the <X11/Xatom.h> header file, where to avoid name conflicts with user symbols their #define name has an XA_ prefix. For further information about atoms and properties, see section 4.3.

Xlib’s selection and cut buffer mechanisms provide the primary programming interfaces by which peer client applications communicate with each other (see sections 4.5 and 16.6). The functions discussed in this chapter provide the primary programming interfaces by which client applications communicate with their window and session managers as well as share standard colormaps.

The standard properties that are of special interest for communicating with window and session managers are:
Name Type Format Description

WM_CLASS
STRING

8
Set by application
programs to allow
window and session
managers to obtain the
application’s
resources from the
resource database.
WM_CLIENT_MACHINE
TEXT

The string name of the
machine on which the
client application is
running.
WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS
WINDOW

32
The list of window IDs
that may need a
different colormap
from that of their
top-level window.
WM_COMMAND
TEXT

The command and
arguments,
null-separated, used
to invoke the
application.
WM_HINTS
WM_HINTS

32
Additional hints set
by the client for use
by the window manager.
The C type of this
property is XWMHints.
WM_ICON_NAME
TEXT

The name to be used in
an icon.
WM_ICON_SIZE
WM_ICON_SIZE

32
The window manager may
set this property on
the root window to
specify the icon sizes
it supports. The C
type of this property
is XIconSize.
WM_NAME
TEXT

The name of the
application.
WM_NORMAL_HINTS
WM_SIZE_HINTS

32
Size hints for a
window in its normal
state. The C type of
this property is
XSizeHints
.
WM_PROTOCOLS
ATOM

32
List of atoms that
identify the
communications
protocols between the
client and window
manager in which the
client is willing to
participate.
WM_STATE
WM_STATE

32
Intended for
communication between
window and session
managers only.
WM_TRANSIENT_FOR
WINDOW

32
Set by application
programs to indicate
to the window manager
that a transient
top-level window, such
as a dialog box.

The remainder of this chapter discusses:

Client to window manager communication

Client to session manager communication

Standard colormaps

14.1. Client to Window Manager Communication

This section discusses how to:

Manipulate top-level windows

Convert string lists

Set and read text properties

Set and read the WM_NAME property

Set and read the WM_ICON_NAME property

Set and read the WM_HINTS property

Set and read the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property

Set and read the WM_CLASS property

Set and read the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property

Set and read the WM_PROTOCOLS property

Set and read the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property

Set and read the WM_ICON_SIZE property

Use window manager convenience functions

14.1.1. Manipulating Top-Level Windows

Xlib provides functions that you can use to change the visibility or size of top-level windows (that is, those that were created as children of the root window). Note that the subwindows that you create are ignored by window managers. Therefore, you should use the basic window functions described in chapter 3 to manipulate your application’s subwindows.

To request that a top-level window be iconified, use XIconifyWindow. __ │

Status XIconifyWindow(display, w, screen_number)
Display *display;
Window w;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

The XIconifyWindow function sends a WM_CHANGE_STATE ClientMessage event with a format of 32 and a first data element of IconicState (as described in section 4.1.4 of the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual) and a window of w to the root window of the specified screen with an event mask set to SubstructureNotifyMask| SubstructureRedirectMask. Window managers may elect to receive this message and if the window is in its normal state, may treat it as a request to change the window’s state from normal to iconic. If the WM_CHANGE_STATE property cannot be interned, XIconifyWindow does not send a message and returns a zero status. It returns a nonzero status if the client message is sent successfully; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

To request that a top-level window be withdrawn, use XWithdrawWindow. __ │

Status XWithdrawWindow(display, w, screen_number)
Display *display;
Window w;
int screen_number;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server. │__

The XWithdrawWindow function unmaps the specified window and sends a synthetic UnmapNotify event to the root window of the specified screen. Window managers may elect to receive this message and may treat it as a request to change the window’s state to withdrawn. When a window is in the withdrawn state, neither its normal nor its iconic representations is visible. It returns a nonzero status if the UnmapNotify event is successfully sent; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

XWithdrawWindow can generate a BadWindow error.

To request that a top-level window be reconfigured, use XReconfigureWMWindow. __ │

Status XReconfigureWMWindow(display, w, screen_number, value_mask, values)
Display *display;
Window w;
int screen_number;
unsigned int value_mask;
XWindowChanges *values;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

screen_number
Specifies the appropriate screen number on the
host server.

value_maskSpecifies which values are to be set using infor-
mation in the values structure. This mask is the
bitwise inclusive OR of the valid configure window
values bits.

values

Specifies the XWindowChanges structure. │__

The XReconfigureWMWindow function issues a ConfigureWindow request on the specified top-level window. If the stacking mode is changed and the request fails with a BadMatch error, the error is trapped by Xlib and a synthetic ConfigureRequestEvent containing the same configuration parameters is sent to the root of the specified window. Window managers may elect to receive this event and treat it as a request to reconfigure the indicated window. It returns a nonzero status if the request or event is successfully sent; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

XReconfigureWMWindow can generate BadValue and BadWindow errors.

14.1.2. Converting String Lists

Many of the text properties allow a variety of types and formats. Because the data stored in these properties are not simple null-terminated strings, an XTextProperty structure is used to describe the encoding, type, and length of the text as well as its value. The XTextProperty structure contains: __ │

typedef struct {

unsigned char *value;/* property data */

Atom encoding;

/* type of property */

int format;

/* 8, 16, or 32 */

unsigned long nitems;/* number of items in value */

} XTextProperty; │__

Xlib provides functions to convert localized text to or from encodings that support the inter-client communication conventions for text. In addition, functions are provided for converting between lists of pointers to character strings and text properties in the STRING encoding.

The functions for localized text return a signed integer error status that encodes Success as zero, specific error conditions as negative numbers, and partial conversion as a count of unconvertible characters. __ │

#de-
fine
XNoMemory

−1

#de-
fine
XLocaleNotSupported

−2

#de-
fine
XConverterNotFound

−3

typedef enum {

XStringStyle,

/* STRING */

XCompoundTextStyle,

/* COMPOUND_TEXT */

XTextStyle,

/* text in owner’s encoding (current locale) */

XStdICCTextStyle

/* STRING, else COMPOUND_TEXT */

} XICCEncodingStyle; │__

To convert a list of text strings to an XTextProperty structure, use XmbTextListToTextProperty or XwcTextListToTextProperty. __ │

int XmbTextListToTextProperty(display, list, count, style, text_prop_return)
Display *display;
char **list;
int count;
XICCEncodingStyle style;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;

int XwcTextListToTextProperty(display, list, count, style, text_prop_return)
Display *display;
wchar_t **list;
int count;
XICCEncodingStyle style;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

list

Specifies a list of null-terminated character

strings.

count

Specifies the number of strings specified.

style

Specifies the manner in which the property is en-

coded.

text_prop_return
Returns the XTextProperty structure. │__

The XmbTextListToTextProperty and XwcTextListToTextProperty functions set the specified XTextProperty value to a set of null-separated elements representing the concatenation of the specified list of null-terminated text strings. A final terminating null is stored at the end of the value field of text_prop_return but is not included in the nitems member.

The functions set the encoding field of text_prop_return to an Atom for the specified display naming the encoding determined by the specified style and convert the specified text list to this encoding for storage in the text_prop_return value field. If the style XStringStyle or XCompoundTextStyle is specified, this encoding is ‘‘STRING’’ or ‘‘COMPOUND_TEXT’’, respectively. If the style XTextStyle is specified, this encoding is the encoding of the current locale. If the style XStdICCTextStyle is specified, this encoding is ‘‘STRING’’ if the text is fully convertible to STRING, else ‘‘COMPOUND_TEXT’’.

If insufficient memory is available for the new value string, the functions return XNoMemory. If the current locale is not supported, the functions return XLocaleNotSupported. In both of these error cases, the functions do not set text_prop_return.

To determine if the functions are guaranteed not to return XLocaleNotSupported, use XSupportsLocale.

If the supplied text is not fully convertible to the specified encoding, the functions return the number of unconvertible characters. Each unconvertible character is converted to an implementation-defined and encoding-specific default string. Otherwise, the functions return Success. Note that full convertibility to all styles except XStringStyle is guaranteed.

To free the storage for the value field, use XFree.

To obtain a list of text strings from an XTextProperty structure, use XmbTextPropertyToTextList or XwcTextPropertyToTextList. __ │

int XmbTextPropertyToTextList(display, text_prop, list_return, count_return)
Display *display;
XTextProperty *text_prop;
char ***list_return;
int *count_return;

int XwcTextPropertyToTextList(display, text_prop, list_return, count_return)
Display *display;
XTextProperty *text_prop;
wchar_t ***list_return;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

text_prop

Specifies the XTextProperty structure to be used.

list_returnReturns a list of null-terminated character
strings.

count_return
Returns the number of strings. │__

The XmbTextPropertyToTextList and XwcTextPropertyToTextList functions return a list of text strings in the current locale representing the null-separated elements of the specified XTextProperty structure. The data in text_prop must be format 8.

Multiple elements of the property (for example, the strings in a disjoint text selection) are separated by a null byte. The contents of the property are not required to be null-terminated; any terminating null should not be included in text_prop.nitems.

If insufficient memory is available for the list and its elements, XmbTextPropertyToTextList and XwcTextPropertyToTextList return XNoMemory. If the current locale is not supported, the functions return XLocaleNotSupported. Otherwise, if the encoding field of text_prop is not convertible to the encoding of the current locale, the functions return XConverterNotFound. For supported locales, existence of a converter from COMPOUND_TEXT, STRING or the encoding of the current locale is guaranteed if XSupportsLocale returns True for the current locale (but the actual text may contain unconvertible characters). Conversion of other encodings is implementation-dependent. In all of these error cases, the functions do not set any return values.

Otherwise, XmbTextPropertyToTextList and XwcTextPropertyToTextList return the list of null-terminated text strings to list_return and the number of text strings to count_return.

If the value field of text_prop is not fully convertible to the encoding of the current locale, the functions return the number of unconvertible characters. Each unconvertible character is converted to a string in the current locale that is specific to the current locale. To obtain the value of this string, use XDefaultString. Otherwise, XmbTextPropertyToTextList and XwcTextPropertyToTextList return Success.

To free the storage for the list and its contents returned by XmbTextPropertyToTextList, use XFreeStringList. To free the storage for the list and its contents returned by XwcTextPropertyToTextList, use XwcFreeStringList.

To free the in-memory data associated with the specified wide character string list, use XwcFreeStringList. __ │

void XwcFreeStringList(list)
wchar_t **list;

list

Specifies the list of strings to be freed. │__

The XwcFreeStringList function frees memory allocated by XwcTextPropertyToTextList.

To obtain the default string for text conversion in the current locale, use XDefaultString. __ │

char *XDefaultString() │__

The XDefaultString function returns the default string used by Xlib for text conversion (for example, in XmbTextPropertyToTextList). The default string is the string in the current locale that is output when an unconvertible character is found during text conversion. If the string returned by XDefaultString is the empty string (""), no character is output in the converted text. XDefaultString does not return NULL.

The string returned by XDefaultString is independent of the default string for text drawing; see XCreateFontSet to obtain the default string for an XFontSet.

The behavior when an invalid codepoint is supplied to any Xlib function is undefined.

The returned string is null-terminated. It is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. It may be freed after the current locale is changed. Until freed, it will not be modified by Xlib.

To set the specified list of strings in the STRING encoding to a XTextProperty structure, use XStringListToTextProperty. __ │

Status XStringListToTextProperty(list, count, text_prop_return)
char **list;
int count;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;

list

Specifies a list of null-terminated character

strings.

count

Specifies the number of strings.

text_prop_return
Returns the XTextProperty structure. │__

The XStringListToTextProperty function sets the specified XTextProperty to be of type STRING (format 8) with a value representing the concatenation of the specified list of null-separated character strings. An extra null byte (which is not included in the nitems member) is stored at the end of the value field of text_prop_return. The strings are assumed (without verification) to be in the STRING encoding. If insufficient memory is available for the new value string, XStringListToTextProperty does not set any fields in the XTextProperty structure and returns a zero status. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero status. To free the storage for the value field, use XFree.

To obtain a list of strings from a specified XTextProperty structure in the STRING encoding, use XTextPropertyToStringList. __ │

Status XTextPropertyToStringList(text_prop, list_return, count_return)
XTextProperty *text_prop;
char ***list_return;
int *count_return;

text_prop

Specifies the XTextProperty structure to be used.

list_returnReturns a list of null-terminated character
strings.

count_return
Returns the number of strings. │__

The XTextPropertyToStringList function returns a list of strings representing the null-separated elements of the specified XTextProperty structure. The data in text_prop must be of type STRING and format 8. Multiple elements of the property (for example, the strings in a disjoint text selection) are separated by NULL (encoding 0). The contents of the property are not null-terminated. If insufficient memory is available for the list and its elements, XTextPropertyToStringList sets no return values and returns a zero status. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero status. To free the storage for the list and its contents, use XFreeStringList.

To free the in-memory data associated with the specified string list, use XFreeStringList. __ │

void XFreeStringList(list)
char **list;

list

Specifies the list of strings to be freed. │__

The XFreeStringList function releases memory allocated by XmbTextPropertyToTextList and XTextPropertyToStringList and the missing charset list allocated by XCreateFontSet.

14.1.3. Setting and Reading Text Properties

Xlib provides two functions that you can use to set and read the text properties for a given window. You can use these functions to set and read those properties of type TEXT (WM_NAME, WM_ICON_NAME, WM_COMMAND, and WM_CLIENT_MACHINE). In addition, Xlib provides separate convenience functions that you can use to set each of these properties. For further information about these convenience functions, see sections 14.1.4, 14.1.5, 14.2.1, and 14.2.2, respectively.

To set one of a window’s text properties, use XSetTextProperty. __ │

void XSetTextProperty(display, w, text_prop, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop

Specifies the XTextProperty structure to be used.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XSetTextProperty function replaces the existing specified property for the named window with the data, type, format, and number of items determined by the value field, the encoding field, the format field, and the nitems field, respectively, of the specified XTextProperty structure. If the property does not already exist, XSetTextProperty sets it for the specified window.

XSetTextProperty can generate BadAlloc, BadAtom, BadValue, and BadWindow errors.

To read one of a window’s text properties, use XGetTextProperty. __ │

Status XGetTextProperty(display, w, text_prop_return, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop_return
Returns the XTextProperty structure.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XGetTextProperty function reads the specified property from the window and stores the data in the returned XTextProperty structure. It stores the data in the value field, the type of the data in the encoding field, the format of the data in the format field, and the number of items of data in the nitems field. An extra byte containing null (which is not included in the nitems member) is stored at the end of the value field of text_prop_return. The particular interpretation of the property’s encoding and data as text is left to the calling application. If the specified property does not exist on the window, XGetTextProperty sets the value field to NULL, the encoding field to None, the format field to zero, and the nitems field to zero.

If it was able to read and store the data in the XTextProperty structure, XGetTextProperty returns a nonzero status; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

XGetTextProperty can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

14.1.4. Setting and Reading the WM_NAME Property

Xlib provides convenience functions that you can use to set and read the WM_NAME property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_NAME property with the supplied convenience function, use XSetWMName. __ │

void XSetWMName(display, w, text_prop)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop

Specifies the XTextProperty structure to be used. │__

The XSetWMName convenience function calls XSetTextProperty to set the WM_NAME property.

To read a window’s WM_NAME property with the supplied convenience function, use XGetWMName. __ │

Status XGetWMName(display, w, text_prop_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop_return
Returns the XTextProperty structure. │__

The XGetWMName convenience function calls XGetTextProperty to obtain the WM_NAME property. It returns a nonzero status on success; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

The following two functions have been superseded by XSetWMName and XGetWMName, respectively. You can use these additional convenience functions for window names that are encoded as STRING properties.

To assign a name to a window, use XStoreName. __ │

XStoreName(display, w, window_name)
Display *display;
Window w;
char *window_name;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

window_nameSpecifies the window name, which should be a
null-terminated string. │__

The XStoreName function assigns the name passed to window_name to the specified window. A window manager can display the window name in some prominent place, such as the title bar, to allow users to identify windows easily. Some window managers may display a window’s name in the window’s icon, although they are encouraged to use the window’s icon name if one is provided by the application. If the string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

XStoreName can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To get the name of a window, use XFetchName. __ │

Status XFetchName(display, w, window_name_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
char **window_name_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

window_name_return
Returns the window name, which is a null-terminat-
ed string. │__

The XFetchName function returns the name of the specified window. If it succeeds, it returns a nonzero status; otherwise, no name has been set for the window, and it returns zero. If the WM_NAME property has not been set for this window, XFetchName sets window_name_return to NULL. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned string is in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. When finished with it, a client must free the window name string using XFree.

XFetchName can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.5. Setting and Reading the WM_ICON_NAME Property

Xlib provides convenience functions that you can use to set and read the WM_ICON_NAME property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_ICON_NAME property, use XSetWMIconName. __ │

void XSetWMIconName(display, w, text_prop)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop

Specifies the XTextProperty structure to be used. │__

The XSetWMIconName convenience function calls XSetTextProperty to set the WM_ICON_NAME property.

To read a window’s WM_ICON_NAME property, use XGetWMIconName. __ │

Status XGetWMIconName(display, w, text_prop_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop_return
Returns the XTextProperty structure. │__

The XGetWMIconName convenience function calls XGetTextProperty to obtain the WM_ICON_NAME property. It returns a nonzero status on success; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

The next two functions have been superseded by XSetWMIconName and XGetWMIconName, respectively. You can use these additional convenience functions for window names that are encoded as STRING properties.

To set the name to be displayed in a window’s icon, use XSetIconName. __ │

XSetIconName(display, w, icon_name)
Display *display;
Window w;
char *icon_name;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

icon_name

Specifies the icon name, which should be a

null-terminated string. │__

If the string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. XSetIconName can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To get the name a window wants displayed in its icon, use XGetIconName. __ │

Status XGetIconName(display, w, icon_name_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
char **icon_name_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

icon_name_return
Returns the window’s icon name, which is a
null-terminated string. │__

The XGetIconName function returns the name to be displayed in the specified window’s icon. If it succeeds, it returns a nonzero status; otherwise, if no icon name has been set for the window, it returns zero. If you never assigned a name to the window, XGetIconName sets icon_name_return to NULL. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned string is in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. When finished with it, a client must free the icon name string using XFree.

XGetIconName can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.6. Setting and Reading the WM_HINTS Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_HINTS property for a given window. These functions use the flags and the XWMHints structure, as defined in the <X11/Xutil.h> header file.

To allocate an XWMHints structure, use XAllocWMHints. __ │

XWMHints *XAllocWMHints() │__

The XAllocWMHints function allocates and returns a pointer to an XWMHints structure. Note that all fields in the XWMHints structure are initially set to zero. If insufficient memory is available, XAllocWMHints returns NULL. To free the memory allocated to this structure, use XFree.

The XWMHints structure contains: __ │
/* Window manager hints mask bits */

#de-
fine
InputHint

(1L << 0)

#de-
fine
StateHint

(1L << 1)

#de-
fine
IconPixmapHint

(1L << 2)

#de-
fine
IconWindowHint

(1L << 3)

#de-
fine
IconPositionHint

(1L << 4)

#de-
fine
IconMaskHint

(1L << 5)

#de-
fine
WindowGroupHint

(1L << 6)

#de-
fine
UrgencyHint

(1L << 8)

#de-
fine
AllHints

(InputHint|State-
Hint|IconPixmapHint|
IconWindowHint|IconPosi-
tionHint|
IconMaskHint|Window-
GroupHint)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

long flags;

/* marks which fields in this structure are defined */

Bool input;

/* does this application rely on the window manager to

get keyboard input? */

int initial_state;

/* see below */

Pixmap icon_pixmap;

/* pixmap to be used as icon */

Window icon_window;

/* window to be used as icon */

int icon_x, icon_y;

/* initial position of icon */

Pixmap icon_mask;

/* pixmap to be used as mask for icon_pixmap */

XID window_group;

/* id of related window group */

/* this structure may be extended in the future */

} XWMHints; │__

The input member is used to communicate to the window manager the input focus model used by the application. Applications that expect input but never explicitly set focus to any of their subwindows (that is, use the push model of focus management), such as X Version 10 style applications that use real-estate driven focus, should set this member to True. Similarly, applications that set input focus to their subwindows only when it is given to their top-level window by a window manager should also set this member to True. Applications that manage their own input focus by explicitly setting focus to one of their subwindows whenever they want keyboard input (that is, use the pull model of focus management) should set this member to False. Applications that never expect any keyboard input also should set this member to False.

Pull model window managers should make it possible for push model applications to get input by setting input focus to the top-level windows of applications whose input member is True. Push model window managers should make sure that pull model applications do not break them by resetting input focus to PointerRoot when it is appropriate (for example, whenever an application whose input member is False sets input focus to one of its subwindows).

The definitions for the initial_state flag are:
#define
WithdrawnState

0
#define
NormalState

1
/* most applications start
this way */
#define
IconicState

3
/* application wants to
start as an icon */

The icon_mask specifies which pixels of the icon_pixmap should be used as the icon. This allows for nonrectangular icons. Both icon_pixmap and icon_mask must be bitmaps. The icon_window lets an application provide a window for use as an icon for window managers that support such use. The window_group lets you specify that this window belongs to a group of other windows. For example, if a single application manipulates multiple top-level windows, this allows you to provide enough information that a window manager can iconify all of the windows rather than just the one window.

The UrgencyHint flag, if set in the flags field, indicates that the client deems the window contents to be urgent, requiring the timely response of the user. The window manager will make some effort to draw the user’s attention to this window while this flag is set. The client must provide some means by which the user can cause the urgency flag to be cleared (either mitigating the condition that made the window urgent or merely shutting off the alarm) or the window to be withdrawn.

To set a window’s WM_HINTS property, use XSetWMHints. __ │

XSetWMHints(display, w, wmhints)
Display *display;
Window w;
XWMHints *wmhints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

wmhints

Specifies the XWMHints structure to be used. │__

The XSetWMHints function sets the window manager hints that include icon information and location, the initial state of the window, and whether the application relies on the window manager to get keyboard input.

XSetWMHints can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_HINTS property, use XGetWMHints. __ │

XWMHints *XGetWMHints(display, w)
Display *display;
Window w;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window. │__

The XGetWMHints function reads the window manager hints and returns NULL if no WM_HINTS property was set on the window or returns a pointer to an XWMHints structure if it succeeds. When finished with the data, free the space used for it by calling XFree.

XGetWMHints can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.7. Setting and Reading the WM_NORMAL_HINTS Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set or read the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property for a given window. The functions use the flags and the XSizeHints structure, as defined in the <X11/Xutil.h> header file.

The size of the XSizeHints structure may grow in future releases, as new components are added to support new ICCCM features. Passing statically allocated instances of this structure into Xlib may result in memory corruption when running against a future release of the library. As such, it is recommended that only dynamically allocated instances of the structure be used.

To allocate an XSizeHints structure, use XAllocSizeHints. __ │

XSizeHints *XAllocSizeHints() │__

The XAllocSizeHints function allocates and returns a pointer to an XSizeHints structure. Note that all fields in the XSizeHints structure are initially set to zero. If insufficient memory is available, XAllocSizeHints returns NULL. To free the memory allocated to this structure, use XFree.

The XSizeHints structure contains: __ │
/* Size hints mask bits */

#de-
fine
USPosition

(1L << 0)
/* user specified x, y */

#de-
fine
USSize

(1L << 1)
/* user specified width, height
*/
#de-
fine
PPosition

(1L << 2)
/* program specified position
*/
#de-
fine
PSize

(1L << 3)
/* program specified size */

#de-
fine
PMinSize

(1L << 4)
/* program specified minimum
size */
#de-
fine
PMaxSize

(1L << 5)
/* program specified maximum
size */
#de-
fine
PResizeInc

(1L << 6)
/* program specified resize in-
crements */
#de-
fine
PAspect

(1L << 7)
/* program specified min and
max aspect ratios */
#de-
fine
PBaseSize

(1L << 8)
#de-
fine
PWinGravity

(1L << 9)
#de-
fine
PAllHints

(PPosi-
tion|PSize|
PMinSize|PMax-
Size|
PRe-
sizeInc|PAspect)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

long flags;

/* marks which fields in this structure are defined */

int x, y;

/* Obsolete */

int width, height;

/* Obsolete */

int min_width, min_height;

int max_width, max_height;

int width_inc, height_inc;

struct {

int x;

/* numerator */

int y;

/* denominator */

} min_aspect, max_aspect;

int base_width, base_height;

int win_gravity;

/* this structure may be extended in the future */

} XSizeHints; │__

The x, y, width, and height members are now obsolete and are left solely for compatibility reasons. The min_width and min_height members specify the minimum window size that still allows the application to be useful. The max_width and max_height members specify the maximum window size. The width_inc and height_inc members define an arithmetic progression of sizes (minimum to maximum) into which the window prefers to be resized. The min_aspect and max_aspect members are expressed as ratios of x and y, and they allow an application to specify the range of aspect ratios it prefers. The base_width and base_height members define the desired size of the window. The window manager will interpret the position of the window and its border width to position the point of the outer rectangle of the overall window specified by the win_gravity member. The outer rectangle of the window includes any borders or decorations supplied by the window manager. In other words, if the window manager decides to place the window where the client asked, the position on the parent window’s border named by the win_gravity will be placed where the client window would have been placed in the absence of a window manager.

Note that use of the PAllHints macro is highly discouraged.

To set a window’s WM_NORMAL_HINTS property, use XSetWMNormalHints. __ │

void XSetWMNormalHints(display, w, hints)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints

Specifies the size hints for the window in its

normal state. │__

The XSetWMNormalHints function replaces the size hints for the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property on the specified window. If the property does not already exist, XSetWMNormalHints sets the size hints for the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property on the specified window. The property is stored with a type of WM_SIZE_HINTS and a format of 32.

XSetWMNormalHints can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_NORMAL_HINTS property, use XGetWMNormalHints. __ │

Status XGetWMNormalHints(display, w, hints_return, supplied_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints_return;
long *supplied_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints_return
Returns the size hints for the window in its
normal state.

supplied_return
Returns the hints that were supplied by the user. │__

The XGetWMNormalHints function returns the size hints stored in the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property on the specified window. If the property is of type WM_SIZE_HINTS, is of format 32, and is long enough to contain either an old (pre-ICCCM) or new size hints structure, XGetWMNormalHints sets the various fields of the XSizeHints structure, sets the supplied_return argument to the list of fields that were supplied by the user (whether or not they contained defined values), and returns a nonzero status. Otherwise, it returns a zero status.

If XGetWMNormalHints returns successfully and a pre-ICCCM size hints property is read, the supplied_return argument will contain the following bits:

(USPosition|USSize|PPosition|PSize|PMinSize|
PMaxSize|PResizeInc|PAspect)

If the property is large enough to contain the base size and window gravity fields as well, the supplied_return argument will also contain the following bits:

PBaseSize|PWinGravity

XGetWMNormalHints can generate a BadWindow error.

To set a window’s WM_SIZE_HINTS property, use XSetWMSizeHints. __ │

void XSetWMSizeHints(display, w, hints, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints

Specifies the XSizeHints structure to be used.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XSetWMSizeHints function replaces the size hints for the specified property on the named window. If the specified property does not already exist, XSetWMSizeHints sets the size hints for the specified property on the named window. The property is stored with a type of WM_SIZE_HINTS and a format of 32. To set a window’s normal size hints, you can use the XSetWMNormalHints function.

XSetWMSizeHints can generate BadAlloc, BadAtom, and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_SIZE_HINTS property, use XGetWMSizeHints. __ │

Status XGetWMSizeHints(display, w, hints_return, supplied_return, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints_return;
long *supplied_return;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints_return
Returns the XSizeHints structure.

supplied_return
Returns the hints that were supplied by the user.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XGetWMSizeHints function returns the size hints stored in the specified property on the named window. If the property is of type WM_SIZE_HINTS, is of format 32, and is long enough to contain either an old (pre-ICCCM) or new size hints structure, XGetWMSizeHints sets the various fields of the XSizeHints structure, sets the supplied_return argument to the list of fields that were supplied by the user (whether or not they contained defined values), and returns a nonzero status. Otherwise, it returns a zero status. To get a window’s normal size hints, you can use the XGetWMNormalHints function.

If XGetWMSizeHints returns successfully and a pre-ICCCM size hints property is read, the supplied_return argument will contain the following bits:

(USPosition|USSize|PPosition|PSize|PMinSize|
PMaxSize|PResizeInc|PAspect)

If the property is large enough to contain the base size and window gravity fields as well, the supplied_return argument will also contain the following bits:

PBaseSize|PWinGravity

XGetWMSizeHints can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

14.1.8. Setting and Reading the WM_CLASS Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and get the WM_CLASS property for a given window. These functions use the XClassHint structure, which is defined in the <X11/Xutil.h> header file.

To allocate an XClassHint structure, use XAllocClassHint. __ │

XClassHint *XAllocClassHint() │__

The XAllocClassHint function allocates and returns a pointer to an XClassHint structure. Note that the pointer fields in the XClassHint structure are initially set to NULL. If insufficient memory is available, XAllocClassHint returns NULL. To free the memory allocated to this structure, use XFree.

The XClassHint contains: __ │

typedef struct {

char *res_name;

char *res_class;

} XClassHint; │__

The res_name member contains the application name, and the res_class member contains the application class. Note that the name set in this property may differ from the name set as WM_NAME. That is, WM_NAME specifies what should be displayed in the title bar and, therefore, can contain temporal information (for example, the name of a file currently in an editor’s buffer). On the other hand, the name specified as part of WM_CLASS is the formal name of the application that should be used when retrieving the application’s resources from the resource database.

To set a window’s WM_CLASS property, use XSetClassHint. __ │

XSetClassHint(display, w, class_hints)
Display *display;
Window w;
XClassHint *class_hints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

class_hintsSpecifies the XClassHint structure that is to be
used. │__

The XSetClassHint function sets the class hint for the specified window. If the strings are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

XSetClassHint can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_CLASS property, use XGetClassHint. __ │

Status XGetClassHint(display, w, class_hints_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XClassHint *class_hints_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

class_hints_return
Returns the XClassHint structure. │__

The XGetClassHint function returns the class hint of the specified window to the members of the supplied structure. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned strings are in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. It returns a nonzero status on success; otherwise, it returns a zero status. To free res_name and res_class when finished with the strings, use XFree on each individually.

XGetClassHint can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.9. Setting and Reading the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property, use XSetTransientForHint. __ │

XSetTransientForHint(display, w, prop_window)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window prop_window;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

prop_windowSpecifies the window that the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR
property is to be set to. │__

The XSetTransientForHint function sets the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property of the specified window to the specified prop_window.

XSetTransientForHint can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property, use XGetTransientForHint. __ │

Status XGetTransientForHint(display, w, prop_window_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window *prop_window_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

prop_window_return
Returns the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property of the spec-
ified window. │__

The XGetTransientForHint function returns the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR property for the specified window. It returns a nonzero status on success; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

XGetTransientForHint can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.10. Setting and Reading the WM_PROTOCOLS Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_PROTOCOLS property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_PROTOCOLS property, use XSetWMProtocols. __ │

Status XSetWMProtocols(display, w, protocols, count)
Display *display;
Window w;
Atom *protocols;
int count;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

protocols

Specifies the list of protocols.

count

Specifies the number of protocols in the list. │__

The XSetWMProtocols function replaces the WM_PROTOCOLS property on the specified window with the list of atoms specified by the protocols argument. If the property does not already exist, XSetWMProtocols sets the WM_PROTOCOLS property on the specified window to the list of atoms specified by the protocols argument. The property is stored with a type of ATOM and a format of 32. If it cannot intern the WM_PROTOCOLS atom, XSetWMProtocols returns a zero status. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero status.

XSetWMProtocols can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_PROTOCOLS property, use XGetWMProtocols. __ │

Status XGetWMProtocols(display, w, protocols_return, count_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
Atom **protocols_return;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

protocols_return
Returns the list of protocols.

count_return
Returns the number of protocols in the list. │__

The XGetWMProtocols function returns the list of atoms stored in the WM_PROTOCOLS property on the specified window. These atoms describe window manager protocols in which the owner of this window is willing to participate. If the property exists, is of type ATOM, is of format 32, and the atom WM_PROTOCOLS can be interned, XGetWMProtocols sets the protocols_return argument to a list of atoms, sets the count_return argument to the number of elements in the list, and returns a nonzero status. Otherwise, it sets neither of the return arguments and returns a zero status. To release the list of atoms, use XFree.

XGetWMProtocols can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.11. Setting and Reading the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property, use XSetWMColormapWindows. __ │

Status XSetWMColormapWindows(display, w, colormap_windows, count)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window *colormap_windows;
int count;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

colormap_windows
Specifies the list of windows.

count

Specifies the number of windows in the list. │__

The XSetWMColormapWindows function replaces the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property on the specified window with the list of windows specified by the colormap_windows argument. If the property does not already exist, XSetWMColormapWindows sets the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property on the specified window to the list of windows specified by the colormap_windows argument. The property is stored with a type of WINDOW and a format of 32. If it cannot intern the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS atom, XSetWMColormapWindows returns a zero status. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero status.

XSetWMColormapWindows can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property, use XGetWMColormapWindows. __ │

Status XGetWMColormapWindows(display, w, colormap_windows_return, count_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
Window **colormap_windows_return;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

colormap_windows_return
Returns the list of windows.

count_return
Returns the number of windows in the list. │__

The XGetWMColormapWindows function returns the list of window identifiers stored in the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property on the specified window. These identifiers indicate the colormaps that the window manager may need to install for this window. If the property exists, is of type WINDOW, is of format 32, and the atom WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS can be interned, XGetWMColormapWindows sets the windows_return argument to a list of window identifiers, sets the count_return argument to the number of elements in the list, and returns a nonzero status. Otherwise, it sets neither of the return arguments and returns a zero status. To release the list of window identifiers, use XFree.

XGetWMColormapWindows can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.12. Setting and Reading the WM_ICON_SIZE Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_ICON_SIZE property for a given window. These functions use the XIconSize structure, which is defined in the <X11/Xutil.h> header file.

To allocate an XIconSize structure, use XAllocIconSize. __ │

XIconSize *XAllocIconSize() │__

The XAllocIconSize function allocates and returns a pointer to an XIconSize structure. Note that all fields in the XIconSize structure are initially set to zero. If insufficient memory is available, XAllocIconSize returns NULL. To free the memory allocated to this structure, use XFree.

The XIconSize structure contains: __ │

typedef struct {

int min_width, min_height;

int max_width, max_height;

int width_inc, height_inc;

} XIconSize; │__

The width_inc and height_inc members define an arithmetic progression of sizes (minimum to maximum) that represent the supported icon sizes.

To set a window’s WM_ICON_SIZE property, use XSetIconSizes. __ │

XSetIconSizes(display, w, size_list, count)
Display *display;
Window w;
XIconSize *size_list;
int count;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

size_list

Specifies the size list.

count

Specifies the number of items in the size list. │__

The XSetIconSizes function is used only by window managers to set the supported icon sizes.

XSetIconSizes can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_ICON_SIZE property, use XGetIconSizes. __ │

Status XGetIconSizes(display, w, size_list_return, count_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XIconSize **size_list_return;
int *count_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

size_list_return
Returns the size list.

count_return
Returns the number of items in the size list. │__

The XGetIconSizes function returns zero if a window manager has not set icon sizes; otherwise, it returns nonzero. XGetIconSizes should be called by an application that wants to find out what icon sizes would be most appreciated by the window manager under which the application is running. The application should then use XSetWMHints to supply the window manager with an icon pixmap or window in one of the supported sizes. To free the data allocated in size_list_return, use XFree.

XGetIconSizes can generate a BadWindow error.

14.1.13. Using Window Manager Convenience Functions

The XmbSetWMProperties function stores the standard set of window manager properties, with text properties in standard encodings for internationalized text communication. The standard window manager properties for a given window are WM_NAME, WM_ICON_NAME, WM_HINTS, WM_NORMAL_HINTS, WM_CLASS, WM_COMMAND, WM_CLIENT_MACHINE, and WM_LOCALE_NAME. __ │

void XmbSetWMProperties(display, w, window_name, icon_name, argv, argc,
normal_hints
, wm_hints, class_hints)
Display *display;
Window w;
char *window_name;
char *icon_name;
char *argv[];
int argc;
XSizeHints *normal_hints;
XWMHints *wm_hints;
XClassHint *class_hints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

window_nameSpecifies the window name, which should be a
null-terminated string.

icon_name

Specifies the icon name, which should be a

null-terminated string.

argv

Specifies the application’s argument list.

argc

Specifies the number of arguments.

hints

Specifies the size hints for the window in its

normal state.

wm_hints

Specifies the XWMHints structure to be used.

class_hintsSpecifies the XClassHint structure to be used. │__

The XmbSetWMProperties convenience function provides a simple programming interface for setting those essential window properties that are used for communicating with other clients (particularly window and session managers).

If the window_name argument is non-NULL, XmbSetWMProperties sets the WM_NAME property. If the icon_name argument is non-NULL, XmbSetWMProperties sets the WM_ICON_NAME property. The window_name and icon_name arguments are null-terminated strings in the encoding of the current locale. If the arguments can be fully converted to the STRING encoding, the properties are created with type ‘‘STRING’’; otherwise, the arguments are converted to Compound Text, and the properties are created with type ‘‘COMPOUND_TEXT’’.

If the normal_hints argument is non-NULL, XmbSetWMProperties calls XSetWMNormalHints, which sets the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property (see section 14.1.7). If the wm_hints argument is non-NULL, XmbSetWMProperties calls XSetWMHints, which sets the WM_HINTS property (see section 14.1.6).

If the argv argument is non-NULL, XmbSetWMProperties sets the WM_COMMAND property from argv and argc. An argc of zero indicates a zero-length command.

The hostname of the machine is stored using XSetWMClientMachine (see section 14.2.2).

If the class_hints argument is non-NULL, XmbSetWMProperties sets the WM_CLASS property. If the res_name member in the XClassHint structure is set to the NULL pointer and the RESOURCE_NAME environment variable is set, the value of the environment variable is substituted for res_name. If the res_name member is NULL, the environment variable is not set, and argv and argv[0] are set, then the value of argv[0], stripped of any directory prefixes, is substituted for res_name.

It is assumed that the supplied class_hints.res_name and argv, the RESOURCE_NAME environment variable, and the hostname of the machine are in the encoding of the locale announced for the LC_CTYPE category (on POSIX-compliant systems, the LC_CTYPE, else LANG environment variable). The corresponding WM_CLASS, WM_COMMAND, and WM_CLIENT_MACHINE properties are typed according to the local host locale announcer. No encoding conversion is performed prior to storage in the properties.

For clients that need to process the property text in a locale, XmbSetWMProperties sets the WM_LOCALE_NAME property to be the name of the current locale. The name is assumed to be in the Host Portable Character Encoding and is converted to STRING for storage in the property.

XmbSetWMProperties can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To set a window’s standard window manager properties with strings in client-specified encodings, use XSetWMProperties. The standard window manager properties for a given window are WM_NAME, WM_ICON_NAME, WM_HINTS, WM_NORMAL_HINTS, WM_CLASS, WM_COMMAND, and WM_CLIENT_MACHINE. __ │

void XSetWMProperties(display, w, window_name, icon_name, argv, argc, normal_hints, wm_hints, class_hints)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *window_name;
XTextProperty *icon_name;
char **argv;
int argc;
XSizeHints *normal_hints;
XWMHints *wm_hints;
XClassHint *class_hints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

window_nameSpecifies the window name, which should be a
null-terminated string.

icon_name

Specifies the icon name, which should be a

null-terminated string.

argv

Specifies the application’s argument list.

argc

Specifies the number of arguments.

normal_hints
Specifies the size hints for the window in its
normal state.

wm_hints

Specifies the XWMHints structure to be used.

class_hintsSpecifies the XClassHint structure to be used. │__

The XSetWMProperties convenience function provides a single programming interface for setting those essential window properties that are used for communicating with other clients (particularly window and session managers).

If the window_name argument is non-NULL, XSetWMProperties calls XSetWMName, which, in turn, sets the WM_NAME property (see section 14.1.4). If the icon_name argument is non-NULL, XSetWMProperties calls XSetWMIconName, which sets the WM_ICON_NAME property (see section 14.1.5). If the argv argument is non-NULL, XSetWMProperties calls XSetCommand, which sets the WM_COMMAND property (see section 14.2.1). Note that an argc of zero is allowed to indicate a zero-length command. Note also that the hostname of this machine is stored using XSetWMClientMachine (see section 14.2.2).

If the normal_hints argument is non-NULL, XSetWMProperties calls XSetWMNormalHints, which sets the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property (see section 14.1.7). If the wm_hints argument is non-NULL, XSetWMProperties calls XSetWMHints, which sets the WM_HINTS property (see section 14.1.6).

If the class_hints argument is non-NULL, XSetWMProperties calls XSetClassHint, which sets the WM_CLASS property (see section 14.1.8). If the res_name member in the XClassHint structure is set to the NULL pointer and the RESOURCE_NAME environment variable is set, then the value of the environment variable is substituted for res_name. If the res_name member is NULL, the environment variable is not set, and argv and argv[0] are set, then the value of argv[0], stripped of any directory prefixes, is substituted for res_name.

XSetWMProperties can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

14.2. Client to Session Manager Communication

This section discusses how to:

Set and read the WM_COMMAND property

Set and read the WM_CLIENT_MACHINE property

14.2.1. Setting and Reading the WM_COMMAND Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_COMMAND property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_COMMAND property, use XSetCommand. __ │

XSetCommand(display, w, argv, argc)
Display *display;
Window w;
char **argv;
int argc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

argv

Specifies the application’s argument list.

argc

Specifies the number of arguments. │__

The XSetCommand function sets the command and arguments used to invoke the application. (Typically, argv is the argv array of your main program.) If the strings are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

XSetCommand can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read a window’s WM_COMMAND property, use XGetCommand. __ │

Status XGetCommand(display, w, argv_return, argc_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
char ***argv_return;
int *argc_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

argv_returnReturns the application’s argument list.

argc_returnReturns the number of arguments returned. │__

The XGetCommand function reads the WM_COMMAND property from the specified window and returns a string list. If the WM_COMMAND property exists, it is of type STRING and format 8. If sufficient memory can be allocated to contain the string list, XGetCommand fills in the argv_return and argc_return arguments and returns a nonzero status. Otherwise, it returns a zero status. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned strings are in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. To free the memory allocated to the string list, use XFreeStringList.

14.2.2. Setting and Reading the WM_CLIENT_MACHINE Property

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and read the WM_CLIENT_MACHINE property for a given window.

To set a window’s WM_CLIENT_MACHINE property, use XSetWMClientMachine. __ │

void XSetWMClientMachine(display, w, text_prop)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop

Specifies the XTextProperty structure to be used. │__

The XSetWMClientMachine convenience function calls XSetTextProperty to set the WM_CLIENT_MACHINE property.

To read a window’s WM_CLIENT_MACHINE property, use XGetWMClientMachine. __ │

Status XGetWMClientMachine(display, w, text_prop_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XTextProperty *text_prop_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

text_prop_return
Returns the XTextProperty structure. │__

The XGetWMClientMachine convenience function performs an XGetTextProperty on the WM_CLIENT_MACHINE property. It returns a nonzero status on success; otherwise, it returns a zero status.

14.3. Standard Colormaps

Applications with color palettes, smooth-shaded drawings, or digitized images demand large numbers of colors. In addition, these applications often require an efficient mapping from color triples to pixel values that display the appropriate colors.

As an example, consider a three-dimensional display program that wants to draw a smoothly shaded sphere. At each pixel in the image of the sphere, the program computes the intensity and color of light reflected back to the viewer. The result of each computation is a triple of red, green, and blue (RGB) coefficients in the range 0.0 to 1.0. To draw the sphere, the program needs a colormap that provides a large range of uniformly distributed colors. The colormap should be arranged so that the program can convert its RGB triples into pixel values very quickly, because drawing the entire sphere requires many such conversions.

On many current workstations, the display is limited to 256 or fewer colors. Applications must allocate colors carefully, not only to make sure they cover the entire range they need but also to make use of as many of the available colors as possible. On a typical X display, many applications are active at once. Most workstations have only one hardware look-up table for colors, so only one application colormap can be installed at a given time. The application using the installed colormap is displayed correctly, and the other applications go technicolor and are displayed with false colors.

As another example, consider a user who is running an image processing program to display earth-resources data. The image processing program needs a colormap set up with 8 reds, 8 greens, and 4 blues, for a total of 256 colors. Because some colors are already in use in the default colormap, the image processing program allocates and installs a new colormap.

The user decides to alter some of the colors in the image by invoking a color palette program to mix and choose colors. The color palette program also needs a colormap with eight reds, eight greens, and four blues, so just like the image processing program, it must allocate and install a new colormap.

Because only one colormap can be installed at a time, the color palette may be displayed incorrectly whenever the image processing program is active. Conversely, whenever the palette program is active, the image may be displayed incorrectly. The user can never match or compare colors in the palette and image. Contention for colormap resources can be reduced if applications with similar color needs share colormaps.

The image processing program and the color palette program could share the same colormap if there existed a convention that described how the colormap was set up. Whenever either program was active, both would be displayed correctly.

The standard colormap properties define a set of commonly used colormaps. Applications that share these colormaps and conventions display true colors more often and provide a better interface to the user.

Standard colormaps allow applications to share commonly used color resources. This allows many applications to be displayed in true colors simultaneously, even when each application needs an entirely filled colormap.

Several standard colormaps are described in this section. Usually, a window manager creates these colormaps. Applications should use the standard colormaps if they already exist.

To allocate an XStandardColormap structure, use XAllocStandardColormap. __ │

XStandardColormap *XAllocStandardColormap() │__

The XAllocStandardColormap function allocates and returns a pointer to an XStandardColormap structure. Note that all fields in the XStandardColormap structure are initially set to zero. If insufficient memory is available, XAllocStandardColormap returns NULL. To free the memory allocated to this structure, use XFree.

The XStandardColormap structure contains: __ │
/* Hints */

#de-
fine
ReleaseByFreeingCol-
ormap

( (XID)
1L)

/* Values */

typedef struct {

Colormap colormap;

unsigned long red_max;

unsigned long red_mult;

unsigned long green_max;

unsigned long green_mult;

unsigned long blue_max;

unsigned long blue_mult;

unsigned long base_pixel;

VisualID visualid;

XID killid;

} XStandardColormap; │__

The colormap member is the colormap created by the XCreateColormap function. The red_max, green_max, and blue_max members give the maximum red, green, and blue values, respectively. Each color coefficient ranges from zero to its max, inclusive. For example, a common colormap allocation is 3/3/2 (3 planes for red, 3 planes for green, and 2 planes for blue). This colormap would have red_max = 7, green_max = 7, and blue_max = 3. An alternate allocation that uses only 216 colors is red_max = 5, green_max = 5, and blue_max = 5.

The red_mult, green_mult, and blue_mult members give the scale factors used to compose a full pixel value. (See the discussion of the base_pixel members for further information.) For a 3/3/2 allocation, red_mult might be 32, green_mult might be 4, and blue_mult might be 1. For a 6-colors-each allocation, red_mult might be 36, green_mult might be 6, and blue_mult might be 1.

The base_pixel member gives the base pixel value used to compose a full pixel value. Usually, the base_pixel is obtained from a call to the XAllocColorPlanes function. Given integer red, green, and blue coefficients in their appropriate ranges, one then can compute a corresponding pixel value by using the following expression:

(r * red_mult + g * green_mult + b * blue_mult + base_pixel) & 0xFFFFFFFF

For GrayScale colormaps, only the colormap, red_max, red_mult, and base_pixel members are defined. The other members are ignored. To compute a GrayScale pixel value, use the following expression:

(gray * red_mult + base_pixel) & 0xFFFFFFFF

Negative multipliers can be represented by converting the 2’s complement representation of the multiplier into an unsigned long and storing the result in the appropriate _mult field. The step of masking by 0xFFFFFFFF effectively converts the resulting positive multiplier into a negative one. The masking step will take place automatically on many machine architectures, depending on the size of the integer type used to do the computation.

The visualid member gives the ID number of the visual from which the colormap was created. The killid member gives a resource ID that indicates whether the cells held by this standard colormap are to be released by freeing the colormap ID or by calling the XKillClient function on the indicated resource. (Note that this method is necessary for allocating out of an existing colormap.)

The properties containing the XStandardColormap information have the type RGB_COLOR_MAP.

The remainder of this section discusses standard colormap properties and atoms as well as how to manipulate standard colormaps.

14.3.1. Standard Colormap Properties and Atoms

Several standard colormaps are available. Each standard colormap is defined by a property, and each such property is identified by an atom. The following list names the atoms and describes the colormap associated with each one. The <X11/Xatom.h> header file contains the definitions for each of the following atoms, which are prefixed with XA_.

RGB_DEFAULT_MAP
This atom names a property. The value of the property is an array of XStandardColormap structures. Each entry in the array describes an RGB subset of the default color map for the Visual specified by visual_id.

Some applications only need a few RGB colors and may be able to allocate them from the system default colormap. This is the ideal situation because the fewer colormaps that are active in the system the more applications are displayed with correct colors at all times.

A typical allocation for the RGB_DEFAULT_MAP on 8-plane displays is 6 reds, 6 greens, and 6 blues. This gives 216 uniformly distributed colors (6 intensities of 36 different hues) and still leaves 40 elements of a 256-element colormap available for special-purpose colors for text, borders, and so on.

RGB_BEST_MAP
This atom names a property. The value of the property is an XStandardColormap.

The property defines the best RGB colormap available on the screen. (Of course, this is a subjective evaluation.) Many image processing and three-dimensional applications need to use all available colormap cells and to distribute as many perceptually distinct colors as possible over those cells. This implies that there may be more green values available than red, as well as more green or red than blue.

For an 8-plane PseudoColor visual, RGB_BEST_MAP is likely to be a 3/3/2 allocation. For a 24-plane DirectColor visual, RGB_BEST_MAP is normally an 8/8/8 allocation.

RGB_RED_MAP
RGB_GREEN_MAP
RGB_BLUE_MAP
These atoms name properties. The value of each property is an XStandardColormap.

The properties define all-red, all-green, and all-blue colormaps, respectively. These maps are used by applications that want to make color-separated images. For example, a user might generate a full-color image on an 8-plane display both by rendering an image three times (once with high color resolution in red, once with green, and once with blue) and by multiply exposing a single frame in a camera.

RGB_GRAY_MAP
This atom names a property. The value of the property is an XStandardColormap.

The property describes the best GrayScale colormap available on the screen. As previously mentioned, only the colormap, red_max, red_mult, and base_pixel members of the XStandardColormap structure are used for GrayScale colormaps.

14.3.2. Setting and Obtaining Standard Colormaps

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set and obtain an XStandardColormap structure.

To set an XStandardColormap structure, use XSetRGBColormaps. __ │

void XSetRGBColormaps(display, w, std_colormap, count, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XStandardColormap *std_colormap;
int count;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

std_colormap
Specifies the XStandardColormap structure to be
used.

count

Specifies the number of colormaps.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XSetRGBColormaps function replaces the RGB colormap definition in the specified property on the named window. If the property does not already exist, XSetRGBColormaps sets the RGB colormap definition in the specified property on the named window. The property is stored with a type of RGB_COLOR_MAP and a format of 32. Note that it is the caller’s responsibility to honor the ICCCM restriction that only RGB_DEFAULT_MAP contain more than one definition.

The XSetRGBColormaps function usually is only used by window or session managers. To create a standard colormap, follow this procedure:

1.

Open a new connection to the same server.

2.

Grab the server.

3.

See if the property is on the property list of the root window for the screen.

4.

If the desired property is not present:

Create a colormap (unless you are using the default colormap of the screen).

Determine the color characteristics of the visual.

Allocate cells in the colormap (or create it with AllocAll).

Call XStoreColors to store appropriate color values in the colormap.

Fill in the descriptive members in the XStandardColormap structure.

Attach the property to the root window.

Use XSetCloseDownMode to make the resource permanent.

5.

Ungrab the server.

XSetRGBColormaps can generate BadAlloc, BadAtom, and BadWindow errors.

To obtain the XStandardColormap structure associated with the specified property, use XGetRGBColormaps. __ │

Status XGetRGBColormaps(display, w, std_colormap_return, count_return, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XStandardColormap **std_colormap_return;
int *count_return;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

std_colormap_return
Returns the XStandardColormap structure.

count_return
Returns the number of colormaps.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XGetRGBColormaps function returns the RGB colormap definitions stored in the specified property on the named window. If the property exists, is of type RGB_COLOR_MAP, is of format 32, and is long enough to contain a colormap definition, XGetRGBColormaps allocates and fills in space for the returned colormaps and returns a nonzero status. If the visualid is not present, XGetRGBColormaps assumes the default visual for the screen on which the window is located; if the killid is not present, None is assumed, which indicates that the resources cannot be released. Otherwise, none of the fields are set, and XGetRGBColormaps returns a zero status. Note that it is the caller’s responsibility to honor the ICCCM restriction that only RGB_DEFAULT_MAP contain more than one definition.

XGetRGBColormaps can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

14

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 15

Resource Manager Functions

A program often needs a variety of options in the X environment (for example, fonts, colors, icons, and cursors). Specifying all of these options on the command line is awkward because users may want to customize many aspects of the program and need a convenient way to establish these customizations as the default settings. The resource manager is provided for this purpose. Resource specifications are usually stored in human-readable files and in server properties.

The resource manager is a database manager with a twist. In most database systems, you perform a query using an imprecise specification, and you get back a set of records. The resource manager, however, allows you to specify a large set of values with an imprecise specification, to query the database with a precise specification, and to get back only a single value. This should be used by applications that need to know what the user prefers for colors, fonts, and other resources. It is this use as a database for dealing with X resources that inspired the name ‘‘Resource Manager,’’ although the resource manager can be and is used in other ways.

For example, a user of your application may want to specify that all windows should have a blue background but that all mail-reading windows should have a red background. With well-engineered and coordinated applications, a user can define this information using only two lines of specifications.

As an example of how the resource manager works, consider a mail-reading application called xmh. Assume that it is designed so that it uses a complex window hierarchy all the way down to individual command buttons, which may be actual small subwindows in some toolkits. These are often called objects or widgets. In such toolkit systems, each user interface object can be composed of other objects and can be assigned a name and a class. Fully qualified names or classes can have arbitrary numbers of component names, but a fully qualified name always has the same number of component names as a fully qualified class. This generally reflects the structure of the application as composed of these objects, starting with the application itself.

For example, the xmh mail program has a name ‘‘xmh’’ and is one of a class of ‘‘Mail’’ programs. By convention, the first character of class components is capitalized, and the first letter of name components is in lowercase. Each name and class finally has an attribute (for example, ‘‘foreground’’ or ‘‘font’’). If each window is properly assigned a name and class, it is easy for the user to specify attributes of any portion of the application.

At the top level, the application might consist of a paned window (that is, a window divided into several sections) named ‘‘toc’’. One pane of the paned window is a button box window named ‘‘buttons’’ and is filled with command buttons. One of these command buttons is used to incorporate new mail and has the name ‘‘incorporate’’. This window has a fully qualified name, ‘‘xmh.toc.buttons.incorporate’’, and a fully qualified class, ‘‘Xmh.Paned.Box.Command’’. Its fully qualified name is the name of its parent, ‘‘xmh.toc.buttons’’, followed by its name, ‘‘incorporate’’. Its class is the class of its parent, ‘‘Xmh.Paned.Box’’, followed by its particular class, ‘‘Command’’. The fully qualified name of a resource is the attribute’s name appended to the object’s fully qualified name, and the fully qualified class is its class appended to the object’s class.

The incorporate button might need the following resources: Title string, Font, Foreground color for its inactive state, Background color for its inactive state, Foreground color for its active state, and Background color for its active state. Each resource is considered to be an attribute of the button and, as such, has a name and a class. For example, the foreground color for the button in its active state might be named ‘‘activeForeground’’, and its class might be ‘‘Foreground’’.

When an application looks up a resource (for example, a color), it passes the complete name and complete class of the resource to a look-up routine. The resource manager compares this complete specification against the incomplete specifications of entries in the resource database, finds the best match, and returns the corresponding value for that entry.

The definitions for the resource manager are contained in <X11/Xresource.h>.

15.1. Resource File Syntax

The syntax of a resource file is a sequence of resource lines terminated by newline characters or the end of the file. The syntax of an individual resource line is:

ResourceLine

=

Comment | IncludeFile | ResourceSpec | <empty line>

Comment

=

"!" {<any character except null or newline>}

IncludeFile

=

"#" WhiteSpace "include" WhiteSpace FileName WhiteSpace

FileName

=

<valid filename for operating system>

ResourceSpec

=

WhiteSpace ResourceName WhiteSpace ":" WhiteSpace Value

ResourceName

=

[Binding] {Component Binding} ComponentName

Binding

=

"." | "*"

WhiteSpace

=

{<space> | <horizontal tab>}

Component

=

"?" | ComponentName

ComponentName

=

NameChar {NameChar}

NameChar

=

"a"−"z" | "A"−"Z" | "0"−"9" | "_" | "-"

Value

=

{<any character except null or unescaped newline>}

Elements separated by vertical bar (|) are alternatives. Curly braces ({...}) indicate zero or more repetitions of the enclosed elements. Square brackets ([...]) indicate that the enclosed element is optional. Quotes ("...") are used around literal characters.

IncludeFile lines are interpreted by replacing the line with the contents of the specified file. The word ‘‘include’’ must be in lowercase. The file name is interpreted relative to the directory of the file in which the line occurs (for example, if the file name contains no directory or contains a relative directory specification).

If a ResourceName contains a contiguous sequence of two or more Binding characters, the sequence will be replaced with a single ‘‘.’’ character if the sequence contains only ‘‘.’’ characters; otherwise, the sequence will be replaced with a single ‘‘*’’ character.

A resource database never contains more than one entry for a given ResourceName. If a resource file contains multiple lines with the same ResourceName, the last line in the file is used.

Any white space characters before or after the name or colon in a ResourceSpec are ignored. To allow a Value to begin with white space, the two-character sequence ‘‘\space’’ (backslash followed by space) is recognized and replaced by a space character, and the two-character sequence ‘‘\tab’’ (backslash followed by horizontal tab) is recognized and replaced by a horizontal tab character. To allow a Value to contain embedded newline characters, the two-character sequence ‘‘\n’’ is recognized and replaced by a newline character. To allow a Value to be broken across multiple lines in a text file, the two-character sequence ‘‘\newline’’ (backslash followed by newline) is recognized and removed from the value. To allow a Value to contain arbitrary character codes, the four-character sequence ‘‘\nnn’’, where each n is a digit character in the range of ‘‘0’’−‘‘7’’, is recognized and replaced with a single byte that contains the octal value specified by the sequence. Finally, the two-character sequence ‘‘\\’’ is recognized and replaced with a single backslash.

As an example of these sequences, the following resource line contains a value consisting of four characters: a backslash, a null, a ‘‘z’’, and a newline:

magic.values: \\\000\
z\n

15.2. Resource Manager Matching Rules

The algorithm for determining which resource database entry matches a given query is the heart of the resource manager. All queries must fully specify the name and class of the desired resource (use of the characters ‘‘*’’ and ‘‘?’’ is not permitted). The library supports up to 100 components in a full name or class. Resources are stored in the database with only partially specified names and classes, using pattern matching constructs. An asterisk (*) is a loose binding and is used to represent any number of intervening components, including none. A period (.) is a tight binding and is used to separate immediately adjacent components. A question mark (?) is used to match any single component name or class. A database entry cannot end in a loose binding; the final component (which cannot be the character ‘‘?’’) must be specified. The lookup algorithm searches the database for the entry that most closely matches (is most specific for) the full name and class being queried. When more than one database entry matches the full name and class, precedence rules are used to select just one.

The full name and class are scanned from left to right (from highest level in the hierarchy to lowest), one component at a time. At each level, the corresponding component and/or binding of each matching entry is determined, and these matching components and bindings are compared according to precedence rules. Each of the rules is applied at each level before moving to the next level, until a rule selects a single entry over all others. The rules, in order of precedence, are:

1. An entry that contains a matching component (whether name, class, or the character ‘‘?’’) takes precedence over entries that elide the level (that is, entries that match the level in a loose binding).

2. An entry with a matching name takes precedence over both entries with a matching class and entries that match using the character ‘‘?’’. An entry with a matching class takes precedence over entries that match using the character ‘‘?’’.

3. An entry preceded by a tight binding takes precedence over entries preceded by a loose binding.

To illustrate these rules, consider the following resource database entries:

xmh*Paned*activeForeground: red(entry A)

*incorporate.Foreground:

blue

(entry B)

xmh.toc*Command*activeForeground:

green(entry C)

xmh.toc*?.Foreground:

white

(entry D)

xmh.toc*Command.activeForeground:

black(entry E)

Consider a query for the resource:

xmh.toc.messagefunctions.incorporate.activeForeground(name)

Xmh.Paned.Box.Command.Foreground

(class)

At the first level (xmh, Xmh), rule 1 eliminates entry B. At the second level (toc, Paned), rule 2 eliminates entry A. At the third level (messagefunctions, Box), no entries are eliminated. At the fourth level (incorporate, Command), rule 2 eliminates entry D. At the fifth level (activeForeground, Foreground), rule 3 eliminates entry C.

15.3. Quarks

Most uses of the resource manager involve defining names, classes, and representation types as string constants. However, always referring to strings in the resource manager can be slow, because it is so heavily used in some toolkits. To solve this problem, a shorthand for a string is used in place of the string in many of the resource manager functions. Simple comparisons can be performed rather than string comparisons. The shorthand name for a string is called a quark and is the type XrmQuark. On some occasions, you may want to allocate a quark that has no string equivalent.

A quark is to a string what an atom is to a string in the server, but its use is entirely local to your application.

To allocate a new quark, use XrmUniqueQuark. __ │

XrmQuark XrmUniqueQuark() │__

The XrmUniqueQuark function allocates a quark that is guaranteed not to represent any string that is known to the resource manager.

Each name, class, and representation type is typedef’d as an XrmQuark. __ │

typedef int XrmQuark, *XrmQuarkList;
typedef XrmQuark XrmName;
typedef XrmQuark XrmClass;
typedef XrmQuark XrmRepresentation;
#define NULLQUARK ((XrmQuark) 0) │__

Lists are represented as null-terminated arrays of quarks. The size of the array must be large enough for the number of components used. __ │

typedef XrmQuarkList XrmNameList;
typedef XrmQuarkList XrmClassList; │__

To convert a string to a quark, use XrmStringToQuark or XrmPermStringToQuark. __ │

#define XrmStringToName(string) XrmStringToQuark(string)
#define XrmStringToClass(string) XrmStringToQuark(string)
#define XrmStringToRepresentation(string) XrmStringToQuark(string)

XrmQuark XrmStringToQuark(string)
char *string;

XrmQuark XrmPermStringToQuark(string)
char *string;

string

Specifies the string for which a quark is to be

allocated. │__

These functions can be used to convert from string to quark representation. If the string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the conversion is implementation-dependent. The string argument to XrmStringToQuark need not be permanently allocated storage. XrmPermStringToQuark is just like XrmStringToQuark, except that Xlib is permitted to assume the string argument is permanently allocated, and, hence, that it can be used as the value to be returned by XrmQuarkToString.

For any given quark, if XrmStringToQuark returns a non-NULL value, all future calls will return the same value (identical address).

To convert a quark to a string, use XrmQuarkToString. __ │

#define XrmNameToString(name) XrmQuarkToString(name)
#define XrmClassToString(class) XrmQuarkToString(class)
#define XrmRepresentationToString(type) XrmQuarkToString(type)

char *XrmQuarkToString(quark)
XrmQuark quark;

quark

Specifies the quark for which the equivalent

string is desired. │__

These functions can be used to convert from quark representation to string. The string pointed to by the return value must not be modified or freed. The returned string is byte-for-byte equal to the original string passed to one of the string-to-quark routines. If no string exists for that quark, XrmQuarkToString returns NULL. For any given quark, if XrmQuarkToString returns a non-NULL value, all future calls will return the same value (identical address).

To convert a string with one or more components to a quark list, use XrmStringToQuarkList. __ │

#define XrmStringToNameList(str, name) XrmStringToQuarkList((str), (name))
#define XrmStringToClassList(str, class) XrmStringToQuarkList((str), (class))

void XrmStringToQuarkList(string, quarks_return)
char *string;
XrmQuarkList quarks_return;

string

Specifies the string for which a quark list is to

be allocated.

quarks_return
Returns the list of quarks. The caller must allo-
cate sufficient space for the quarks list before
calling XrmStringToQuarkList. │__

The XrmStringToQuarkList function converts the null-terminated string (generally a fully qualified name) to a list of quarks. Note that the string must be in the valid ResourceName format (see section 15.1). If the string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the conversion is implementation-dependent.

A binding list is a list of type XrmBindingList and indicates if components of name or class lists are bound tightly or loosely (that is, if wildcarding of intermediate components is specified).

typedef enum {XrmBindTightly, XrmBindLoosely} XrmBinding, *XrmBindingList;

XrmBindTightly indicates that a period separates the components, and XrmBindLoosely indicates that an asterisk separates the components.

To convert a string with one or more components to a binding list and a quark list, use XrmStringToBindingQuarkList. __ │

XrmStringToBindingQuarkList(string, bindings_return, quarks_return)
char *string;
XrmBindingList bindings_return;
XrmQuarkList quarks_return;

string

Specifies the string for which a quark list is to

be allocated.

bindings_return
Returns the binding list. The caller must allo-
cate sufficient space for the binding list before
calling XrmStringToBindingQuarkList.

quarks_return
Returns the list of quarks. The caller must allo-
cate sufficient space for the quarks list before
calling XrmStringToBindingQuarkList. │__

Component names in the list are separated by a period or an asterisk character. The string must be in the format of a valid ResourceName (see section 15.1). If the string does not start with a period or an asterisk, a tight binding is assumed. For example, the string ‘‘*a.b*c’’ becomes:

quarks:

a

bc

bindings:

loose

tightloose

15.4. Creating and Storing Databases

A resource database is an opaque type, XrmDatabase. Each database value is stored in an XrmValue structure. This structure consists of a size, an address, and a representation type. The size is specified in bytes. The representation type is a way for you to store data tagged by some application-defined type (for example, the strings ‘‘font’’ or ‘‘color’’). It has nothing to do with the C data type or with its class. The XrmValue structure is defined as: __ │

typedef struct {

unsigned int size;

XPointer addr;

} XrmValue, *XrmValuePtr; │__

To initialize the resource manager, use XrmInitialize. __ │

void XrmInitialize(); │__

To retrieve a database from disk, use XrmGetFileDatabase. __ │

XrmDatabase XrmGetFileDatabase(filename)
char *filename;

filename

Specifies the resource database file name. │__

The XrmGetFileDatabase function opens the specified file, creates a new resource database, and loads it with the specifications read in from the specified file. The specified file should contain a sequence of entries in valid ResourceLine format (see section 15.1); the database that results from reading a file with incorrect syntax is implementation-dependent. The file is parsed in the current locale, and the database is created in the current locale. If it cannot open the specified file, XrmGetFileDatabase returns NULL.

To store a copy of a database to disk, use XrmPutFileDatabase. __ │

void XrmPutFileDatabase(database, stored_db)
XrmDatabase database;
char *stored_db;

database

Specifies the database that is to be used.

stored_db

Specifies the file name for the stored database. │__

The XrmPutFileDatabase function stores a copy of the specified database in the specified file. Text is written to the file as a sequence of entries in valid ResourceLine format (see section 15.1). The file is written in the locale of the database. Entries containing resource names that are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding or containing values that are not in the encoding of the database locale, are written in an implementation-dependent manner. The order in which entries are written is implementation-dependent. Entries with representation types other than ‘‘String’’ are ignored.

To obtain a pointer to the screen-independent resources of a display, use XResourceManagerString. __ │

char *XResourceManagerString(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XResourceManagerString function returns the RESOURCE_MANAGER property from the server’s root window of screen zero, which was returned when the connection was opened using XOpenDisplay. The property is converted from type STRING to the current locale. The conversion is identical to that produced by XmbTextPropertyToTextList for a single element STRING property. The returned string is owned by Xlib and should not be freed by the client. The property value must be in a format that is acceptable to XrmGetStringDatabase. If no property exists, NULL is returned.

To obtain a pointer to the screen-specific resources of a screen, use XScreenResourceString. __ │

char *XScreenResourceString(screen)
Screen *screen;

screen

Specifies the screen. │__

The XScreenResourceString function returns the SCREEN_RESOURCES property from the root window of the specified screen. The property is converted from type STRING to the current locale. The conversion is identical to that produced by XmbTextPropertyToTextList for a single element STRING property. The property value must be in a format that is acceptable to XrmGetStringDatabase. If no property exists, NULL is returned. The caller is responsible for freeing the returned string by using XFree.

To create a database from a string, use XrmGetStringDatabase. __ │

XrmDatabase XrmGetStringDatabase(data)
char *data;

data

Specifies the database contents using a string. │__

The XrmGetStringDatabase function creates a new database and stores the resources specified in the specified null-terminated string. XrmGetStringDatabase is similar to XrmGetFileDatabase except that it reads the information out of a string instead of out of a file. The string should contain a sequence of entries in valid ResourceLine format (see section 15.1) terminated by a null character; the database that results from using a string with incorrect syntax is implementation-dependent. The string is parsed in the current locale, and the database is created in the current locale.

To obtain the locale name of a database, use XrmLocaleOfDatabase. __ │

char *XrmLocaleOfDatabase(database)
XrmDatabase database;

database

Specifies the resource database. │__

The XrmLocaleOfDatabase function returns the name of the locale bound to the specified database, as a null-terminated string. The returned locale name string is owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client. Xlib is not permitted to free the string until the database is destroyed. Until the string is freed, it will not be modified by Xlib.

To destroy a resource database and free its allocated memory, use XrmDestroyDatabase. __ │

void XrmDestroyDatabase(database)
XrmDatabase database;

database

Specifies the resource database. │__

If database is NULL, XrmDestroyDatabase returns immediately.

To associate a resource database with a display, use XrmSetDatabase. __ │

void XrmSetDatabase(display, database)
Display *display;
XrmDatabase database;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

database

Specifies the resource database. │__

The XrmSetDatabase function associates the specified resource database (or NULL) with the specified display. The database previously associated with the display (if any) is not destroyed. A client or toolkit may find this function convenient for retaining a database once it is constructed.

To get the resource database associated with a display, use XrmGetDatabase. __ │

XrmDatabase XrmGetDatabase(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

The XrmGetDatabase function returns the database associated with the specified display. It returns NULL if a database has not yet been set.

15.5. Merging Resource Databases

To merge the contents of a resource file into a database, use XrmCombineFileDatabase. __ │

Status XrmCombineFileDatabase(filename, target_db, override)
char *filename;
XrmDatabase *target_db;
Bool override;

filename

Specifies the resource database file name.

target_db

Specifies the resource database into which the

source database is to be merged.

override

Specifies whether source entries override target

ones. │__

The XrmCombineFileDatabase function merges the contents of a resource file into a database. If the same specifier is used for an entry in both the file and the database, the entry in the file will replace the entry in the database if override is True; otherwise, the entry in the file is discarded. The file is parsed in the current locale. If the file cannot be read, a zero status is returned; otherwise, a nonzero status is returned. If target_db contains NULL, XrmCombineFileDatabase creates and returns a new database to it. Otherwise, the database pointed to by target_db is not destroyed by the merge. The database entries are merged without changing values or types, regardless of the locale of the database. The locale of the target database is not modified.

To merge the contents of one database into another database, use XrmCombineDatabase. __ │

void XrmCombineDatabase(source_db, target_db, override)
XrmDatabase source_db, *target_db;
Bool override;

source_db

Specifies the resource database that is to be

merged into the target database.

target_db

Specifies the resource database into which the

source database is to be merged.

override

Specifies whether source entries override target

ones. │__

The XrmCombineDatabase function merges the contents of one database into another. If the same specifier is used for an entry in both databases, the entry in the source_db will replace the entry in the target_db if override is True; otherwise, the entry in source_db is discarded. If target_db contains NULL, XrmCombineDatabase simply stores source_db in it. Otherwise, source_db is destroyed by the merge, but the database pointed to by target_db is not destroyed. The database entries are merged without changing values or types, regardless of the locales of the databases. The locale of the target database is not modified.

To merge the contents of one database into another database with override semantics, use XrmMergeDatabases. __ │

void XrmMergeDatabases(source_db, target_db)
XrmDatabase source_db, *target_db;

source_db

Specifies the resource database that is to be

merged into the target database.

target_db

Specifies the resource database into which the

source database is to be merged. │__

Calling the XrmMergeDatabases function is equivalent to calling the XrmCombineDatabase function with an override argument of True.

15.6. Looking Up Resources

To retrieve a resource from a resource database, use XrmGetResource, XrmQGetResource, or XrmQGetSearchResource. __ │

Bool XrmGetResource(database, str_name, str_class, str_type_return, value_return)
XrmDatabase database;
char *str_name;
char *str_class;
char **str_type_return;
XrmValue *value_return;

database

Specifies the database that is to be used.

str_name

Specifies the fully qualified name of the value

being retrieved (as a string).

str_class

Specifies the fully qualified class of the value

being retrieved (as a string).

str_type_return
Returns the representation type of the destination
(as a string).

value_return
Returns the value in the database. │__ __ │

Bool XrmQGetResource(database, quark_name, quark_class, quark_type_return, value_return)
XrmDatabase database;
XrmNameList quark_name;
XrmClassList quark_class;
XrmRepresentation *quark_type_return;
XrmValue *value_return;

database

Specifies the database that is to be used.

quark_nameSpecifies the fully qualified name of the value
being retrieved (as a quark).

quark_classSpecifies the fully qualified class of the value
being retrieved (as a quark).

quark_type_return
Returns the representation type of the destination
(as a quark).

value_return
Returns the value in the database. │__

The XrmGetResource and XrmQGetResource functions retrieve a resource from the specified database. Both take a fully qualified name/class pair, a destination resource representation, and the address of a value (size/address pair). The value and returned type point into database memory; therefore, you must not modify the data.

The database only frees or overwrites entries on XrmPutResource, XrmQPutResource, or XrmMergeDatabases. A client that is not storing new values into the database or is not merging the database should be safe using the address passed back at any time until it exits. If a resource was found, both XrmGetResource and XrmQGetResource return True; otherwise, they return False.

Most applications and toolkits do not make random probes into a resource database to fetch resources. The X toolkit access pattern for a resource database is quite stylized. A series of from 1 to 20 probes is made with only the last name/class differing in each probe. The XrmGetResource function is at worst a Image grohtml-19291-31.png algorithm, where n is the length of the name/class list. This can be improved upon by the application programmer by prefetching a list of database levels that might match the first part of a name/class list.

To obtain a list of database levels, use XrmQGetSearchList. __ │

typedef XrmHashTable *XrmSearchList;

Bool XrmQGetSearchList(database, names, classes, list_return, list_length)
XrmDatabase database;
XrmNameList names;
XrmClassList classes;
XrmSearchList list_return;
int list_length;

database

Specifies the database that is to be used.

names

Specifies a list of resource names.

classes

Specifies a list of resource classes.

list_returnReturns a search list for further use. The
caller must allocate sufficient space for the list
before calling XrmQGetSearchList.

list_lengthSpecifies the number of entries (not the byte
size) allocated for list_return. │__

The XrmQGetSearchList function takes a list of names and classes and returns a list of database levels where a match might occur. The returned list is in best-to-worst order and uses the same algorithm as XrmGetResource for determining precedence. If list_return was large enough for the search list, XrmQGetSearchList returns True; otherwise, it returns False.

The size of the search list that the caller must allocate is dependent upon the number of levels and wildcards in the resource specifiers that are stored in the database. The worst case length is Image grohtml-19291-32.png , where n is the number of name or class components in names or classes.

When using XrmQGetSearchList followed by multiple probes for resources with a common name and class prefix, only the common prefix should be specified in the name and class list to XrmQGetSearchList.

To search resource database levels for a given resource, use XrmQGetSearchResource. __ │

Bool XrmQGetSearchResource(list, name, class, type_return, value_return)
XrmSearchList list;
XrmName name;
XrmClass class;
XrmRepresentation *type_return;
XrmValue *value_return;

list

Specifies the search list returned by XrmQGet-

SearchList.

name

Specifies the resource name.

class

Specifies the resource class.

type_returnReturns data representation type.

value_return
Returns the value in the database. │__

The XrmQGetSearchResource function searches the specified database levels for the resource that is fully identified by the specified name and class. The search stops with the first match. XrmQGetSearchResource returns True if the resource was found; otherwise, it returns False.

A call to XrmQGetSearchList with a name and class list containing all but the last component of a resource name followed by a call to XrmQGetSearchResource with the last component name and class returns the same database entry as XrmGetResource and XrmQGetResource with the fully qualified name and class.

15.7. Storing into a Resource Database

To store resources into the database, use XrmPutResource or XrmQPutResource. Both functions take a partial resource specification, a representation type, and a value. This value is copied into the specified database. __ │

void XrmPutResource(database, specifier, type, value)
XrmDatabase *database;
char *specifier;
char *type;
XrmValue *value;

database

Specifies the resource database.

specifier

Specifies a complete or partial specification of

the resource.

type

Specifies the type of the resource.

value

Specifies the value of the resource, which is

specified as a string. │__

If database contains NULL, XrmPutResource creates a new database and returns a pointer to it. XrmPutResource is a convenience function that calls XrmStringToBindingQuarkList followed by:

XrmQPutResource(database, bindings, quarks, XrmStringToQuark(type), value)

If the specifier and type are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. The value is stored in the database without modification. __ │

void XrmQPutResource(database, bindings, quarks, type, value)
XrmDatabase *database;
XrmBindingList bindings;
XrmQuarkList quarks;
XrmRepresentation type;
XrmValue *value;

database

Specifies the resource database.

bindings

Specifies a list of bindings.

quarks

Specifies the complete or partial name or the

class list of the resource.

type

Specifies the type of the resource.

value

Specifies the value of the resource, which is

specified as a string. │__

If database contains NULL, XrmQPutResource creates a new database and returns a pointer to it. If a resource entry with the identical bindings and quarks already exists in the database, the previous type and value are replaced by the new specified type and value. The value is stored in the database without modification.

To add a resource that is specified as a string, use XrmPutStringResource. __ │

void XrmPutStringResource(database, specifier, value)
XrmDatabase *database;
char *specifier;
char *value;

database

Specifies the resource database.

specifier

Specifies a complete or partial specification of

the resource.

value

Specifies the value of the resource, which is

specified as a string. │__

If database contains NULL, XrmPutStringResource creates a new database and returns a pointer to it. XrmPutStringResource adds a resource with the specified value to the specified database. XrmPutStringResource is a convenience function that first calls XrmStringToBindingQuarkList on the specifier and then calls XrmQPutResource, using a ‘‘String’’ representation type. If the specifier is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. The value is stored in the database without modification.

To add a string resource using quarks as a specification, use XrmQPutStringResource. __ │

void XrmQPutStringResource(database, bindings, quarks, value)
XrmDatabase *database;
XrmBindingList bindings;
XrmQuarkList quarks;
char *value;

database

Specifies the resource database.

bindings

Specifies a list of bindings.

quarks

Specifies the complete or partial name or the

class list of the resource.

value

Specifies the value of the resource, which is

specified as a string. │__

If database contains NULL, XrmQPutStringResource creates a new database and returns a pointer to it. XrmQPutStringResource is a convenience routine that constructs an XrmValue for the value string (by calling strlen to compute the size) and then calls XrmQPutResource, using a ‘‘String’’ representation type. The value is stored in the database without modification.

To add a single resource entry that is specified as a string that contains both a name and a value, use XrmPutLineResource. __ │

void XrmPutLineResource(database, line)
XrmDatabase *database;
char *line;

database

Specifies the resource database.

line

Specifies the resource name and value pair as a

single string. │__

If database contains NULL, XrmPutLineResource creates a new database and returns a pointer to it. XrmPutLineResource adds a single resource entry to the specified database. The line should be in valid ResourceLine format (see section 15.1) terminated by a newline or null character; the database that results from using a string with incorrect syntax is implementation-dependent. The string is parsed in the locale of the database. If the ResourceName is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Note that comment lines are not stored.

15.8. Enumerating Database Entries

To enumerate the entries of a database, use XrmEnumerateDatabase. __ │

#de-
fine
XrmEnumAllLevels

0

#de-
fine
XrmEnumOneLevel

1

Bool XrmEnumerateDatabase(database, name_prefix, class_prefix, mode, proc, arg)
XrmDatabase database;
XrmNameList name_prefix;
XrmClassList class_prefix;
int mode;
Bool (*proc)();
XPointer arg;

database

Specifies the resource database.

name_prefixSpecifies the resource name prefix.

class_prefix
Specifies the resource class prefix.

mode

Specifies the number of levels to enumerate.

proc

Specifies the procedure that is to be called for

each matching entry.

arg

Specifies the user-supplied argument that will be

passed to the procedure. │__

The XrmEnumerateDatabase function calls the specified procedure for each resource in the database that would match some completion of the given name/class resource prefix. The order in which resources are found is implementation-dependent. If mode is XrmEnumOneLevel, a resource must match the given name/class prefix with just a single name and class appended. If mode is XrmEnumAllLevels, the resource must match the given name/class prefix with one or more names and classes appended. If the procedure returns True, the enumeration terminates and the function returns True. If the procedure always returns False, all matching resources are enumerated and the function returns False.

The procedure is called with the following arguments:

(*proc)(database, bindings, quarks, type, value, arg)

XrmDatabase *database;

XrmBindingList bindings;

XrmQuarkList quarks;

XrmRepresentation *type;

XrmValue *value;

XPointer arg;

The bindings and quarks lists are terminated by NULLQUARK. Note that pointers to the database and type are passed, but these values should not be modified.

The procedure must not modify the database. If Xlib has been initialized for threads, the procedure is called with the database locked and the result of a call by the procedure to any Xlib function using the same database is not defined.

15.9. Parsing Command Line Options

The XrmParseCommand function can be used to parse the command line arguments to a program and modify a resource database with selected entries from the command line. __ │

typedef enum {

XrmoptionNoArg,

/* Value is specified in XrmOptionDescRec.value */

XrmoptionIsArg,

/* Value is the option string itself */

XrmoptionStickyArg,

/* Value is characters immediately following option */

XrmoptionSepArg,

/* Value is next argument in argv */

XrmoptionResArg,

/* Resource and value in next argument in argv */

XrmoptionSkipArg,

/* Ignore this option and the next argument in argv */

XrmoptionSkipLine,

/* Ignore this option and the rest of argv */

XrmoptionSkipNArgs

/* Ignore this option and the next

   XrmOptionDescRec.value arguments in argv */

} XrmOptionKind; │__

Note that XrmoptionSkipArg is equivalent to XrmoptionSkipNArgs with the XrmOptionDescRec.value field containing the value one. Note also that the value zero for XrmoptionSkipNArgs indicates that only the option itself is to be skipped. __ │

typedef struct {

char *option;

/* Option specification string in argv */

char *specifier;

/* Binding and resource name (sans application name) */

XrmOptionKind argKind;/* Which style of option it is */

XPointer value;

/* Value to provide if XrmoptionNoArg or

   XrmoptionSkipNArgs */

} XrmOptionDescRec, *XrmOptionDescList; │__

To load a resource database from a C command line, use XrmParseCommand. __ │

void XrmParseCommand(database, table, table_count, name, argc_in_out, argv_in_out)
XrmDatabase *database;
XrmOptionDescList table;
int table_count;
char *name;
int *argc_in_out;
char **argv_in_out;

database

Specifies the resource database.

table

Specifies the table of command line arguments to

be parsed.

table_countSpecifies the number of entries in the table.

name

Specifies the application name.

argc_in_outSpecifies the number of arguments and returns the
number of remaining arguments.

argv_in_outSpecifies the command line arguments and returns
the remaining arguments. │__

The XrmParseCommand function parses an (argc, argv) pair according to the specified option table, loads recognized options into the specified database with type ‘‘String,’’ and modifies the (argc, argv) pair to remove all recognized options. If database contains NULL, XrmParseCommand creates a new database and returns a pointer to it. Otherwise, entries are added to the database specified. If a database is created, it is created in the current locale.

The specified table is used to parse the command line. Recognized options in the table are removed from argv, and entries are added to the specified resource database in the order they occur in argv. The table entries contain information on the option string, the option name, the style of option, and a value to provide if the option kind is XrmoptionNoArg. The option names are compared byte-for-byte to arguments in argv, independent of any locale. The resource values given in the table are stored in the resource database without modification. All resource database entries are created using a ‘‘String’’ representation type. The argc argument specifies the number of arguments in argv and is set on return to the remaining number of arguments that were not parsed. The name argument should be the name of your application for use in building the database entry. The name argument is prefixed to the resourceName in the option table before storing a database entry. The name argument is treated as a single component, even if it has embedded periods. No separating (binding) character is inserted, so the table must contain either a period (.) or an asterisk (*) as the first character in each resourceName entry. To specify a more completely qualified resource name, the resourceName entry can contain multiple components. If the name argument and the resourceNames are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

The following provides a sample option table:

static XrmOptionDescRec opTable[] = {

{"−background",

"*background",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−bd",

"*borderColor",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−bg",

"*background",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−borderwidth",

"*TopLevelShell.borderWidth",XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−bordercolor",

"*borderColor",XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−bw",

"*TopLevelShell.borderWidth",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−display",

".display",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−fg",

"*foreground",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−fn",

"*font",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−font",

"*font",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−foreground",

"*foreground",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−geometry",

".TopLevelShell.geometry",XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−iconic",

".TopLevelShell.iconic",

XrmoptionNoArg,(XPointer) "on"},

{"−name",

".name",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−reverse",

"*reverseVideo",XrmoptionNoArg,(XPointer) "on"},

{"−rv",

"*reverseVideo",

XrmoptionNoArg,(XPointer) "on"},

{"−synchronous",

"*synchronous",XrmoptionNoArg,(XPointer) "on"},

{"−title",

".TopLevelShell.title",

XrmoptionSepArg,(XPointer) NULL},

{"−xrm",

NULL,

XrmoptionResArg,(XPointer) NULL},

};

In this table, if the −background (or −bg) option is used to set background colors, the stored resource specifier matches all resources of attribute background. If the −borderwidth option is used, the stored resource specifier applies only to border width attributes of class TopLevelShell (that is, outer-most windows, including pop-up windows). If the −title option is used to set a window name, only the topmost application windows receive the resource.

When parsing the command line, any unique unambiguous abbreviation for an option name in the table is considered a match for the option. Note that uppercase and lowercase matter.

15

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Chapter 16

Application Utility Functions

Once you have initialized the X system, you can use the Xlib utility functions to:

Use keyboard utility functions

Use Latin-1 keyboard event functions

Allocate permanent storage

Parse the window geometry

Manipulate regions

Use cut buffers

Determine the appropriate visual type

Manipulate images

Manipulate bitmaps

Use the context manager

As a group, the functions discussed in this chapter provide the functionality that is frequently needed and that spans toolkits. Many of these functions do not generate actual protocol requests to the server.

16.1. Using Keyboard Utility Functions

This section discusses mapping between KeyCodes and KeySyms, classifying KeySyms, and mapping between KeySyms and string names. The first three functions in this section operate on a cached copy of the server keyboard mapping. The first four KeySyms for each KeyCode are modified according to the rules given in section 12.7. To obtain the untransformed KeySyms defined for a key, use the functions described in section 12.7.

To obtain a KeySym for the KeyCode of an event, use XLookupKeysym. __ │

KeySym XLookupKeysym(key_event, index)
XKeyEvent *key_event;
int index;

key_event

Specifies the KeyPress or KeyRelease event.

index

Specifies the index into the KeySyms list for the

event’s KeyCode. │__

The XLookupKeysym function uses a given keyboard event and the index you specified to return the KeySym from the list that corresponds to the KeyCode member in the XKeyPressedEvent or XKeyReleasedEvent structure. If no KeySym is defined for the KeyCode of the event, XLookupKeysym returns NoSymbol.

To obtain a KeySym for a specific KeyCode, use XKeycodeToKeysym. __ │

KeySym XKeycodeToKeysym(display, keycode, index)
Display *display;
KeyCode keycode;
int index;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

keycode

Specifies the KeyCode.

index

Specifies the element of KeyCode vector. │__

The XKeycodeToKeysym function uses internal Xlib tables and returns the KeySym defined for the specified KeyCode and the element of the KeyCode vector. If no symbol is defined, XKeycodeToKeysym returns NoSymbol.

To obtain a KeyCode for a key having a specific KeySym, use XKeysymToKeycode. __ │

KeyCode XKeysymToKeycode(display, keysym)
Display *display;
KeySym keysym;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be searched for. │__

If the specified KeySym is not defined for any KeyCode, XKeysymToKeycode returns zero.

The mapping between KeyCodes and KeySyms is cached internal to Xlib. When this information is changed at the server, an Xlib function must be called to refresh the cache. To refresh the stored modifier and keymap information, use XRefreshKeyboardMapping. __ │

XRefreshKeyboardMapping(event_map)
XMappingEvent *event_map;

event_map

Specifies the mapping event that is to be used. │__

The XRefreshKeyboardMapping function refreshes the stored modifier and keymap information. You usually call this function when a MappingNotify event with a request member of MappingKeyboard or MappingModifier occurs. The result is to update Xlib’s knowledge of the keyboard.

To obtain the uppercase and lowercase forms of a KeySym, use XConvertCase. __ │

void XConvertCase(keysym, lower_return, upper_return)
KeySym keysym;
KeySym *lower_return;
KeySym *upper_return;

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be converted.

lower_return
Returns the lowercase form of keysym, or keysym.

upper_return
Returns the uppercase form of keysym, or keysym. │__

The XConvertCase function returns the uppercase and lowercase forms of the specified Keysym, if the KeySym is subject to case conversion; otherwise, the specified KeySym is returned to both lower_return and upper_return. Support for conversion of other than Latin and Cyrillic KeySyms is implementation-dependent.

KeySyms have string names as well as numeric codes. To convert the name of the KeySym to the KeySym code, use XStringToKeysym. __ │

KeySym XStringToKeysym(string)
char *string;

string

Specifies the name of the KeySym that is to be

converted. │__

Standard KeySym names are obtained from <X11/keysymdef.h> by removing the XK_ prefix from each name. KeySyms that are not part of the Xlib standard also may be obtained with this function. The set of KeySyms that are available in this manner and the mechanisms by which Xlib obtains them is implementation-dependent.

If the KeySym name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. If the specified string does not match a valid KeySym, XStringToKeysym returns NoSymbol.

To convert a KeySym code to the name of the KeySym, use XKeysymToString. __ │

char *XKeysymToString(keysym)
KeySym keysym;

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be converted. │__

The returned string is in a static area and must not be modified. The returned string is in the Host Portable Character Encoding. If the specified KeySym is not defined, XKeysymToString returns a NULL.

16.1.1. KeySym Classification Macros

You may want to test if a KeySym is, for example, on the keypad or on one of the function keys. You can use KeySym macros to perform the following tests. __ │

IsCursorKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a cursor key. __ │

IsFunctionKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a function key. __ │

IsKeypadKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a standard keypad key. __ │

IsPrivateKeypadKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a vendor-private keypad key. __ │

IsMiscFunctionKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a miscellaneous function key. __ │

IsModifierKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a modifier key. __ │

IsPFKey(keysym)

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be tested. │__

Returns True if the specified KeySym is a PF key.

16.2. Using Latin-1 Keyboard Event Functions

Chapter 13 describes internationalized text input facilities, but sometimes it is expedient to write an application that only deals with Latin-1 characters and ASCII controls, so Xlib provides a simple function for that purpose. XLookupString handles the standard modifier semantics described in section 12.7. This function does not use any of the input method facilities described in chapter 13 and does not depend on the current locale.

To map a key event to an ISO Latin-1 string, use XLookupString. __ │

int XLookupString(event_struct, buffer_return, bytes_buffer, keysym_return, status_in_out)
XKeyEvent *event_struct;
char *buffer_return;
int bytes_buffer;
KeySym *keysym_return;
XComposeStatus *status_in_out;

event_struct
Specifies the key event structure to be used. You
can pass XKeyPressedEvent or XKeyReleasedEvent.

buffer_return
Returns the translated characters.

bytes_buffer
Specifies the length of the buffer. No more than
bytes_buffer of translation are returned.

keysym_return
Returns the KeySym computed from the event if this
argument is not NULL.

status_in_out
Specifies or returns the XComposeStatus structure
or NULL. │__

The XLookupString function translates a key event to a KeySym and a string. The KeySym is obtained by using the standard interpretation of the Shift, Lock, group, and numlock modifiers as defined in the X Protocol specification. If the KeySym has been rebound (see XRebindKeysym), the bound string will be stored in the buffer. Otherwise, the KeySym is mapped, if possible, to an ISO Latin-1 character or (if the Control modifier is on) to an ASCII control character, and that character is stored in the buffer. XLookupString returns the number of characters that are stored in the buffer.

If present (non-NULL), the XComposeStatus structure records the state, which is private to Xlib, that needs preservation across calls to XLookupString to implement compose processing. The creation of XComposeStatus structures is implementation-dependent; a portable program must pass NULL for this argument.

XLookupString depends on the cached keyboard information mentioned in the previous section, so it is necessary to use XRefreshKeyboardMapping to keep this information up-to-date.

To rebind the meaning of a KeySym for XLookupString, use XRebindKeysym. __ │

XRebindKeysym(display, keysym, list, mod_count, string, num_bytes)
Display *display;
KeySym keysym;
KeySym list[];
int mod_count;
unsigned char *string;
int num_bytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

keysym

Specifies the KeySym that is to be rebound.

list

Specifies the KeySyms to be used as modifiers.

mod_count

Specifies the number of modifiers in the modifier

list.

string

Specifies the string that is copied and will be

returned by XLookupString.

num_bytes

Specifies the number of bytes in the string argu-

ment. │__

The XRebindKeysym function can be used to rebind the meaning of a KeySym for the client. It does not redefine any key in the X server but merely provides an easy way for long strings to be attached to keys. XLookupString returns this string when the appropriate set of modifier keys are pressed and when the KeySym would have been used for the translation. No text conversions are performed; the client is responsible for supplying appropriately encoded strings. Note that you can rebind a KeySym that may not exist.

16.3. Allocating Permanent Storage

To allocate some memory you will never give back, use Xpermalloc. __ │

char *Xpermalloc(size)
unsigned int size; │__

The Xpermalloc function allocates storage that can never be freed for the life of the program. The memory is allocated with alignment for the C type double. This function may provide some performance and space savings over the standard operating system memory allocator.

16.4. Parsing the Window Geometry

To parse standard window geometry strings, use XParseGeometry. __ │

int XParseGeometry(parsestring, x_return, y_return, width_return, height_return)
char *parsestring;
int *x_return, *y_return;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;

parsestringSpecifies the string you want to parse.

x_return

y_return

Return the x and y offsets.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height determined. │__

By convention, X applications use a standard string to indicate window size and placement. XParseGeometry makes it easier to conform to this standard because it allows you to parse the standard window geometry. Specifically, this function lets you parse strings of the form:

[=][<width>{xX}<height>][{+-}<xoffset>{+-}<yoffset>]

The fields map into the arguments associated with this function. (Items enclosed in <> are integers, items in [] are optional, and items enclosed in {} indicate ‘‘choose one of.’’ Note that the brackets should not appear in the actual string.) If the string is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

The XParseGeometry function returns a bitmask that indicates which of the four values (width, height, xoffset, and yoffset) were actually found in the string and whether the x and y values are negative. By convention, −0 is not equal to +0, because the user needs to be able to say ‘‘position the window relative to the right or bottom edge.’’ For each value found, the corresponding argument is updated. For each value not found, the argument is left unchanged. The bits are represented by XValue, YValue, WidthValue, HeightValue, XNegative, or YNegative and are defined in <X11/Xutil.h>. They will be set whenever one of the values is defined or one of the signs is set.

If the function returns either the XValue or YValue flag, you should place the window at the requested position.

To construct a window’s geometry information, use XWMGeometry. __ │

int XWMGeometry(display, screen, user_geom, def_geom, bwidth, hints, x_return, y_return,
width_return
, height_return, gravity_return)
Display *display;
int screen;
char *user_geom;
char *def_geom;
unsigned int bwidth;
XSizeHints *hints;
int *x_return, *y_return;
int *width_return;
int *height_return;
int *gravity_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen

Specifies the screen.

user_geom

Specifies the user-specified geometry or NULL.

def_geom

Specifies the application’s default geometry or

NULL.

bwidth

Specifies the border width.

hints

Specifies the size hints for the window in its

normal state.

x_return

y_return

Return the x and y offsets.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height determined.

gravity_return
Returns the window gravity. │__

The XWMGeometry function combines any geometry information (given in the format used by XParseGeometry) specified by the user and by the calling program with size hints (usually the ones to be stored in WM_NORMAL_HINTS) and returns the position, size, and gravity (NorthWestGravity, NorthEastGravity, SouthEastGravity, or SouthWestGravity) that describe the window. If the base size is not set in the XSizeHints structure, the minimum size is used if set. Otherwise, a base size of zero is assumed. If no minimum size is set in the hints structure, the base size is used. A mask (in the form returned by XParseGeometry) that describes which values came from the user specification and whether or not the position coordinates are relative to the right and bottom edges is returned. Note that these coordinates will have already been accounted for in the x_return and y_return values.

Note that invalid geometry specifications can cause a width or height of zero to be returned. The caller may pass the address of the hints win_gravity field as gravity_return to update the hints directly.

16.5. Manipulating Regions

Regions are arbitrary sets of pixel locations. Xlib provides functions for manipulating regions. The opaque type Region is defined in <X11/Xutil.h>. Xlib provides functions that you can use to manipulate regions. This section discusses how to:

Create, copy, or destroy regions

Move or shrink regions

Compute with regions

Determine if regions are empty or equal

Locate a point or rectangle in a region

16.5.1. Creating, Copying, or Destroying Regions

To create a new empty region, use XCreateRegion. __ │

Region XCreateRegion() │__

To generate a region from a polygon, use XPolygonRegion. __ │

Region XPolygonRegion(points, n, fill_rule)
XPoint points[];
int n;

int fill_rule;

points

Specifies an array of points.

n

Specifies the number of points in the polygon.

fill_rule

Specifies the fill-rule you want to set for the

specified GC. You can pass EvenOddRule or Windin-
gRule
. │__

The XPolygonRegion function returns a region for the polygon defined by the points array. For an explanation of fill_rule, see XCreateGC.

To set the clip-mask of a GC to a region, use XSetRegion. __ │

XSetRegion(display, gc, r)
Display *display;
GC gc;
Region r;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC.

r

Specifies the region. │__

The XSetRegion function sets the clip-mask in the GC to the specified region. The region is specified relative to the drawable’s origin. The resulting GC clip origin is implementation-dependent. Once it is set in the GC, the region can be destroyed.

To deallocate the storage associated with a specified region, use XDestroyRegion. __ │

XDestroyRegion(r)
Region r;

r

Specifies the region. │__

16.5.2. Moving or Shrinking Regions

To move a region by a specified amount, use XOffsetRegion. __ │

XOffsetRegion(r, dx, dy)
Region r;
int dx, dy;

r

Specifies the region.

dx

dy

Specify the x and y coordinates, which define the

amount you want to move the specified region. │__

To reduce a region by a specified amount, use XShrinkRegion. __ │

XShrinkRegion(r, dx, dy)
Region r;
int dx, dy;

r

Specifies the region.

dx

dy

Specify the x and y coordinates, which define the

amount you want to shrink the specified region. │__

Positive values shrink the size of the region, and negative values expand the region.

16.5.3. Computing with Regions

To generate the smallest rectangle enclosing a region, use XClipBox. __ │

XClipBox(r, rect_return)
Region r;
XRectangle *rect_return;

r

Specifies the region.

rect_returnReturns the smallest enclosing rectangle. │__

The XClipBox function returns the smallest rectangle enclosing the specified region.

To compute the intersection of two regions, use XIntersectRegion. __ │

XIntersectRegion(sra, srb, dr_return)
Region sra, srb, dr_return;

sra

srb

Specify the two regions with which you want to

perform the computation.

dr_return

Returns the result of the computation. │__

To compute the union of two regions, use XUnionRegion. __ │

XUnionRegion(sra, srb, dr_return)
Region sra, srb, dr_return;

sra

srb

Specify the two regions with which you want to

perform the computation.

dr_return

Returns the result of the computation. │__

To create a union of a source region and a rectangle, use XUnionRectWithRegion. __ │

XUnionRectWithRegion(rectangle, src_region, dest_region_return)
XRectangle *rectangle;
Region src_region;
Region dest_region_return;

rectangle

Specifies the rectangle.

src_regionSpecifies the source region to be used.

dest_region_return
Returns the destination region. │__

The XUnionRectWithRegion function updates the destination region from a union of the specified rectangle and the specified source region.

To subtract two regions, use XSubtractRegion. __ │

XSubtractRegion(sra, srb, dr_return)
Region sra, srb, dr_return;

sra

srb

Specify the two regions with which you want to

perform the computation.

dr_return

Returns the result of the computation. │__

The XSubtractRegion function subtracts srb from sra and stores the results in dr_return.

To calculate the difference between the union and intersection of two regions, use XXorRegion. __ │

XXorRegion(sra, srb, dr_return)
Region sra, srb, dr_return;

sra

srb

Specify the two regions with which you want to

perform the computation.

dr_return

Returns the result of the computation. │__

16.5.4. Determining if Regions Are Empty or Equal

To determine if the specified region is empty, use XEmptyRegion. __ │

Bool XEmptyRegion(r)
Region r;

r

Specifies the region. │__

The XEmptyRegion function returns True if the region is empty.

To determine if two regions have the same offset, size, and shape, use XEqualRegion. __ │

Bool XEqualRegion(r1, r2)
Region r1, r2;

r1

r2

Specify the two regions. │__

The XEqualRegion function returns True if the two regions have the same offset, size, and shape.

16.5.5. Locating a Point or a Rectangle in a Region

To determine if a specified point resides in a specified region, use XPointInRegion. __ │

Bool XPointInRegion(r, x, y)
Region r;
int x, y;

r

Specifies the region.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which define the

point. │__

The XPointInRegion function returns True if the point (x, y) is contained in the region r.

To determine if a specified rectangle is inside a region, use XRectInRegion. __ │

int XRectInRegion(r, x, y, width, height)
Region r;
int x, y;
unsigned int width, height;

r

Specifies the region.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates, which define the

coordinates of the upper-left corner of the rec-
tangle.

width

height

Specify the width and height, which define the

rectangle. │__

The XRectInRegion function returns RectangleIn if the rectangle is entirely in the specified region, RectangleOut if the rectangle is entirely out of the specified region, and RectanglePart if the rectangle is partially in the specified region.

16.6. Using Cut Buffers

Xlib provides functions to manipulate cut buffers, a very simple form of cut-and-paste inter-client communication. Selections are a much more powerful and useful mechanism for interchanging data between clients (see section 4.5) and generally should be used instead of cut buffers.

Cut buffers are implemented as properties on the first root window of the display. The buffers can only contain text, in the STRING encoding. The text encoding is not changed by Xlib when fetching or storing. Eight buffers are provided and can be accessed as a ring or as explicit buffers (numbered 0 through 7).

To store data in cut buffer 0, use XStoreBytes. __ │

XStoreBytes(display, bytes, nbytes)
Display *display;
char *bytes;
int nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

bytes

Specifies the bytes, which are not necessarily

ASCII or null-terminated.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes to be stored. │__

The data can have embedded null characters and need not be null-terminated. The cut buffer’s contents can be retrieved later by any client calling XFetchBytes.

XStoreBytes can generate a BadAlloc error.

To store data in a specified cut buffer, use XStoreBuffer. __ │

XStoreBuffer(display, bytes, nbytes, buffer)
Display *display;
char *bytes;
int nbytes;
int buffer;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

bytes

Specifies the bytes, which are not necessarily

ASCII or null-terminated.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes to be stored.

buffer

Specifies the buffer in which you want to store

the bytes. │__

If an invalid buffer is specified, the call has no effect. The data can have embedded null characters and need not be null-terminated.

XStoreBuffer can generate a BadAlloc error.

To return data from cut buffer 0, use XFetchBytes. __ │

char *XFetchBytes(display, nbytes_return)
Display *display;
int *nbytes_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

nbytes_return
Returns the number of bytes in the buffer. │__

The XFetchBytes function returns the number of bytes in the nbytes_return argument, if the buffer contains data. Otherwise, the function returns NULL and sets nbytes to 0. The appropriate amount of storage is allocated and the pointer returned. The client must free this storage when finished with it by calling XFree.

To return data from a specified cut buffer, use XFetchBuffer. __ │

char *XFetchBuffer(display, nbytes_return, buffer)
Display *display;
int *nbytes_return;
int buffer;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

nbytes_return
Returns the number of bytes in the buffer.

buffer

Specifies the buffer from which you want the

stored data returned. │__

The XFetchBuffer function returns zero to the nbytes_return argument if there is no data in the buffer or if an invalid buffer is specified.

To rotate the cut buffers, use XRotateBuffers. __ │

XRotateBuffers(display, rotate)
Display *display;
int rotate;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

rotate

Specifies how much to rotate the cut buffers. │__

The XRotateBuffers function rotates the cut buffers, such that buffer 0 becomes buffer n, buffer 1 becomes n + 1 mod 8, and so on. This cut buffer numbering is global to the display. Note that XRotateBuffers generates BadMatch errors if any of the eight buffers have not been created.

16.7. Determining the Appropriate Visual Type

A single display can support multiple screens. Each screen can have several different visual types supported at different depths. You can use the functions described in this section to determine which visual to use for your application.

The functions in this section use the visual information masks and the XVisualInfo structure, which is defined in <X11/Xutil.h> and contains: __ │

/* Visual information mask bits */

#de-
fine
VisualNoMask

0x0

#de-
fine
VisualIDMask

0x1

#de-
fine
VisualScreenMask

0x2

#de-
fine
VisualDepthMask

0x4

#de-
fine
VisualClassMask

0x8

#de-
fine
VisualRedMaskMask

0x10

#de-
fine
VisualGreenMaskMask

0x20

#de-
fine
VisualBlueMaskMask

0x40

#de-
fine
VisualColormapSizeMask

0x80

#de-
fine
VisualBitsPerRGBMask

0x100

#de-
fine
VisualAllMask

0x1FF

/* Values */

typedef struct {

Visual *visual;

VisualID visualid;

int screen;

unsigned int depth;

int class;

unsigned long red_mask;

unsigned long green_mask;

unsigned long blue_mask;

int colormap_size;

int bits_per_rgb;

} XVisualInfo; │__

To obtain a list of visual information structures that match a specified template, use XGetVisualInfo. __ │

XVisualInfo *XGetVisualInfo(display, vinfo_mask, vinfo_template, nitems_return)
Display *display;
long vinfo_mask;
XVisualInfo *vinfo_template;
int *nitems_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

vinfo_maskSpecifies the visual mask value.

vinfo_template
Specifies the visual attributes that are to be
used in matching the visual structures.

nitems_return
Returns the number of matching visual structures. │__

The XGetVisualInfo function returns a list of visual structures that have attributes equal to the attributes specified by vinfo_template. If no visual structures match the template using the specified vinfo_mask, XGetVisualInfo returns a NULL. To free the data returned by this function, use XFree.

To obtain the visual information that matches the specified depth and class of the screen, use XMatchVisualInfo. __ │

Status XMatchVisualInfo(display, screen, depth, class, vinfo_return)
Display *display;
int screen;
int depth;
int class;
XVisualInfo *vinfo_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen

Specifies the screen.

depth

Specifies the depth of the screen.

class

Specifies the class of the screen.

vinfo_return
Returns the matched visual information. │__

The XMatchVisualInfo function returns the visual information for a visual that matches the specified depth and class for a screen. Because multiple visuals that match the specified depth and class can exist, the exact visual chosen is undefined. If a visual is found, XMatchVisualInfo returns nonzero and the information on the visual to vinfo_return. Otherwise, when a visual is not found, XMatchVisualInfo returns zero.

16.8. Manipulating Images

Xlib provides several functions that perform basic operations on images. All operations on images are defined using an XImage structure, as defined in <X11/Xlib.h>. Because the number of different types of image formats can be very large, this hides details of image storage properly from applications.

This section describes the functions for generic operations on images. Manufacturers can provide very fast implementations of these for the formats frequently encountered on their hardware. These functions are neither sufficient nor desirable to use for general image processing. Rather, they are here to provide minimal functions on screen format images. The basic operations for getting and putting images are XGetImage and XPutImage.

Note that no functions have been defined, as yet, to read and write images to and from disk files.

The XImage structure describes an image as it exists in the client’s memory. The user can request that some of the members such as height, width, and xoffset be changed when the image is sent to the server. Note that bytes_per_line in concert with offset can be used to extract a subset of the image. Other members (for example, byte order, bitmap_unit, and so forth) are characteristics of both the image and the server. If these members differ between the image and the server, XPutImage makes the appropriate conversions. The first byte of the first line of plane n must be located at the address (data + (n * height * bytes_per_line)). For a description of the XImage structure, see section 8.7.

To allocate an XImage structure and initialize it with image format values from a display, use XCreateImage. __ │

XImage *XCreateImage(display, visual, depth, format, offset, data, width, height, bitmap_pad,
bytes_per_line
)
Display *display;
Visual *visual;
unsigned int depth;
int format;
int offset;
char *data;
unsigned int width;
unsigned int height;
int bitmap_pad;
int bytes_per_line;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

visual

Specifies the Visual structure.

depth

Specifies the depth of the image.

format

Specifies the format for the image. You can pass

XYBitmap, XYPixmap, or ZPixmap.

offset

Specifies the number of pixels to ignore at the

beginning of the scanline.

data

Specifies the image data.

width

Specifies the width of the image, in pixels.

height

Specifies the height of the image, in pixels.

bitmap_padSpecifies the quantum of a scanline (8, 16, or
32). In other words, the start of one scanline is
separated in client memory from the start of the
next scanline by an integer multiple of this many
bits.

bytes_per_line
Specifies the number of bytes in the client image
between the start of one scanline and the start of
the next. │__

The XCreateImage function allocates the memory needed for an XImage structure for the specified display but does not allocate space for the image itself. Rather, it initializes the structure byte-order, bit-order, and bitmap-unit values from the display and returns a pointer to the XImage structure. The red, green, and blue mask values are defined for Z format images only and are derived from the Visual structure passed in. Other values also are passed in. The offset permits the rapid displaying of the image without requiring each scanline to be shifted into position. If you pass a zero value in bytes_per_line, Xlib assumes that the scanlines are contiguous in memory and calculates the value of bytes_per_line itself.

Note that when the image is created using XCreateImage, XGetImage, or XSubImage, the destroy procedure that the XDestroyImage function calls frees both the image structure and the data pointed to by the image structure.

The basic functions used to get a pixel, set a pixel, create a subimage, and add a constant value to an image are defined in the image object. The functions in this section are really macro invocations of the functions in the image object and are defined in <X11/Xutil.h>.

To obtain a pixel value in an image, use XGetPixel. __ │

unsigned long XGetPixel(ximage, x, y)
XImage *ximage;
int x;
int y;

ximage

Specifies the image.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates. │__

The XGetPixel function returns the specified pixel from the named image. The pixel value is returned in normalized format (that is, the least significant byte of the long is the least significant byte of the pixel). The image must contain the x and y coordinates.

To set a pixel value in an image, use XPutPixel. __ │

XPutPixel(ximage, x, y, pixel)
XImage *ximage;
int x;
int y;
unsigned long pixel;

ximage

Specifies the image.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates.

pixel

Specifies the new pixel value. │__

The XPutPixel function overwrites the pixel in the named image with the specified pixel value. The input pixel value must be in normalized format (that is, the least significant byte of the long is the least significant byte of the pixel). The image must contain the x and y coordinates.

To create a subimage, use XSubImage. __ │

XImage *XSubImage(ximage, x, y, subimage_width, subimage_height)
XImage *ximage;
int x;
int y;
unsigned int subimage_width;
unsigned int subimage_height;

ximage

Specifies the image.

x

y

Specify the x and y coordinates.

subimage_width
Specifies the width of the new subimage, in pix-
els.

subimage_height
Specifies the height of the new subimage, in pix-
els. │__

The XSubImage function creates a new image that is a subsection of an existing one. It allocates the memory necessary for the new XImage structure and returns a pointer to the new image. The data is copied from the source image, and the image must contain the rectangle defined by x, y, subimage_width, and subimage_height.

To increment each pixel in an image by a constant value, use XAddPixel. __ │

XAddPixel(ximage, value)
XImage *ximage;
long value;

ximage

Specifies the image.

value

Specifies the constant value that is to be added. │__

The XAddPixel function adds a constant value to every pixel in an image. It is useful when you have a base pixel value from allocating color resources and need to manipulate the image to that form.

To deallocate the memory allocated in a previous call to XCreateImage, use XDestroyImage. __ │

XDestroyImage(ximage)
XImage *ximage;

ximage

Specifies the image. │__

The XDestroyImage function deallocates the memory associated with the XImage structure.

Note that when the image is created using XCreateImage, XGetImage, or XSubImage, the destroy procedure that this macro calls frees both the image structure and the data pointed to by the image structure.

16.9. Manipulating Bitmaps

Xlib provides functions that you can use to read a bitmap from a file, save a bitmap to a file, or create a bitmap. This section describes those functions that transfer bitmaps to and from the client’s file system, thus allowing their reuse in a later connection (for example, from an entirely different client or to a different display or server).

The X version 11 bitmap file format is: __ │

#define name_width width
#define name_height height
#define name_x_hot x
#define name_y_hot y
static unsigned char name_bits[] = { 0xNN,... } │__

The lines for the variables ending with _x_hot and _y_hot suffixes are optional because they are present only if a hotspot has been defined for this bitmap. The lines for the other variables are required. The word ‘‘unsigned’’ is optional; that is, the type of the _bits array can be ‘‘char’’ or ‘‘unsigned char’’. The _bits array must be large enough to contain the size bitmap. The bitmap unit is 8.

To read a bitmap from a file and store it in a pixmap, use XReadBitmapFile. __ │

int XReadBitmapFile(display, d, filename, width_return, height_return, bitmap_return, x_hot_return,
y_hot_return
)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
char *filename;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;
Pixmap *bitmap_return;
int *x_hot_return, *y_hot_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable that indicates the screen.

filename

Specifies the file name to use. The format of the

file name is operating-system dependent.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height values of the read in
bitmap file.

bitmap_return
Returns the bitmap that is created.

x_hot_return
y_hot_return

Return the hotspot coordinates. │__

The XReadBitmapFile function reads in a file containing a bitmap. The file is parsed in the encoding of the current locale. The ability to read other than the standard format is implementation-dependent. If the file cannot be opened, XReadBitmapFile returns BitmapOpenFailed. If the file can be opened but does not contain valid bitmap data, it returns BitmapFileInvalid. If insufficient working storage is allocated, it returns BitmapNoMemory. If the file is readable and valid, it returns BitmapSuccess.

XReadBitmapFile returns the bitmap’s height and width, as read from the file, to width_return and height_return. It then creates a pixmap of the appropriate size, reads the bitmap data from the file into the pixmap, and assigns the pixmap to the caller’s variable bitmap. The caller must free the bitmap using XFreePixmap when finished. If name_x_hot and name_y_hot exist, XReadBitmapFile returns them to x_hot_return and y_hot_return; otherwise, it returns −1,−1.

XReadBitmapFile can generate BadAlloc, BadDrawable, and BadGC errors.

To read a bitmap from a file and return it as data, use XReadBitmapFileData. __ │

int XReadBitmapFileData(filename, width_return, height_return, data_return, x_hot_return, y_hot_return)
char *filename;
unsigned int *width_return, *height_return;
unsigned char *data_return;
int *x_hot_return, *y_hot_return;

filename

Specifies the file name to use. The format of the

file name is operating-system dependent.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height values of the read in
bitmap file.

data_returnReturns the bitmap data.

x_hot_return
y_hot_return

Return the hotspot coordinates. │__

The XReadBitmapFileData function reads in a file containing a bitmap, in the same manner as XReadBitmapFile, but returns the data directly rather than creating a pixmap in the server. The bitmap data is returned in data_return; the client must free this storage when finished with it by calling XFree. The status and other return values are the same as for XReadBitmapFile.

To write out a bitmap from a pixmap to a file, use XWriteBitmapFile. __ │

int XWriteBitmapFile(display, filename, bitmap, width, height, x_hot, y_hot)
Display *display;
char *filename;
Pixmap bitmap;
unsigned int width, height;
int x_hot, y_hot;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

filename

Specifies the file name to use. The format of the

file name is operating-system dependent.

bitmap

Specifies the bitmap.

width

height

Specify the width and height.

x_hot

y_hot

Specify where to place the hotspot coordinates (or

−1,−1 if none are present) in the file. │__

The XWriteBitmapFile function writes a bitmap out to a file in the X Version 11 format. The name used in the output file is derived from the file name by deleting the directory prefix. The file is written in the encoding of the current locale. If the file cannot be opened for writing, it returns BitmapOpenFailed. If insufficient memory is allocated, XWriteBitmapFile returns BitmapNoMemory; otherwise, on no error, it returns BitmapSuccess. If x_hot and y_hot are not −1, −1, XWriteBitmapFile writes them out as the hotspot coordinates for the bitmap.

XWriteBitmapFile can generate BadDrawable and BadMatch errors.

To create a pixmap and then store bitmap-format data into it, use XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData. __ │

Pixmap XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData(display, d, data, width, height, fg, bg, depth)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
char *data;
unsigned int width, height;
unsigned long fg, bg;
unsigned int depth;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable that indicates the screen.

data

Specifies the data in bitmap format.

width

height

Specify the width and height.

fg

bg

Specify the foreground and background pixel values

to use.

depth

Specifies the depth of the pixmap. │__

The XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData function creates a pixmap of the given depth and then does a bitmap-format XPutImage of the data into it. The depth must be supported by the screen of the specified drawable, or a BadMatch error results.

XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData can generate BadAlloc, BadDrawable, BadGC, and BadValue errors.

To include a bitmap written out by XWriteBitmapFile in a program directly, as opposed to reading it in every time at run time, use XCreateBitmapFromData. __ │

Pixmap XCreateBitmapFromData(display, d, data, width, height)
Display *display;
Drawable d;
char *data;
unsigned int width, height;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable that indicates the screen.

data

Specifies the location of the bitmap data.

width

height

Specify the width and height. │__

The XCreateBitmapFromData function allows you to include in your C program (using #include) a bitmap file that was written out by XWriteBitmapFile (X version 11 format only) without reading in the bitmap file. The following example creates a gray bitmap:

#include "gray.bitmap"
Pixmap bitmap;
bitmap = XCreateBitmapFromData(display, window, gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height);

If insufficient working storage was allocated, XCreateBitmapFromData returns None. It is your responsibility to free the bitmap using XFreePixmap when finished.

XCreateBitmapFromData can generate BadAlloc and BadGC errors.

16.10. Using the Context Manager

The context manager provides a way of associating data with an X resource ID (mostly typically a window) in your program. Note that this is local to your program; the data is not stored in the server on a property list. Any amount of data in any number of pieces can be associated with a resource ID, and each piece of data has a type associated with it. The context manager requires knowledge of the resource ID and type to store or retrieve data.

Essentially, the context manager can be viewed as a two-dimensional, sparse array: one dimension is subscripted by the X resource ID and the other by a context type field. Each entry in the array contains a pointer to the data. Xlib provides context management functions with which you can save data values, get data values, delete entries, and create a unique context type. The symbols used are in <X11/Xutil.h>.

To save a data value that corresponds to a resource ID and context type, use XSaveContext. __ │

int XSaveContext(display, rid, context, data)

Display *display;

XID rid;
XContext context;
XPointer data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

rid

Specifies the resource ID with which the data is

associated.

context

Specifies the context type to which the data be-

longs.

data

Specifies the data to be associated with the win-

dow and type. │__

If an entry with the specified resource ID and type already exists, XSaveContext overrides it with the specified context. The XSaveContext function returns a nonzero error code if an error has occurred and zero otherwise. Possible errors are XCNOMEM (out of memory).

To get the data associated with a resource ID and type, use XFindContext. __ │

int XFindContext(display, rid, context, data_return)
Display *display;
XID rid;
XContext context;

XPointer *data_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

rid

Specifies the resource ID with which the data is

associated.

context

Specifies the context type to which the data be-

longs.

data_returnReturns the data. │__

Because it is a return value, the data is a pointer. The XFindContext function returns a nonzero error code if an error has occurred and zero otherwise. Possible errors are XCNOENT (context-not-found).

To delete an entry for a given resource ID and type, use XDeleteContext. __ │

int XDeleteContext(display, rid, context)
Display *display;
XID rid;
XContext context;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

rid

Specifies the resource ID with which the data is

associated.

context

Specifies the context type to which the data be-

longs. │__

The XDeleteContext function deletes the entry for the given resource ID and type from the data structure. This function returns the same error codes that XFindContext returns if called with the same arguments. XDeleteContext does not free the data whose address was saved.

To create a unique context type that may be used in subsequent calls to XSaveContext and XFindContext, use XUniqueContext. __ │

XContext XUniqueContext() │__

16

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Appendix A

Xlib Functions and Protocol Requests

This appendix provides two tables that relate to Xlib functions and the X protocol. The following table lists each Xlib function (in alphabetical order) and the corresponding protocol request that it generates.
Xlib Function Protocol Request

XActivateScreenSaver ForceScreenSaver
XAddHost ChangeHosts
XAddHosts ChangeHosts
XAddToSaveSet ChangeSaveSet
XAllocColor AllocColor
XAllocColorCells AllocColorCells
XAllocColorPlanes AllocColorPlanes
XAllocNamedColor AllocNamedColor
XAllowEvents AllowEvents
XAutoRepeatOff ChangeKeyboardControl
XAutoRepeatOn ChangeKeyboardControl
XBell Bell
XChangeActivePointerGrab ChangeActivePointerGrab
XChangeGC ChangeGC
XChangeKeyboardControl ChangeKeyboardControl
XChangeKeyboardMapping ChangeKeyboardMapping
XChangePointerControl ChangePointerControl
XChangeProperty ChangeProperty
XChangeSaveSet ChangeSaveSet
XChangeWindowAttributes ChangeWindowAttributes
XCirculateSubwindows CirculateWindow
XCirculateSubwindowsDown CirculateWindow
XCirculateSubwindowsUp CirculateWindow
XClearArea ClearArea
XClearWindow ClearArea
XConfigureWindow ConfigureWindow
XConvertSelection ConvertSelection
XCopyArea CopyArea
XCopyColormapAndFree CopyColormapAndFree
XCopyGC CopyGC
XCopyPlane CopyPlane
XCreateBitmapFromData CreateGC
CreatePixmap
FreeGC
PutImage
XCreateColormap CreateColormap
XCreateFontCursor CreateGlyphCursor
XCreateGC CreateGC
XCreateGlyphCursor CreateGlyphCursor
XCreatePixmap CreatePixmap
XCreatePixmapCursor CreateCursor
XCreatePixmapFromData CreateGC
CreatePixmap
FreeGC
PutImage
XCreateSimpleWindow CreateWindow
XCreateWindow CreateWindow
XDefineCursor ChangeWindowAttributes
XDeleteProperty DeleteProperty
XDestroySubwindows DestroySubwindows
XDestroyWindow DestroyWindow
XDisableAccessControl SetAccessControl
XDrawArc PolyArc
XDrawArcs PolyArc
XDrawImageString ImageText8
XDrawImageString16 ImageText16
XDrawLine PolySegment
XDrawLines PolyLine
XDrawPoint PolyPoint
XDrawPoints PolyPoint
XDrawRectangle PolyRectangle
XDrawRectangles PolyRectangle
XDrawSegments PolySegment
XDrawString PolyText8
XDrawString16 PolyText16
XDrawText PolyText8
XDrawText16 PolyText16
XEnableAccessControl SetAccessControl
XFetchBytes GetProperty
XFetchName GetProperty
XFillArc PolyFillArc
XFillArcs PolyFillArc
XFillPolygon FillPoly
XFillRectangle PolyFillRectangle
XFillRectangles PolyFillRectangle
XForceScreenSaver ForceScreenSaver
XFreeColormap FreeColormap
XFreeColors FreeColors
XFreeCursor FreeCursor
XFreeFont CloseFont
XFreeGC FreeGC
XFreePixmap FreePixmap
XGetAtomName GetAtomName
XGetClassHint GetProperty
XGetFontPath GetFontPath
XGetGeometry GetGeometry
XGetIconName GetProperty
XGetIconSizes GetProperty
XGetImage GetImage
XGetInputFocus GetInputFocus
XGetKeyboardControl GetKeyboardControl
XGetKeyboardMapping GetKeyboardMapping
XGetModifierMapping GetModifierMapping
XGetMotionEvents GetMotionEvents
XGetNormalHints GetProperty
XGetPointerControl GetPointerControl
XGetPointerMapping GetPointerMapping
XGetRGBColormaps GetProperty
XGetScreenSaver GetScreenSaver
XGetSelectionOwner GetSelectionOwner
XGetSizeHints GetProperty
XGetTextProperty GetProperty
XGetTransientForHint GetProperty
XGetWMClientMachine GetProperty
XGetWMColormapWindows GetProperty
InternAtom
XGetWMHints GetProperty
XGetWMIconName GetProperty
XGetWMName GetProperty
XGetWMNormalHints GetProperty
XGetWMProtocols GetProperty
InternAtom
XGetWMSizeHints GetProperty
XGetWindowAttributes GetWindowAttributes
GetGeometry
XGetWindowProperty GetProperty
XGetZoomHints GetProperty
XGrabButton GrabButton
XGrabKey GrabKey
XGrabKeyboard GrabKeyboard
XGrabPointer GrabPointer
XGrabServer GrabServer
XIconifyWindow InternAtom
SendEvent
XInitExtension QueryExtension
XInstallColormap InstallColormap
XInternAtom InternAtom
XKillClient KillClient
XListExtensions ListExtensions
XListFonts ListFonts
XListFontsWithInfo ListFontsWithInfo
XListHosts ListHosts
XListInstalledColormaps ListInstalledColormaps
XListProperties ListProperties
XLoadFont OpenFont
XLoadQueryFont OpenFont
QueryFont
XLookupColor LookupColor
XLowerWindow ConfigureWindow
XMapRaised ConfigureWindow
MapWindow
XMapSubwindows MapSubwindows
XMapWindow MapWindow
XMoveResizeWindow ConfigureWindow
XMoveWindow ConfigureWindow
XNoOp NoOperation
XOpenDisplay CreateGC
XParseColor LookupColor
XPutImage PutImage
XQueryBestCursor QueryBestSize
XQueryBestSize QueryBestSize
XQueryBestStipple QueryBestSize
XQueryBestTile QueryBestSize
XQueryColor QueryColors
XQueryColors QueryColors
XQueryExtension QueryExtension
XQueryFont QueryFont
XQueryKeymap QueryKeymap
XQueryPointer QueryPointer
XQueryTextExtents QueryTextExtents
XQueryTextExtents16 QueryTextExtents
XQueryTree QueryTree
XRaiseWindow ConfigureWindow
XReadBitmapFile CreateGC
CreatePixmap
FreeGC
PutImage
XRecolorCursor RecolorCursor
XReconfigureWMWindow ConfigureWindow
SendEvent
XRemoveFromSaveSet ChangeSaveSet
XRemoveHost ChangeHosts
XRemoveHosts ChangeHosts
XReparentWindow ReparentWindow
XResetScreenSaver ForceScreenSaver
XResizeWindow ConfigureWindow
XRestackWindows ConfigureWindow
XRotateBuffers RotateProperties
XRotateWindowProperties RotateProperties
XSelectInput ChangeWindowAttributes
XSendEvent SendEvent
XSetAccessControl SetAccessControl
XSetArcMode ChangeGC
XSetBackground ChangeGC
XSetClassHint ChangeProperty
XSetClipMask ChangeGC
XSetClipOrigin ChangeGC
XSetClipRectangles SetClipRectangles
XSetCloseDownMode SetCloseDownMode
XSetCommand ChangeProperty
XSetDashes SetDashes
XSetFillRule ChangeGC
XSetFillStyle ChangeGC
XSetFont ChangeGC
XSetFontPath SetFontPath
XSetForeground ChangeGC
XSetFunction ChangeGC
XSetGraphicsExposures ChangeGC
XSetIconName ChangeProperty
XSetIconSizes ChangeProperty
XSetInputFocus SetInputFocus
XSetLineAttributes ChangeGC
XSetModifierMapping SetModifierMapping
XSetNormalHints ChangeProperty
XSetPlaneMask ChangeGC
XSetPointerMapping SetPointerMapping
XSetRGBColormaps ChangeProperty
XSetScreenSaver SetScreenSaver
XSetSelectionOwner SetSelectionOwner
XSetSizeHints ChangeProperty
XSetStandardProperties ChangeProperty
XSetState ChangeGC
XSetStipple ChangeGC
XSetSubwindowMode ChangeGC
XSetTextProperty ChangeProperty
XSetTile ChangeGC
XSetTransientForHint ChangeProperty
XSetTSOrigin ChangeGC
XSetWMClientMachine ChangeProperty
XSetWMColormapWindows ChangeProperty
InternAtom
XSetWMHints ChangeProperty
XSetWMIconName ChangeProperty
XSetWMName ChangeProperty
XSetWMNormalHints ChangeProperty
XSetWMProperties ChangeProperty
XSetWMProtocols ChangeProperty
InternAtom
XSetWMSizeHints ChangeProperty
XSetWindowBackground ChangeWindowAttributes
XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap ChangeWindowAttributes
XSetWindowBorder ChangeWindowAttributes
XSetWindowBorderPixmap ChangeWindowAttributes
XSetWindowBorderWidth ConfigureWindow
XSetWindowColormap ChangeWindowAttributes
XSetZoomHints ChangeProperty
XStoreBuffer ChangeProperty
XStoreBytes ChangeProperty
XStoreColor StoreColors
XStoreColors StoreColors
XStoreName ChangeProperty
XStoreNamedColor StoreNamedColor
XSync GetInputFocus
XSynchronize GetInputFocus
XTranslateCoordinates TranslateCoordinates
XUndefineCursor ChangeWindowAttributes
XUngrabButton UngrabButton
XUngrabKey UngrabKey
XUngrabKeyboard UngrabKeyboard
XUngrabPointer UngrabPointer
XUngrabServer UngrabServer
XUninstallColormap UninstallColormap
XUnloadFont CloseFont
XUnmapSubwindows UnmapSubwindows
XUnmapWindow UnmapWindow
XWarpPointer WarpPointer
XWithdrawWindow SendEvent
UnmapWindow

17

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1
The following table lists each X protocol request (in alphabetical order) and the Xlib functions that reference it.
Protocol Request Xlib Function

AllocColor XAllocColor
AllocColorCells XAllocColorCells
AllocColorPlanes XAllocColorPlanes
AllocNamedColor XAllocNamedColor
AllowEvents XAllowEvents
Bell XBell
ChangeActivePointerGrab XChangeActivePointerGrab
ChangeGC XChangeGC
XSetArcMode
XSetBackground
XSetClipMask
XSetClipOrigin
XSetFillRule
XSetFillStyle
XSetFont
XSetForeground
XSetFunction
XSetGraphicsExposures
XSetLineAttributes
XSetPlaneMask
XSetState
XSetStipple
XSetSubwindowMode
XSetTile
XSetTSOrigin
ChangeHosts XAddHost
XAddHosts
XRemoveHost
XRemoveHosts
ChangeKeyboardControl XAutoRepeatOff
XAutoRepeatOn
XChangeKeyboardControl
ChangeKeyboardMapping XChangeKeyboardMapping
ChangePointerControl XChangePointerControl
ChangeProperty XChangeProperty
XSetClassHint
XSetCommand
XSetIconName
XSetIconSizes
XSetNormalHints
XSetRGBColormaps
XSetSizeHints
XSetStandardProperties
XSetTextProperty
XSetTransientForHint
XSetWMClientMachine
XSetWMColormapWindows
XSetWMHints
XSetWMIconName
XSetWMName
XSetWMNormalHints
XSetWMProperties
XSetWMProtocols
XSetWMSizeHints
XSetZoomHints
XStoreBuffer
XStoreBytes
XStoreName
ChangeSaveSet XAddToSaveSet
XChangeSaveSet
XRemoveFromSaveSet
ChangeWindowAttributes XChangeWindowAttributes
XDefineCursor
XSelectInput
XSetWindowBackground
XSetWindowBackgroundPixmap
XSetWindowBorder
XSetWindowBorderPixmap
XSetWindowColormap
XUndefineCursor
CirculateWindow XCirculateSubwindowsDown
XCirculateSubwindowsUp
XCirculateSubwindows
ClearArea XClearArea
XClearWindow
CloseFont XFreeFont
XUnloadFont
ConfigureWindow XConfigureWindow
XLowerWindow
XMapRaised
XMoveResizeWindow
XMoveWindow
XRaiseWindow
XReconfigureWMWindow
XResizeWindow
XRestackWindows
XSetWindowBorderWidth
ConvertSelection XConvertSelection
CopyArea XCopyArea
CopyColormapAndFree XCopyColormapAndFree
CopyGC XCopyGC
CopyPlane XCopyPlane
CreateColormap XCreateColormap
CreateCursor XCreatePixmapCursor
CreateGC XCreateGC
XCreateBitmapFromData
XCreatePixmapFromData
XOpenDisplay
XReadBitmapFile
CreateGlyphCursor XCreateFontCursor
XCreateGlyphCursor
CreatePixmap XCreatePixmap
XCreateBitmapFromData
XCreatePixmapFromData
XReadBitmapFile
CreateWindow XCreateSimpleWindow
XCreateWindow
DeleteProperty XDeleteProperty
DestroySubwindows XDestroySubwindows
DestroyWindow XDestroyWindow
FillPoly XFillPolygon
ForceScreenSaver XActivateScreenSaver
XForceScreenSaver
XResetScreenSaver
FreeColormap XFreeColormap
FreeColors XFreeColors
FreeCursor XFreeCursor
FreeGC XFreeGC
XCreateBitmapFromData
XCreatePixmapFromData
XReadBitmapFile
FreePixmap XFreePixmap
GetAtomName XGetAtomName
GetFontPath XGetFontPath
GetGeometry XGetGeometry
XGetWindowAttributes
GetImage XGetImage
GetInputFocus XGetInputFocus
XSync
XSynchronize
GetKeyboardControl XGetKeyboardControl
GetKeyboardMapping XGetKeyboardMapping
GetModifierMapping XGetModifierMapping
GetMotionEvents XGetMotionEvents
GetPointerControl XGetPointerControl
GetPointerMapping XGetPointerMapping
GetProperty XFetchBytes
XFetchName
XGetClassHint
XGetIconName
XGetIconSizes
XGetNormalHints
XGetRGBColormaps
XGetSizeHints
XGetTextProperty
XGetTransientForHint
XGetWMClientMachine
XGetWMColormapWindows
XGetWMHints
XGetWMIconName
XGetWMName
XGetWMNormalHints
XGetWMProtocols
XGetWMSizeHints
XGetWindowProperty
XGetZoomHints
GetSelectionOwner XGetSelectionOwner
GetWindowAttributes XGetWindowAttributes
GrabButton XGrabButton
GrabKey XGrabKey
GrabKeyboard XGrabKeyboard
GrabPointer XGrabPointer
GrabServer XGrabServer
ImageText8 XDrawImageString
ImageText16 XDrawImageString16
InstallColormap XInstallColormap
InternAtom XGetWMColormapWindows
XGetWMProtocols
XIconifyWindow
XInternAtom
XSetWMColormapWindows
XSetWMProtocols
KillClient XKillClient
ListExtensions XListExtensions
ListFonts XListFonts
ListFontsWithInfo XListFontsWithInfo
ListHosts XListHosts
ListInstalledColormaps XListInstalledColormaps
ListProperties XListProperties
LookupColor XLookupColor
XParseColor
MapSubwindows XMapSubwindows
MapWindow XMapRaised
XMapWindow
NoOperation XNoOp
OpenFont XLoadFont
XLoadQueryFont
PolyArc XDrawArc
XDrawArcs
PolyFillArc XFillArc
XFillArcs
PolyFillRectangle XFillRectangle
XFillRectangles
PolyLine XDrawLines
PolyPoint XDrawPoint
XDrawPoints
PolyRectangle XDrawRectangle
XDrawRectangles
PolySegment XDrawLine
XDrawSegments
PolyText8 XDrawString
XDrawText
PolyText16 XDrawString16
XDrawText16
PutImage XPutImage
XCreateBitmapFromData
XCreatePixmapFromData
XReadBitmapFile
QueryBestSize XQueryBestCursor
XQueryBestSize
XQueryBestStipple
XQueryBestTile
QueryColors XQueryColor
XQueryColors
QueryExtension XInitExtension
XQueryExtension
QueryFont XLoadQueryFont
XQueryFont
QueryKeymap XQueryKeymap
QueryPointer XQueryPointer
QueryTextExtents XQueryTextExtents
XQueryTextExtents16
QueryTree XQueryTree
RecolorCursor XRecolorCursor
ReparentWindow XReparentWindow
RotateProperties XRotateBuffers
XRotateWindowProperties
SendEvent XIconifyWindow
XReconfigureWMWindow
XSendEvent
XWithdrawWindow
SetAccessControl XDisableAccessControl
XEnableAccessControl
XSetAccessControl
SetClipRectangles XSetClipRectangles
SetCloseDownMode XSetCloseDownMode
SetDashes XSetDashes
SetFontPath XSetFontPath
SetInputFocus XSetInputFocus
SetModifierMapping XSetModifierMapping
SetPointerMapping XSetPointerMapping
SetScreenSaver XGetScreenSaver
XSetScreenSaver
SetSelectionOwner XSetSelectionOwner
StoreColors XStoreColor
XStoreColors
StoreNamedColor XStoreNamedColor
TranslateCoordinates XTranslateCoordinates
UngrabButton XUngrabButton
UngrabKey XUngrabKey
UngrabKeyboard XUngrabKeyboard
UngrabPointer XUngrabPointer
UngrabServer XUngrabServer
UninstallColormap XUninstallColormap
UnmapSubwindows XUnmapSubWindows
UnmapWindow XUnmapWindow
XWithdrawWindow
WarpPointer XWarpPointer

18

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Appendix B

X Font Cursors

The following are the available cursors that can be used with XCreateFontCursor.

#define XC_X_cursor 0

#define XC_ll_angle 76

#define XC_arrow 2

#define XC_lr_angle 78

#define XC_based_arrow_down 4

#define XC_man 80

#define XC_based_arrow_up 6

#define XC_middlebutton 82

#define XC_boat 8

#define XC_mouse 84

#define XC_bogosity 10

#define XC_pencil 86

#define XC_bottom_left_corner 12#define XC_pirate 88
#define XC_bottom_right_corner 14#define XC_plus 90

#define XC_bottom_side 16

#define XC_question_arrow 92

#define XC_bottom_tee 18

#define XC_right_ptr 94

#define XC_box_spiral 20

#define XC_right_side 96

#define XC_center_ptr 22

#define XC_right_tee 98

#define XC_circle 24

#define XC_rightbutton 100

#define XC_clock 26

#define XC_rtl_logo 102

#define XC_coffee_mug 28

#define XC_sailboat 104

#define XC_cross 30

#define XC_sb_down_arrow 106

#define XC_cross_reverse 32

#define XC_sb_h_double_arrow 108

#define XC_crosshair 34

#define XC_sb_left_arrow 110

#define XC_diamond_cross 36

#define XC_sb_right_arrow 112

#define XC_dot 38

#define XC_sb_up_arrow 114

#define XC_dot_box_mask 40

#define XC_sb_v_double_arrow 116

#define XC_double_arrow 42

#define XC_shuttle 118

#define XC_draft_large 44

#define XC_sizing 120

#define XC_draft_small 46

#define XC_spider 122

#define XC_draped_box 48

#define XC_spraycan 124

#define XC_exchange 50

#define XC_star 126

#define XC_fleur 52

#define XC_target 128

#define XC_gobbler 54

#define XC_tcross 130

#define XC_gumby 56

#define XC_top_left_arrow 132

#define XC_hand1 58

#define XC_top_left_corner 134

#define XC_hand2 60

#define XC_top_right_corner 136

#define XC_heart 62

#define XC_top_side 138

#define XC_icon 64

#define XC_top_tee 140

#define XC_iron_cross 66

#define XC_trek 142

#define XC_left_ptr 68

#define XC_ul_angle 144

#define XC_left_side 70

#define XC_umbrella 146

#define XC_left_tee 72

#define XC_ur_angle 148

#define XC_leftbutton 74

#define XC_watch 150

#define XC_xterm 152

19

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Appendix C

Extensions

Because X can evolve by extensions to the core protocol, it is important that extensions not be perceived as second-class citizens. At some point, your favorite extensions may be adopted as additional parts of the X Standard.

Therefore, there should be little to distinguish the use of an extension from that of the core protocol. To avoid having to initialize extensions explicitly in application programs, it is also important that extensions perform lazy evaluations, automatically initializing themselves when called for the first time.

This appendix describes techniques for writing extensions to Xlib that will run at essentially the same performance as the core protocol requests.

Note

It is expected that a given extension to X consists of multiple requests. Defining 10 new features as 10 separate extensions is a bad practice. Rather, they should be packaged into a single extension and should use minor opcodes to distinguish the requests.

The symbols and macros used for writing stubs to Xlib are listed in <X11/Xlibint.h>.

Basic Protocol Support Routines

The basic protocol requests for extensions are XQueryExtension and XListExtensions. __ │

Bool XQueryExtension(display, name, major_opcode_return, first_event_return, first_error_return)
Display *display;
char *name;
int *major_opcode_return;
int *first_event_return;
int *first_error_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

name

Specifies the extension name.

major_opcode_return
Returns the major opcode.

first_event_return
Returns the first event code, if any.

first_error_return
Returns the first error code, if any. │__

The XQueryExtension function determines if the named extension is present. If the extension is not present, XQueryExtension returns False; otherwise, it returns True. If the extension is present, XQueryExtension returns the major opcode for the extension to major_opcode_return; otherwise, it returns zero. Any minor opcode and the request formats are specific to the extension. If the extension involves additional event types, XQueryExtension returns the base event type code to first_event_return; otherwise, it returns zero. The format of the events is specific to the extension. If the extension involves additional error codes, XQueryExtension returns the base error code to first_error_return; otherwise, it returns zero. The format of additional data in the errors is specific to the extension.

If the extension name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding the result is implementation-dependent. Uppercase and lowercase matter; the strings ‘‘thing’’, ‘‘Thing’’, and ‘‘thinG’’ are all considered different names. __ │

char **XListExtensions(display, nextensions_return)
Display *display;
int *nextensions_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

nextensions_return
Returns the number of extensions listed. │__

The XListExtensions function returns a list of all extensions supported by the server. If the data returned by the server is in the Latin Portable Character Encoding, then the returned strings are in the Host Portable Character Encoding. Otherwise, the result is implementation-dependent. __ │

XFreeExtensionList(list)
char **list;

list

Specifies the list of extension names. │__

The XFreeExtensionList function frees the memory allocated by XListExtensions.

Hooking into Xlib

These functions allow you to hook into the library. They are not normally used by application programmers but are used by people who need to extend the core X protocol and the X library interface. The functions, which generate protocol requests for X, are typically called stubs.

In extensions, stubs first should check to see if they have initialized themselves on a connection. If they have not, they then should call XInitExtension to attempt to initialize themselves on the connection.

If the extension needs to be informed of GC/font allocation or deallocation or if the extension defines new event types, the functions described here allow the extension to be called when these events occur.

The XExtCodes structure returns the information from XInitExtension and is defined in <X11/Xlib.h>: __ │

typedef struct _XExtCodes {

/* public to extension, cannot be changed */

int extension;

/* extension number */

int major_opcode;

/* major op-code assigned by server */

int first_event;

/* first event number for the extension */

int first_error;

/* first error number for the extension */

} XExtCodes; │__ __ │

XExtCodes *XInitExtension(display, name)
Display *display;
char *name;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

name

Specifies the extension name. │__

The XInitExtension function determines if the named extension exists. Then, it allocates storage for maintaining the information about the extension on the connection, chains this onto the extension list for the connection, and returns the information the stub implementor will need to access the extension. If the extension does not exist, XInitExtension returns NULL.

If the extension name is not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent. Uppercase and lowercase matter; the strings ‘‘thing’’, ‘‘Thing’’, and ‘‘thinG’’ are all considered different names.

The extension number in the XExtCodes structure is needed in the other calls that follow. This extension number is unique only to a single connection. __ │

XExtCodes *XAddExtension(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

For local Xlib extensions, the XAddExtension function allocates the XExtCodes structure, bumps the extension number count, and chains the extension onto the extension list. (This permits extensions to Xlib without requiring server extensions.)

Hooks into the Library

These functions allow you to define procedures that are to be called when various circumstances occur. The procedures include the creation of a new GC for a connection, the copying of a GC, the freeing of a GC, the creating and freeing of fonts, the conversion of events defined by extensions to and from wire format, and the handling of errors.

All of these functions return the previous procedure defined for this extension. __ │

int (*XESetCloseDisplay(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when the display

is closed. │__

The XESetCloseDisplay function defines a procedure to be called whenever XCloseDisplay is called. It returns any previously defined procedure, usually NULL.

When XCloseDisplay is called, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, codes)

Display *display;

XExtCodes *codes; │__ __ │

int (*XESetCreateGC(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when a GC is

closed. │__

The XESetCreateGC function defines a procedure to be called whenever a new GC is created. It returns any previously defined procedure, usually NULL.

When a GC is created, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, gc, codes)

Display *display;

GC gc;

XExtCodes *codes; │__ __ │

int (*XESetCopyGC(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when GC components

are copied. │__

The XESetCopyGC function defines a procedure to be called whenever a GC is copied. It returns any previously defined procedure, usually NULL.

When a GC is copied, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, gc, codes)

Display *display;

GC gc;

XExtCodes *codes; │__ __ │

int (*XESetFreeGC(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when a GC is

freed. │__

The XESetFreeGC function defines a procedure to be called whenever a GC is freed. It returns any previously defined procedure, usually NULL.

When a GC is freed, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, gc, codes)

Display *display;

GC gc;

XExtCodes *codes; │__ __ │

int (*XESetCreateFont(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when a font is

created. │__

The XESetCreateFont function defines a procedure to be called whenever XLoadQueryFont and XQueryFont are called. It returns any previously defined procedure, usually NULL.

When XLoadQueryFont or XQueryFont is called, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, fs, codes)

Display *display;

XFontStruct *fs;

XExtCodes *codes; │__ __ │

int (*XESetFreeFont(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when a font is

freed. │__

The XESetFreeFont function defines a procedure to be called whenever XFreeFont is called. It returns any previously defined procedure, usually NULL.

When XFreeFont is called, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, fs, codes)

Display *display;

XFontStruct *fs;

XExtCodes *codes; │__

The XESetWireToEvent and XESetEventToWire functions allow you to define new events to the library. An XEvent structure always has a type code (type int) as the first component. This uniquely identifies what kind of event it is. The second component is always the serial number (type unsigned long) of the last request processed by the server. The third component is always a Boolean (type Bool) indicating whether the event came from a SendEvent protocol request. The fourth component is always a pointer to the display the event was read from. The fifth component is always a resource ID of one kind or another, usually a window, carefully selected to be useful to toolkit dispatchers. The fifth component should always exist, even if the event does not have a natural destination; if there is no value from the protocol to put in this component, initialize it to zero.

Note

There is an implementation limit such that your host event structure size cannot be bigger than the size of the XEvent union of structures. There also is no way to guarantee that more than 24 elements or 96 characters in the structure will be fully portable between machines. __ │

int (*XESetWireToEvent(display, event_number, proc))()
Display *display;
int event_number;
Status (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_number
Specifies the event code.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when converting an

event. │__

The XESetWireToEvent function defines a procedure to be called when an event needs to be converted from wire format (xEvent) to host format (XEvent). The event number defines which protocol event number to install a conversion procedure for. XESetWireToEvent returns any previously defined procedure.

Note

You can replace a core event conversion function with one of your own, although this is not encouraged. It would, however, allow you to intercept a core event and modify it before being placed in the queue or otherwise examined.

When Xlib needs to convert an event from wire format to host format, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

Status (*proc)(display, re, event)

Display *display;

XEvent *re;

xEvent *event; │__

Your procedure must return status to indicate if the conversion succeeded. The re argument is a pointer to where the host format event should be stored, and the event argument is the 32-byte wire event structure. In the XEvent structure you are creating, you must fill in the five required members of the event structure. You should fill in the type member with the type specified for the xEvent structure. You should copy all other members from the xEvent structure (wire format) to the XEvent structure (host format). Your conversion procedure should return True if the event should be placed in the queue or False if it should not be placed in the queue.

To initialize the serial number component of the event, call _XSetLastRequestRead with the event and use the return value. __ │

unsigned long _XSetLastRequestRead(display, rep)
Display *display;
xGenericReply *rep;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

rep

Specifies the wire event structure. │__

The _XSetLastRequestRead function computes and returns a complete serial number from the partial serial number in the event. __ │

Status (*XESetEventToWire(display, event_number, proc))()
Display *display;
int event_number;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

event_number
Specifies the event code.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when converting an

event. │__

The XESetEventToWire function defines a procedure to be called when an event needs to be converted from host format (XEvent) to wire format (xEvent) form. The event number defines which protocol event number to install a conversion procedure for. XESetEventToWire returns any previously defined procedure. It returns zero if the conversion fails or nonzero otherwise.

Note

You can replace a core event conversion function with one of your own, although this is not encouraged. It would, however, allow you to intercept a core event and modify it before being sent to another client.

When Xlib needs to convert an event from host format to wire format, your procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

(*proc)(display, re, event)

Display *display;

XEvent *re;

xEvent *event; │__

The re argument is a pointer to the host format event, and the event argument is a pointer to where the 32-byte wire event structure should be stored. You should fill in the type with the type from the XEvent structure. All other members then should be copied from the host format to the xEvent structure. __ │

Bool (*XESetWireToError(display, error_number, proc)()
Display *display;
int error_number;
Bool (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

error_number
Specifies the error code.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when an error is

received. │__

The XESetWireToError function defines a procedure to be called when an extension error needs to be converted from wire format to host format. The error number defines which protocol error code to install the conversion procedure for. XESetWireToError returns any previously defined procedure.

Use this function for extension errors that contain additional error values beyond those in a core X error, when multiple wire errors must be combined into a single Xlib error, or when it is necessary to intercept an X error before it is otherwise examined.

When Xlib needs to convert an error from wire format to host format, the procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

Bool (*proc)(display, he, we)

Display *display;

XErrorEvent *he;

xError *we; │__

The he argument is a pointer to where the host format error should be stored. The structure pointed at by he is guaranteed to be as large as an XEvent structure and so can be cast to a type larger than an XErrorEvent to store additional values. If the error is to be completely ignored by Xlib (for example, several protocol error structures will be combined into one Xlib error), then the function should return False; otherwise, it should return True. __ │

int (*XESetError(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when an error is

received. │__

Inside Xlib, there are times that you may want to suppress the calling of the external error handling when an error occurs. This allows status to be returned on a call at the cost of the call being synchronous (though most such functions are query operations, in any case, and are typically programmed to be synchronous).

When Xlib detects a protocol error in _XReply, it calls your procedure with these arguments: __ │

int (*proc)(display, err, codes, ret_code)

Display *display;

xError *err;

XExtCodes *codes;

int *ret_code; │__

The err argument is a pointer to the 32-byte wire format error. The codes argument is a pointer to the extension codes structure. The ret_code argument is the return code you may want _XReply returned to.

If your procedure returns a zero value, the error is not suppressed, and the client’s error handler is called. (For further information, see section 11.8.2.) If your procedure returns nonzero, the error is suppressed, and _XReply returns the value of ret_code. __ │

char *(*XESetErrorString(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
char *(*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call to obtain an error

string. │__

The XGetErrorText function returns a string to the user for an error. XESetErrorString allows you to define a procedure to be called that should return a pointer to the error message. The following is an example. __ │

(*proc)(display, code, codes, buffer, nbytes)

Display *display;

int code;

XExtCodes *codes;

char *buffer;

int nbytes; │__

Your procedure is called with the error code for every error detected. You should copy nbytes of a null-terminated string containing the error message into buffer. __ │

void (*XESetPrintErrorValues(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
void (*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when an error is

printed. │__

The XESetPrintErrorValues function defines a procedure to be called when an extension error is printed, to print the error values. Use this function for extension errors that contain additional error values beyond those in a core X error. It returns any previously defined procedure.

When Xlib needs to print an error, the procedure is called with these arguments: __ │

void (*proc)(display, ev, fp)

Display *display;

XErrorEvent *ev;

void *fp; │__

The structure pointed at by ev is guaranteed to be as large as an XEvent structure and so can be cast to a type larger than an XErrorEvent to obtain additional values set by using XESetWireToError. The underlying type of the fp argument is system dependent; on a POSIX-compliant system, fp should be cast to type FILE*. __ │

int (*XESetFlushGC(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int *(*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when a GC is

flushed. │__

The procedure set by the XESetFlushGC function has the same interface as the procedure set by the XESetCopyGC function, but is called when a GC cache needs to be updated in the server. __ │

int (*XESetBeforeFlush(display, extension, proc))()
Display *display;
int extension;
int *(*proc)();

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

extension

Specifies the extension number.

proc

Specifies the procedure to call when a buffer is

flushed. │__

The XESetBeforeFlush function defines a procedure to be called when data is about to be sent to the server. When data is about to be sent, your procedure is called one or more times with these arguments: __ │

void (*proc)(display, codes, data, len)

Display *display;

XExtCodes *codes;

char *data;

long len; │__

The data argument specifies a portion of the outgoing data buffer, and its length in bytes is specified by the len argument. Your procedure must not alter the contents of the data and must not do additional protocol requests to the same display.

Hooks onto Xlib Data Structures

Various Xlib data structures have provisions for extension procedures to chain extension supplied data onto a list. These structures are GC, Visual, Screen, ScreenFormat, Display, and XFontStruct. Because the list pointer is always the first member in the structure, a single set of procedures can be used to manipulate the data on these lists.

The following structure is used in the functions in this section and is defined in <X11/Xlib.h>: __ │

typedef struct _XExtData {

int number;

/* number returned by XInitExtension */

struct _XExtData *next;

/* next item on list of data for structure */

int (*free_private)();

/* if defined, called to free private */

XPointer private_data;

/* data private to this extension. */

} XExtData; │__

When any of the data structures listed above are freed, the list is walked, and the structure’s free procedure (if any) is called. If free is NULL, then the library frees both the data pointed to by the private_data member and the structure itself. __ │

union {Display *display;

GC gc;

Visual *visual;

Screen *screen;

ScreenFormat *pixmap_format;

XFontStruct *font } XEDataObject; │__ __ │

XExtData **XEHeadOfExtensionList(object)

XEDataObject object;

object

Specifies the object. │__

The XEHeadOfExtensionList function returns a pointer to the list of extension structures attached to the specified object. In concert with XAddToExtensionList, XEHeadOfExtensionList allows an extension to attach arbitrary data to any of the structures of types contained in XEDataObject. __ │

XAddToExtensionList(structure, ext_data)
XExtData **structure;
XExtData *ext_data;

structure

Specifies the extension list.

ext_data

Specifies the extension data structure to add. │__

The structure argument is a pointer to one of the data structures enumerated above. You must initialize ext_data->number with the extension number before calling this function. __ │

XExtData *XFindOnExtensionList(structure, number)
struct _XExtData **structure;
int number;

structure

Specifies the extension list.

number

Specifies the extension number from XInitExten-

sion. │__

The XFindOnExtensionList function returns the first extension data structure for the extension numbered number. It is expected that an extension will add at most one extension data structure to any single data structure’s extension data list. There is no way to find additional structures.

The XAllocID macro, which allocates and returns a resource ID, is defined in <X11/Xlib.h>. __ │

XAllocID(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

This macro is a call through the Display structure to an internal resource ID allocator. It returns a resource ID that you can use when creating new resources.

The XAllocIDs macro allocates and returns an array of resource ID. __ │

XAllocIDs(display, ids_return, count)
Display *display;
XID *ids_return;
int count;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

ids_returnReturns the resource IDs.

rep

Specifies the number of resource IDs requested. │__

This macro is a call through the Display structure to an internal resource ID allocator. It returns resource IDs to the array supplied by the caller. To correctly handle automatic reuse of resource IDs, you must call XAllocIDs when requesting multiple resource IDs. This call might generate protocol requests.

GC Caching

GCs are cached by the library to allow merging of independent change requests to the same GC into single protocol requests. This is typically called a write-back cache. Any extension procedure whose behavior depends on the contents of a GC must flush the GC cache to make sure the server has up-to-date contents in its GC.

The FlushGC macro checks the dirty bits in the library’s GC structure and calls _XFlushGCCache if any elements have changed. The FlushGC macro is defined as follows: __ │

FlushGC(display, gc)
Display *display;
GC gc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC. │__

Note that if you extend the GC to add additional resource ID components, you should ensure that the library stub sends the change request immediately. This is because a client can free a resource immediately after using it, so if you only stored the value in the cache without forcing a protocol request, the resource might be destroyed before being set into the GC. You can use the _XFlushGCCache procedure to force the cache to be flushed. The _XFlushGCCache procedure is defined as follows: __ │

_XFlushGCCache(display, gc)
Display *display;
GC gc;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

gc

Specifies the GC. │__

Graphics Batching

If you extend X to add more poly graphics primitives, you may be able to take advantage of facilities in the library to allow back-to-back single calls to be transformed into poly requests. This may dramatically improve performance of programs that are not written using poly requests. A pointer to an xReq, called last_req in the display structure, is the last request being processed. By checking that the last request type, drawable, gc, and other options are the same as the new one and that there is enough space left in the buffer, you may be able to just extend the previous graphics request by extending the length field of the request and appending the data to the buffer. This can improve performance by five times or more in naive programs. For example, here is the source for the XDrawPoint stub. (Writing extension stubs is discussed in the next section.) __ │

#include <X11/Xlibint.h>

/* precompute the maximum size of batching request allowed */

static int size = sizeof(xPolyPointReq) + EPERBATCH * sizeof(xPoint);

XDrawPoint(dpy, d, gc, x, y)
register Display *dpy;
Drawable d;
GC gc;
int x, y; /* INT16 */
{
xPoint *point;
LockDisplay(dpy);
FlushGC(dpy, gc);
{
register xPolyPointReq *req = (xPolyPointReq *) dpy->last_req;
/* if same as previous request, with same drawable, batch requests */
if (
(req->reqType == X_PolyPoint)
&& (req->drawable == d)
&& (req->gc == gc->gid)
&& (req->coordMode == CoordModeOrigin)
&& ((dpy->bufptr + sizeof (xPoint)) <= dpy->bufmax)
&& (((char *)dpy->bufptr - (char *)req) < size) ) {
point = (xPoint *) dpy->bufptr;
req->length += sizeof (xPoint) >> 2;
dpy->bufptr += sizeof (xPoint);
}

else {
GetReqExtra(PolyPoint, 4, req); /* 1 point = 4 bytes */
req->drawable = d;
req->gc = gc->gid;
req->coordMode = CoordModeOrigin;
point = (xPoint *) (req + 1);
}
point->x = x;
point->y = y;
}
UnlockDisplay(dpy);
SyncHandle();
} │__

To keep clients from generating very long requests that may monopolize the server, there is a symbol defined in <X11/Xlibint.h> of EPERBATCH on the number of requests batched. Most of the performance benefit occurs in the first few merged requests. Note that FlushGC is called before picking up the value of last_req, because it may modify this field.

Writing Extension Stubs

All X requests always contain the length of the request, expressed as a 16-bit quantity of 32 bits. This means that a single request can be no more than 256K bytes in length. Some servers may not support single requests of such a length. The value of dpy->max_request_size contains the maximum length as defined by the server implementation. For further information, see ‘‘X Window System Protocol.’’

Requests, Replies, and Xproto.h

The <X11/Xproto.h> file contains three sets of definitions that are of interest to the stub implementor: request names, request structures, and reply structures.

You need to generate a file equivalent to <X11/Xproto.h> for your extension and need to include it in your stub procedure. Each stub procedure also must include <X11/Xlibint.h>.

The identifiers are deliberately chosen in such a way that, if the request is called X_DoSomething, then its request structure is xDoSomethingReq, and its reply is xDoSomethingReply. The GetReq family of macros, defined in <X11/Xlibint.h>, takes advantage of this naming scheme.

For each X request, there is a definition in <X11/Xproto.h> that looks similar to this:

#define X_DoSomething 42

In your extension header file, this will be a minor opcode, instead of a major opcode.

Request Format

Every request contains an 8-bit major opcode and a 16-bit length field expressed in units of 4 bytes. Every request consists of 4 bytes of header (containing the major opcode, the length field, and a data byte) followed by zero or more additional bytes of data. The length field defines the total length of the request, including the header. The length field in a request must equal the minimum length required to contain the request. If the specified length is smaller or larger than the required length, the server should generate a BadLength error. Unused bytes in a request are not required to be zero. Extensions should be designed in such a way that long protocol requests can be split up into smaller requests, if it is possible to exceed the maximum request size of the server. The protocol guarantees the maximum request size to be no smaller than 4096 units (16384 bytes).

Major opcodes 128 through 255 are reserved for extensions. Extensions are intended to contain multiple requests, so extension requests typically have an additional minor opcode encoded in the second data byte in the request header, but the placement and interpretation of this minor opcode as well as all other fields in extension requests are not defined by the core protocol. Every request is implicitly assigned a sequence number (starting with one) used in replies, errors, and events.

To help but not cure portability problems to certain machines, the B16 and B32 macros have been defined so that they can become bitfield specifications on some machines. For example, on a Cray, these should be used for all 16-bit and 32-bit quantities, as discussed below.

Most protocol requests have a corresponding structure typedef in <X11/Xproto.h>, which looks like: __ │

typedef struct _DoSomethingReq {

CARD8 reqType;

/* X_DoSomething */

CARD8 someDatum;

/* used differently in different requests */

CARD16 length B16;

/* total # of bytes in request, divided by 4 */

...

/* request-specific data */

...

} xDoSomethingReq; │__

If a core protocol request has a single 32-bit argument, you need not declare a request structure in your extension header file. Instead, such requests use the xResourceReq structure in <X11/Xproto.h>. This structure is used for any request whose single argument is a Window, Pixmap, Drawable, GContext, Font, Cursor, Colormap, Atom, or VisualID. __ │

typedef struct _ResourceReq {

CARD8 reqType;

/* the request type, e.g. X_DoSomething */

BYTE pad;

/* not used */

CARD16 length B16;

/* 2 (= total # of bytes in request, divided by 4) */

CARD32 id B32;

/* the Window, Drawable, Font, GContext, etc. */

} xResourceReq; │__

If convenient, you can do something similar in your extension header file.

In both of these structures, the reqType field identifies the type of the request (for example, X_MapWindow or X_CreatePixmap). The length field tells how long the request is in units of 4-byte longwords. This length includes both the request structure itself and any variable-length data, such as strings or lists, that follow the request structure. Request structures come in different sizes, but all requests are padded to be multiples of four bytes long.

A few protocol requests take no arguments at all. Instead, they use the xReq structure in <X11/Xproto.h>, which contains only a reqType and a length (and a pad byte).

If the protocol request requires a reply, then <X11/Xproto.h> also contains a reply structure typedef: __ │

typedef struct _DoSomethingReply {

BYTE type;

/* always X_Reply */

BYTE someDatum;

/* used differently in different requests */

CARD16 sequenceNumber B16;/* # of requests sent so far */

CARD32 length B32;

/* # of additional bytes, divided by 4 */

...

/* request-specific data */

...

} xDoSomethingReply; │__

Most of these reply structures are 32 bytes long. If there are not that many reply values, then they contain a sufficient number of pad fields to bring them up to 32 bytes. The length field is the total number of bytes in the request minus 32, divided by 4. This length will be nonzero only if:

The reply structure is followed by variable-length data, such as a list or string.

The reply structure is longer than 32 bytes.

Only GetWindowAttributes, QueryFont, QueryKeymap, and GetKeyboardControl have reply structures longer than 32 bytes in the core protocol.

A few protocol requests return replies that contain no data. <X11/Xproto.h> does not define reply structures for these. Instead, they use the xGenericReply structure, which contains only a type, length, and sequence number (and sufficient padding to make it 32 bytes long).

Starting to Write a Stub Procedure

An Xlib stub procedure should start like this:

#include "<X11/Xlibint.h>

XDoSomething (arguments, ... )
/* argument declarations */
{

register XDoSomethingReq *req;
...

If the protocol request has a reply, then the variable declarations should include the reply structure for the request. The following is an example:

xDoSomethingReply rep;

Locking Data Structures

To lock the display structure for systems that want to support multithreaded access to a single display connection, each stub will need to lock its critical section. Generally, this section is the point from just before the appropriate GetReq call until all arguments to the call have been stored into the buffer. The precise instructions needed for this locking depend upon the machine architecture. Two calls, which are generally implemented as macros, have been provided. __ │

LockDisplay(display)
Display *display;

UnlockDisplay(display)
Display *display;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server. │__

Sending the Protocol Request and Arguments

After the variable declarations, a stub procedure should call one of four macros defined in <X11/Xlibint.h>: GetReq, GetReqExtra, GetResReq, or GetEmptyReq. All of these macros take, as their first argument, the name of the protocol request as declared in <X11/Xproto.h> except with X_ removed. Each one declares a Display structure pointer, called dpy, and a pointer to a request structure, called req, which is of the appropriate type. The macro then appends the request structure to the output buffer, fills in its type and length field, and sets req to point to it.

If the protocol request has no arguments (for instance, X_GrabServer), then use GetEmptyReq.

GetEmptyReq (DoSomething, req);

If the protocol request has a single 32-bit argument (such as a Pixmap, Window, Drawable, Atom, and so on), then use GetResReq. The second argument to the macro is the 32-bit object. X_MapWindow is a good example.

GetResReq (DoSomething, rid, req);

The rid argument is the Pixmap, Window, or other resource ID.

If the protocol request takes any other argument list, then call GetReq. After the GetReq, you need to set all the other fields in the request structure, usually from arguments to the stub procedure.

GetReq (DoSomething, req);
/* fill in arguments here */
req->arg1 = arg1;
req->arg2 = arg2;
...

A few stub procedures (such as XCreateGC and XCreatePixmap) return a resource ID to the caller but pass a resource ID as an argument to the protocol request. Such procedures use the macro XAllocID to allocate a resource ID from the range of IDs that were assigned to this client when it opened the connection.

rid = req->rid = XAllocID();
...
return (rid);

Finally, some stub procedures transmit a fixed amount of variable-length data after the request. Typically, these procedures (such as XMoveWindow and XSetBackground) are special cases of more general functions like XMoveResizeWindow and XChangeGC. These procedures use GetReqExtra, which is the same as GetReq except that it takes an additional argument (the number of extra bytes to allocate in the output buffer after the request structure). This number should always be a multiple of four.

Variable Length Arguments

Some protocol requests take additional variable-length data that follow the xDoSomethingReq structure. The format of this data varies from request to request. Some requests require a sequence of 8-bit bytes, others a sequence of 16-bit or 32-bit entities, and still others a sequence of structures.

It is necessary to add the length of any variable-length data to the length field of the request structure. That length field is in units of 32-bit longwords. If the data is a string or other sequence of 8-bit bytes, then you must round the length up and shift it before adding:

req->length += (nbytes+3)>>2;

To transmit variable-length data, use the Data macros. If the data fits into the output buffer, then this macro copies it to the buffer. If it does not fit, however, the Data macro calls _XSend, which transmits first the contents of the buffer and then your data. The Data macros take three arguments: the display, a pointer to the beginning of the data, and the number of bytes to be sent. __ │

Data(display, (char *) data, nbytes);

Data16(display, (short *) data, nbytes);

Data32(display, (long *) data, nbytes); │__

Data, Data16, and Data32 are macros that may use their last argument more than once, so that argument should be a variable rather than an expression such as ‘‘nitems*sizeof(item)’’. You should do that kind of computation in a separate statement before calling them. Use the appropriate macro when sending byte, short, or long data.

If the protocol request requires a reply, then call the procedure _XSend instead of the Data macro. _XSend takes the same arguments, but because it sends your data immediately instead of copying it into the output buffer (which would later be flushed anyway by the following call on _XReply), it is faster.

Replies

If the protocol request has a reply, then call _XReply after you have finished dealing with all the fixed-length and variable-length arguments. _XReply flushes the output buffer and waits for an xReply packet to arrive. If any events arrive in the meantime, _XReply places them in the queue for later use. __ │

Status _XReply(display, rep, extra, discard)
Display *display;
xReply *rep;
int extra;
Bool discard;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

rep

Specifies the reply structure.

extra

Specifies the number of 32-bit words expected

after the replay.

discard

Specifies if any data beyond that specified

in the extra argument should be discarded. │__

The _XReply function waits for a reply packet and copies its contents into the specified rep. _XReply handles error and event packets that occur before the reply is received. _XReply takes four arguments:

A Display * structure

A pointer to a reply structure (which must be cast to an xReply *)

The number of additional 32-bit words (beyond sizeof(xReply) = 32 bytes) in the reply structure

A Boolean that indicates whether _XReply is to discard any additional bytes beyond those it was told to read

Because most reply structures are 32 bytes long, the third argument is usually 0. The only core protocol exceptions are the replies to GetWindowAttributes, QueryFont, QueryKeymap, and GetKeyboardControl, which have longer replies.

The last argument should be False if the reply structure is followed by additional variable-length data (such as a list or string). It should be True if there is not any variable-length data.

Note

This last argument is provided for upward-compatibility reasons to allow a client to communicate properly with a hypothetical later version of the server that sends more data than the client expected. For example, some later version of GetWindowAttributes might use a larger, but compatible, xGetWindowAttributesReply that contains additional attribute data at the end.

_XReply returns True if it received a reply successfully or False if it received any sort of error.

For a request with a reply that is not followed by variable-length data, you write something like:

_XReply(display, (xReply *)&rep, 0, True);
*ret1 = rep.ret1;
*ret2 = rep.ret2;
*ret3 = rep.ret3;
...
UnlockDisplay(dpy);
SyncHandle();
return (rep.ret4);
}

If there is variable-length data after the reply, change the True to False, and use the appropriate _XRead function to read the variable-length data. __ │

_XRead(display, data_return, nbytes)
Display *display;
char *data_return;

long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

data_returnSpecifies the buffer.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

The _XRead function reads the specified number of bytes into data_return. __ │

_XRead16(display, data_return, nbytes)
Display *display;
short *data_return;
long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

data_returnSpecifies the buffer.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

The _XRead16 function reads the specified number of bytes, unpacking them as 16-bit quantities, into the specified array as shorts. __ │

_XRead32(display, data_return, nbytes)
Display *display;
long *data_return;
long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

data_returnSpecifies the buffer.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

The _XRead32 function reads the specified number of bytes, unpacking them as 32-bit quantities, into the specified array as longs. __ │

_XRead16Pad(display, data_return, nbytes)
Display *display;
short *data_return;
long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

data_returnSpecifies the buffer.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

The _XRead16Pad function reads the specified number of bytes, unpacking them as 16-bit quantities, into the specified array as shorts. If the number of bytes is not a multiple of four, _XRead16Pad reads and discards up to two additional pad bytes. __ │

_XReadPad(display, data_return, nbytes)
Display *display;
char *data_return;
long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

data_returnSpecifies the buffer.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

The _XReadPad function reads the specified number of bytes into data_return. If the number of bytes is not a multiple of four, _XReadPad reads and discards up to three additional pad bytes.

Each protocol request is a little different. For further information, see the Xlib sources for examples.

Synchronous Calling

Each procedure should have a call, just before returning to the user, to a macro called SyncHandle. If synchronous mode is enabled (see XSynchronize), the request is sent immediately. The library, however, waits until any error the procedure could generate at the server has been handled.

Allocating and Deallocating Memory

To support the possible reentry of these procedures, you must observe several conventions when allocating and deallocating memory, most often done when returning data to the user from the window system of a size the caller could not know in advance (for example, a list of fonts or a list of extensions). The standard C library functions on many systems are not protected against signals or other multithreaded uses. The following analogies to standard I/O library functions have been defined:
Xmalloc
()
Replaces malloc()
XFree
()
Replaces free()
Xcalloc
()
Replaces calloc()

These should be used in place of any calls you would make to the normal C library functions.

If you need a single scratch buffer inside a critical section (for example, to pack and unpack data to and from the wire protocol), the general memory allocators may be too expensive to use (particularly in output functions, which are performance critical). The following function returns a scratch buffer for use within a critical section: __ │

char *_XAllocScratch(display, nbytes)
Display *display;
unsigned long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

This storage must only be used inside of a critical section of your stub. The returned pointer cannot be assumed valid after any call that might permit another thread to execute inside Xlib. For example, the pointer cannot be assumed valid after any use of the GetReq or Data families of macros, after any use of _XReply, or after any use of the _XSend or _XRead families of functions.

The following function returns a scratch buffer for use across critical sections: __ │

char *_XAllocTemp(display, nbytes)
Display *display;
unsigned long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

nbytes

Specifies the number of bytes required. │__

This storage can be used across calls that might permit another thread to execute inside Xlib. The storage must be explicitly returned to Xlib. The following function returns the storage: __ │

void _XFreeTemp(display, buf, nbytes)
Display *display;
char *buf;
unsigned long nbytes;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

buf

Specifies the buffer to return.

nbytes

Specifies the size of the buffer. │__

You must pass back the same pointer and size that were returned by _XAllocTemp.

Portability Considerations

Many machine architectures, including many of the more recent RISC architectures, do not correctly access data at unaligned locations; their compilers pad out structures to preserve this characteristic. Many other machines capable of unaligned references pad inside of structures as well to preserve alignment, because accessing aligned data is usually much faster. Because the library and the server use structures to access data at arbitrary points in a byte stream, all data in request and reply packets must be naturally aligned; that is, 16-bit data starts on 16-bit boundaries in the request and 32-bit data on 32-bit boundaries. All requests must be a multiple of 32 bits in length to preserve the natural alignment in the data stream. You must pad structures out to 32-bit boundaries. Pad information does not have to be zeroed unless you want to preserve such fields for future use in your protocol requests. Floating point varies radically between machines and should be avoided completely if at all possible.

This code may run on machines with 16-bit ints. So, if any integer argument, variable, or return value either can take only nonnegative values or is declared as a CARD16 in the protocol, be sure to declare it as unsigned int and not as int. (This, of course, does not apply to Booleans or enumerations.)

Similarly, if any integer argument or return value is declared CARD32 in the protocol, declare it as an unsigned long and not as int or long. This also goes for any internal variables that may take on values larger than the maximum 16-bit unsigned int.

The library currently assumes that a char is 8 bits, a short is 16 bits, an int is 16 or 32 bits, and a long is 32 bits. The PackData macro is a half-hearted attempt to deal with the possibility of 32 bit shorts. However, much more work is needed to make this work properly.

Deriving the Correct Extension Opcode

The remaining problem a writer of an extension stub procedure faces that the core protocol does not face is to map from the call to the proper major and minor opcodes. While there are a number of strategies, the simplest and fastest is outlined below.

1.

Declare an array of pointers, _NFILE long (this is normally found in <stdio.h> and is the number of file descriptors supported on the system) of type XExtCodes. Make sure these are all initialized to NULL.

2.

When your stub is entered, your initialization test is just to use the display pointer passed in to access the file descriptor and an index into the array. If the entry is NULL, then this is the first time you are entering the procedure for this display. Call your initialization procedure and pass to it the display pointer.

3.

Once in your initialization procedure, call XInitExtension; if it succeeds, store the pointer returned into this array. Make sure to establish a close display handler to allow you to zero the entry. Do whatever other initialization your extension requires. (For example, install event handlers and so on.) Your initialization procedure would normally return a pointer to the XExtCodes structure for this extension, which is what would normally be found in your array of pointers.

4.

After returning from your initialization procedure, the stub can now continue normally, because it has its major opcode safely in its hand in the XExtCodes structure.

20

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Appendix D

Compatibility Functions

The X Version 11 and X Version 10 functions discussed in this appendix are obsolete, have been superseded by newer X Version 11 functions, and are maintained for compatibility reasons only.

X Version 11 Compatibility Functions

You can use the X Version 11 compatibility functions to:

Set standard properties

Set and get window sizing hints

Set and get an XStandardColormap structure

Parse window geometry

Get X environment defaults

Setting Standard Properties

To specify a minimum set of properties describing the simplest application, use XSetStandardProperties. This function has been superseded by XSetWMProperties and sets all or portions of the WM_NAME, WM_ICON_NAME, WM_HINTS, WM_COMMAND, and WM_NORMAL_HINTS properties. __ │

XSetStandardProperties(display, w, window_name, icon_name, icon_pixmap, argv, argc, hints)
Display *display;
Window w;
char *window_name;
char *icon_name;
Pixmap icon_pixmap;
char **argv;
int argc;
XSizeHints *hints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

window_nameSpecifies the window name, which should be a
null-terminated string.

icon_name

Specifies the icon name, which should be a

null-terminated string.

icon_pixmapSpecifies the bitmap that is to be used for
the icon or None.

argv

Specifies the application’s argument list.

argc

Specifies the number of arguments.

hints

Specifies a pointer to the size hints for the

window in its normal state. │__

The XSetStandardProperties function provides a means by which simple applications set the most essential properties with a single call. XSetStandardProperties should be used to give a window manager some information about your program’s preferences. It should not be used by applications that need to communicate more information than is possible with XSetStandardProperties. (Typically, argv is the argv array of your main program.) If the strings are not in the Host Portable Character Encoding, the result is implementation-dependent.

XSetStandardProperties can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

Setting and Getting Window Sizing Hints

Xlib provides functions that you can use to set or get window sizing hints. The functions discussed in this section use the flags and the XSizeHints structure, as defined in the <X11/Xutil.h> header file and use the WM_NORMAL_HINTS property.

To set the size hints for a given window in its normal state, use XSetNormalHints. This function has been superseded by XSetWMNormalHints. __ │

XSetNormalHints(display, w, hints)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints

Specifies a pointer to the size hints for the

window in its normal state. │__

The XSetNormalHints function sets the size hints structure for the specified window. Applications use XSetNormalHints to inform the window manager of the size or position desirable for that window. In addition, an application that wants to move or resize itself should call XSetNormalHints and specify its new desired location and size as well as making direct Xlib calls to move or resize. This is because window managers may ignore redirected configure requests, but they pay attention to property changes.

To set size hints, an application not only must assign values to the appropriate members in the hints structure but also must set the flags member of the structure to indicate which information is present and where it came from. A call to XSetNormalHints is meaningless, unless the flags member is set to indicate which members of the structure have been assigned values.

XSetNormalHints can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To return the size hints for a window in its normal state, use XGetNormalHints. This function has been superseded by XGetWMNormalHints. __ │

Status XGetNormalHints(display, w, hints_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints_return
Returns the size hints for the window in its
normal state. │__

The XGetNormalHints function returns the size hints for a window in its normal state. It returns a nonzero status if it succeeds or zero if the application specified no normal size hints for this window.

XGetNormalHints can generate a BadWindow error.

The next two functions set and read the WM_ZOOM_HINTS property.

To set the zoom hints for a window, use XSetZoomHints. This function is no longer supported by the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual. __ │

XSetZoomHints(display, w, zhints)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *zhints;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

zhints

Specifies a pointer to the zoom hints. │__

Many window managers think of windows in one of three states: iconic, normal, or zoomed. The XSetZoomHints function provides the window manager with information for the window in the zoomed state.

XSetZoomHints can generate BadAlloc and BadWindow errors.

To read the zoom hints for a window, use XGetZoomHints. This function is no longer supported by the Inter-Client Communication Conventions Manual. __ │

Status XGetZoomHints(display, w, zhints_return)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *zhints_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

zhints_return
Returns the zoom hints. │__

The XGetZoomHints function returns the size hints for a window in its zoomed state. It returns a nonzero status if it succeeds or zero if the application specified no zoom size hints for this window.

XGetZoomHints can generate a BadWindow error.

To set the value of any property of type WM_SIZE_HINTS, use XSetSizeHints. This function has been superseded by XSetWMSizeHints. __ │

XSetSizeHints(display, w, hints, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints

Specifies a pointer to the size hints.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XSetSizeHints function sets the XSizeHints structure for the named property and the specified window. This is used by XSetNormalHints and XSetZoomHints and can be used to set the value of any property of type WM_SIZE_HINTS. Thus, it may be useful if other properties of that type get defined.

XSetSizeHints can generate BadAlloc, BadAtom, and BadWindow errors.

To read the value of any property of type WM_SIZE_HINTS, use XGetSizeHints. This function has been superseded by XGetWMSizeHints. __ │

Status XGetSizeHints(display, w, hints_return, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XSizeHints *hints_return;
Atom property;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

hints_return
Returns the size hints.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XGetSizeHints function returns the XSizeHints structure for the named property and the specified window. This is used by XGetNormalHints and XGetZoomHints. It also can be used to retrieve the value of any property of type WM_SIZE_HINTS. Thus, it may be useful if other properties of that type get defined. XGetSizeHints returns a nonzero status if a size hint was defined or zero otherwise.

XGetSizeHints can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

Getting and Setting an XStandardColormap Structure

To get the XStandardColormap structure associated with one of the described atoms, use XGetStandardColormap. This function has been superseded by XGetRGBColormap. __ │

Status XGetStandardColormap(display, w, colormap_return, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XStandardColormap *colormap_return;

Atom property;

/* RGB_BEST_MAP, etc. */

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

colormap_return
Returns the colormap associated with the
specified atom.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XGetStandardColormap function returns the colormap definition associated with the atom supplied as the property argument. XGetStandardColormap returns a nonzero status if successful and zero otherwise. For example, to fetch the standard GrayScale colormap for a display, you use XGetStandardColormap with the following syntax: __ │

XGetStandardColormap(dpy, DefaultRootWindow(dpy), &cmap, XA_RGB_GRAY_MAP); │__

See section 14.3 for the semantics of standard colormaps.

XGetStandardColormap can generate BadAtom and BadWindow errors.

To set a standard colormap, use XSetStandardColormap. This function has been superseded by XSetRGBColormap. __ │

XSetStandardColormap(display, w, colormap, property)
Display *display;
Window w;
XStandardColormap *colormap;

Atom property;

/* RGB_BEST_MAP, etc. */

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

w

Specifies the window.

colormap

Specifies the colormap.

property

Specifies the property name. │__

The XSetStandardColormap function usually is only used by window or session managers.

XSetStandardColormap can generate BadAlloc, BadAtom, BadDrawable, and BadWindow errors.

Parsing Window Geometry

To parse window geometry given a user-specified position and a default position, use XGeometry. This function has been superseded by XWMGeometry. __ │

int XGeometry(display, screen, position, default_position, bwidth, fwidth, fheight, xadder,
yadder
, x_return, y_return, width_return, height_return)
Display *display;
int screen;
char *position, *default_position;
unsigned int bwidth;
unsigned int fwidth, fheight;

int xadder, yadder;

int *x_return, *y_return;
int *width_return, *height_return;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

screen

Specifies the screen.

position

default_position
Specify the geometry specifications.

bwidth

Specifies the border width.

fheight

fwidth

Specify the font height and width in pixels

(increment size).

xadder

yadder

Specify additional interior padding needed in

the window.

x_return

y_return

Return the x and y offsets.

width_return
height_return

Return the width and height determined. │__

You pass in the border width (bwidth), size of the increments fwidth and fheight (typically font width and height), and any additional interior space (xadder and yadder) to make it easy to compute the resulting size. The XGeometry function returns the position the window should be placed given a position and a default position. XGeometry determines the placement of a window using a geometry specification as specified by XParseGeometry and the additional information about the window. Given a fully qualified default geometry specification and an incomplete geometry specification, XParseGeometry returns a bitmask value as defined above in the XParseGeometry call, by using the position argument.

The returned width and height will be the width and height specified by default_position as overridden by any user-specified position. They are not affected by fwidth, fheight, xadder, or yadder. The x and y coordinates are computed by using the border width, the screen width and height, padding as specified by xadder and yadder, and the fheight and fwidth times the width and height from the geometry specifications.

Getting the X Environment Defaults

The XGetDefault function provides a primitive interface to the resource manager facilities discussed in chapter 15. It is only useful in very simple applications. __ │

char *XGetDefault(display, program, option)
Display *display;
char *program;
char *option;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

program

Specifies the program name for the Xlib de-

faults (usually argv[0] of the main program).

option

Specifies the option name. │__

The XGetDefault function returns the value of the resource prog.option, where prog is the program argument with the directory prefix removed and option must be a single component. Note that multilevel resources cannot be used with XGetDefault. The class "Program.Name" is always used for the resource lookup. If the specified option name does not exist for this program, XGetDefault returns NULL. The strings returned by XGetDefault are owned by Xlib and should not be modified or freed by the client.

If a database has been set with XrmSetDatabase, that database is used for the lookup. Otherwise, a database is created and is set in the display (as if by calling XrmSetDatabase). The database is created in the current locale. To create a database, XGetDefault uses resources from the RESOURCE_MANAGER property on the root window of screen zero. If no such property exists, a resource file in the user’s home directory is used. On a POSIX-conformant system, this file is $HOME/.Xdefaults. After loading these defaults, XGetDefault merges additional defaults specified by the XENVIRONMENT environment variable. If XENVIRONMENT is defined, it contains a full path name for the additional resource file. If XENVIRONMENT is not defined, XGetDefault looks for $HOME/.Xdefaults-name, where name specifies the name of the machine on which the application is running.

X Version 10 Compatibility Functions

You can use the X Version 10 compatibility functions to:

Draw and fill polygons and curves

Associate user data with a value

Drawing and Filling Polygons and Curves

Xlib provides functions that you can use to draw or fill arbitrary polygons or curves. These functions are provided mainly for compatibility with X Version 10 and have no server support. That is, they call other Xlib functions, not the server directly. Thus, if you just have straight lines to draw, using XDrawLines or XDrawSegments is much faster.

The functions discussed here provide all the functionality of the X Version 10 functions XDraw, XDrawFilled, XDrawPatterned, XDrawDashed, and XDrawTiled. They are as compatible as possible given X Version 11’s new line-drawing functions. One thing to note, however, is that VertexDrawLastPoint is no longer supported. Also, the error status returned is the opposite of what it was under X Version 10 (this is the X Version 11 standard error status). XAppendVertex and XClearVertexFlag from X Version 10 also are not supported.

Just how the graphics context you use is set up actually determines whether you get dashes or not, and so on. Lines are properly joined if they connect and include the closing of a closed figure (see XDrawLines). The functions discussed here fail (return zero) only if they run out of memory or are passed a Vertex list that has a Vertex with VertexStartClosed set that is not followed by a Vertex with VertexEndClosed set.

To achieve the effects of the X Version 10 XDraw, XDrawDashed, and XDrawPatterned, use XDraw. __ │

#include <X11/X10.h>

Status XDraw(display, d, gc, vlist, vcount)

Display *display;

Drawable d;

GC gc;

Vertex *vlist;

int vcount;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

vlist

Specifies a pointer to the list of vertices

that indicate what to draw.

vcount

Specifies how many vertices are in vlist. │__

The XDraw function draws an arbitrary polygon or curve. The figure drawn is defined by the specified list of vertices (vlist). The points are connected by lines as specified in the flags in the vertex structure.

Each Vertex, as defined in <X11/X10.h>, is a structure with the following members: __ │

typedef struct _Vertex {

short x,y;

unsigned short flags;

} Vertex; │__

The x and y members are the coordinates of the vertex that are relative to either the upper left inside corner of the drawable (if VertexRelative is zero) or the previous vertex (if VertexRelative is one).

The flags, as defined in <X11/X10.h>, are as follows: __ │

VertexRelative
0x0001
/* else abso-
lute */
VertexDontDraw

0x0002
/* else draw */
VertexCurved

0x0004
/* else
straight */
VertexStart-
Closed

0x0008
/* else not */

VertexEndClosed
0x0010
/* else not */ │__

If VertexRelative is not set, the coordinates are absolute (that is, relative to the drawable’s origin). The first vertex must be an absolute vertex.

If VertexDontDraw is one, no line or curve is drawn from the previous vertex to this one. This is analogous to picking up the pen and moving to another place before drawing another line.

If VertexCurved is one, a spline algorithm is used to draw a smooth curve from the previous vertex through this one to the next vertex. Otherwise, a straight line is drawn from the previous vertex to this one. It makes sense to set VertexCurved to one only if a previous and next vertex are both defined (either explicitly in the array or through the definition of a closed curve).

It is permissible for VertexDontDraw bits and VertexCurved bits both to be one. This is useful if you want to define the previous point for the smooth curve but do not want an actual curve drawing to start until this point.

If VertexStartClosed is one, then this point marks the beginning of a closed curve. This vertex must be followed later in the array by another vertex whose effective coordinates are identical and that has a VertexEndClosed bit of one. The points in between form a cycle to determine predecessor and successor vertices for the spline algorithm.

This function uses these GC components: function, plane-mask, line-width, line-style, cap-style, join-style, fill-style, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. It also uses these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, tile-stipple-y-origin, dash-offset, and dash-list.

To achieve the effects of the X Version 10 XDrawTiled and XDrawFilled, use XDrawFilled. __ │

#include <X11/X10.h>

Status XDrawFilled(display, d, gc, vlist, vcount)

Display *display;

Drawable d;

GC gc;

Vertex *vlist;

int vcount;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

d

Specifies the drawable.

gc

Specifies the GC.

vlist

Specifies a pointer to the list of vertices

that indicate what to draw.

vcount

Specifies how many vertices are in vlist. │__

The XDrawFilled function draws arbitrary polygons or curves and then fills them.

This function uses these GC components: function, plane-mask, line-width, line-style, cap-style, join-style, fill-style, subwindow-mode, clip-x-origin, clip-y-origin, and clip-mask. It also uses these GC mode-dependent components: foreground, background, tile, stipple, tile-stipple-x-origin, tile-stipple-y-origin, dash-offset, dash-list, fill-style, and fill-rule.

Associating User Data with a Value

These functions have been superseded by the context management functions (see section 16.10). It is often necessary to associate arbitrary information with resource IDs. Xlib provides the XAssocTable functions that you can use to make such an association. Application programs often need to be able to easily refer to their own data structures when an event arrives. The XAssocTable system provides users of the X library with a method for associating their own data structures with X resources (Pixmaps, Fonts, Windows, and so on).

An XAssocTable can be used to type X resources. For example, the user may want to have three or four types of windows, each with different properties. This can be accomplished by associating each X window ID with a pointer to a window property data structure defined by the user. A generic type has been defined in the X library for resource IDs. It is called an XID.

There are a few guidelines that should be observed when using an XAssocTable:

All XIDs are relative to the specified display.

Because of the hashing scheme used by the association mechanism, the following rules for determining the size of a XAssocTable should be followed. Associations will be made and looked up more efficiently if the table size (number of buckets in the hashing system) is a power of two and if there are not more than 8 XIDs per bucket.

To return a pointer to a new XAssocTable, use XCreateAssocTable. __ │

XAssocTable *XCreateAssocTable(size)

int size;

size

Specifies the number of buckets in the hash

system of XAssocTable. │__

The size argument specifies the number of buckets in the hash system of XAssocTable. For reasons of efficiency the number of buckets should be a power of two. Some size suggestions might be: use 32 buckets per 100 objects, and a reasonable maximum number of objects per buckets is 8. If an error allocating memory for the XAssocTable occurs, a NULL pointer is returned.

To create an entry in a given XAssocTable, use XMakeAssoc. __ │

XMakeAssoc(display, table, x_id, data)
Display *display;

XAssocTable *table;

XID x_id;
char *data;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

table

Specifies the assoc table.

x_id

Specifies the X resource ID.

data

Specifies the data to be associated with the

X resource ID. │__

The XMakeAssoc function inserts data into an XAssocTable keyed on an XID. Data is inserted into the table only once. Redundant inserts are ignored. The queue in each association bucket is sorted from the lowest XID to the highest XID.

To obtain data from a given XAssocTable, use XLookUpAssoc. __ │

char *XLookUpAssoc(display, table, x_id)
Display *display;
XAssocTable *table;
XID x_id;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

table

Specifies the assoc table.

x_id

Specifies the X resource ID. │__

The XLookUpAssoc function retrieves the data stored in an XAssocTable by its XID. If an appropriately matching XID can be found in the table, XLookUpAssoc returns the data associated with it. If the x_id cannot be found in the table, it returns NULL.

To delete an entry from a given XAssocTable, use XDeleteAssoc. __ │

XDeleteAssoc(display, table, x_id)
Display *display;
XAssocTable *table;
XID x_id;

display

Specifies the connection to the X server.

table

Specifies the assoc table.

x_id

Specifies the X resource ID. │__

The XDeleteAssoc function deletes an association in an XAssocTable keyed on its XID. Redundant deletes (and deletes of nonexistent XIDs) are ignored. Deleting associations in no way impairs the performance of an XAssocTable.

To free the memory associated with a given XAssocTable, use XDestroyAssocTable. __ │

XDestroyAssocTable(table)
XAssocTable *table;

table

Specifies the assoc table. │__

21

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Glossary

Access control list

X maintains a list of hosts from which client pro-
grams can be run. By default, only programs on
the local host and hosts specified in an initial
list read by the server can use the display. This
access control list can be changed by clients on
the local host. Some server implementations can
also implement other authorization mechanisms in
addition to or in place of this mechanism. The
action of this mechanism can be conditional based
on the authorization protocol name and data re-
ceived by the server at connection setup.

Active grab

A grab is active when the pointer or keyboard is actu-
ally owned by the single grabbing client.

Ancestors

If W is an inferior of A, then A is an ancestor of W.

Atom

An atom is a unique ID corresponding to a string name.
Atoms are used to identify properties, types, and se-
lections.

Background

An InputOutput window can have a background, which is
defined as a pixmap. When regions of the window have
their contents lost or invalidated, the server automat-
ically tiles those regions with the background.

Backing store

When a server maintains the contents of a window, the
pixels saved off-screen are known as a backing store.

Base font name

A font name used to select a family of fonts whose mem-
bers may be encoded in various charsets. The CharSe-
tRegistry
and CharSetEncoding fields of an XLFD name
identify the charset of the font. A base font name may
be a full XLFD name, with all fourteen ’-’ delimiters,
or an abbreviated XLFD name containing only the first
12 fields of an XLFD name, up to but not including
CharSetRegistry
, with or without the thirteenth ’-’, or
a non-XLFD name. Any XLFD fields may contain wild
cards.

When creating an XFontSet, Xlib accepts from the client
a list of one or more base font names which select one
or more font families. They are combined with charset
names obtained from the encoding of the locale to load
the fonts required to render text.

Bit gravity

When a window is resized, the contents of the window
are not necessarily discarded. It is possible to re-
quest that the server relocate the previous contents to
some region of the window (though no guarantees are
made). This attraction of window contents for some lo-
cation of a window is known as bit gravity.

Bit plane

When a pixmap or window is thought of as a stack of
bitmaps, each bitmap is called a bit plane or plane.

Bitmap

A bitmap is a pixmap of depth one.

Border

An InputOutput window can have a border of equal thick-
ness on all four sides of the window. The contents of
the border are defined by a pixmap, and the server au-
tomatically maintains the contents of the border. Ex-
posure events are never generated for border regions.

Button grabbing

Buttons on the pointer can be passively grabbed by a
client. When the button is pressed, the pointer is
then actively grabbed by the client.

Byte order

For image (pixmap/bitmap) data, the server defines the
byte order, and clients with different native byte or-
dering must swap bytes as necessary. For all other
parts of the protocol, the client defines the byte or-
der, and the server swaps bytes as necessary.

Character

A member of a set of elements used for the organiza-
tion, control, or representation of text (ISO2022, as
adapted by XPG3). Note that in ISO2022 terms, a char-
acter is not bound to a coded value until it is identi-
fied as part of a coded character set.

Character glyph

The abstract graphical symbol for a character. Charac-
ter glyphs may or may not map one-to-one to font
glyphs, and may be context-dependent, varying with the
adjacent characters. Multiple characters may map to a
single character glyph.

Character set

A collection of characters.

Charset

An encoding with a uniform, state-independent mapping
from characters to codepoints. A coded character set.

For display in X, there can be a direct mapping from a
charset to one font, if the width of all characters in
the charset is either one or two bytes. A text string
encoded in an encoding such as Shift-JIS cannot be
passed directly to the X server, because the text imag-
ing requests accept only single-width charsets (either
8 or 16 bits). Charsets which meet these restrictions
can serve as ‘‘font charsets’’. Font charsets strictly
speaking map font indices to font glyphs, not charac-
ters to character glyphs.

Note that a single font charset is sometimes used as
the encoding of a locale, for example, ISO8859-1.

Children

The children of a window are its first-level subwin-
dows.

Class

Windows can be of different classes or types. See the
entries for InputOnly and InputOutput windows for fur-
ther information about valid window types.

Client

An application program connects to the window system
server by some interprocess communication (IPC) path,
such as a TCP connection or a shared memory buffer.
This program is referred to as a client of the window
system server. More precisely, the client is the IPC
path itself. A program with multiple paths open to the
server is viewed as multiple clients by the protocol.
Resource lifetimes are controlled by connection life-
times, not by program lifetimes.

Clipping region

In a graphics context, a bitmap or list of rectangles
can be specified to restrict output to a particular re-
gion of the window. The image defined by the bitmap or
rectangles is called a clipping region.

Coded character

A character bound to a codepoint.

Coded character set

A set of unambiguous rules that establishes a character
set and the one-to-one relationship between each char-
acter of the set and its bit representation. (ISO2022,
as adapted by XPG3) A definition of a one-to-one map-
ping of a set of characters to a set of codepoints.

Codepoint

The coded representation of a single character in a
coded character set.

Colormap

A colormap consists of a set of entries defining color
values. The colormap associated with a window is used
to display the contents of the window; each pixel value
indexes the colormap to produce an RGB value that
drives the guns of a monitor. Depending on hardware
limitations, one or more colormaps can be installed at
one time so that windows associated with those maps
display with true colors.

Connection

The IPC path between the server and client program is
known as a connection. A client program typically (but
not necessarily) has one connection to the server over
which requests and events are sent.

Containment

A window contains the pointer if the window is viewable
and the hotspot of the cursor is within a visible re-
gion of the window or a visible region of one of its
inferiors. The border of the window is included as
part of the window for containment. The pointer is in
a window if the window contains the pointer but no in-
ferior contains the pointer.

Coordinate system

The coordinate system has X horizontal and Y vertical,
with the origin [0, 0] at the upper left. Coordinates
are integral and coincide with pixel centers. Each
window and pixmap has its own coordinate system. For a
window, the origin is inside the border at the inside
upper-left corner.

Cursor

A cursor is the visible shape of the pointer on a
screen. It consists of a hotspot, a source bitmap, a
shape bitmap, and a pair of colors. The cursor defined
for a window controls the visible appearance when the
pointer is in that window.

Depth

The depth of a window or pixmap is the number of bits
per pixel it has. The depth of a graphics context is
the depth of the drawables it can be used in conjunc-
tion with graphics output.

Device

Keyboards, mice, tablets, track-balls, button boxes,
and so on are all collectively known as input devices.
Pointers can have one or more buttons (the most common
number is three). The core protocol only deals with
two devices: the keyboard and the pointer.

DirectColor

DirectColor is a class of colormap in which a pixel
value is decomposed into three separate subfields for
indexing. The first subfield indexes an array to pro-
duce red intensity values. The second subfield indexes
a second array to produce blue intensity values. The
third subfield indexes a third array to produce green
intensity values. The RGB (red, green, and blue) val-
ues in the colormap entry can be changed dynamically.

Display

A server, together with its screens and input devices,
is called a display. The Xlib Display structure con-
tains all information about the particular display and
its screens as well as the state that Xlib needs to
communicate with the display over a particular connec-
tion.

Drawable

Both windows and pixmaps can be used as sources and
destinations in graphics operations. These windows and
pixmaps are collectively known as drawables. However,
an InputOnly window cannot be used as a source or des-
tination in a graphics operation.

Encoding

A set of unambiguous rules that establishes a character
set and a relationship between the characters and their
representations. The character set does not have to be
fixed to a finite pre-defined set of characters. The
representations do not have to be of uniform length.
Examples are an ISO2022 graphic set, a state-indepen-
dent or state-dependent combination of graphic sets,
possibly including control sets, and the X Compound
Text encoding.

In X, encodings are identified by a string which ap-
pears as: the CharSetRegistry and CharSetEncoding com-
ponents of an XLFD name; the name of a charset of the
locale for which a font could not be found; or an atom
which identifies the encoding of a text property or
which names an encoding for a text selection target
type. Encoding names should be composed of characters
from the X Portable Character Set.

Escapement

The escapement of a string is the distance in pixels in
the primary draw direction from the drawing origin to
the origin of the next character (that is, the one fol-
lowing the given string) to be drawn.

Event

Clients are informed of information asynchronously by
means of events. These events can be either asyn-
chronously generated from devices or generated as side
effects of client requests. Events are grouped into
types. The server never sends an event to a client un-
less the client has specifically asked to be informed
of that type of event. However, clients can force
events to be sent to other clients. Events are typi-
cally reported relative to a window.

Event mask

Events are requested relative to a window. The set of
event types a client requests relative to a window is
described by using an event mask.

Event propagation

Device-related events propagate from the source window
to ancestor windows until some client has expressed in-
terest in handling that type of event or until the
event is discarded explicitly.

Event source

The deepest viewable window that the pointer is in is
called the source of a device-related event.

Event synchronization

There are certain race conditions possible when demul-
tiplexing device events to clients (in particular, de-
ciding where pointer and keyboard events should be sent
when in the middle of window management operations).
The event synchronization mechanism allows synchronous
processing of device events.

Exposure event

Servers do not guarantee to preserve the contents of
windows when windows are obscured or reconfigured. Ex-
posure events are sent to clients to inform them when
contents of regions of windows have been lost.

Extension

Named extensions to the core protocol can be defined to
extend the system. Extensions to output requests, re-
sources, and event types are all possible and expected.

Font

A font is an array of glyphs (typically characters).
The protocol does no translation or interpretation of
character sets. The client simply indicates values
used to index the glyph array. A font contains addi-
tional metric information to determine interglyph and
interline spacing.

Font glyph

The abstract graphical symbol for an index into a font.

Frozen events

Clients can freeze event processing during keyboard and
pointer grabs.

GC

GC is an abbreviation for graphics context. See Graph-
ics context
.

Glyph

An identified abstract graphical symbol independent of
any actual image. (ISO/IEC/DIS 9541-1) An abstract vi-
sual representation of a graphic character, not bound
to a codepoint.

Glyph image

An image of a glyph, as obtained from a glyph represen-
tation displayed on a presentation surface.
(ISO/IEC/DIS 9541-1)

Grab

Keyboard keys, the keyboard, pointer buttons, the
pointer, and the server can be grabbed for exclusive
use by a client. In general, these facilities are not
intended to be used by normal applications but are in-
tended for various input and window managers to imple-
ment various styles of user interfaces.

Graphics context

Various information for graphics output is stored in a
graphics context (GC), such as foreground pixel, back-
ground pixel, line width, clipping region, and so on.
A graphics context can only be used with drawables that
have the same root and the same depth as the graphics
context.

Gravity

The contents of windows and windows themselves have a
gravity, which determines how the contents move when a
window is resized. See Bit gravity and Window gravity.

GrayScale

GrayScale can be viewed as a degenerate case of Pseudo-
Color
, in which the red, green, and blue values in any
given colormap entry are equal and thus, produce shades
of gray. The gray values can be changed dynamically.

Host Portable Character Encoding

The encoding of the X Portable Character Set on the
host. The encoding itself is not defined by this stan-
dard, but the encoding must be the same in all locales
supported by Xlib on the host. If a string is said to
be in the Host Portable Character Encoding, then it on-
ly contains characters from the X Portable Character
Set, in the host encoding.

Hotspot

A cursor has an associated hotspot, which defines the
point in the cursor corresponding to the coordinates
reported for the pointer.

Identifier

An identifier is a unique value associated with a re-
source that clients use to name that resource. The
identifier can be used over any connection to name the
resource.

Inferiors

The inferiors of a window are all of the subwindows
nested below it: the children, the children’s children,
and so on.

Input focus

The input focus is usually a window defining the scope
for processing of keyboard input. If a generated key-
board event usually would be reported to this window or
one of its inferiors, the event is reported as usual.
Otherwise, the event is reported with respect to the
focus window. The input focus also can be set such
that all keyboard events are discarded and such that
the focus window is dynamically taken to be the root
window of whatever screen the pointer is on at each
keyboard event.

Input manager

Control over keyboard input is typically provided by an
input manager client, which usually is part of a window
manager.

InputOnly window

An InputOnly window is a window that cannot be used for
graphics requests. InputOnly windows are invisible and
are used to control such things as cursors, input event
generation, and grabbing. InputOnly windows cannot
have InputOutput windows as inferiors.

InputOutput window

An InputOutput window is the normal kind of window that
is used for both input and output. InputOutput windows
can have both InputOutput and InputOnly windows as in-
feriors.

Internationalization

The process of making software adaptable to the re-
quirements of different native languages, local cus-
toms, and character string encodings. Making a comput-
er program adaptable to different locales without pro-
gram source modifications or recompilation.

ISO2022

ISO standard for code extension techniques for 7-bit
and 8-bit coded character sets.

Key grabbing

Keys on the keyboard can be passively grabbed by a
client. When the key is pressed, the keyboard is then
actively grabbed by the client.

Keyboard grabbing

A client can actively grab control of the keyboard, and
key events will be sent to that client rather than the
client the events would normally have been sent to.

Keysym

An encoding of a symbol on a keycap on a keyboard.

Latin-1

The coded character set defined by the ISO8859-1 stan-
dard.

Latin Portable Character Encoding

The encoding of the X Portable Character Set using the
Latin-1 codepoints plus ASCII control characters. If a
string is said to be in the Latin Portable Character
Encoding, then it only contains characters from the X
Portable Character Set, not all of Latin-1.

Locale

The international environment of a computer program
defining the ‘‘localized’’ behavior of that program at
run-time. This information can be established from one
or more sets of localization data. ANSI C defines lo-
cale-specific processing by C system library calls.
See ANSI C and the X/Open Portability Guide specifica-
tions for more details. In this specification, on im-
plementations that conform to the ANSI C library, the
‘‘current locale’’ is the current setting of the
LC_CTYPE setlocale category. Associated with each lo-
cale is a text encoding. When text is processed in the
context of a locale, the text must be in the encoding
of the locale. The current locale affects Xlib in its:

Encoding and processing of input method text

Encoding of resource files and values

Encoding and imaging of text strings

Encoding and decoding for inter-client text commu-

nication

Locale name

The identifier used to select the desired locale for
the host C library and X library functions. On ANSI C
library compliant systems, the locale argument to the
setlocale
function.

Localization

The process of establishing information within a com-
puter system specific to the operation of particular
native languages, local customs and coded character
sets. (XPG3)

Mapped

A window is said to be mapped if a map call has been
performed on it. Unmapped windows and their inferiors
are never viewable or visible.

Modifier keys

Shift, Control, Meta, Super, Hyper, Alt, Compose, Ap-
ple, CapsLock, ShiftLock, and similar keys are called
modifier keys.

Monochrome

Monochrome is a special case of StaticGray in which
there are only two colormap entries.

Multibyte

A character whose codepoint is stored in more than one
byte; any encoding which can contain multibyte charac-
ters; text in a multibyte encoding. The ‘‘char *’’
null-terminated string datatype in ANSI C. Note that
references in this document to multibyte strings imply
only that the strings may contain multibyte characters.

Obscure

A window is obscured if some other window obscures it.
A window can be partially obscured and so still have
visible regions. Window A obscures window B if both
are viewable InputOutput windows, if A is higher in the
global stacking order, and if the rectangle defined by
the outside edges of A intersects the rectangle defined
by the outside edges of B. Note the distinction be-
tween obscures and occludes. Also note that window
borders are included in the calculation.

Occlude

A window is occluded if some other window occludes it.
Window A occludes window B if both are mapped, if A is
higher in the global stacking order, and if the rectan-
gle defined by the outside edges of A intersects the
rectangle defined by the outside edges of B. Note the
distinction between occludes and obscures. Also note
that window borders are included in the calculation and
that InputOnly windows never obscure other windows but
can occlude other windows.

Padding

Some padding bytes are inserted in the data stream to
maintain alignment of the protocol requests on natural
boundaries. This increases ease of portability to some
machine architectures.

Parent window

If C is a child of P, then P is the parent of C.

Passive grab

Grabbing a key or button is a passive grab. The grab
activates when the key or button is actually pressed.

Pixel value

A pixel is an N-bit value, where N is the number of bit
planes used in a particular window or pixmap (that is,
is the depth of the window or pixmap). A pixel in a
window indexes a colormap to derive an actual color to
be displayed.

Pixmap

A pixmap is a three-dimensional array of bits. A
pixmap is normally thought of as a two-dimensional ar-
ray of pixels, where each pixel can be a value from 0
to Image grohtml-19291-33.png −1, and where N is the depth (z axis) of the
pixmap. A pixmap can also be thought of as a stack of
N bitmaps. A pixmap can only be used on the screen
that it was created in.

Plane

When a pixmap or window is thought of as a stack of
bitmaps, each bitmap is called a plane or bit plane.

Plane mask

Graphics operations can be restricted to only affect a
subset of bit planes of a destination. A plane mask is
a bit mask describing which planes are to be modified.
The plane mask is stored in a graphics context.

Pointer

The pointer is the pointing device currently attached
to the cursor and tracked on the screens.

Pointer grabbing

A client can actively grab control of the pointer.
Then button and motion events will be sent to that
client rather than the client the events would normally
have been sent to.

Pointing device

A pointing device is typically a mouse, tablet, or some
other device with effective dimensional motion. The
core protocol defines only one visible cursor, which
tracks whatever pointing device is attached as the
pointer.

POSIX

Portable Operating System Interface, ISO/IEC 9945-1
(IEEE Std 1003.1).

POSIX Portable Filename Character Set

The set of 65 characters which can be used in naming
files on a POSIX-compliant host that are correctly pro-
cessed in all locales. The set is:

a..z A..Z 0..9 ._-

Property

Windows can have associated properties that consist of
a name, a type, a data format, and some data. The pro-
tocol places no interpretation on properties. They are
intended as a general-purpose naming mechanism for
clients. For example, clients might use properties to
share information such as resize hints, program names,
and icon formats with a window manager.

Property list

The property list of a window is the list of properties
that have been defined for the window.

PseudoColor

PseudoColor is a class of colormap in which a pixel
value indexes the colormap entry to produce an indepen-
dent RGB value; that is, the colormap is viewed as an
array of triples (RGB values). The RGB values can be
changed dynamically.

Rectangle

A rectangle specified by [x,y,w,h] has an infinitely
thin outline path with corners at [x,y], [x+w,y],
[x+w,y+h], and [x, y+h]. When a rectangle is filled,
the lower-right edges are not drawn. For example, if
w=h=0, nothing would be drawn. For w=h=1, a single
pixel would be drawn.

Redirecting control

Window managers (or client programs) may enforce window
layout policy in various ways. When a client attempts
to change the size or position of a window, the opera-
tion may be redirected to a specified client rather
than the operation actually being performed.

Reply

Information requested by a client program using the X
protocol is sent back to the client with a reply. Both
events and replies are multiplexed on the same connec-
tion. Most requests do not generate replies, but some
requests generate multiple replies.

Request

A command to the server is called a request. It is a
single block of data sent over a connection.

Resource

Windows, pixmaps, cursors, fonts, graphics contexts,
and colormaps are known as resources. They all have
unique identifiers associated with them for naming pur-
poses. The lifetime of a resource usually is bounded
by the lifetime of the connection over which the re-
source was created.

RGB values

RGB values are the red, green, and blue intensity val-
ues that are used to define a color. These values are
always represented as 16-bit, unsigned numbers, with 0
the minimum intensity and 65535 the maximum intensity.
The X server scales these values to match the display
hardware.

Root

The root of a pixmap or graphics context is the same as
the root of whatever drawable was used when the pixmap
or GC was created. The root of a window is the root
window under which the window was created.

Root window

Each screen has a root window covering it. The root
window cannot be reconfigured or unmapped, but other-
wise it acts as a full-fledged window. A root window
has no parent.

Save set

The save set of a client is a list of other clients’
windows that, if they are inferiors of one of the
client’s windows at connection close, should not be de-
stroyed and that should be remapped if currently un-
mapped. Save sets are typically used by window man-
agers to avoid lost windows if the manager should ter-
minate abnormally.

Scanline

A scanline is a list of pixel or bit values viewed as a
horizontal row (all values having the same y coordi-
nate) of an image, with the values ordered by increas-
ing the x coordinate.

Scanline order

An image represented in scanline order contains scan-
lines ordered by increasing the y coordinate.

Screen

A server can provide several independent screens, which
typically have physically independent monitors. This
would be the expected configuration when there is only
a single keyboard and pointer shared among the screens.
A Screen structure contains the information about that
screen and is linked to the Display structure.

Selection

A selection can be thought of as an indirect property
with dynamic type. That is, rather than having the
property stored in the X server, it is maintained by
some client (the owner). A selection is global and is
thought of as belonging to the user and being main-
tained by clients, rather than being private to a par-
ticular window subhierarchy or a particular set of
clients. When a client asks for the contents of a se-
lection, it specifies a selection target type, which
can be used to control the transmitted representation
of the contents. For example, if the selection is
‘‘the last thing the user clicked on,’’ and that is
currently an image, then the target type might specify
whether the contents of the image should be sent in XY
format or Z format.

The target type can also be used to control the class
of contents transmitted; for example, asking for the
‘‘looks’’ (fonts, line spacing, indentation, and so
forth) of a paragraph selection, rather than the text
of the paragraph. The target type can also be used for
other purposes. The protocol does not constrain the
semantics.

Server

The server, which is also referred to as the X server,
provides the basic windowing mechanism. It handles IPC
connections from clients, multiplexes graphics requests
onto the screens, and demultiplexes input back to the
appropriate clients.

Server grabbing

The server can be grabbed by a single client for exclu-
sive use. This prevents processing of any requests
from other client connections until the grab is com-
pleted. This is typically only a transient state for
such things as rubber-banding, pop-up menus, or execut-
ing requests indivisibly.

Shift sequence

ISO2022 defines control characters and escape sequences
which temporarily (single shift) or permanently (lock-
ing shift) cause a different character set to be in ef-
fect (‘‘invoking’’ a character set).

Sibling

Children of the same parent window are known as sibling
windows.

Stacking order

Sibling windows, similar to sheets of paper on a desk,
can stack on top of each other. Windows above both ob-
scure and occlude lower windows. The relationship be-
tween sibling windows is known as the stacking order.

State-dependent encoding

An encoding in which an invocation of a charset can ap-
ply to multiple characters in sequence. A state-depen-
dent encoding begins in an ‘‘initial state’’ and enters
other ‘‘shift states’’ when specific ‘‘shift se-
quences’’ are encountered in the byte sequence. In
ISO2022 terms, this means use of locking shifts, not
single shifts.

State-independent encoding

Any encoding in which the invocations of the charsets
are fixed, or span only a single character. In ISO2022
terms, this means use of at most single shifts, not
locking shifts.

StaticColor

StaticColor can be viewed as a degenerate case of Pseu-
doColor
in which the RGB values are predefined and
read-only.

StaticGray

StaticGray can be viewed as a degenerate case of
GrayScale
in which the gray values are predefined and
read-only. The values are typically linear or
near-linear increasing ramps.

Status

Many Xlib functions return a success status. If the
function does not succeed, however, its arguments are
not disturbed.

Stipple

A stipple pattern is a bitmap that is used to tile a
region to serve as an additional clip mask for a fill
operation with the foreground color.

STRING encoding

Latin-1, plus tab and newline.

String Equivalence

Two ISO Latin-1 STRING8 values are considered equal if
they are the same length and if corresponding bytes are
either equal or are equivalent as follows: decimal
values 65 to 90 inclusive (characters ‘‘A’’ to ‘‘Z’’)
are pairwise equivalent to decimal values 97 to 122 in-
clusive (characters ‘‘a’’ to ‘‘z’’), decimal values 192
to 214 inclusive (characters ‘‘A grave’’ to ‘‘O diaere-
sis’’) are pairwise equivalent to decimal values 224 to
246 inclusive (characters ‘‘a grave’’ to ‘‘o diaere-
sis’’), and decimal values 216 to 222 inclusive (char-
acters ‘‘O oblique’’ to ‘‘THORN’’) are pairwise equiva-
lent to decimal values 246 to 254 inclusive (characters
‘‘o oblique’’ to ‘‘thorn’’).

Tile

A pixmap can be replicated in two dimensions to tile a
region. The pixmap itself is also known as a tile.

Timestamp

A timestamp is a time value expressed in milliseconds.
It is typically the time since the last server reset.
Timestamp values wrap around (after about 49.7 days).
The server, given its current time is represented by
timestamp T, always interprets timestamps from clients
by treating half of the timestamp space as being earli-
er in time than T and half of the timestamp space as
being later in time than T. One timestamp value, rep-
resented by the constant CurrentTime, is never generat-
ed by the server. This value is reserved for use in
requests to represent the current server time.

TrueColor

TrueColor can be viewed as a degenerate case of Direct-
Color
in which the subfields in the pixel value direct-
ly encode the corresponding RGB values. That is, the
colormap has predefined read-only RGB values. The val-
ues are typically linear or near-linear increasing
ramps.

Type

A type is an arbitrary atom used to identify the inter-
pretation of property data. Types are completely unin-
terpreted by the server. They are solely for the bene-
fit of clients. X predefines type atoms for many fre-
quently used types, and clients also can define new
types.

Viewable

A window is viewable if it and all of its ancestors are
mapped. This does not imply that any portion of the
window is actually visible. Graphics requests can be
performed on a window when it is not viewable, but out-
put will not be retained unless the server is maintain-
ing backing store.

Visible

A region of a window is visible if someone looking at
the screen can actually see it; that is, the window is
viewable and the region is not occluded by any other
window.

Whitespace

Any spacing character. On implementations that conform
to the ANSI C library, whitespace is any character for
which isspace returns true.

Window gravity

When windows are resized, subwindows may be reposi-
tioned automatically relative to some position in the
window. This attraction of a subwindow to some part of
its parent is known as window gravity.

Window manager

Manipulation of windows on the screen and much of the
user interface (policy) is typically provided by a win-
dow manager client.

X Portable Character Set

A basic set of 97 characters which are assumed to exist
in all locales supported by Xlib. This set contains
the following characters:

a..z A..Z 0..9
!"#$%&’()*+,-./:;<=>?@[\]^_‘{|}~
<space>, <tab>, and <newline>

This is the left/lower half (also called the G0 set) of the graphic character set of ISO8859-1 plus <space>, <tab>, and <newline>. It is also the set of graphic characters in 7-bit ASCII plus the same three control characters. The actual encoding of these characters on the host is system dependent; see the Host Portable Character Encoding.

XLFD

The X Logical Font Description Conventions that define
a standard syntax for structured font names.

XY format

The data for a pixmap is said to be in XY format if it
is organized as a set of bitmaps representing individu-
al bit planes with the planes appearing from most-sig-
nificant to least-significant bit order.

Z format

The data for a pixmap is said to be in Z format if it
is organized as a set of pixel values in scanline or-
der.

References

ANSI Programming Language - C: ANSI X3.159-1989, December 14, 1989.

Draft Proposed Multibyte Extension of ANSI C, Draft 1.1, November 30, 1989, SC22/C WG/SWG IPSJ/ITSCJ Japan.

ISO2022: Information processing - ISO 7-bit and 8-bit coded character sets - Code extension techniques.

ISO8859-1: Information processing - 8-bit single-byte coded graphic character sets - Part 1: Latin alphabet No. 1.

POSIX: Information Technology - Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX) - Part 1: System Application Program Interface (API) [C Language], ISO/IEC 9945-1.

Text of ISO/IEC/DIS 9541-1, Information Processing - Font Information Interchange - Part 1: Architecture.

X/Open Portability Guide, Issue 3, December 1988 (XPG3), X/Open Company, Ltd, Prentice-Hall, Inc. 1989. ISBN 0-13-685835-8. (See especially Volume 3: XSI Supplementary Definitions.)

22

Xlib − C Library libX11 1.3.1

Table of Contents

Table of Contents

.....................................
ii

Acknowledgments

.......................................
iii

Chapter 1: Introduction to Xlib

.......................
1

1.1. Overview of the X Window System

..................
1

1.2. Errors

...........................................
1

1.3. Standard Header Files

............................
1

1.4. Generic Values and Types

.........................
1

1.5. Naming and Argument Conventions within Xlib

......
1

1.6. Programming Considerations

.......................
1

1.7. Character Sets and Encodings

.....................
1

1.8. Formatting Conventions

...........................
1

Chapter 2: Display Functions

..........................
2

2.1. Opening the Display

..............................
2
2.2. Obtaining Information about the Display, Image

Formats, or Screens

...................................
2

2.2.1. Display Macros

.................................
2

2.2.2. Image Format Functions and Macros

..............
2

2.2.3. Screen Information Macros

......................
2

2.3. Generating a NoOperation Protocol Request

........
2

2.4. Freeing Client-Created Data

......................
2

2.5. Closing the Display

..............................
2

2.6. Using X Server Connection Close Operations

.......
2

2.7. Using Xlib with Threads

..........................
2

2.8. Using Internal Connections

.......................
2

Chapter 3: Window Functions

...........................
3

3.1. Visual Types

.....................................
3

3.2. Window Attributes

................................
3

3.2.1. Background Attribute

...........................
3

3.2.2. Border Attribute

...............................
3

3.2.3. Gravity Attributes

.............................
3

3.2.4. Backing Store Attribute

........................
3

3.2.5. Save Under Flag

................................
3

3.2.6. Backing Planes and Backing Pixel Attributes

....
3
3.2.7. Event Mask and Do Not Propagate Mask

Attributes

............................................
3

3.2.8. Override Redirect Flag

.........................
3

3.2.9. Colormap Attribute

.............................
3

3.2.10. Cursor Attribute

..............................
3

3.3. Creating Windows

.................................
3

3.4. Destroying Windows

...............................
3

3.5. Mapping Windows

..................................
3

3.6. Unmapping Windows

................................
3

3.7. Configuring Windows

..............................
3

3.8. Changing Window Stacking Order

...................
3

3.9. Changing Window Attributes

.......................
3

Chapter 4: Window Information Functions

...............
4

4.1. Obtaining Window Information

.....................
4

4.2. Translating Screen Coordinates

...................
4

4.3. Properties and Atoms

.............................
4

4.4. Obtaining and Changing Window Properties

.........
4

4.5. Selections

.......................................
4

Chapter 5: Pixmap and Cursor Functions

................
5

5.1. Creating and Freeing Pixmaps

.....................
5

5.2. Creating, Recoloring, and Freeing Cursors

........
5

Chapter 6: Color Management Functions

.................
6

6.1. Color Structures

.................................
6

6.2. Color Strings

....................................
6

6.2.1. RGB Device String Specification

................
6

6.2.2. RGB Intensity String Specification

.............
6

6.2.3. Device-Independent String Specifications

.......
6

6.3. Color Conversion Contexts and Gamut Mapping

......
6

6.4. Creating, Copying, and Destroying Colormaps

......
6

6.5. Mapping Color Names to Values

....................
6

6.6. Allocating and Freeing Color Cells

...............
6

6.7. Modifying and Querying Colormap Cells

............
6

6.8. Color Conversion Context Functions

...............
6
6.8.1. Getting and Setting the Color Conversion

Context of a Colormap

.................................
6
6.8.2. Obtaining the Default Color Conversion

Context

...............................................
6

6.8.3. Color Conversion Context Macros

................
6
6.8.4. Modifying Attributes of a Color Conversion

Context

...............................................
6
6.8.5. Creating and Freeing a Color Conversion

Context

...............................................
6

6.9. Converting between Color Spaces

..................
6

6.10. Callback Functions

..............................
6

6.10.1. Prototype Gamut Compression Procedure

.........
6

6.10.2. Supplied Gamut Compression Procedures

.........
6

6.10.3. Prototype White Point Adjustment Procedure

....
6

6.10.4. Supplied White Point Adjustment Procedures

....
6

6.11. Gamut Querying Functions

........................
6

6.11.1. Red, Green, and Blue Queries

..................
6

6.11.2. CIELab Queries

................................
6

6.11.3. CIELuv Queries

................................
6

6.11.4. TekHVC Queries

................................
6

6.12. Color Management Extensions

.....................
6

6.12.1. Color Spaces

..................................
6

6.12.2. Adding Device-Independent Color Spaces

........
6

6.12.3. Querying Color Space Format and Prefix

........
6

6.12.4. Creating Additional Color Spaces

..............
6

6.12.5. Parse String Callback

.........................
6

6.12.6. Color Specification Conversion Callback

.......
6

6.12.7. Function Sets

.................................
6

6.12.8. Adding Function Sets

..........................
6

6.12.9. Creating Additional Function Sets

.............
6

Chapter 7: Graphics Context Functions

.................
7

7.1. Manipulating Graphics Context/State

..............
7

7.2. Using Graphics Context Convenience Routines

......
7
7.2.1. Setting the Foreground, Background, Function,

or Plane Mask

.........................................
7

7.2.2. Setting the Line Attributes and Dashes

.........
7

7.2.3. Setting the Fill Style and Fill Rule

...........
7

7.2.4. Setting the Fill Tile and Stipple

..............
7

7.2.5. Setting the Current Font

.......................
7

7.2.6. Setting the Clip Region

........................
7
7.2.7. Setting the Arc Mode, Subwindow Mode, and

Graphics Exposure

.....................................
7

Chapter 8: Graphics Functions

.........................
8

8.1. Clearing Areas

...................................
8

8.2. Copying Areas

....................................
8

8.3. Drawing Points, Lines, Rectangles, and Arcs

......
8

8.3.1. Drawing Single and Multiple Points

.............
8

8.3.2. Drawing Single and Multiple Lines

..............
8

8.3.3. Drawing Single and Multiple Rectangles

.........
8

8.3.4. Drawing Single and Multiple Arcs

...............
8

8.4. Filling Areas

....................................
8

8.4.1. Filling Single and Multiple Rectangles

.........
8

8.4.2. Filling a Single Polygon

.......................
8

8.4.3. Filling Single and Multiple Arcs

...............
8

8.5. Font Metrics

.....................................
8

8.5.1. Loading and Freeing Fonts

......................
8
8.5.2. Obtaining and Freeing Font Names and

Information

...........................................
8

8.5.3. Computing Character String Sizes

...............
8

8.5.4. Computing Logical Extents

......................
8

8.5.5. Querying Character String Sizes

................
8

8.6. Drawing Text

.....................................
8

8.6.1. Drawing Complex Text

...........................
8

8.6.2. Drawing Text Characters

........................
8

8.6.3. Drawing Image Text Characters

..................
8

8.7. Transferring Images between Client and Server

....
8

Chapter 9: Window and Session Manager Functions

.......
9

9.1. Changing the Parent of a Window

..................
9

9.2. Controlling the Lifetime of a Window

.............
9

9.3. Managing Installed Colormaps

.....................
9

9.4. Setting and Retrieving the Font Search Path

......
9

9.5. Grabbing the Server

..............................
9

9.6. Killing Clients

..................................
9

9.7. Controlling the Screen Saver

.....................
9

9.8. Controlling Host Access

..........................
9

9.8.1. Adding, Getting, or Removing Hosts

.............
9
9.8.2. Changing, Enabling, or Disabling Access

Control

...............................................
9

Chapter 10: Events

....................................
10

10.1. Event Types

.....................................
10

10.2. Event Structures

................................
10

10.3. Event Masks

.....................................
10

10.4. Event Processing Overview

.......................
10

10.5. Keyboard and Pointer Events

.....................
10

10.5.1. Pointer Button Events

.........................
10

10.5.2. Keyboard and Pointer Events

...................
10

10.6. Window Entry/Exit Events

........................
10

10.6.1. Normal Entry/Exit Events

......................
10

10.6.2. Grab and Ungrab Entry/Exit Events

.............
10

10.7. Input Focus Events

..............................
10
10.7.1. Normal Focus Events and Focus Events While

Grabbed

...............................................
10

10.7.2. Focus Events Generated by Grabs

...............
10

10.8. Key Map State Notification Events

...............
10

10.9. Exposure Events

.................................
10

10.9.1. Expose Events

.................................
10

10.9.2. GraphicsExpose and NoExpose Events

............
10

10.10. Window State Change Events

.....................
10

10.10.1. CirculateNotify Events

.......................
10

10.10.2. ConfigureNotify Events

.......................
10

10.10.3. CreateNotify Events

..........................
10

10.10.4. DestroyNotify Events

.........................
10

10.10.5. GravityNotify Events

.........................
10

10.10.6. MapNotify Events

.............................
10

10.10.7. MappingNotify Events

.........................
10

10.10.8. ReparentNotify Events

........................
10

10.10.9. UnmapNotify Events

...........................
10

10.10.10. VisibilityNotify Events

.....................
10

10.11. Structure Control Events

.......................
10

10.11.1. CirculateRequest Events

......................
10

10.11.2. ConfigureRequest Events

......................
10

10.11.3. MapRequest Events

............................
10

10.11.4. ResizeRequest Events

.........................
10

10.12. Colormap State Change Events

...................
10

10.13. Client Communication Events

....................
10

10.13.1. ClientMessage Events

.........................
10

10.13.2. PropertyNotify Events

........................
10

10.13.3. SelectionClear Events

........................
10

10.13.4. SelectionRequest Events

......................
10

10.13.5. SelectionNotify Events

.......................
10

Chapter 11: Event Handling Functions

..................
11

11.1. Selecting Events

................................
11

11.2. Handling the Output Buffer

......................
11

11.3. Event Queue Management

..........................
11

11.4. Manipulating the Event Queue

....................
11

11.4.1. Returning the Next Event

......................
11
11.4.2. Selecting Events Using a Predicate Procedure

.......................................................

11
11.4.3. Selecting Events Using a Window or Event

Mask

..................................................
11

11.5. Putting an Event Back into the Queue

............
11

11.6. Sending Events to Other Applications

............
11

11.7. Getting Pointer Motion History

..................
11

11.8. Handling Protocol Errors

........................
11

11.8.1. Enabling or Disabling Synchronization

.........
11

11.8.2. Using the Default Error Handlers

..............
11

Chapter 12: Input Device Functions

....................
12

12.1. Pointer Grabbing

................................
12

12.2. Keyboard Grabbing

...............................
12

12.3. Resuming Event Processing

.......................
12

12.4. Moving the Pointer

..............................
12

12.5. Controlling Input Focus

.........................
12
12.6. Manipulating the Keyboard and Pointer Settings

.......................................................

12

12.7. Manipulating the Keyboard Encoding

..............
12
Chapter 13: Locales and Internationalized Text

Functions

.............................................
13

13.1. X Locale Management

.............................
13

13.2. Locale and Modifier Dependencies

................
13

13.3. Variable Argument Lists

.........................
13

13.4. Output Methods

..................................
13

13.4.1. Output Method Overview

........................
13

13.4.2. Output Method Functions

.......................
13

13.4.3. X Output Method Values

........................
13

13.4.3.1. Required Char Set

...........................
13

13.4.3.2. Query Orientation

...........................
13

13.4.3.3. Directional Dependent Drawing

...............
13

13.4.3.4. Context Dependent Drawing

...................
13

13.4.4. Output Context Functions

......................
13

13.4.5. Output Context Values

.........................
13

13.4.5.1. Base Font Name

..............................
13

13.4.5.2. Missing CharSet

.............................
13

13.4.5.3. Default String

..............................
13

13.4.5.4. Orientation

.................................
13

13.4.5.5. Resource Name and Class

.....................
13

13.4.5.6. Font Info

...................................
13

13.4.5.7. OM Automatic

................................
13

13.4.6. Creating and Freeing a Font Set

...............
13

13.4.7. Obtaining Font Set Metrics

....................
13

13.4.8. Drawing Text Using Font Sets

..................
13

13.5. Input Methods

...................................
13

13.5.1. Input Method Overview

.........................
13

13.5.1.1. Input Method Architecture

...................
13

13.5.1.2. Input Contexts

..............................
13

13.5.1.3. Getting Keyboard Input

......................
13

13.5.1.4. Focus Management

............................
13

13.5.1.5. Geometry Management

.........................
13

13.5.1.6. Event Filtering

.............................
13

13.5.1.7. Callbacks

...................................
13

13.5.1.8. Visible Position Feedback Masks

.............
13

13.5.1.9. Preedit String Management

...................
13

13.5.2. Input Method Management

.......................
13

13.5.2.1. Hot Keys

....................................
13

13.5.2.2. Preedit State Operation

.....................
13

13.5.3. Input Method Functions

........................
13

13.5.4. Input Method Values

...........................
13

13.5.4.1. Query Input Style

...........................
13

13.5.4.2. Resource Name and Class

.....................
13

13.5.4.3. Destroy Callback

............................
13

13.5.4.4. Query IM/IC Values List

.....................
13

13.5.4.5. Visible Position

............................
13

13.5.4.6. Preedit Callback Behavior

...................
13

13.5.5. Input Context Functions

.......................
13

13.5.6. Input Context Values

..........................
13

13.5.6.1. Input Style

.................................
13

13.5.6.2. Client Window

...............................
13

13.5.6.3. Focus Window

................................
13

13.5.6.4. Resource Name and Class

.....................
13

13.5.6.5. Geometry Callback

...........................
13

13.5.6.6. Filter Events

...............................
13

13.5.6.7. Destroy Callback

............................
13

13.5.6.8. String Conversion Callback

..................
13

13.5.6.9. String Conversion

...........................
13

13.5.6.10. Reset State

................................
13

13.5.6.11. Hot Keys

...................................
13

13.5.6.12. Hot Key State

..............................
13

13.5.6.13. Preedit and Status Attributes

..............
13

13.5.6.13.1. Area

.....................................
13

13.5.6.13.2. Area Needed

..............................
13

13.5.6.13.3. Spot Location

............................
13

13.5.6.13.4. Colormap

.................................
13

13.5.6.13.5. Foreground and Background

................
13

13.5.6.13.6. Background Pixmap

........................
13

13.5.6.13.7. Font Set

.................................
13

13.5.6.13.8. Line Spacing

.............................
13

13.5.6.13.9. Cursor

...................................
13

13.5.6.13.10. Preedit State

...........................
13

13.5.6.13.11. Preedit State Notify Callback

...........
13

13.5.6.13.12. Preedit and Status Callbacks

............
13

13.5.7. Input Method Callback Semantics

...............
13

13.5.7.1. Geometry Callback

...........................
13

13.5.7.2. Destroy Callback

............................
13

13.5.7.3. String Conversion Callback

..................
13

13.5.7.4. Preedit State Callbacks

.....................
13

13.5.7.5. Preedit Draw Callback

.......................
13

13.5.7.6. Preedit Caret Callback

......................
13

13.5.7.7. Status Callbacks

............................
13

13.5.8. Event Filtering

...............................
13

13.5.9. Getting Keyboard Input

........................
13

13.5.10. Input Method Conventions

.....................
13

13.5.10.1. Client Conventions

.........................
13

13.5.10.2. Synchronization Conventions

................
13

13.6. String Constants

................................
13

Chapter 14: Inter-Client Communication Functions

......
14

14.1. Client to Window Manager Communication

..........
14

14.1.1. Manipulating Top-Level Windows

................
14

14.1.2. Converting String Lists

.......................
14

14.1.3. Setting and Reading Text Properties

...........
14

14.1.4. Setting and Reading the WM_NAME Property

......
14
14.1.5. Setting and Reading the WM_ICON_NAME

Property

..............................................
14

14.1.6. Setting and Reading the WM_HINTS Property

.....
14
14.1.7. Setting and Reading the WM_NORMAL_HINTS

Property

..............................................
14

14.1.8. Setting and Reading the WM_CLASS Property

.....
14
14.1.9. Setting and Reading the WM_TRANSIENT_FOR

Property

..............................................
14
14.1.10. Setting and Reading the WM_PROTOCOLS

Property

..............................................
14
14.1.11. Setting and Reading the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS

Property

..............................................
14
14.1.12. Setting and Reading the WM_ICON_SIZE

Property

..............................................
14
14.1.13. Using Window Manager Convenience Functions

.......................................................

14

14.2. Client to Session Manager Communication

.........
14
14.2.1. Setting and Reading the WM_COMMAND Property

.......................................................

14
14.2.2. Setting and Reading the WM_CLIENT_MACHINE

Property

..............................................
14

14.3. Standard Colormaps

..............................
14

14.3.1. Standard Colormap Properties and Atoms

........
14

14.3.2. Setting and Obtaining Standard Colormaps

......
14

Chapter 15: Resource Manager Functions

................
15

15.1. Resource File Syntax

............................
15

15.2. Resource Manager Matching Rules

.................
15

15.3. Quarks

..........................................
15

15.4. Creating and Storing Databases

..................
15

15.5. Merging Resource Databases

......................
15

15.6. Looking Up Resources

............................
15

15.7. Storing into a Resource Database

................
15

15.8. Enumerating Database Entries

....................
15

15.9. Parsing Command Line Options

....................
15

Chapter 16: Application Utility Functions

.............
16

16.1. Using Keyboard Utility Functions

................
16

16.1.1. KeySym Classification Macros

..................
16

16.2. Using Latin-1 Keyboard Event Functions

..........
16

16.3. Allocating Permanent Storage

....................
16

16.4. Parsing the Window Geometry

.....................
16

16.5. Manipulating Regions

............................
16

16.5.1. Creating, Copying, or Destroying Regions

......
16

16.5.2. Moving or Shrinking Regions

...................
16

16.5.3. Computing with Regions

........................
16

16.5.4. Determining if Regions Are Empty or Equal

.....
16
16.5.5. Locating a Point or a Rectangle in a Region

.......................................................

16

16.6. Using Cut Buffers

...............................
16

16.7. Determining the Appropriate Visual Type

.........
16

16.8. Manipulating Images

.............................
16

16.9. Manipulating Bitmaps

............................
16

16.10. Using the Context Manager

......................
16

Appendix A: Xlib Functions and Protocol Requests

......
17

Appendix B: X Font Cursors

...........................
19

Appendix C: Extensions

................................
20

Appendix D: Compatibility Functions

..............
21

Glossary

.........................................
22

Index

.................................................
23